WO2004016767A2 - Evolving new molecular function - Google Patents

Evolving new molecular function Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2004016767A2
WO2004016767A2 PCT/US2003/025984 US0325984W WO2004016767A2 WO 2004016767 A2 WO2004016767 A2 WO 2004016767A2 US 0325984 W US0325984 W US 0325984W WO 2004016767 A2 WO2004016767 A2 WO 2004016767A2
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
reactive
oligonucleotide
template
unit
codon
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2003/025984
Other languages
French (fr)
Other versions
WO2004016767A3 (en
Inventor
David R. Liu
Zev J. Gartner
Jeffrey B. Doyon
Christopher T. Calderone
Matthew W. Kanan
Xiaoyu Li
Thomas M. Snyder
Daniel M. Rosenbaum
Original Assignee
The President And Fellows Of Harvard College
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by The President And Fellows Of Harvard College filed Critical The President And Fellows Of Harvard College
Priority to JP2005502071A priority Critical patent/JP4657919B2/en
Priority to CA2495881A priority patent/CA2495881C/en
Priority to AU2003263937A priority patent/AU2003263937B2/en
Priority to EP03788662.9A priority patent/EP1540013B1/en
Publication of WO2004016767A2 publication Critical patent/WO2004016767A2/en
Publication of WO2004016767A3 publication Critical patent/WO2004016767A3/en
Priority to AU2010202702A priority patent/AU2010202702B2/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12QMEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
    • C12Q1/00Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions
    • C12Q1/68Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions involving nucleic acids
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/10Processes for the isolation, preparation or purification of DNA or RNA
    • C12N15/1034Isolating an individual clone by screening libraries
    • C12N15/1068Template (nucleic acid) mediated chemical library synthesis, e.g. chemical and enzymatical DNA-templated organic molecule synthesis, libraries prepared by non ribosomal polypeptide synthesis [NRPS], DNA/RNA-polymerase mediated polypeptide synthesis

Definitions

  • the invention provides a variety of methods and compositions that expand the scope of template-directed synthesis, selection, amplification and evolution of molecules of interest.
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis the information encoded within a nucleic acid template is used to bring two or more reactants together into reactive proximity. These methods permit the creation of, for example, small molecule and polymer libraries that have not been possible to create to date using conventional combinational chemistries.
  • the invention provides a method of performing nucleic acid- templated synthesis using a template having an "omega" or " ⁇ " type architecture.
  • This type of template permits distance-dependent nucleic acid-templated reactions to be encoded by bases far removed from the associated reactive unit.
  • the method involves providing (i) a template comprising a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a codon and (ii) a transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon that is capable of annealing to the codon.
  • the codon and/or the anti- codon include first and second regions spaced apart from one another.
  • the oligonucleotides then are annealed together to bring the reactive units into reactive proximity.
  • the codon (or anti-codon) with the spaced-apart regions produce a loop of oligonucleotides not annealed to the corresponding anti-codon (or codon).
  • a covalent bond-forming reaction then is induced between the reactive units to produce the reaction product.
  • At least one ofthe reactive units are attached adjacent a terminal region of its corresponding oligonucleotide.
  • the codon or anti- codon is disposed more than one base away (for example, 10, 20, 30 bases or more) from its corresponding reactive unit.
  • the first spaced apart region typically is disposed directly adjacent a terminus of its corresponding oligonucleotide.
  • the first spaced apart region preferably includes, for example, three, four, or five nucleotides, although other embodiments (e.g., more than five nucleotides) are also envisioned.
  • the second region may be disposed, for example, at least twenty or at least thirty bases away from its corresponding reactive unit.
  • the end ofthe second region closest to the reactive unit may be disposed, for example, at least ten, twenty, thirty or more bases from the end ofthe oligonucleotide attached to its reactive unit.
  • the template may include additional (e.g., 2, 3, A, or more than 4) codons, in which case a corresponding number of transfer units can be annealed to the template, optionally permitting multi-step or alternative syntheses.
  • the invention provides a method of performing a nucleic acid- templated synthesis using a template having a "T" type architecture.
  • the T architecture permits two nucleic acid-templated reactions to take place on a single template in a single step.
  • the method involves providing (i) a template comprising a first reactive unit (e.g., a scaffold molecule) associated with a first oligonucleotide having a codon, and (ii) a transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide having an anti-codon capable of annealing to the codon.
  • the first reactive unit is attached, preferably covalently, to an attachment site intermediate the proximal and distal ends ofthe first oligonucleotide ofthe template.
  • the oligonucleotides ofthe template and transfer unit are annealed to one another to bring the reactive units into reactive proximity, and a covalent bond-forming reaction between the reactive units is induced.
  • the template also includes a second, different codon capable of annealing to a' second, different anti-codon sequence of a second, different transfer unit.
  • the first codon is located proximal to the attachment site and the second codon, if present, is located distal to the attachment site.
  • the second transfer unit may bind to the template at the second codon position.
  • the first anti-codon of Jhe first transfer unit anneals to the first codon ofthe template and the second anti-codon ofthe second transfer unit anneals to the second codon ofthe template.
  • the invention provides a series of methods for increasing reaction selectivity between reactants in a templated synthesis.
  • the method comprises providing a template and at least two transfer units.
  • the template comprises a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a predetermined codon sequence.
  • the first transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the codon sequence.
  • the second transfer unit comprises a third reactive unit, different from the second reactive unit.
  • the third reactive unit is associated with a third oligonucleotide that lacks an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the codon sequence.
  • the template and transfer units are mixed under conditions to permit annealing ofthe second oligonucleotide to the first oligonucleotide, thereby to enhance covalent bond formation between the second and first reactive units relative to covalent bond formation between the third and first reactive units.
  • This method may be particularly helpful when the second and third reactive units are each capable of reacting independently with the first reactive unit. Furthermore, the method may also be helpful when the second and third reactive units are capable of reacting with one another, for example, to modify or inactivate one another. Accordingly, this type of method permits a series of otherwise incompatible reactions to occur in the same solution, for example, where a reaction between the second and third reactive units is incompatible with a reaction between the second reactive unit and the first reactive unit. The method may enhance covalent bond formation between the first and second reactive units by at least 2-fold, at least 5-fold, at least 10-fold, or at least 50-fold relative to cbvalentjbond formation between the first and third reactive units.
  • the template, the, first transfer unit, and/or the second transfer, unit are associated with a capturable moiety for example, biotin, avidin, or streptavidin. If a , capturable moiety is present, the method may include capturing the capturable moiety as a way to enrich a reaction product from a reaction mixture.
  • the method comprises providing (i) a template comprising a first oligonucleotide having first and second cod ⁇ n seq ⁇ ences (ii) a first transfer unit, (iii) a second transfer unit, and (iv) a third transfer unit.
  • the first transfer unit comprises a first reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising a first anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the first codon sequence.
  • the second transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a third oligonucleotide comprising a second anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the second codon sequence.
  • the third transfer unit comprises a third reactive unit associated with a fourth oligonucleotide sequence that lacks an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the first or second codon sequences.
  • the template, first transfer unit, second transfer unit, and third transfer unit then are mixed under conditions to permit (i) annealing ofthe first anti-codon sequence to the first codon sequence and (ii) annealing ofthe second anti-codon sequence to the second codon sequence thereby to enhance covalent bond formation between the first and second reactive units relative to covalent bond formation between the third reactive unit and the first reactive unit and/or between the third reactive unit the second reactive unit.
  • This type of method may be particularly useful for producing non- natural polymers by nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • the template is associated with a capturable moiety, for example, biotin, avidin, or streptavidin.
  • the capturable moiety may also be a reaction product resulting from a reaction between the first and second reactive units when the first and second reactive units are annealed to a template. If a capturable moiety is present, the method may include capturing the capturable moiety as a way to enrich a reaction production from the reaction mixture.
  • the third reactive unit is capable of reacting with the first and/or second reactive units.
  • the reaction between the first and third reactive units and/or between the second and third reactive units may be incompatible with the reaction between the first and second reactive units.
  • the method may enhance covalent bond formation between the first and second reactive units by at least 2-fold, at least 5-fold, at ieast 10- fold, or at least 50- fold relative to covalent bond formation between the first and third reactive units.
  • the invention provides a series of methods for performing stereoselective nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • the stereoselectivity ofthe synthesis may result from the choice of a particular template, transfer unit, reactive unit, hybridized template and transfer unit, stereoselective catalyst, or any combination ofthe above.
  • the resulting product may be at least 60%, at least 70%, at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 98%, or at least 99% stereochemically pure.
  • the method involves providing (i) a template comprising a first oligonucleotide that optionally is associated with a reactive unit and (ii) one or more transfer units, each comprising a second oligonucleotide associated with a reactive unit.
  • Annealing 'of the first and second oligonucleotides brings at least two reactive units into reactive proximity and to react to produce a reaction product where the reaction product contains a chiral center and is of at least 60%, more preferably at least 80%, and more preferably at least 95% stereochemically pure at the chiral center. It is contemplated that this method can be accomplished when one reactive unit is associated with the template and the other reactive unit is associated with the transfer unit. Also, it is contemplated that this method can be accomplished when the template does not provide a reactive unit and two transfer units when they anneal to the template provide the two reactive units that come into reactive proximity to produce the reaction product.
  • the method involves providing at least two templates and at least one transfer unit.
  • One template includes a first oligonucleotide associated with a first reactive unit comprising a first stereochemical configuration
  • the other template includes another first oligonucleotide associated with another first reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration.
  • the transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide including a sequence complementary to a sequence ofthe first oligonucleotide ofthe template.
  • the first and, second oligonucleotides then are annealed under conditions to permit the second reactive unit ofthe transfer unit to react preferentially with either, the first reactive unit ofthe first stereochemical configuration or the first reactive unit ofthe second stereochemical configuration to produce a reaction product.
  • the resulting reaction product may have a particular stereochemical configuratiqn.
  • a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation ofthe first oligonucleotide ofthe template determines which one ofthe first , reactive units reacts with the second reactive unit.
  • the method involves providing at least one template and at least two transfer units.
  • the template includes a first oligonucleotide associated with a first reactive unit.
  • One transfer unit comprises a second oligonucleotide associated with a second , reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration
  • the other transfer unit comprises another second oligonucleotide associated with a second reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration.
  • a sequence ofthe second oligonucleotides is complementary to a sequence ofthe first oligonucleotide.
  • the first and second oligonucleotides then are annealed under conditions to permit the first reactive unit ofthe template to react preferentially with either the second reactive unit having the first stereochemical configuration or with the second reactive unit having the second stereochemical configuration to produce a reaction product.
  • the resulting reaction product may have a particular stereochemical configuration.
  • a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation ofthe second oligonucleotide determines which ofthe second reactive units reacts with the first reactive unit.
  • the method involves providing at least one template and at least two transfer units, wherein one or optionally both ofthe transfer units comprise a pair of reactive units with one reactive unit ofthe pair having a first stereochemical configuration and the other reactive unit ofthe pair having a second, different stereochemical configuration.
  • the template comprises a first oligonucleotide comprising a first codon sequence and a second codon sequence.
  • One transfer unit of a first pair of transfer units includes a second oligonucleotide with a first anti-codon sequence associated with a first reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration.
  • the other transfer unit ofthe first pair of transfer units includes another second oligonucleotide associated with a second stereochemical configuration ofthe first reactive unit.
  • the second transfer unit includes a third oligonucleotide with a second anti-codon sequence associated with a second reactive unit.
  • the template, the first pair of transfer units, arid the second transfer unit are annealed to permit a member of the first pair of transfer units to react . preferentially with the second transfer unit to produce a reaction product.
  • the resulting reaction product may have a particular stereochemical configuration.
  • a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation of the second oligonucleotide determines which member of the first .pair of transfer units reacts preferentially to produce the reaction product.
  • the method involves providing a template and at least two pairs of transfer units.
  • the template comprises a first oligonucleotide comprising first and second codon sequences.
  • One transfer unit ofthe first pair comprises a second oligonucleotide with a first anti-codon sequence associated with a first reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration.
  • the other transfer unit ofthe first pair comprises the second oligonucleotide with the first anti-codon sequence associated with a first reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration.
  • One transfer unit ofthe second pair of transfer units comprises a third oligonucleotide having a second, different anti-codon sequence associated with a second reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration.
  • the other transfer unit ofthe second pair comprises the third oligonucleotide with the second anti-codon sequence associated with the second reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration.
  • the template, the first pair of transfer units and the second pair of transfer units are annealed to permit a member ofthe first pair of transfer units to react preferentially with a member ofthe second pair of transfer units to produce a reaction product.
  • a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation ofthe second oligonucleotide determines which member ofthe first pair of transfer units reacts preferentially to produce the reaction product.
  • a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation ofthe third oligonucleotide determines which member ofthe second pair of transfer units reacts preferentially to produce the reaction product.
  • the invention provides a method for enriching a product of a templated synthesis reaction.
  • the method comprises providing a first library of molecules comprising a plurality of reaction products associated with a corresponding plurality of oligonucleotides, wherein each oligonucleotide comprises a nucleotide sequence indicative ofthe , associated reaction product.
  • a portion of the reaction products in the first library are capable of binding to a preselected moiety.
  • the first library theri is exposed to the binding moiety under conditions to permit reaction product capable of binding the binding moiety to do so.
  • Unbound reaction products are' removed, and bound reaction product then is eluted from the binding moiety to produce a second library of molecules enriched at least 10-fold, more preferably at' least 50-fold, relative to the first library, for reaction products that bind the binding moiety.
  • the binding moiety for example, a target biomolecule, for example, a protein
  • the second library is enriched at least 100-fold or at least 1 ,000-fold for reaction products that bind to the binding moiety.
  • the steps of exposing the library to the binding moiety, removing unbound reaction products, and eluting bound reaction products can be repeated (e.g., repeated one, two, three or more times). Repetition of these steps preferably yields a second library enriched at least 1, 000-fold, more preferably, at least 10,000-fold, or, more preferably, at least 100, 000-fold, for reaction products that bind to the binding moiety.
  • the oligonucleotide attached to the selected library member includes a first sequence that identifies a first reactive unit that produced the reaction product bindable by the preselected binding moiety.
  • the oligonucleotide also includes a second sequence that identifies a second reactive unit that produced the reaction product bindable by the preselected binding moiety.
  • the method may further comprise the step of amplifying the oligonucleotide associated with the enriched reaction product and, preferably, determining the sequence ofthe amplified oligonucleotide.
  • the reaction product can be further characterized by using information encoded within the sequence ofthe oligonucleotide. For example, the sequence ofthe oligonucleotide may be determined and then from the sequence it is possible to determine what reactive units reacted to produce the reaction product. Using a similar approach, it is possible to identify the existence of new chemical reactions that produced the reaction product.
  • the invention provides a variety of methods for identifying the existence of new chemical reactions.
  • One approach invblves providing a library of molecules ' comprising a plurality of reaction products associated with a corresponding plurality of oligonucleotides, wherein each oligonucleotide includes a nucleotide sequence indicative of an associated'reaction product.
  • a particular reaction product associated with its corresponding oligonucleotide then is selected, and characterized. Following characterizatipn ofthe reaction ' product and identification ofthe reactive units that reacted to create the reaction product, it i ⁇ possible to identify one or more new chemical' reactions necessary to produce the reaction product. ' , . . . [0034]
  • the method further includes, after selecting the reaction product, amplifying its corresponding oligonucleotide.
  • the amplified oligonucleotide can then be sequenced to identify what reactive units reacted to produce the reaction product 1
  • the oligonucleotide may also be amplified for use in preparing more ofthe selected reaction product.
  • the oligonucleotide niay be mutated, and the resulting mutated oligonucleotide may be used in the creation of a second generation library.
  • a second approach involves providing (i) a template and (ii) a first transfer unit.
  • the template comprises a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a codon.
  • the transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon capable of annealing to the codon.
  • the oligonucleotides are annealed to bring the first and second reactive units into reactive proximity.
  • a covalent bond-forming reaction is induced between the reactive units to produce a reaction product.
  • the reaction product then is characterized, and a new chemical reaction necessary to make the reaction product is identified using information encoded by the template to identify the first and second reactive units that reacted to produce the reaction product.
  • the method may also include the step of selecting the reaction product prior to its characterization.
  • the invention involves providing at least (i) a template, (ii) a first transfer unit and (iii) a second transfer unit.
  • the first transfer unit comprises a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide.
  • the second transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide.
  • the template includes sequences capable of annealing to the first and second oligonucleotides.
  • the oligonucleotides are annealed to the template to bring the reactive units into reactive proximity and a covalent bond- forming reaction is induced between the reactive units to produce a reaction product:
  • the reaction product then is characterized, for example, by using information encoded by the template to identify the first and second reactive units that reacted with one another to produce the reaction product. Based on the characterization, it is then possible to identify one or more , new chemical reactions that were necessary to make the reaction product.
  • the method may also include the step of selecting the reaction product prior to its characterization.
  • association describes the interaction between or among two or more groups, moieties, compounds, monomers, etc.
  • two or more entities are “associated with” one another as described herein, they are linked by a direct or indirect covalent or non-covalent interaction.
  • the association is covalent.
  • the covalent association may be, for example, but without limitation, through an amide, ester, carbon-carbon, disulfide, carbamate, ether, thioether, urea, amine, or carbonate linkage.
  • the covalent association may also include a linker moiety, for example, a photocleavable linker.
  • Desirable non-covalent interactions include hydrogen bonding, van der Waals interactions, dipole-dipole interactions, pi stacking interactions, hydrophobic interactions, magnetic interactions, electrostatic interactions, etc. Also, two or more entities or agents may be "associated with" one another by being present together in the same composition.
  • biological macromolecule refers to a polynucleotide
  • RNA e.g., RNA, DNA, RNA/DNA hybrid
  • protein e.g., peptide, lipid, or polysaccharide.
  • the biological macromolecule may be naturally occurring or non-naturally occurring.
  • a biological macromolecule has a molecular weight greater than about 5,000 Daltons.
  • polynucleotide refers to a polymer of nucleotides.
  • the polymer may include, without limitation, natural nucleosides (i.e., adenosine, thymidine, guanosine, cytidine, uridine, deoxyadenosine, deoxythymidine, deoxyguanosine; and deoxycytidihe), nucleoside analogs 1 (e.g., 2- aminoadenoisine, 2-thi , othymidine, ihosihe, pyrrolo-pyrimidine, 3-methyl adenosine, 5- ' methylcytidine, C5-bromouridine, C5-fluorduridine, C5-iodouridine, C5-pfopynyl-uridine, C5-pro ⁇ ynyl-cytidine,
  • oligonucleotides may also include other polymers of bases having a modified backbone, such as > a locked nucleic acid (LNA), a peptide nucleic acid (PNA), a threose nucleic acid (TNA) and any other polymers capable of serving as a template for an amplification reaction using an amplification technique, for example, a polymerase chain reaction, a ligase chain reaction, or non-enzymatic, template-directed replication.
  • LNA locked nucleic acid
  • PNA peptide nucleic acid
  • TAA threose nucleic acid
  • small molecule refers to an organic compound either synthesized in the laboratory or found in nature having a molecular weight less than 10,000 grams per mole, optionally less than 5,000 grams per mole, and optionally less than 2,000 grams per mole.
  • small molecule scaffold or “molecular scaffold” as used herein, refer to a chemical compound having at least one site or chemical moiety suitable for functionalization.
  • the small molecule scaffold or molecular scaffold may have two, three, four, five or more sites or chemical moieties suitable for functionalization. These functionalization sites may be protected or masked as would be appreciated by one of skill in this art. The sites may also be found on an underlying ring structure or backbone.
  • transfer unit refers to a molecule comprising an oligonucleotide having an anti-codon sequence associated with a reactive unit including, for example, but not limited to, a building block, monomer, monomer unit, molecular scaffold, or other reactant useful in template mediated chemical synthesis.
  • template refers to a molecule comprising an oligonucleotide having at least one codon sequence suitable for a template mediated chemical synthesis.
  • the template optionally may comprise (i) a plurality of codon sequences, (ii) an amplification means, for example, a PCR primer binding site or a sequence complementary thereto, (iii) a reactive unit associated therewith, (iv) a combination of (i) and (ii), (v) a combination of (i) and (iii), (vi) a combination of (ii) and (iii), or a combination of (i), (ii) and ,
  • codon and anti-codon as used herein, refer to complementary oligonucleotide sequences in the template and in the transfer unit, respectively, that permit the transfer unit to anneal to the template during template mediated chemical synthesis.
  • compositions ofthe present invention also consist essentially of, or consist of, the recited components ⁇ and that the processes ofthe present invention also consist essentially of, or consist of, the recited processing steps. Further, it should be understood that the order of steps or order for performing certain actions are immaterial so long as the invention remains operable. Moreover, two or more steps or actions may be conducted simultaneously. DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIG. 1 depicts known sequence-specific oligomerizations of complimentary oligonucleotides catalyzed by single-stranded nucleic acid templates.
  • Figure 2 is a schematic representation of one embodiment of nucleic acid- templated synthesis where a reactive unit is attached to a template at the start of synthesis.
  • Figure 3 is a schematic representation of a second embodiment of nucleic acid- templated synthesis where a reactive unit is not attached to the template at the start of synthesis.
  • Figure 4 is a schematic representation of a third embodiment of nucleic acid- templated synthesis suitable for polymer synthesis.
  • Figures 5A-F are schematic representations of various exemplary templates useful in nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • Figures 6A-E are schematic representations of desirable and undesirable possible interactions between a codon of a template and an anti-codon of a transfer unit.
  • Figures 7A-G are schematic representations of various template architectures useful in nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • Figure 8 is a schematic representation of a method for producing a template
  • Figure 9 is a schematic representation, of a general method for making a library of reaction products. '. . , '
  • Figure 1 10 is a graph showing the, relationship between the effective concentration of target protein and the fraction of ligand that, binds the target.
  • Figures 11A-B are schematic representations of methods for screening a library , for bond-clea age ( Figure 11 A) and bond-formation (Figure 11B) catalysts.
  • Figure 12 is a schematic representation of an in vitro selection scheme for identifying non-natural polymer catalysts of bond-forming reactions.
  • Figure 13 is a schematic representation of an in vitro selection scheme for identifying non-natural polymer catalysts of bond-cleaving reactions.
  • Figure 14 is a schematic representation of exemplary reagents and their use in a recombination method for diversifying a template ' library.
  • Figure 15 depicts synthetic reactions directed by hairpin (H) and end-of-helix (E)
  • Figures 17A-17B depict various mismatch reactions analyzed by denaturing
  • Figure 17A depicts results of reactions in which H templates linked to an iodoacetamide group were reacted with thiol reagents containing 0, 1, or 3 mismatches at 25°C.
  • Figure 17B depicts results of reactions in which the reactions in Figure 17A were repeated at the indicated temperatures for 16 hours.
  • Figure 18 depicts a reaction performed using a 41-base E template and a 10-base reagent designed to anneal 1-30 bases from the 5' end ofthe template.
  • Figures 21 A-21B are a schematic representation of a method for translating, selecting, and amplifying a synthetic molecule that binds streptavidin from a DNA-encoded library. ' . • .
  • Figure 22A depicts DNA sequencing results of a PCR amplified pool of nucleic acid templates of Figures 21 A-21B before and after selection.
  • Figure 22B is a schematic representation of a method for creating and evolving libraries of non-natural molecules using nucleic acid-templated synthesis, where — Ri represents the library of product functionality transferred from reagent library 1 and -R I B represents a selected product.
  • Figures 23 A-23D are schematic representations of exemplary DNA-templated reactions.
  • Figure 24 depicts analysis by denaturing PAGE of representative DNA-templated reactions listed in Figures 23 and 25.
  • Figures 25A-25B are schematic representations of DNA-templated amide bond formation reactions mediated by EDC and sulfo-NHS or by DMT-MM for a variety of substituted carboxylic acids and amines.
  • Figure 26A-26B depict an analysis ofthe distance independent nature of certain nucleic acid-templated reactions.
  • Figure 26A is a schematic representation showing a model for distance-independent nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • Figure 26B depicts the results of denaturing PAGE of a DNA-templated Wittig olefination between complementary aldehyde- linked template 11 and phosphorous ylide reagent 13 from Figure 23B with either zero bases (lanes 1-3) or ten bases (lanes 4-6) separating annealed reactants.
  • Figure 27 is a schematic representation of exemplary nucleic acid-templated complexity building reactions.
  • Figures 28A-28B depict strategies for DNA-templated synthesis using autocleaving linkers ( Figures 28A and 28B), scarless linkers (Figure 28C), and useful scar linkers (Figure 28D).
  • Figure 29 depicts results from nucleic acid-templated reactions with various ' linkers.
  • Figures 30A-30B are schematic representations depicting strategies for purifying products of DNA-templated synthesis, using an autocleaving reagent linker (Figure 30A) or scar and non scar linkers ( Figure 30B).
  • Figures 31 A-B depict an exemplary DNA-templated multi-step tripeptide synthesis. '
  • Figures 32A-B depict an exemplary DNA-templated multi-step synthesis.
  • Figure 33 depicts DNA-templated amide bond formation reactions in which reagents and templates are complexed with dimethyldidodecylammonium cations.
  • Figure 34 shows denaturing PAGE gels with representative DNA-templated amine acylation, Wittig olefination, 1,3-di ⁇ olar cycloaddition, and reductive amination reactions using the end-of-helix (E) and omega ( ⁇ ) architectures.
  • Figures 35A-35D are bar charts showing a comparison of end-of-helix (E)j hai ⁇ in (H), and omega ( ⁇ ) architectures for mediating DNA-templated amine acylation (Figure 35A), Wittig olefination (Figure 35B), 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition (Figure 35C), or reductive amination reactions (Figure 35D).
  • Figure 36 is a table showing the melting temperatures of selected template- reagent combinations using the omega ( ⁇ ) and end-of-helix (E) architectures.
  • Figure 37 is a bar chart showing the efficiencies of DNA-templated reactions mediated by a template having the T architecture.
  • Figures 38A-38C depict two DNA-templated reactions on a single template in one solution mediated by templates having a T architecture.
  • Figure 39A-39C are schematic illustrations showing the relative rates of product formation from (S)-and (R)-bromides in H template ( Figure 39 A) or E template ( Figures 39B and 39C) mediated stereoselective DNA-templated substitution reactions.
  • Figures 40A-40D depict results on' reaction stereoselectivity when aromatic bases between the reactive groups are deleted and restored. The Figures show changes in stereoselectivity as a result of restoring aromatic DNA bases from the 5' end ( Figures 40A-40C) or from the 3' end ( Figure 40D) ofthe 12-base intervening region.
  • Figures 41A-41B show the stereofeelectivities of DNA-templated reactions mediated by right-handed helix (B-f ⁇ rm) ( Figure 4iA) or left-handed helix (Z-forrn) ( Figures 41 A and 41B) hai ⁇ in architectures. , ' ' ', ' •
  • Figures 42A-42D shows graphical .representations of product yield versus time for exemplary stereoselective DNA-templated reactions used to calculate I S /I R .
  • Figure 42A ⁇ corresponds to the reaction shown in Figure 39A;
  • Figure 42B corresponds to the reaction shown in Figure 39B;
  • Figure 42C corresponds to the.reaction shown in Figure 44A arid
  • Figure 42D corresponds to the reaction shown in Figure ,44B.
  • Figures 43A-43F are a schematic representations showing template' and reagent structures that inco ⁇ orate achiral, flexible linkers.
  • Figure 4 A-44B are graphical representations of circular dichroism spectra obtained for B-form ( Figure 44A) and Z-form ( Figure 44B) template-reagent complexes.
  • Figure 45 shows a representative denaturing PAGE analysis of reactions using the CG-rich sequences at low and high salt concentrations.
  • Figure 46 is a schematic representation of a DNA-templated synthesis in which maleimides, aldehydes, or amines are subjected to multiple DNA-templated reaction types in a single solution.
  • Figure 47 depicts templates and reagents used pairwise in 12-reactant one-pot
  • Figure 48 depicts a "one-pot" DNA-templated reaction containing 12 reactants and at least seven possible reaction types which generates only 6 sequence-programmed products out of at least 28 possible products.
  • Figure 49 is a schematic representation of a method for diversifying a DNA- templated library by sequentially exposing or creating reactive groups.
  • Figures 50A-50E are schematic representations of exemplary nucleic acid- templated deprotections useful in the practice ofthe invention.
  • Figures 51A-51B are schematic representations of exemplary nucleic acid- templated functional group interconversions useful in th practice ofthe invention.
  • Figure 52 is a schematic representation showing the assembly of transfer units along a nucleic acid template.
  • Figure 53 is a schematic representation showing the polymerization of dicarbamate units along a nucleic acid template to form a polycarbamate.
  • Figure 54 is a schematic representation showing cleavage of a polycarbamate polymer from a nucleotide backbone.
  • Figure 55 is a schematic representation showing the synthesis of a DNA- templated macrocyclic fumaramide library.
  • Figure 56 is a schematic representation ofthe amine acylation and cyclization steps of various fumaramide library members of Figure 55.
  • Figure 57 shows exemplary amino acid building blocks for the synthesis of a
  • Figure 58 is a schematic representation of a method of creating a template used in the synthesis of a DNA-templated macrocyclic fumaramide library.
  • Figure 59 is a schematic representation of an amine acylation and cyclization reaction useful in the synthesis of macrocyclic fumaramide library.
  • Figure 60 depicts representative monomer structures that can be inco ⁇ orated into a PNA polymer.
  • Figure 61 is a schematic representation of a method for making functional polymers. As shown the polymer is still associated with the template.
  • Figure 62 depicts a DNA-templated aldehyde polymerization reaction.
  • Figure 63 depicts PNA polymerization reactions using a 40 base template with mismatched codons located at certain positions ofthe template.
  • Figure 64 shows the specificity of DNA-templated polymerization reactions.
  • Figure 65A is a schematic representation, showing a method of using a nucleic acid to direct the synthesis of new polymers, and plastics.
  • Figure 65B is a schematic ⁇ representation showing the use of Grubbs' ring-opening metathesis polymerization catalysis to evolve plastics.
  • Figure 66 is a schematic representation showing the evolution of plastics through iterative cycles of ligand diversification, selection, and, amplification to create polymers with desired properties. ' ", : ⁇ • , •
  • Figure 67 depicts exemplary' functionalized nucleotides that can be inco ⁇ orated by DNA polymerase.
  • I I ' [0115]
  • Figure 68 depicts exemplary metal binding uridine and 7-deazaadenosine analogs. ⁇ , '
  • Figure 69 depicts an exemplary synthesis of analog 7 from Figure 67.
  • Figure 70 depicts an exemplary synthesis of compound 30, a precursor to compound 13 from Figure 67.
  • Figure 71 depicts an exemplary synthesis of compound 40, a precursor to compound 13 from Figure 67.
  • Figure 72 depicts an exemplary synthesis of compound 38, a precursor to compound 40 from Figure 71.
  • Figure 73 depicts exemplary deoxyadenosine derivatives.
  • Figure 74 depicts an exemplary synthesis of modified deoxyadenosine triphosphates.
  • Figure 75 depicts a summary of modified nucleotide triphosphates containing metal-binding functionalities which are or are not inco ⁇ orated by DNA-polymerase.
  • Figure 76 depicts a non-natural polymer library containing a synthetic metal- binding nucleotide that is compatible with DNA polymerases.
  • Figure 77 is a schematic representation showing the generation of libraries of nucleic acids containing polymerase-accepted metal-binding nucleotides.
  • Figures 78A-78C show reaction schemes for identifying certain reaction catalysts.
  • Figure 78A is a schematic rep'resentation of an exemplary scheme for the in vitro selection of synthetic polymers containing polymerase-accepted metal-binding nucleotides that
  • Figure 78B is a schematic representation of an exemplary scheme for the in vitro selection of synthetic polymers containing polymerase-accepted metal-binding nucleotides that catalyze hetero Diels- Alder reactions.
  • Figure 78C is a schematic representation of an exemplary scheme for the in vitro selection of synthetic polymers containing polymerase- i accepted metal-binding nucleotides that catalyze aldol reactions.
  • Figure 79 depicts exemplary DNA-linked synthetic molecules subjected to protein binding selections, and enrichment factors for a single round of selection.
  • Figure 80 depicts the results of an exemplary selection scheme.
  • Figure 81 depicts the net, enrichment realized by three rounds of enrichment.
  • Figure 82 depicts the separation of target-specific and non-specific DNA-linked synthetic molecules from a single solution.
  • Figure 83 depicts exemplary specific DNA-linked synthetic molecules selected in
  • Figure 84 depicts an exemplary iterated carbonic anhydrase selection scheme.
  • Figure 85 is a schematic representation of a method for performing one-pot selections for bond-forming reactions.
  • Figure 86 is a schematic representation of a method for validating the discovery of new bond-forming reactions using DNA-templated synthesis.
  • Figure 87 depicts an example of reaction discovery using nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • Figure 88 depicts the discovery of Cu-mediated coupling reactions identified using nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • Figure 89 depicts the discovery of Pd-mediated coupling reactions identified using nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • Figure 90 is a schematic representation of a microarray based sequence analysis protocol.
  • Figure 91 depicts the analysis ,of the Pd ⁇ mediated reactions identified via microarray based sequence analysis. ' ' , , , , ' , , , '
  • Nucl ⁇ ic-acid templated synthe ⁇ js as described herein permits the production, selection, amplification and evolution of a broad variety of chemical compounds such as , , synthetic small molecules and non-natura ⁇ polymers.
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis the information encoded by a DNA or other nucleic acid sequence is translated into the synthesis of a reaction product.
  • the nucleic acid template typically comprises a plurality of coding regions which anneal to complementary anti-codon sequences, associated with reactive units, thereby bringing the reactive Units together in a sequence-specific manner to create a reaction product. Since nucleic acid hybridization is sequence ⁇ speci ' fic, the result of a nucleic acid-templated reaction is the translation of a specific nucleic acid sequence into a corresponding re'action ' ⁇ product. '
  • DNA or RNA templates have since been shown to accelerate the formation of a variety of non-natural nucleic acid analogs, including peptide nucleic acids (Bohler et al. (1995) NATURE 376: 578), phosphorothioate- (Herrlein et al. (1995) J. AM. CHEM. SOC.
  • Nucleic acid templates can also catalyze amine acylation between nucleotide analogs (Bruick et al. (1996) CHEM. BIOL. 3: 49-56). [0141] Although nucleic acid templates have been 1 demonstrated to accelerate the formation of a variety of non-natural nucleic acid/analogues, nearly all of these reactions Were' designed to proceed through transition states closely resembling the natural nucleic acid backbone (Figure 1), typically affording products that preserve the same six-bond backbone spacing between nucleotide units.
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis is useful broadly only if synthetic molecules other than nucleic acids and nucleic acid analogs can be synthesized in a nucleic acid-templated fashion.
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis is indeed a general phenomenon and can be used for a variety of reactions and conditions to generate a diverse range of compounds, specifically including compounds that are not, and do not resemble, nucleic acids or nucleic acid analogs. More specifically, the present invention extends the ability to amplify and evolve libraries of chemical compounds beyond natural biopolymers.
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis as performed herein involves ,1) providing one, or more nucleic acid templates optionally associated with a reactive unit, and 2)' contacting the one or more nucleic acid templates with one or more transfer units including an anti-codon associated with a reactive unit.
  • the anti-codons ofthe transfer units are designed to hybridize to the nucleic acid template.
  • the transfer unit comprises a single moiety simultaneously inco ⁇ orating the hybridization capability ofthe anti- codon unit and the chemical functionality ofthe reaction unit.
  • the reactive units present on the transfer units and/or the nucleic acid template come into reactive proximity to react and generate a reaction product.
  • the oligonucleotide portion ofthe transfer unit is removed once the reactive units have reacted to generate the reaction product or an intermediate ofthe reaction product.
  • the sequence ofthe nucleic acid template can later be determined, to permit decoding ofthe synthetic history ofthe attached reaction product and, thereby, its structure. This method may be used to synthesize one molecule at a time or may be used to synthesize thousands to millions of compounds using combinatorial methods.
  • the template molecule optionally is associated with a reactive unit prior to interaction with any transfer units.
  • the template can be connected by a covalent bond to a reactive unit, either directly or via a linker.
  • the template can be connected by a noncovalent linkage.
  • the template can be biotinylated, generally at a fixed location on the molecule, and can stably interact with a reactive unit associated with an avidin or streptavidin moiety.
  • the reactive unit is preferably placed at or near the 5' end ofthe template in some embodiments as shown in Figure 2. In other embodiments, placement ofthe reactive unit at an internal position ofthe template or at the 3' end is preferred.
  • the template molecule also includes at least one codon capable of annealing to an anti-codon of a transfer unit.
  • the transfer unit anneals to the codon, bringing its reactive unit into reactive proximity, with the reactive unit ofthe template to produce a reaction prqduct. ' ⁇ . , . , ' . ⁇ ,
  • the template is not initially associated with a reactive unit, but permits the nucleic acid-templated synthesis of at least two reactive units disposed with two transfer units.
  • the template molecule includes at least 1 two codons, each capable of annealing to a different anti-codon disposed within each transfer unit.
  • each transfer unit anneals to the corresponding codon in the template to bring, the reactive units of each transfer unit into reactive proximity with one another to produce a , reaction product.
  • the template can bring together, either simultaneously or sequentially, a plurality of transfer units in a sequence-specific manner.
  • the reactive units on each annealed transfer unit can then be reacted with one another in a polymerization process to produce a polymer.
  • the polymerization may' be a step-by-step process or may be a simultaneous process whereby all the annealed monomers are reacted in one reaction sequence.
  • the nucleic acid template can direct a wide variety of chemical reactions without obvious structural requirements by sequence-specifically recruiting reactants linked to complementary oligonucleotides.
  • the nucleic acid mediated format permits reactions that may not be possible using conventional synthetic approaches.
  • the template hybridizes or anneals to one or more transfer units to direct the synthesis of a reaction product, which during certain steps of templated synthesis remain associated with the template.
  • a reaction product then is selected or screened based on certain criteria, such as the ability to bind to a preselected target molecule.
  • the associated template can then be sequenced to decode the synthetic history ofthe reaction product.
  • the template may be evolved to guide the synthesis of another chemical compound or library of chemical compounds.
  • the template may be based on a nucleic acid sequence, for example, a DNA, an RNA, a hybrid of DNA and RNA, or a derivative of DNA and RNA, and may be single- or double-stranded.
  • the design of a particular template may vary depending upon the type of nucleic acid templated synthesis contemplated.
  • Figure 5 shows a variety of templates that may be useful in the practice ofthe invention.
  • Figures 5 A-C are schematic representations of templates including two codons for ' interaction with complementary anti-codons of two transfer units.
  • These templates can be used in the type of nucleic acid-templated synthesis where no reactive units are linked to the template at the initiation of synthesis; for example, when two transfer units anneal to the template to bring their reactive units into reactive proximity to create a reaction product.
  • One such example is polymerization.
  • the templates can be associated with a reactive unit prior to annealing ofthe transfer units.
  • Figures 5D-F are schematic representations of templates that can be used in the type of nucleic acid-templated synthesis where one reactive unit is linked to the template at the initiation of synthesis, for example, when one transfer unit anneals to the template to bring its reactive unit into reactive proximity with the other reactive unit linked to the template to create a reaction product.
  • Figure 5A shows a template comprising in a 5 ' to 3 ' direction, a nucleotide sequence encoding a first primer binding site (PBS1) or a sequence complementary thereto, a nucleotide sequence encoding a first codon (Cl) that anneals to an anti-codon sequence of a first transfer unit, a nucleotide sequence encoding a second codon (C2) that anneals to an anti-codon sequence of a second, different transfer unit, and a nucleotide sequence encoding a second primer binding site (PBS2) or a sequence complementary thereto.
  • the primer binding sites although optional, are preferred in some embodiments to facilitate PCR-based amplification of templates.
  • the Cl sequence is selected so as to minimize cross-reactivity with the anti-codon sequence ofthe second transfer unit
  • the C2 sequence is selected so as to minimize cross-reactivity with the anti-codon sequence ofthe first transfer unit.
  • the Cl and C2 sequences are separated by one or more intervening bases. In other words, the Cl and C2 sequences do not directly abut one another.
  • both the first and second transfer units are capable of binding to the template at the same time.
  • Figure 5B shows a template similar to that shown in Figure 5A, except there are no intervening bases disposed between Cl and C2. In other words, the Cl and C2 sequences directly abut one another.
  • both the first and second transfer units ate capable to binding to the template at the same time.
  • Figure 5C shows 1 a template similar, to those shown in Figures 5A and 5B, except ' that the, sequence of Cl overlaps the sequence of C2.
  • the first and second transfer units cannot both bind to the template at the same time.
  • a third icodon' should normally be present, so that two reactive , units can anneal simultaneously to the template to permit the reaction to proceed.
  • This type of template can require a step-by-step approach to the synthesis of the reaction product. For example, the transfer units with anti-codons to Cl are added first, allowed to hybridize and react, and then removed before the transfer units with anti-codons to C2 are added.
  • Figures 5D-5F show templates similar
  • the nucleotide sequence ofthe template further comprises a sequence of nucleotides or sequence tag that uniquely identifies the reactive unit associated with the template. Following template mediated synthesis, the reactive unit actually attached to the template that participated in the reaction to generate the reaction product may be identified by reading the sequence ofthe sequence tag.
  • R is linked to the template at a location in the vicinity ofthe 5' terminal end, for example, at the 5' end ofthe template or downstream ofthe 5' end ofthe template.
  • R is linked to the template at a location between the 5' terminal end and the 3' terminal end. In this particular case, R is located at a position between Cl and C2, and represents an example ofthe T type template architecture discussed in more detail below.
  • R is linked to the template at a location in the vicinity ofthe 3' terminal end, for example, at the 3' end ofthe template or upstream ofthe 3' end ofthe template.
  • each ofthe templates shown in Figures 5A-F may comprise one or more restriction endonuclease sites.
  • the template may comprise a restriction endonuclease site disposed between (i) PBS1 and Cl, (ii) Cl arid C2, and (iii) C2 and PBS2.
  • the restriction endonuclease sites facilitate the use of nucleic acid cassettes to easily introduce various sequences to replace the PBS1 sequence, the Cl ' sequence, the C2 sequence, the PBS2 sequence, or any combination thereof.
  • the template may also inco ⁇ or'ate a hai ⁇ in loop on one end terminating in a reactive unit that can interact with one or more reactive units associated with transfer units.
  • a DNA template can comprise a hai ⁇ in loop terminating in a 5'- amino group, which may or may not be protected. The amino group may act as an initiation, point for formation of an unnatural polymer, or may be modified to bind a small molecule scaffold for subsequent modification by reactive units of other transfer units.
  • the length of the template may vary greatly depending upon the type of the nucleic acid-templated synthesis contemplated.
  • the template may be from 10 to 10,000 nucleotides in length, from 20 to 1,000 nucleotides in length, from 20 to 400 nucleotides in length, from 40 to 1,000 nucleotides in length, or from 40 to 400 nucleotides in length.
  • the length ofthe template will of course depend on, for example, the length ofthe codons, the complexity ofthe library, the complexity and/or size of a reaction product, the use of spacer sequences, etc.
  • the sequence ofthe template may be designed in a number of ways without going beyond the scope ofthe present invention.
  • the length ofthe codon must be determined and the codon sequences must be set. If a codon length of two is used, then using the four naturally occurring bases only 16 possible combinations are available to be used in encoding the library. If the length ofthe codon is increased to three (the number Nature uses in encoding proteins), the number of possible combinations increases to 64. If the length ofthe codon is increased to four, the number of possible combinations increases to 256. Other factors to be considered in determining the length ofthe codon are mismatching, frame- shifting, complexity of library, etc. As the length ofthe codon is increased up to a certain point the number of mismatches is decreased; however, excessively long codons likely will hybridize despite mismatched base pairs.
  • the codons may range from 2 to 50 nucleotides, from 2 to 40 nucleotides, from 2 to 30 nucleotides, from 2 to 20 nucleotides, from 2 to 15 nucleotides, from 2 to 10 nucleotides, from 3 to 50 nucleotides, from 3 to 40 nucleotides, from 3 to 30 nucleotides, from 3 to 20 nucleotides, from 3 to 15 nucleotides, from 3 to 10 nucleotides, from 4 to 50 nucleotides, frdm 4 to 40 nucleotides, from 4 to 30 nucleotides, from 4 to 20 nucleotides, from 4 to 15 nucleotides, from 4 to 10 nucleotides, from 5 to 50 nucleotides, from 5 to 40 nucleotides, from 5 to 30 nucleotides, from 5 to 50 nucleotides, from 5 to 40 nucleotides, from 5 to 30 nucleotides, from 5 to 50 nucle
  • the set of codons used in the template maximizes the number of mismatches between any two codons within a codon set to ensure that only the proper anti- codons ofthe transfer units anneal to the codon sites ofthe template. Furthermore, it is important that the template has mismatches between all the members of one codon set and all the codons of a different codon set to ensure that the anti-codons do not inadvertently bind to the wrong codon set.
  • each ofthe codons within a particular codon set should differ with one another by k mismatches, and all ofthe codons in one codon set (for example, Cl in Figure 5A) should differ by m mismatches with all ofthe codons in the other codon set (for example, C2 in Figure 5A).
  • Exemplary values for n, k, and m, for a variety of codon sets suitable for use on a template are summarized in Table 1.
  • any twn subcodons of n - (k- 1) bases must have at least one mismatch.
  • Such an algorithm preferably 1 starts with the A" 'M possible subcodons of length n - (k- 1) and then tests all combinations of adding k - 1 bases for those that always maintain k mismatches.
  • Codons can also be chosen to increase control over the GC content and, therefore, the melting temperature ofthe codon arid anti-codon.
  • Cbdons sets with a wide range in GC content versus AT content may rpsult in reagents that anneal with different efficiencies due to different melting temperatures.
  • the GC content for 1 the codon sets can be optimized.
  • the four (6, 4, 2) c ⁇ don sets ⁇ et forth in Tables 6 9 each contain 40 codons with identical GC content (i.e., 50% GC content).
  • GC codons (12, 8) sets with 64 codons all with 50% GC content can be generated for use in reaction discovery selections as well as other application where multiple mismatches might be ' advantageous. These codons satisfy the requirements for encoding a 30 x 30 matri of functional group combinations for reaction discovery.
  • an anti-codon may also bind to an unintended sequence on a template if complementary sequence is present.
  • an anti-codon may inadvertently bind to a non-codon sequence as shown in Figure 6B.
  • an anti-codon might inadvertently bind out-of-frame by annealing in part to one codon and in part to another codon ( Figure 6C) or to a non-codon sequence ( Figure 6D).
  • Figure 6E an anti- codon might bind in-frame to an incorrect codon, an issue addressed by the codon sets described above by requiring at least one base difference distinguishing each codon.
  • the problems of noncoding sequences and out-of-frame binding are avoided by the ribosome.
  • the nucleic acid-templated methods described herein do not take advantage ofthe ribosome's fidelity. Therefore, in order to avoid erroneous annealing as in Figures 6B-D, the templates can be designed such that sequences complementary to anti-codons are found exclusively at in-frame codon positions. For example, codons can be designed to begin, or end, with a particular base (e.g., "G").
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis When the nucleic acid-templated synthesis is used to produce a polymer, spacer sequences may also be placed between the codons to prevent frame shifting. More preferably, the bases ofthe template that encode each polymer subunit (the "genetic code” for the p'olymer) may be chosen from Table 10 to preclude or minimize the possibility of out- ⁇ f-frame annealing.
  • V A, C, or G
  • S C or G
  • W A or T
  • N A, C, G, or T
  • start and stop codons are useful, particularly in the context of polymer synthesis, to restrict erroneous anti-codon annealing to non-codons and to prevent excessive extension of a growing polymer.
  • a start codon can anneal to a transfer unit bearing a small molecule scaffold or a start monomer unit for use in polymer, synthesis; the start monomer unit can be masked by a photolabile protecting group as shown in Example 9A.
  • a stop codon, if used to terminate polymer synthesis, should not conflict with any other Codons used in the synthesis and should be ofthe same general format as the other codons.
  • a stop codon can encode a monomer unit that terminates polymerization by not providing a reactive group for further attachment.
  • a stop monomer unit may contain a blocked reactive group such as an acetamide rather than a primary amine as shown in Example 9A.
  • the stop monomer unit can include a biotinylated terminus that terminates the polymerization and facilitates purification ofthe resulting polymer.
  • the template may be further associated (for example, covalently coupled) with a particular reactive unit.
  • Various templates useful in nucleic acid-templated synthesis are shown in Figures 7A-7G, and include templates referred to as the "end- ⁇ f helix" or "E" templates (see, Figure 7A-C), "Hai ⁇ in” or “H” templates (see, Figure 7D), "Omega” or " ⁇ ” templates (see, Figure 7E-F), or "T” templates (see, Figure 7G).
  • Figures 7A-C show E type template architectures where the reactive units on the annealed templates (denoted by A) and transfer units (denoted by B) are separated by 1 base (Figure 7A), 10 bases (Figure 7B) and 20 bases ( Figure 7C).
  • Figure 7D shows a H type template architecture where the reactive unit is attached to the template (denoted by A) and the template folds back on itself to create a hai ⁇ in loop stabilized by a plurality of intramolecular bonds. As shown, the reactive units on the annealed template (denoted by A) and the transfer unit (denoted by B) are separated by 1 base.
  • Figures 7E-F show omega type template architecture where the codon for the transfer unit, bearing reactive unit B, is separated from reactive unit A on the template by 10 intervening template bases (Figure 7E) or by 20 bases (Figure 7F).
  • the omega template comprises a three base constant region ( ⁇ -3) and creates a seven base loop when the transfer unit anneals to the template.
  • the omega template includes a five base constant region ( ⁇ -5) and creates a fifteen base loop when the transfer unit anneals to the template. The loop gets larger as transfer units anneal to codons further away from the constant region ofthe template.
  • Figure 7G shows a T-type template architecture where the reactive units on the annealed template (denoted by A) and the transfer unit (denoted by B) are separated by 1 base.
  • reactive unit A is attached at a location intermediate the 5' and 3' terminal erids. of the template.
  • the reactive unit may be attached to the template at a location at least 10, 20, ,
  • Example 1 As a result of performing nuclej ⁇ acid mediated syntheses, it has been discovered that certain reactions, referred to as distance dependent reactions, do not proceed , efficiently when the annealed reactive units on the template and transfer unit are separated by even small numbers of bases. Using the E arid H type templates, certain distance' dependent reactions may only be encoded by template bases at the reactive end ofthe template f The new ⁇ type template overcomes the distance dependence problems that can be experienced with the E and H type templates (see, Example 5). Furthermore, it has been discovered that the presence of double-stranded nucleic acids between annealed reactive units can greatly reduce the efficiency of templated reactions because the flexibility of a single-stranded template is required.
  • the new T type template overcomes this problem that can be experienced with the E and H type templates (see, Example 5).
  • the omega architecture permits distance dependent reactions to be directed efficiently by nucleotide bases far away from the reaction end of the template, effectively overcoming their distance dependence.
  • five bases ofthe template are held constant at the 5 '-end ofthe template (see, Figure 7F).
  • the transfer units contain at their 3 '-ends the complementary five bases but otherwise possess sequences that complement distal coding regions ofthe template. This permits the transfer unit to anneal to the distal coding regions ofthe template while still placing the reactive group ofthe transfer unit in close proximity by looping out large numbers of template bases that would ordinarily prevent a distance dependent reaction from proceeding.
  • the omega architecture retains sequence specificity because the .five bases ofthe transfer unit that complement the end of the template are insufficient by themselves to anneal to the template at room temperature.
  • the omega architecture expands the types of reactions that can be encoded anywhere on the template.
  • the T architecture permits a single template to encode two distance-dependent reactions and in addition permits a template to undergo two different nucleotide-templated reactions in a single solution or in "one-pot.”
  • the template can present a molecular scaffold through the non- Watson-Crick face of a base located in the center, rather than the end, ofthe template (see, Figure 7G). This permits two transfer units to anneal to either side ofthe reactive unit attached to the template and react either simultaneously or in successive steps to give the product of two nucleotide-templated transformations.
  • distance dependent reactions tolerate this architecture when reactive groups are proximal.
  • the T- type architecture permits two sequence-specific nucleic acid-templated reactions to take place on one template in one solution, i.e., in one step.
  • this architecture may permit three- or more component reactions commonly used to build structural complexity in synthetic libraries.
  • the omega and T architectures permit a broader range of template mediated reactions that can be performed in fewer steps with other template architectures and are especially useful in distance-dependent reactions.
  • the variety of available architectures provide significant flexibility in the placement of reactive units on templates, particularly for the synthesis of small molecules. It is contemplate, d that the reactive unit including, for example, ' molecular scaffold rilay, be associated with. a, template at any site along the template including the , 5'-end (e.g., end-of-helix architecture, omega architecture), the 3'-end (e.g., end-of-helix architecture, omega architecture), at the end of a hairpin.
  • 5'-end e.g., end-of-helix architecture, omega architecture
  • the 3'-end e.g., end-of-helix architecture, omega architecture
  • the molecular scaffqld is attached ' covalently to the template.
  • the molecular scaffold like the other reactive units, can be brought to the template using transfer unit, in which case the molecular scaffold is only associated with the template through a non-covalent (here, hydrogen ⁇ bonding) interaction.
  • the templates may be synthesized using methodologies well known in the art.
  • the nucleic acid sequence may be prepared using any method known in the art to prepare nucleic acid sequences. These methods include both in vivo and in vitro methods including PCR, plasmid preparation, endonuclease digestion, solid phase synthesis (for example, using an automated synthesizer), in vitro transcription, strand separation, etc.
  • the template when desired may be associated (for example, covalently or non covalently coupled) with a reactive unit of interest using standard coupling chemistries known in the art.
  • oligonucleotides representing all transfer unit annealing regions together with T4 DNA ligase in a single solution. Due to the sequence design ofthe oligonucleotide termini, the desired assembled template library is the only possible product when the ligation is complete. This strategy requires 2n x m short oligonucleotides to assemble a library of n m templates, where n refers to the number of different sequences per codon position and m refers to the number of. codons per library member. Thus, .
  • This procedure can provide 20 nmoles ofthe 5' functionalized single-stranded template library (sufficient material for thousands of DNA-templated library syntheses and selections) in about 6 hours.
  • the constant 10-base primer binding regions at the ends of each template were sufficient to permit PCR amplification of as few as 1 ,000 molecules (10 " mol) of template from this assembled material.
  • Figure 8 shows a protocol for producing a template containing in a 5' to 3' direction,, a small molecule reactant, a hai ⁇ in loop, an annealing region, a coding region, and a primer binding site.
  • This type of protocol may be used to synthesize a wide variety of templates, in particular, H type templates useful in the practice ofthe invention.
  • An efficient method to synthesize a large variety of templates is to use a "split- pool" technique.
  • the oligonucleotides are synthesized using standard 3' to 5' chemistries.
  • the constant 3' end is synthesized.
  • This is then split into n different vessels, where n is the number of different codons to appear at that position in the template.
  • n is the number of different codons to appear at that position in the template.
  • n is the number of different codons to appear at that position in the template.
  • one ofthe n different codons is synthesized on the (growing) 5' end ofthe constant 3' end.
  • each vessel contains, from 5' to 3', a different codon attached to a constant 3' end.
  • the n vessels are then pooled, so that a single vessel contains n different codons attached to the constant 3' end.
  • any constant bases adjacent the 5 ' end ofthe codon are now synthesized.
  • the pool then is split into m different vessels, where m is the number of different codons to appear at the next (more 5') position ofthe template.
  • a different codon is synthesized (at the 5' end ofthe growing oligonucleotide) in each ofthe m vessels.
  • the resulting oligonucleotides are pooled in a single vessel. Splitting, synthesizing, and pooling are repeated as required to synthesize all codons and constant regions in the oligonucleotides.
  • a transfer unit comprises , an oligonucleotide containing an anti-codon sequence • and a reactive unit.
  • the anti-codons are designed to be complementary to the codons present in the template. Accordingly, the sequences used in the template and the codon lengths should be considered when designing the anti-codons. Any molecule complementary to a codon used in the template may be used, including natural or non-natural nucleotides.
  • the codons include one or more bases found in nature (i.e., thymidine, uracil, guanidine, cytosirie, ,and adenine).
  • the anti-codon can include one or more nucleotides normally found in Nature with a base, a sugar, and an optional phosphate group.
  • the bases may be connected via a backbone other than the sugar-phosphate backbone normally found in Nature (e.g., non-natural nucleotides).
  • the anti-codon is associated with a particular type of reactive unit to form a transfer unit.
  • the reactive unit may represent a distinct entity or may be part of the functionality ofthe anti-codon unit.
  • each anti-codon sequence is associated with one monomer type.
  • the anti-codon sequence ATTAG may be associated with a carbamate residue with an isobutyl side chain
  • the anti-codon sequence CATAG may be associated with a carbamate residue with a phenyl side chain.
  • This one-for-one mapping of anti-codon to monomer units allows the decoding of any polymer ofthe library by sequencing the nucleic acid template used in the synthesis and allows synthesis ofthe same polymer or a related polymer by knowing the sequence ofthe original polymer. By changing (e.g., mutating) the sequence ofthe template, different monomer units may be introduced, thereby allowing the synthesis of related polymers, which can subsequently be selected and evolved.
  • several anti-codons may code for one monomer unit as is the case in Nature.
  • the anti-codon generally is associated with a reactive unit or reactant used to modify a small molecule scaffold.
  • the reactant is linked to the anti-codon via a linker long enough to allow the reactant to come into reactive proximity with the small molecule scaffold.
  • the linker preferably has a length and composition to permit intramolecular reactions but yet minimize intermolecular reactions.
  • the reactants include a variety of reagents as demonstrated by the wide range of reactions that can be utilized in nucleic acid-templated synthesis (see, Examples 2, and 7) and can be any chemical group, catalyst (e.g., organometallic compounds), or reactive moiety (e.g., electrophiles, nucleophiles) known in the chemical arts.
  • catalyst e.g., organometallic compounds
  • reactive moiety e.g., electrophiles, nucleophiles
  • association between the anti-codon and the reactive unit, for example, a monomer unit or reactant, in the transfer unit may be covalent or non-covaleht.
  • the association maybe through a covalent bond and, in certain embodiments, the covalent bond may
  • the anti-codon can be associated with the reactant through a linker moiety
  • the linkage can be cleavable by light, oxidation, hydrolysis, exposure to acid, exposure to base, reduction, etc.
  • Fruchtel et al. (1996) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. ENGL. 35: 17 describes a variety of linkages useful in the practice ofthe invention.
  • the linker facilitates contact ofthe reactant with the small molecule scaffold, and in certain embodiments,!
  • positions DNA as a leaving group may link reactive groups to the template via the "scarless” linker strategy (which yields product without leaving behind an additional atom or atoms having chemical functionality), or a “useful scar” strategy (in which a portion ofthe linker is left behind to be functionalized in subsequent steps following linker cleavage).
  • the anti-codon and the reactive unit may also be associated through non-covalent interactions such as ionic, electrostatic, hydrogen bonding, van der Waals interactions, hydrophobic interactions, pi-stacking, etc. and combinations thereof.
  • an anti-codon may be linked to biotin, and a monomer unit linked to streptavidin.
  • streptavidin linked to streptavidin.
  • the propensity of streptavidin to bind biotin leads to the non-covalent association between the anti-codon and the monomer unit to form the transfer unit.
  • the specific annealing of transfer units to templates permits the use of transfer units at concentrations lower than concentrations used in many traditional organic syntheses.
  • transfer units can be used at submillimolar concentrations (e.g. less than 100 ⁇ M, less than 10 ⁇ M, less than 1 ⁇ M, less than 100 nM, or less than 10 nM).
  • a variety of compounds and or libraries can be prepared using the methods described herein.
  • compounds that are not, or do not resemble, nucleic acids or analogs thereof are synthesized' according to the method of the invention;
  • compounds that are not, or do not resemble, proteins, peptides, or analogs thereof are synthesized according to the method ofthe invention.
  • small molecules such as small molecules using the methods described herein.
  • These small molecules may be like natural products, non- polymeric, and/or non-oligomeric.
  • the substantial interest in small molecules is due in part to their use as the active ingredient in many pharmaceutical preparations although they may also be used, for example, as catalysts, materials, or additives.
  • an evolvable template also is provided.
  • the template can include a small molecule scaffold upon which the small molecule is to be built, or a small molecule scaffold may be added to the template.
  • the small molecule scaffold can be any chemical compound with two or more sites for functionalization.
  • the small molecule scaffold can include a ring system (e.g., the ABCD steroid ring system found in cholesterol) with functionalizable groups coupled to the atoms making up the rings.
  • the small molecule may be the underlying structure of a pharmaceutical agent such as mo ⁇ hine, epothilone or a cephalosporin antibiotic.
  • the sites or groups to be functionalized on the small molecule scaffold may be protected using methods and protecting groups known in the art.
  • the protecting groups used in a small molecule scaffold may be orthogonal to one another so that protecting groups can be removed one at a time.
  • the transfer units comprise an anti-codon associated with a reactant or a building block for use in modifying, adding to, or taking away from the small molecule scaffold.
  • the reactants or building blockjs may be, for example, electrophiles (e.g. , acetyl, amides, acid chlorides, esters, nitrile/s, imines), nucleophiles (e.g. , amines, hydroxyl groups, thiols)* catalysts (e.g., organoriietallic catalysts), or side chains.
  • the transfer units are allowed to contact the template under hydridizirig conditions.
  • the attached reactant or building block is allowed to react with a site on the small molecule scaffold.
  • protecting groups on the small molecule teriiplat'e are removed one at a time from the sites to be functionalized so that the reactant ofthe transfer unit will react at only the desired position on the scaffold. , ⁇ • ,
  • reaction conditions, linker, reactant, and site to be functionalized are chosen to avoid intermolecular reactions and accelerate intramolecular reactions. Sequential or simultaneous contacting ofthe template with transfer units can be employed depending on the particular compound to be synthesized. In 1 certain embodiments of special interest, the multi-step synthesis of chemical compounds is provided m which the template is coritacted sequentially with two or more transfer units to facilitate rriulti-step synthesis of complex chemical compounds.
  • the newly synthesized small molecule remains associated with the template that encoded its synthesis.
  • Decoding the sequence ofthe template permits the deconvoluti ⁇ n ofthe synthetic history and thereby the structure ofthe small molecule.
  • the template can also be amplified in order to create more of the desired small molecule and/or the template can be evolved (mutagenized) to create related small molecules.
  • the small molecule can also be cleaved from the template for purification or screening.
  • polymers specifically unnatural polymers, are prepared according to the method ofthe present invention.
  • the unnatural polymers that can be created using the inventive method and system include any unnatural polymers.
  • Exemplary unnatural polymers include, but are not limited to, peptide nucleic acid (PNA) polymers, polycarbamates, polyureas, polyesters, polyacrylate, polyalkylene (e.g., polyethylene, polypropylene), polycarbonates, polypeptides with unnatural stereochemistry, polypeptides with unnatural amino acids, and combination thereof.
  • the polymers comprise at least 10, 25, 75, 100, 125, 150 monomer units or more.
  • the polymers synthesized using the inventive system may be used, for example, as catalysts, pharmaceuticals, metal chelators, or catalysts.
  • the monomer units attached to the anti- codons may be any monomers or oligomers capable of being joined together to form a polymbr.
  • the monomer units may be, for example, carbamates, D-amino acids, unnatural amino acids, PNAs, ureas, hydroxy acids, esters, carbonates, acrylates, or ethers.
  • the monomer units have two reactive groups used to link the monomer unit into the' growing
  • the two reactive groups are not the same so that the monomer unit may be inco ⁇ orated into the polymer in a directional sense, for example, 0 at one end may be an electrophile and at the other end a nucleophile.
  • Reactive groups may include, but are not limited to, esters, amides, carboxylic acids, activated carbonyl groups, acid chlorides, amines, hydroxyl groups, and thiols.
  • the reactive groups are masked or protected (Greene et al (1999) PROTECTIVE GROUPS IN ORGANIC SYNTHESIS 3rd Edition, Wiley) so that polymerization may not take place until a desired time when the reactive 5 groups are deprotected.
  • initiation ofthe polymerization sequence results in a cascade of polymerization and deprotection steps wherein the polymerization step results in deprotection of a reactive group to be used in the subsequent polymerization step.
  • the monomer units to be polymerized can include two or more monomers 0 depending on the geometry along the nucleic acid template.
  • the monomer units to be polymerized must be able to stretch along the nucleic acid template and particularly across the distance spanned by its encoding anti-codon and optional spacer sequence.
  • the monomer unit actually comprises two monomers, for example, a dicarbamate, a diurea, or a dipeptide.
  • the monomer unit comprises three or more monomers.
  • Example 9C discloses the synthesis of PNA based polymers wherein each monomer unit comprises four PNA molecules.
  • the monomer units may contain any chemical groups known in the art. Reactive chemical groups especially those that would interfere with polymerization, hybridization, etc., are preferably masked using known protecting groups (Greene et al. (1999) supra). In general, the protecting groups used to mask these reactive groups are orthogonal to those used in protecting the groups used in the polymerization steps. [0198] It has been discovered that, under certain circumstances, the type of chemical reaction may affect the fidelity of the pOlymerization process.
  • distance ' ' independent chemical reactions for example, reactions that occur efficiently when the reactive units are spaced apart by intervening bases, for' example, amine acylation reactions
  • distance ' dependent chemical reactions for example, reactions that becorrie' inefficient the further the reactive units are ' spaced part via intervening bases, for example, reductive amination reactions
  • Example 9 discusses in detail effect of using. distance dependent chemical reactions to enhance the fidelity ofthe polymerization process during template mediated synthesis.
  • Nucleic acid-templated synthesis can be used to effect functional group transformations that either (i) unmask or (ii) interconvert functionality used in coupling reactions.
  • nucleic acid-templated functional group interconversions permit the generation of library diversity by sequential unmasking.
  • the sequential unmasking approach offers the major advantage of enabling reactants that would normally lack the ability to be linked to a nucleic acid (for example, simple alkyl halides) to contribute to library diversity by reacting with a sequence- specified subset of templates in an intermolecular, non-templated reaction mode. This advantage significantly increases the types of structures that can be generated.
  • One embodiment ofthe invention involves deprotection or unmasking of functional groups present in a reactive unit.
  • a nucleic acid- template is associated with a reactive unit that contains a protected functional group.
  • a transfer unit comprising an oligonucleotide complimentary to the template codon region and a reagent capable of removing the protecting group, is annealed to the template, and the reagent reacts with the protecting group, removing it from the reactive unit.
  • the exposed functional group then is subjected to a reagent not linked to a nucleic acid.
  • the reactive unit contains two or more protected functional groups.
  • the protecting groups are orthogonal protecting groups that are sequentially removed by iterated annealing with reagents linked to transfer units.
  • Another embodiment ofthe invention involves interconversions of functional groups present on a reactive unit.
  • a transfer unit associated with a reagent that can catalyze a reaction is annealed to a template bearing the reactive unit.
  • a reagent not linked to a nucleic acid is added to the reaction, and the transfer unit reagent catalyzes the reaction between the unlinked reagent and the reactive unit, yielding a newly functionalized reactive unit.
  • the, reactive unit contains two or more ' • functional groups which are sequentially intefc ⁇ nverted'by iterative exposure to different transfer unit-bound teagents. ' ' , • • • ' ⁇ .
  • Nucleic acid-templated reactions can occur in aqueous or non-aqueous (i. e. , organic) solutions, or a mixture of one or more. aqueous and non-aqueous solutions. In aqueous solutions, reactions can be performed at pH ranges from about 2 to about 12, or preferably from about 2 to about 10, or more preferably from about 4 to about 10.
  • the reactions used in DNA- templated chemistry preferably should not require very basic conditions (e.g., pH > 12,,pH > 10) or very acidic conditions (e.g., pH ⁇ 1, pH ⁇ 2, pH ⁇ 4), because extreme conditions may lead to degradation or modification ofthe nucleic acid template and or molecule (for example, the polymer, or small molecule) being synthesized.
  • the aqueous solution can contain one or more inorganic salts, including, but not limited to, NaCI, Na 2 SO 4 , KCl, Mg +2 , Mn +2 , etc., at various concentrations.
  • Organic solvents suitable for nucleic acid-templated reactions include, but are not limited to, methylene chloride, chloroform, dimethylformamide, and organic alcohols, including methanol and ethanol.
  • quaternized ammonium salts such as, for example, long chain tetraalkylammonium salts, can be added (Jost et al. (1989) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 17: 2143; Mel'nikov et al (1999) LANGMUIR 15: 1923-1928).
  • Nucleic acid-templated reactions may require a catalyst, such as, for example, homogeneous, heterogeneous, phase transfer, and asymmetric catalysis. In other embodiments, a catalyst is not required.
  • a catalyst is not required.
  • additional, accessory reagents not linked to a nucleic acid are preferred in some embodiments.
  • Useful accessory reagents can include, for example, oxidizing agents (e.g., NaIO ); reducing agents (e.g., NaCNBH 3 ); activating reagents (e.g., EDC, NHS, and sulfo-NHS); transition metals such as nickel (e.g., Ni(NO 3 ) 2 ), rhodium (e.g.
  • RhCl 3 ruthenium (e.g. RuCl 3 ), copper (e.g. Cu(NO 3 ) 2 ), cobalt (e.g. CoCl 2 ), iron (e.g. Fe(NO 3 ) 3 ), osmium (e.g. OsO 4 ), titanium (e.g. TiCLi or titanium tetraisopropoxide), palladium (e.g. NaPdCl ), or Ln; transition metal ligands (e.g., phosphines, amines, and halides); Lewis 1 acids; and Lewis bases.
  • Reaction conditions preferably are optimized to suit the nature ofthe reactive units and oligonucleotides used.
  • nucleic acid-templated reactions Known chemical reactions for synthesizing polymers, small molecules, or other chemical compounds can be used in nucleic acid-templated reactions.
  • reactions such as those listed in Marc 's Advanced Organic Chemistry, Organic Reactions, Organic Syntheses, organic text books, journals such as Journal ofthe American Chemical Society, Journal of Organic Chemistry, Tetrahedron, etc., and Carruther's Some Modern Methods of Organic Chemistry can be used.
  • the chosen reactions preferably are compatible with nucleic acids such as DNA or RNA or are compatible with the modified nucleic acids used as the template.
  • Reactions useful in nucleic-acid templated chemistry include, for example, substitution reactions, carbon-carbon bond forming reactions, elimination reactions, acylation reactions, and addition reactions.
  • An illustrative but not exhaustive list of aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions useful in the present invention includes, for example, S N 2 reactions, S N I reactions, S>[i reactions, allylic rearrangements, nucleophilic substitution at an aliphatic trigonal carbon, and nucleophilic substation at a vinylic carbon.
  • Specific aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with oxygen nucleophiles include, for example, hydrolysis of alkyl halides, hydrolysis of gen-dihalides, hydrolysis of 1,1,1-trihalides, hydrolysis of alkyl esters or inorganic acids, hydrolysis of diazo ketones, hydrolysis of acetal and enol ethers, hydrolysis of epoxides, hydrolysis of acyl halides, hydrolysis of anhydrides, hydrolysis of carboxylic esters, hydrolysis of amides, alkylation with alkyl halides (Williamson Reaction), epoxide formation, alkylation with inorganic esters, alkylation with diazo compounds, dehydration of alcohols, transetherification, alcoholysis of epoxides, alkylation with onium salts, hydroxylation of silanes, alcoholysis of acyl halides, alcoholysis of anhydrides, esterfication of carboxylic acids, alcohol
  • Specific aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with sulfur nucleophiles include, for 1 example, attack by SH at an alkyl carbon to form thiols, attack by, S at an alkyl carbon to form thioethers, attack by SH or SR at an acyl carbon, formation of disulfides, fqrmation of Bunte salts, alkylation of, sulfinic acid salts, and formation of alkyl thiocyanates.
  • Aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with nitrogen nucleophiles include, for example, alkylation of amines, N-arylati ⁇ n of amines, replacement of a hydroxy by an amino group, trarisamination, transamidation, alkylation of amines with diazo compounds, amination of epoxides, amination of oxetanes, amination of aziri dines, amination of alkanes, formation of isocyanides, acylation of amines by acyl halides, acylation of amines by anhydrides, acylation of amines by carboxylic acids, acylation of amines by carboxylic esters, acylation of amines by amides, acylation of amines by other acid derivatives, N-alkylation or N-arylation of amides and imides, N-acylation of amides and imides, formation of aziridines from epoxides,
  • Aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with halogen nucleophiles include, for example, attack at an alkyl carbon, halide exchange, formation of alkyl halides from esters of sulfuric and sulfonic acids, formation of alkyl halides from alcohols, formation of alkyl halides from ethers, formation of halohydrins from epoxides, cleavage of carboxylic esters with lithium iodide, conversion of diazo ketones to ⁇ -halo ketones, conversion of amines to halides, conversion of tertiary amines to cyanamides (the von Braun reaction), formation of acyl halides from carboxylic acids, and formation of acyl halides from acid derivatives.
  • Aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions using hydrogen as a nucleophile include, for example, reduction of alkyl halides, reduction of tosylates, other sulfonates, and similar compounds, hydrogenolysis of alcohols, hydrogenolysis of esters (Barton-McCombie reaction), hydrogenolysis of nitriles, replacement of alkoxyl by hydrogen, reduction of epoxides, reductive cleavage of carboxylic esters, reduction of a C- ⁇ bond, desulfurization, reduction of acyl halides, reduction of carboxylic acids, esters, and anhydrides to aldehydes, and reduction of amides to aldehydes.
  • aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions using carbon nucleophiles include, for example, coupling with silanes, coupling of alkyl halides (the
  • Reactions which involve nucleophilic attack at a sulfonyl sulfur atom may also be used in the present invention and include, for example, hydrolysis of sulfonic acid derivatives (attack by OH), formation of sulfonic esters (attack by OR), formation of sulfonamides (attack by nitrogen), formation of sulfonyl halides (attack by halides), reduction of sulfonyl chlorides (attack by hydrogen), and preparation of sulfones (attack by carbon).
  • Aromatic electrophilic substitutionjreactions may also be used in nucleotide- templated chemistry.
  • Hydrogen exchange reactions are examples of aromatic electrophilic substitution reactions that use hydrogen as the electrOphile.
  • Aromatic electrophilic substitution reactions which use nitrogen electrophiles include; for example, nitration and nitro-de- hydrogenation, nitr ⁇ sation of nitroso-de-hydrogenation, diazonium coupling/ direct introduction ofthe diazonium group, and amination or arnino-de-hydrogenation.
  • Reactions of this type with sulfur electrophiles include, for example, sulfphation, sulfo-de-hydrogenation, halosulfonation, halosulfo-de-hydrogenation, sulfurization, and sulfonylation.
  • Reactions using halogen , electrophiles include, for example, halogenatip'n, and halo-de-hydrogenation.
  • Aromatic > electrophilic substitution reactions with carbon electrophiles include, for example, Friedel-Crafts alkylation, alkylation, alkyl-de-hydrogenation, Friedel-Crafts arylation (the Scholl reaction), Friedel-Crafts acylation, formylation with disubstituted formamides, formylation with zinc cyanide and HCl (the Gatterman reaction), formylation with chloroform (the Reimer-Tiemanh * reaction), other formylations, formyl-de-hydrogenation, carboxylation with carbonyl halides, carboxylation with carbon dioxide (the Kolbe-Schmitt reaction), amidation with isocyanates, N- alkylcarbamoyl-de-hydrogenation, hydroxyalkylation, hydroxyalkyl-de-hydrogenation, cyclodehydration of aldehydes and ketones, haloalkylation, halo-de-hydrogenation, aminoalkylation, amidoalky
  • Rearrangement reactions include, for example, the Fries rearrangement, migration of a nitro group, migration of a nitroso group (the Fischer-Hepp Rearrangement), migration of an arylazo group, migration of a halogen (the Orton rearrangement), migration of an alkyl group, etc.
  • Other reaction on an aromatic ring include the reversal of a Friedel-Crafts alkylation, decarboxylation of aromatic aldehydes, decarboxylation of aromatic acids, the Jacobsen reaction, deoxygenation, desulfonation, hydro-de-sulfonation, dehalogenation, hydro-de-halogenation, and hydrolysis of organometallic compounds.
  • Aliphatic electrophilic substitution reactions are also useful. Reactions using the S E I, S E 2 (front), S E 2 (back), S ⁇ i, addition-elimination, and cyclic mechanisms can be used in the present invention. Reactions of this type with hydrogen as the leaving group include, for example, hydrogen exchange (deuterio-de-hydrogenation, deuteriation), migration, of a double bond, and keto-enol tautomerization. Reactions with halogen electrophiles include, for example, halogenation of aldehydes and ketones, halogenation of carboxylic acids and acyl halides, and halogenation of sulfoxides and sulfones.
  • Reactions with nitrogen electrophiles include, for , example, aliphatic diazonium coupling, nitrosation at a carbon bearing an active hydrogen, direct formation of diazo compounds, conversion of amides to ⁇ -azido amides, direct amination at an activated position, and insertion by nitrenes.
  • Reactions with sulfur or selenium electrophiles i include, for example, sulfenylation, sulfonation, and selenylation of ketones and Carboxylic ' . ' ' esters.
  • Reactions with carbon electrophiles include, for example, acylation at an aliphatic carbon, conversion of aldehydes to ⁇ -ketb esters or ketones, cyanation, cyano-de-hydrogenation, alkylation of alkanes, the Stork enamine reaction, and insertion by carbenes.
  • Reactions with metal electrophiles include, for example, metalation with organometallic compounds, metalation with metals and strong bases, and conversion of enolates to silyl enol ethers.
  • Aliphatic electrophilic substitution reactions with metals as leaving groups include, for example, replacement of metals by hydrogen, reactions between organometallic reagents and oxygen, reactions between organometallic reagents and peroxides, oxidation of trialkylboranes to borates, conversion of Grignard reagents to sulfur compounds, halo-de-metalation, the conversion of organometallic compounds to amines, the conversion of organometallic compounds to ketones, aldehydes, carboxylic esters and amides, cyano-de-metalation, transmetalation with a metal, transmetalation with a metal halide, transmetalation with an organometallic compound, reduction of alkyl halides, metallo-de-halogenation, replacement of a halogen by a metal from an organometallic compound, decarboxylation of aliphatic acids, cleavage of alkoxides, replacement of a carboxyl group by an acyl group, basic
  • Elecfrophlic substitution reactions at nitrogen include, for example, diazotization, conversion of hydrazines to azides, N-nitrosation, N-nitroso-de-hydrogenation, conversion of amines to azo compounds, N-halogenation, N-halo- de-hydrogenation, reactions of amines with carbon monoxide, and reactions of amines with carbon dioxide.
  • Aromatic nucleophilic substitution reactions may also be used in the present invention. Reactions proceeding via the S ⁇ A ⁇ mechanism, the S ⁇ I mechanism, the benzyne mechanism, the S R ⁇ I mechanism, or other mechanism, for example, can be used. Aromatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with oxygen nucleophiles.
  • reactions with sulfur nucleophiles include, for example', replacement by'SH or SR.
  • reactions using nitrogen nucleophiles include, for example, replacement by NH 2 , NHR, or NR 2 , and replacement of a , hydroxy group by an amino group:
  • Reactions with halogen nucleophiles include, for example, the introduction halogens.
  • Aromatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with hydrogen as the nucleophile include, for example, reduction of phenols and phenolic esters and ethers, and i reduction of halides and nitro compounds.
  • Reactions with carbon nucleophiles include, for example, the Rosenmund-von Braun reaction, coupling of organometallic compounds with aryl halides, ethers, and carboxylic esters, arylation at a carbon containing an active hydrogen, conversions of aryl substrates to carboxylic acids, their derivatives, aldehydes, and ketones, and the Ullmann reaction.
  • Reactions with hydrogen as the leaving group include, for example, alkylation, arylation, and amination of nitrogen heterocycles.
  • Reactions with N 2 + as the leaving group include, for example, hydroxy-de-diazoniation, replacement by sulfur-containing groups, iodo-de-diazoniation, and the Schiemann reaction.
  • Rearrangement reactions include, for example, the von Richter rearrangement, the Sommelet-Hauser rearrangement, rearrangement of aryl hydroxylamines, and the Smiles rearrangement.
  • Reactions involving free radicals can also be used, although the free radical reactions used in nucleotide-templated chemistry should be carefully chosen to avoid modification or cleavage ofthe nucleotide template. With that limitation, free radical substitution reactions can be used in the present invention.
  • Particular free radical substitution reactions include, for example, substitution by halogen, halogenation at an alkyl carbon, allylic halogenation, benzylic halogenation, halogenation of aldehydes, hydroxylation at an aliphatic carbon, hydroxylation at an aromatic carbon, oxidation of aldehydes to carboxylic acids, formation of cyclic ethers, formation of hydroperoxides, formation of peroxides, acyloxylation, acyloxy-de-hydrogenation, chlorosulfonation, nitration of alkanes, direct conversion of aldehydes to amides, amidation and amination at an alkyl carbon, simple coupling at a susceptible position, coupling of alkynes, arylation of aromatic compounds by diazonium salts, arylation of activated alkenes by diazonium salts (the Meerwein arylation), arylation and alkylation of alkenes by organopalladium compounds (the Heck reaction),
  • Free radical , ' substitution reactions with metals as leaving groups include, for example, coupling of Grignard reagents,' coupling of boranes, and coupling of other organometallic reagents. Reaction with halogen as the leaving group are included.
  • reactions involving additions' to carbon-carbon multiple bonds are also used in nucleotide-templated chemistry. Any mechanism may be used in the addition reaction including, for example, electrophilic addition, nucleophilic addition, free radical addition, and cyclic mechanisms. Reactions involving additions to conjugated systems can also be used. Addition to cyclopropane rings can also be utilized.
  • Particular reactions include, for example, isomerization, addition of hydrogen halides, hydration of double bonds, hydration of triple bonds, addition of alcohols, addition of carboxylic acids, addition of H S and thiols, addition of ammonia and amines, addition of amides, addition of hydrazoic acid, hydrogenation of double and triple bonds, other reduction of double and triple bonds, reduction ofthe double and triple bonds of conjugated systems, hydrogenation of aromatic rings, reductive cleavage of cyclopropanes, hydroboration, other hydrometalations, addition of alkanes, addition of alkenes and/or alkynes to alkenes and/or alkynes (e.g., pi-cation cyclization reactions, hydro-alkenyl-addition), ene reactions, the Michael reaction, addition of organometallics to double and triple bonds not conjugated to carbonyls, the addition of two alkyl groups to an alkyne, 1,4-addition of organometallic compounds to activate
  • addition reactions to carbon-hetero multiple bonds can be used in nucleotide-templated chemistry.
  • Exemplary reactions include, for example, the addition of water to aldehydes and ketones (formation of hydrates), hydrolysis of carbon-nitrogen double bond, hydrolysis of aliphatic nitro compounds, hydrolysis of nitriles, addition of alcohols and thiols to aldehydes and ketones, reductive alkylation of alcohols, addition of alcohols to isocyanates, alcoholysis of nitriles, formation of xanthates, addition of H S and thiols to carbonyl compounds, formation of bisulfite addition products, addition of amines to aldehydes and ketones, addition of amides to aldehydes, reductive alkylation of ammonia or amines, the Mannich reaction, the addition of amines to isocyanates, addition of ammonia or amines, the Mannich reaction, the addition of amines to isocyan
  • Elimination reactions including ⁇ , ⁇ , and ⁇ eliminations, as well as extrusion reactions, can be performed using nucleotide-templated chemistry, although the strength ofthe reagents and conditions employed should be considered.
  • Preferred elimination reactions include reactions that go by El, E2, ElcB, or E2C mechanisms.
  • Exemplary reactions include, for example, reactions in which hydrogen is removed from one side (e.g., dehydration of alcohols, cleavage of ethers to alkenes, the Chugaev reaction, ester decomposition, cleavage of quarternary ammonium hydroxides, cleavage of quaternary ammonium salts with strong bases, cleavage of amine oxides, pyrolysis of keto-ylids, decomposition of toluene-p-solfonylhydrazones, cleavage of sulfoxides, cleavage of selenoxides, cleavage of sulfornes, dehydrogalogenation of alkyl halides, dehydrohalogenation of acyl halides, dehydrohalogenation of sulfonyl halides, elimination of boranes, conversion of alkenes to alkynes, decarbonylation of acyl halides), reactions in which neither leaving atom is hydrogen (e.
  • Extrusion reactions include, for example, extrusion of N 2 from pyrazolines, extrusion of N 2 from pyrazoles, extrusion of N 2 from triazolines, extrusion of CO, extrusion of CO 2 , extrusion of SO , the Story synthesis, and alkene synthesis by twofold extrusion.
  • Rearrangements including, for example, nucleophilic rearrangements, electrophilic rearrangements, prototropic rearrangements, and free-radical rearrangements, can also be performed using nucleotide-templated chemistry. Both 1,2 rearrangements and non- 1,2 rearrangements can be performed.
  • Exemplary reactions include, for example, carbon-to-carbon migrations of R, H, and Ar (e.g., Wagner-Meerwein and related reactions, the Pinacol rearrangement, ring expansion reactions, ring contraction reactions, acid-catalyzed rearrangements of aldehydes and ketones, the dienone-phenol rearrangement, the Favorskii rearrangement, the Arndt-Eistert synthesis, homologation of aldehydes, and homologation of ketones), carbon-to-carbon migrations of other groups (e.g., migrations of halogen, hydroxyl, amino, etc.; migration of boron; and the Neber rearrangement), carbon-to-nitrogen migrations of R and Ar (e.g., the Hofmann rearrangement, the Curtius rearrangement, the Lossen rearrangement, the Schmidt reaction, the Beckman rearrangement, the Stieglits rearrangement, and related rearrangements), carbon-to-oxygen migrations of R and Ar (e
  • Oxidative and reductive reactions may also be performed using nucleptide- templated chemistry.
  • Exemplary reactions may involve, for example, direct electron transfer, hydride transfer, hydrogen-atom transfer, formation of ester intermediates, displacement mechanisms, or addition-elimination mechanisms.
  • Exemplary oxidations include, for exaniple, eliminations of hydrogen (e.g., aromatization of six-membered rings, dehydrogenations yielding carbon-carbon double bonds, oxidation or dehydrogenation of alcohols to aldehydes and ketones, oxidation of phenols and aromatic amines to quinones, oxidative cleavage of ketones, oxidative cleavage of aldehydes, oxidative cleavage of alcohols, ozonolysis, oxidative cleavage of double bonds and aromatic rings, oxidation of aromatic side chains, oxidative decarboxylation, and bisdecarboxylation), reactions involving replacement of hydrogen by oxygen (e.g., oxidation of methylene to carbonyl, oxidation of methylene to OH, CO 2 R, or OR, oxidation of arylmethanes, oxidation of ethers to carboxylic esters and related reactions, oxidation of aromatic hydrocarbons to quinones, oxidation of
  • Exemplary reductive reactions include, for example, reactions involving replacement of oxygen by hydrogen ' (e.g., reduction of carbonyl to methylene in aldehydes and ' ketones, reduction of carboxylic acids to alcqhols, reduction of amides to amines, reduction of carboxylic esters to ethers, reduction of cyclic anhydrides to lactones and acid derivatives to alcohols, reduction of carboxylic esters to alcohols* reduction of carboxylic acids and esters to alkanes, complete reduction of epoxides, reduction of nitro compounds to a ⁇ unes, reduction of nitro compounds to hydroxylamines, reduction pf nitr ⁇ so' compounds and hydroxylamines to 1 amines, reduction of oximes to primary amines' or aziridines, reduction of azides to primary amines, reduction of nitrogen compounds, and reduction of sulfonyl halides and sulfonic acids to • thiols), removal of oxygen from hydrogen '
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis can proceed stereoselectively without the assistance of chiral groups beyond those present in the nucleic acid, thereby transferring not only sequence but also stereochemical information from the template to the product.
  • Previous studies have demonstrated that the chirality of nucleic acid templates can induce a preference for the template-directed ligation of (D)-nucleotides over (L)-nucleotides (Kozlov et al. (2000) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 39: 4292- 4295; Bolli et al. (1997) A. CHEM. BIOL.4: 309-320).
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis it is possible to transfer the chirality of a nucleic acid template transfer unit, catalyst or a combination ofthe foregoing to reaction products that do not resemble the nucleic acid backbone.
  • the reactive unit with a chiral center is associated with the template and the reactive unit associated with the transfer unit is achiral, while in other embodiments, the transfer unit's reactive unit is chiral and the template's reactive unit is achiral.
  • both reactive units can possess chiral
  • the chirality ofthe template directs which ofthe chiral reactive unit's stereoisomers reacts preferentially (i.e., with a higher rate constant) with the other reactive unit.
  • Useful template architectures include the H type, E. type, ⁇ type and T type architecture.
  • One or more template or transfer unit nucleotides may be replaced with non- nucleotide, linkers, however, replacement ofthe nucleotides nearest the reactive units may result in loss of stereoselectivity.
  • Preferably, 5 or more consecutive aromatic nucleotides are adjacent to the reactive units, and more preferably 6 or more consecutive aromatic nucleotides are adjacent to the reactive units.
  • double-stranded DNA sequences rich in (5-Me-C)G repeats can adopt a left-handed helix (Z-form) rather than the usual right-handed helix (B-form).
  • Z-form left-handed helix
  • B-form right-handed helix
  • a high concentration e.g., at least 2.5 M, or at least 5 M
  • a salt such as, for example, sodium chloride (NaCI) or sodium sulfate (Na 2 SO 4 ) is used during DNA-templated synthesis.
  • the concentration of salt is low (e.g., not greater than 100 mM) or is not present at all. The principles of DNA-templated stereospecific reactions are discussed in more detail in Example 6.
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis it has been discovered that during nucleic acid-templated synthesis, oligonucleotides can simultaneously direct several different types of synthetic reactions within the same solution, even though the reactants involved would be cross-reactive and therefore incompatible under traditional synthesis conditions (see, Example 7). As a result, nucleic acid- templated synthesis permits one-pot diversification of synthetic library precursors into products of multiple reaction types.
  • one or more templates associated with a single reactive unit are exposed to two or more transfer units, each associated with a different reagent that is capable of reacting with the templates reactive unit.
  • one or more transfer units associated with a single reagent are exposed to two or more templates, each associated with a different reactive unit that is capable of reacting, with the reagent.
  • nucleic acid-templated chemistries described herein use very low concentrations'of reactants, that because of concentration effects do not reacj: with one another: It is only when the reactants are brought together via annealing ofthe oligonucleotide in the ' transfer unit to the template that their local concentrations are increased to permit a reaction occur.
  • a single accessory reagent i.e., a reagent not linked, to a nucleic > acid or nucleic acid analbg
  • a single accessory reagent i.e., a reagent not linked, to a nucleic > acid or nucleic acid analbg
  • a single accessory reagent such as, for example, a reducing agent, an oxidizing agent, or an activating agent, is added to the reaction.
  • no accessory reagent is added.
  • templates and transfer units are provided as described above, but the template reactive units and transfer unit reagents react with one another using multiple different reaction types. In some embodiments, multiple different accessory reagents are added to the reaction. Again, only reaction products resulting from complimentary template/transfer unit sequences are formed in appreciable amounts.
  • multiple transfer unit reagents are capable of reacting with each template reactive unit, and some ofthe transfer unit reagents can cross-react with one another. Even in the presence of several different cross-reactive functional groups, only reaction products resulting from complimentary template/transfer unit sequences are formed in appreciable amounts.
  • nucleic acid- ⁇ . ⁇ templatpd synthesis can be used to discover previously unknown chemical reactions between two or more reactive units.
  • multiple templates are synthesized, each comprising a different reactive unit coupled to a different oligonucleotide.
  • Each template oligonucleotide contains a coding region, wliich identifies the reactive unit attached to the template, and an annealing region.
  • other sequences are included in the template pligonucleotide, including, for example, PCR primer sites.
  • Transfer units are also prepared, each comprising a different reagent coupled to a different oligonucleotide.
  • one or more templates are combined with one or more transfer units under conditions that allow for hybridization ofthe transfer units to the templates.
  • non-DNA linked accessory molecules are added to the reaction, such as, for example, an activating agent or a catalyst.
  • reaction conditions including, for example, reaction duration, temperature, solvent, and pH, are varied to select reactions that proceed at different rates and under different conditions.
  • the crude reaction mixture then is selected for particular reaction products.
  • the reaction products preferably still are associated with their respective templates whose nucleotide sequence encodes the bond forming reactions that produced the reaction products.
  • the transfer unit is coupled to a capturable molecule, such as, for example, biotin.
  • the associated templates can be selected by capturing the biotin by streptavidin.
  • the streptavidin is immobilized to a solid support, for example, by linkage to a magnetic bead.
  • the selected templates then are amplified by PCR and subjected to DNA sequencing to determine the identities ofthe reactive unit and the reagent.
  • the reactions revealed by the above approach are characterized in a non-DNA-templated format in both aqueous and organic solvents using traditional reaction analysis methods including, for example, thin-layer chromatography, NMR, HPLC, and mass spectroscopy.
  • nucleic acid-templated library synthesis A major practical difference, between traditional and nucleic acid-templated library synthesis is the scale of each manipulation. Due to the amounts of material needed for ' screening and compound identification, traditional, combinatorial syntheses typically proceed on the nmol- ⁇ mpl scale per library member. , In contrast, nucleic acid-templated library synthesis can take place on the frnol-pmol scale because only mmute quantities (e.g., about 10 " mol) of each nucleic acid-linked synthetic molecule are needed for selection and PCR amplification. This vast difference in scale, combined with the: single-solution format ofthe nucleic acid- templated libraries, simplifies significantly the preparation of materials required for nucleic acid- templated library syntheses. [0239] Libraries can be produced via the template mediated syntheses described herein.
  • the template may comprise one or rriore reactive units (for example, scaffold molecules). However, in each case the template contains a coding sequence that identifies the particular reactive unit associated with the oligonucleotide.
  • a library of templates is initially subjected to one or more nucleic acid-templated bond formation reactions using reagents attached to decoding oligonucleotides through a linker as described above.
  • the template library can be subjected to multiple iterations of bond formation reactions, wherein each intermediate product is purified before the subsequent round of reactions. In other circumstances, the intermediate products are not purified between reaction iterations.
  • Preferably less than 20 bond forming reactions are required to create a library. In other embodiments, less than 10 bond forming reaction steps are needed, and more preferably, between 3 and 7 steps are needed to create a full library.
  • accessory reagents can be added to protect exposed reactive functional groups on the reaction product, if necessary.
  • accessory reagents are added to initiate a subsequent reaction with the reaction product, such as, for example, a cyclization reaction.
  • the resulting library of reaction products attached to template oligonucleotides then are purified and/or selected as discussed herein.
  • libraries of small molecules or polymers can be synthesized using the principles discussed herein.
  • the template encodes two or more codons which when annealed to corresponding anti-codons attached to monomer units bring together the monomer units in a sequence specific manner.
  • the transfer units then are allowed to contact the template under conditions that permit hybridization ofthe anti-codons on eachtransfer unit to the complementary codon on the template. Polymerization ofthe monomer units along the template then produces the polymer.
  • the polymerization may be step-by-step or may be essentially simultaneous with the chain being formed in one large reaction with one reaction between adjacent monomers leading to the attachment ofthe next monomer.
  • the functional group or groups of each monomer are protected, and must be deprotected prior to polymerization.
  • the newly synthesized polymer can then be cleaved from the anti-codons and the template, and selected for a. desired activity or characteristic, as described herein. DNA-templated polymer synthesis reactions are described in more detail in Example 9A and 9C.
  • Selection and/or screening for reaction products with desired activities may be performed according to any standard protocol.
  • affinity selections may be performed according to the principles used in library-based selection methods such as phage display, polysome display, and mRNA-fusion protein displayed peptides.
  • Selection for catalytic activity may be performed by affinity selections on transition-state analog affinity columns (Baca et al. (1997) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 94(19): 10063-8) or by function-based selection schemes (Pedersen et al. (1998) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 95(18): 10523-8).
  • the templates and reaction products can be selected (or screened) for binding to a target molecule.
  • selection or partitioning means any process whereby a library member bound to a target molecule is separated from library members not bound to target molecules. ' Selection can be accomplished by various methods known in the art. .
  • the templates ofthe present invention contain a built-in function for direct selection and amplification. In most applications, binding to a target molecule preferably is ' selective, such that the template and the resulting reaction product bind preferentially with a specific target molecule, perhaps preventing or inducing a specific biological effect. Ultimately, a binding molecule identified using the present invention may be useful as a therapeutic and/or diagnostic agent.
  • the selected templates optionally can be amplified and sequenced.
  • the selected reaction products if present in sufficient quantity, can be separated from the templates, purified (e.g., by HPLC, column chromatography, or other chromatographic method), and further characterized.
  • Binding assays provide a rapid means for isolating and identifying reaction products that bind to, for example, a surface (such as metal, plastic, composite, glass, ceramics, rubber, skin, or tissue); a polymer; a catalyst; or a target biomolecule such as a nucleic acid, a protein (including enzymes, receptors, antibodies, and glycoproteins), a signal molecule (such as cAMP, inositol triphosphate, peptides, or prostaglandins), a carbohydrate, or a lipid. Binding assays can be advantageously combined with activity assays for the effect of a reaction product on a function of a target molecule.
  • the selection strategy can be carried out to allow selection against almost any target. Importantly, the selection strategy does not require any detailed structural information about the target molecule or about the molecules in the libraries. The entire process is driven by the binding affinity involved in the specific recognition and binding ofthe molecules in the library to a given target. Examples of various selection procedures are described below.
  • the libraries ofthe present invention can contain molecules that could potentially bind to any known or unknown target.
  • the binding region of a target molecule could include a catalytic site of an enzyme, a binding pocket on a receptor (for example, a G-protein coupled receptor), a protein surface area involved in a protean-protein or protein-nucleic acid interaction (preferably a hot-spot region), or a specific site, on DNA/ (such as the major groove).
  • the natural function of the target' could be stimulated (agonized), reduced (antagonized), unaffected, or completely changed by the binding ofthe reaction product. This will depend on the precise binding mode and the particular binding site the reaction product occupies on the target,
  • Functional sites such as protein-protein interaction or catalytic sites
  • proteins often are more prone to bind molecules than are, other more neutral surface areas on a protein.
  • these functional sites normally contain a smaller region that seems, to be primarily , responsible for the binding energy: the so-called ''hot-spot regions" (Wells, et al. (1993) RECENT PROG. HORMONE RES,. 48: 253- 262). This phenomenon facilitates selection for molecules affecting the biological function of a certain target,
  • the linkage between the template! molequle and reaction product allows rapid , identification of binding molecules using various selection strategies.
  • This invention broadly permits identifying binding molecules for any known target molecule.
  • novel unknown targets can be discovered by isolating binding molecules against unknown antigens (epitopes) and using these binding molecules for identification and validation.
  • the target molecule is designed to mimic a transition state of a chemical reaction; one or more reaction products resulting from the selection may stabilize the transition state and catalyze the chemical reaction.
  • the template-directed synthesis of the invention permits selection procedures analogous to other display methods such as phage display (Smith (1985) SCIENCE 228: 1315- 1317). Phage display selection has been used successfully on peptides (Wells et al. (1992) CURR. OP. STRUCT. BIOL.2: 597-604), proteins (Marks etal. (1992) J. BIOL. CHEM. 267: 16007- 16010) and antibodies (Winter et al. (1994) ANNU. REV. IMMUNOL. 12: 433-455). Similar selection procedures also are exploited for other types of display systems such as ribosome display Mattheakis et al. (1994) PROC. NATL.
  • ACAD. SCI. 91: 9022-9026 and mRNA display (Roberts, et al (1997) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. 94:12297-302).
  • the libraries ofthe present invention allow direct selection of target-specific molecules without requiring traditional ribosome-mediated translation.
  • the present invention also allows the display of small molecules which have not previously been synthesized directly from a nucleic acid template. ⁇
  • binding molecules from a library can be performed in any format to identify optimal binding molecules. Binding selections typically involve immobilizing the desired target molecule, adding a library of potential binders, and removing non-binders by washing. When the molecules showing low affinity for an immobilized target are washed away, the molecules with a stronger affinity generally remain attached to the target.
  • the enriched population remaining bound to the target after stringent washing is preferably eluted with, for example, acid, chaotropic salts, heat, competitive elution with a known ligand or by proteolytic
  • the eluted templates are suitable for PCR, leading to many orders of amplification, whereby essentially each selected template becomes available at a greatly increased copy number for cloning, sequencing, and/or further enrichment or diversification.
  • the fraction of ligand bound to target is determined by the effective concentration ofthe target protein (see, Figure 10).
  • the target molecule (peptide, protein, DNA or other antigen) can be immobilized on a solid support, for example, a container wall, a wall of a microtiter plate well.
  • the library preferably is dissolved in aqueous binding buffer in one pot and equilibrated in the presence of immobilized target molecule. Non-binders are washed away with buffer. Those molecules that may be binding to the target molecule through their attached DNA templates rather than through their synthetic moieties can be eliminated by washing the bound library with unfunctionalized templates lacking PCR primer binding sites. Remaining bound library members then can be eluted, for example, by denaturation.
  • the target molecule can be immobilized on beads, particularly if there is doubt that the target molecule will adsorb sufficiently to a container wall, as may be the case for an unfolded target eluted from an SDS-PAGE gel.
  • the derivatized beads can then be used to separate high-affinity library members from nonbinders by simply sedimenting the beads in a benchtop centrifuge.
  • the beads can be used to make an affimty column. In such cases, the library is passed through'the column one or more times to permit binding. The column then is washed to remove nonbinding library members.
  • Magnetic beads are essentially a variant on the above; the target is attached to magnetic beads which are then used in the selection. ' > ⁇
  • the target molecule There are many reactive matrices available for immobilizing the target molecule, including matrices bearing -NH 2 groups or -SH groups.
  • the target molecule can be immobilized by conjugation with NHS ester or maleimide groups pvalently linked to Sepharose beads and the integrity of known properties ofthe target molecule can be verified.
  • Activated beads are available with attachment sites for -NH 2 or -COOH groups (which can be used for coupling).
  • the target molecule is blotted onto nitrocellulose or PVDF. When using a blotting strategy, the blot should be blocked (e.g., with BSA or similar protein) after immobilization of the target to prevent nonspecific binding of library members to the blot.
  • Library members that bind a target molecule can be released by denaturation, acid, or chaotropic salts.
  • elution conditions can be more specific to reduce ' background or to select for a desired specificity. Elution can be accomplished using proteolysis to cleave a linker between the target molecule and the immobilizing surface or between the reaction product and the template. Also, elution can be accomplished by competition with a known competitive ligand for the target molecule. Alternatively, a PCR reaction can be performed directly in the presence ofthe washed target molecules at the end ofthe selection procedure.
  • the binding molecules need not be elutable from the target to be selectable since only the template is needed for further amplification or cloning, not the reaction product itself. Indeed, some target molecules bind the most avid ligands so tightly that elution would be difficult.
  • the cells themselves can be used as the selection agent.
  • the library preferably is first exposed to cells not expressing the target molecule on their surfaces to remove library members that bind specifically or non specifically to other cell surface epitopes.
  • cells lacking the target molecule are present in large excess in the selection process and separable (by fluorescence-activated cell sorting (FACS), for example) from cells bearing the target molecule.
  • FACS fluorescence-activated cell sorting
  • cells bearing the target molecule then are used to isolate library members bearing the target molecule (e.g., by sedimenting the cells or by FA.CS sorting).
  • a recombinant DNA encoding the target molecule can be introduced into a cell line; library members that bind the transformed cells but not the untransformed cells are enriched for target molecule binders. This approach is also called . subtraction, selection and has successfully been used for phage display on antibody libraries (Hoogenboom et ⁇ /. (1998) IMMUNOTECH 4:T- 20). , '
  • a selection procedure can also involve selection for binding to cell surface re ⁇ ept ⁇ rs that are internalized so that the, receptor together with the selected binding molecule passes into the cytoplasm, nucleus, or other cellular compartment, such as the Golgi or lysosomes. Depending on the dissociation rate constant for specific selected binding molecules, these molecules may localize primarily within the intracellular compartments.
  • Internalized library members can be distinguished from molecules attached to the cell surface by washing the cells, preferably with a denaturant. More preferably, standard subcellular fractionation techniques are used to isolate the selected library members in a desired subcellular compartment.
  • An alternative selection protocol also includes a known, weak ligand affixed to each member ofthe library.
  • the known ligand guides the selection by interacting with a defined part ofthe target molecule and focuses the selection on molecules that bind to the same region, providing a cooperative effect. This can be particularly useful for increasing the affinity of a ligand with a desired biological function but with too low a potency.
  • Other methods for selection or partitioning are also available for use with the present invention. These include, for example: immunoprecipitation (direct or indirect) where the target molecule is captured together with library members; mobility shift assays in agarose or polyacrylamide gels, where the selected library members migrate with the target molecule in a gel; cesium chloride gradient centrifugation to isolate the target molecule with library members; mass specfroscopy to identify target molecules labeled with library members. In general, any method where the library member/ target molecule complex can be separated from library members not bound to the target is useful.
  • the selection process is well suited for optimizations, where the selection steps are made in series, starting with the selection of binding molecules and ending with an optimized binding molecule.
  • the procedures in each step can be automated using various robotic systems.
  • the invention permits supplying a suitable library and target molecule to a fully automatic system which finally generates an optimized binding molecule. Under ideal conditions, this process should run without any requirement/ or external'work outside the robotic system during the entire procedure. ' ' , ' , ' .
  • the selection methods ofthe present invention can be combined with secondary selection or screening to identify reaction products capable of modifying target moleculb function upon binding.
  • the methods .described herein can be employe to isolate or produce binding molecules that bind to and modify the function of any protein or nucleic acid.
  • nucleic acid-templated chemistry can he used to identify, isolate, or produce , binding molecules (1) affecting catalytic activity of target enzymes by inhibiting catalysis or , modifying substrate binding; (2) affecting the functionality of protein receptors, by inhibiting binding to receptors or by modifying the specificity of binding to receptors; (3) affecting the formation of protein multimers by disrupting the quaternary structure of protein subunits; or (4)
  • Functional assays can be included in the selection process. For example, after selecting for binding activity, selected library members can be directly tested for a desired > functional effect, such as an effect on cell signaling. This can, for example, be performed via FACS methodologies. .
  • the binding molecules ofthe invention can be selected for other properties in addition to binding. For example, to select for stability of binding interactions in a desired working environment. If stability in the presence of a certain protease is desired, that protease can be part ofthe buffer medium used during selection. Similarly, the selection can be performed in serum or cell extracts or in any type of medium, aqueous or organic. Conditions that disrupt or degrade the template should however be avoided to allow subsequent amplification. (iv) Other Selections
  • selections for other desired properties can also be performed.
  • the selection should be designed such that library members with the desired activity are isolatable on that basis from other library members.
  • library members can be screened for the ability to fold or otherwise significantly change conformation in the presence of a target molecule, such as a metal ion, or under particular pH or salinity conditions.
  • the folded library members can be isolated by performing non-deriaturing gel electrophoresis under the conditions of interest. The folded library members , migrate to a different position in the gel and can subsequently be extracted from the gel and ⁇ , ' ' ' isolated. . , ' ⁇ ' ' . , ' . ' ' '
  • reaction products that fluoresce in the presence of specific ligands may be selected by FACS based sorting of translated polymers linked through their DNA templates to beads. Those beads that fluoresce in the presence, , but not in the absence, ofthe target ligand are isolated and characterized.
  • Useful beads with a homogenous population of nucleic acid- templates on any bead can be prepared using.the split-pool synthesis technique on the bead, such that each bead is exposed to only a single nucleotide sequence.
  • a different ariti r template (each complementary to only a single ⁇ different template) can by synthesized on beads using a split-pool technique, and then can anneal to capture a solution-phase library.
  • Biotin-terminated biopolymers can be splected for the actual catalysis of bond- , breaking reactions by passing these biopolymers over a resin linked through a substrate to avidin ( Figure 11A). Those biopolymers that catalyze substrate cleavage self-elute from a col ⁇ mn charged with this resin. Similarly, biotin-terminated biopolymers can be selected for the ' catalysis of bond-forming reactions (see, Figure 11B). One substrate is linked to resin and the second substrate is linked to avidin. Biopolymers that catalyze bond formation between the substrates are selected by their ability to react the' substrates together, resulting in attachment of the biopolymer to the resin.
  • Library members can also be selected for their catalytic effects on synthesis of a polymer to which the template is or becomes attached.
  • the library member may influence the selection of monomer units to be polymerized as well as how the polymerization reaction takes place (e.g., stereochemistry, tacticity, activity).
  • the synthesized polymers can be selected for specific properties, such as, molecular weight, density, hydrophobicity, tacticity, stereoselectivity, using standard techniques, such as, electrophoresis, gel filtration, centrifugal sedimentation, or partitioning into solvents of different hydrophobicities.
  • the attached template that directed the synthesis ofthe polymer can then be identified.
  • Library members that catalyze virtually any reaction causing bond formation between two substrate molecules or resulting in bond breakage into two product molecules can be selected using the schemes proposed in Figures 12 and 13.
  • bond forming catalysts for example, hetero Diels- Alder, Heck coupling, aldol reaction, or olefin metathesis catalysts
  • library members are covalently linked to one substrate through their 5' amino or thiol termini.
  • the other substrate ofthe reaction is synthesized as a derivative linked to biotin.
  • those library members that catalyze bond formation cause the biotin group to become covalently attached to themselves.
  • Active bond forming catalysts can then be separated from inactive library members by capturing the former with immobilized streptavidin and washing away inactive library members ( Figure 12).
  • library members that catalyze bond cleavage reactions such as retro-aldol reactions, amide hydrolysis, elimination reactions, or olefin dihydroxylation followed by periodate cleavage can be selected.
  • library members are covalently linked to biotinylated substrates such that the bond breakage reaction causes the disconnection of the biotin moiety from the library members ( Figure 13).
  • active catalysts but not inactive library members, induce the loss of their biotin groups.
  • Streptavidin-linked beads can then be used to capture inactive polymers, while active catalysts are able to be eluted from the beads.
  • RNAs and DNAs selected in this manner have in general proven to be multiple turnover catalysts when separated from their substrate moieties (Jaschke et al. (2000) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 4: 257-62; Jaeger et a (1999) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 96: 14712-7; Bartel et al. (1993) SCIENCE 261: 1411-8; Sen et al (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 680-7).
  • Substrate specificity among catalysts can be selected by selecting for active catalysts in the presence ofthe desired substrate and then selecting for inactive catalysts in the presence of one or more undesired substrates. If the desired and undesired substrates differ by their configuration at one or more stereocenters, enantioselective or diastereoselective catalysts can emerge from rounds of selection.
  • metal selectivity can be evolved by selecting for active catalysts in the presence of desired metals and selecting for inactive catalysts in the presence of undesired metals.
  • catalysts with broad substrate tolerance can be evolved by varying subsfrate structures between successive rounds of selection. . '' , ' '
  • a first rpund of selection provides at least a 50-fold increase in the number of binding ligands.
  • the increase in enrichments is over 100-fold, more preferably over 1,000 fold, and even more preferably over 100,000-fold.
  • Subsequent rounds of selection may further increase the enrichment 100-fold over the original library, preferably 1 ,000-fold, more preferably over 100,000-fold, and most preferably over 1 ,000,000-fold. .
  • in vitro selections can also select for specificity in addition to binding affinity.
  • Library screening methods for binding specificity typically require duplicating the entire screen for each target or non-target of interest.
  • selections for specificity can be performed in a single experiment by selecting for target binding as well as for the inability to bind one or more non-targets.
  • the library can be pre-depleted by removing library members that bind to a non-target.
  • selection for binding to the target molecule can be performed in the presence of an excess of one or more non-targets, as described in Example 11.
  • the non-target can be a homologous molecule.
  • the target molecule is a protein
  • appropriate non-target proteins include, for example, a generally promiscuous protein such as an albumin. If the binding assay is designed to target only a specific portion of a target molecule, the non-target can be a variation on the molecule in which that portion has been changed or removed.
  • the templates which are, or formerly were, associated with the selected reaction product preferably are amplified using any suitable technique to facilitate sequencing or other subsequent manipulation ofthe templates.
  • Natural oligonucleotides can be amplified by any state ofthe art method. These methods include, for example, polymerase chain reaction (PCR); nucleic acid sequence-based amplification (see, for example, Compton (1991) NATURE 350: 91-92), amplified anti-sense RNA (see, for example, van Gelder et al. (1988) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 85: 77652-77656); self-sustained sequence replication systems (Gnatelli et al. (1990) PROC.
  • PCR polymerase chain reaction
  • nucleic acid sequence-based amplification see, for example, Compton (1991) NATURE 350: 91-92
  • amplified anti-sense RNA see, for example, van Gelder et al. (1988) PROC. NATL. ACAD
  • any means allowing faithful, efficient amplification of selected nucleic acid sequences can be employed in the method ofthe present invention. It is preferable, although not necessary, that the proportionate representations ofthe sequences after amplification reflect the relative proportions of sequences in the mixture before amplification.
  • non-natural nucleotides the choices of efficient amplification procedures are fewer. As non-natural nucleotides can be inco ⁇ orated by certain enzymes including polymerases it will be possible to perform manual polymerase chain reaction by adding the polymerase during each extension cycle. [0277] For oligonucleotides containing nucleotide analogs, fewer methods for amplification exist. One may use non-enzyme mediated amplification schemes (Schmidt et al. (1997) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 25: 4797-4802). For backbone-modified oligonucleotides such as PNA and LNA, this amplification method may be used.
  • Sequencing can be done by a, standard dideoxy chain termination method, or by chemical sequencing, for example, using the Maxam-Gilbert sequencing procedure. '
  • the sequence ofthe template (or, if a long template is used, the variable portion(s) thereof) can be determined by hybridization to a chip (see, Example 12).
  • a single- stranded template mqlecule associated with a detectable moiety such as a fluorescent moiety is exposed to a chip bearing a large number of ⁇ clpnal pop ⁇ lations of single-stranded nucleic acids, or nucleic acid analogs of known sequence ⁇ each clpnal population being present at a particular addressable location on the chip.
  • the template sequences are permitted to anneal to the ' chip , sequences.
  • the position ofthe detectable moieties on the chip then is determined. Based upon the location ofthe detectable moiety and the immobilized sequence at that location, the sequence ofthe template can be determined. It is contemplated that large numbers of such
  • oligonucleotides can be immobilized in an array on a chip or other solid support.
  • Inventive libraries can be evolved by introducing mutations at the DNA level, for example, using error-prone PCR (Cadwell et al. (1992) PCR METHODS APPL. 2: 28) or by subjecting the DNA to in vitro homologous recombination (Stemmer (1994) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 91: 10747; Stemmer (1994) NATURE 370: 389).
  • Random point mutagenesis is performed by conducting the PCR amplification step under enor-prone PCR (Cadwell et al (1992) PCR METHODS APPLIC. 2: 28.-33) conditions. Because the genetic code of these molecules are written to assign related codons to related chemical groups, similar to the way that the natural protein genetic code is constructed, random point mutations in the templates encoding selected molecules will diversify progeny towards chemically related analogs. Because error-prone PCR is inherently less efficient than normal PCR, error-prone PCR diversification is preferably conducted with only natural, dATP, dTTP, dCTP, and dGTP and using primers that lack chemical handles or biotin groups.
  • Libraries may be diversified using recombination.
  • Ddel C/TNAG
  • HrnFI G/ANTC
  • a prefened method of diversifying library members is through nonhomologous random recombination, as described, for example, in WO 02/074978; US Patent Application Publication No. 2003-0027180-Al ; and Bittker et al. (2002) NATURE BIOTECH. 20(10): 1024-9.
  • Random cassette mutagenesis is useful to create a diversified library from a fixed starting sequence.
  • a method can be used, for example, after a library has been subjected to selection and one or more library members have been isolated and sequenced.
  • a library of oligonucleotides with variations on the starting sequence is generated by traditional chemical synthesis, enor-prone PCR, or other methods.
  • a library of oligonucleotides can be generated in which, for each nucleotide position in a codon, tfre
  • 1 nucleotide has a 90% probability of being identical fo the starting sequence at that position, and a
  • the oligonucleotides can be complete templates when synthesized, or can be fragments that are subsequently ligated with other oligonucleotides to form a diverse library of templates.
  • the methods and compositions of the present invention represent new ways to generate molecules with desired properties.
  • This approach marries extremely powerful genetic methods, which molecular biologists have taken advantage of for decades, with the flexibility and power of organic chemistry.
  • the ability to prepare, amplify, and evolve unnatural polymers by genetic selection may lead to new classes of catalysts that possess activity, bioavailability, stability, fluorescence, photolability, or other properties that are difficult or impossible to achieve using the limited set of building blocks found in proteins and nucleic acids.
  • developing new systems for preparing, amplifying, and evolving small molecules by iterated cycles of mutation and selection may lead to the isolation of novel ligands or drugs with properties superior to those isolated by slower traditional drug discovery methods.
  • unnatural biopolymers useful as artificial receptors to selectively bind molecules or as catalysts for chemical reactions can be isolated. Characterization of these molecules would provide important insight into the ability of polycarbamates, polyureas, polyesters, polycarbonates, polypeptides with unnatural side chain and stereochemistries, or other unnatural polymers to form secondary or tertiary structures with binding or catalytic properties.
  • the present invention further allows the discovery of new chemical reactions.
  • the field of chemistry is continually being transformed by the discovery of new chemical reactions providing access to previously inaccessible molecules, allowing for expedited syntheses, and revealing new chemical principles: Guided by predictions of reactivity based on literature precedent, chemists typically search for a new reaction to overcome a particular' shortcoming in cunent synthetic methodology. Until now, it has not been feasible to conduct a broad, n ⁇ n-biased search for chemical reactivity iri which a large number of diverse reactants are simultaneously evaluated for their ability to react with one another under many different t conditions.
  • the inventive method of discovering chemical reactions offers a much greater chance of discovering unexpected and unprecedented reactivity that may lead to new insights into reactivity and to useful new reactions for chemical synthesis.
  • Discovering new reactions from very large and diverse collections of reactants and conditions entails (1) a general assay for reactivity that does not depend on a particular substrate or product, and (2) increasing the overall efficiency of assaying reactions such'that both reaction condition space and reactant space can be searched extensively.
  • researchers evolving catalytic nucleic acids routinely select for bond formation catalysts by attaching one reactant to the pool of evolving nucleic acids and linking another reactant to a handle that can be easily immobilized such as biotin (Wilson et al. (1999) ANNU. ' REV.
  • Nucleic acid-templated synthesis provides a way to use bond formation selections to discover new chemical reactivity independent of nucleic acid catalysis (Gartner et al. (2002) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 41: 1796-1800; Gartner et al. (2001) supra).
  • Nucleic acid templates can direct a wide variety of chemical reactions in a highly sequence-specific manner without any obvious requirements for reaction geometry. By attaching reactants to appropriately designed nucleic acid sequences, it becomes possible to test thousands of unprecedented reactions in a single pot with individual sequences encoding each reaction. Pools of nucleic acid-linked reactants would be truly selected (not simply screened) for covalent bond formation with members of a second nucleic acid-linked reactant pool. PCR amplification and DNA sequencing would reveal which combinations of reactants successfully undergo bond formation.
  • the searchable reactions are those transformations that can occur in aqueous or substantially aqueous medium. In other embodiments, the searchable reactions are limited to those that do not degrade nucleic acids rapidly.
  • the known chemical robustness of DNA suggests that a wide range of reaction conditions spanning different temperatures, pH ranges, and additives such as transition metals are compatible with the proposed approach.
  • a DNA-templated Heck reaction demonstrates that transition metal catalyzed reactions are viable in a DNA-templated format, consistent with extensive evidence (Patolsky et al. (2002) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 124: 770-772; Weizman et al. (2002) J. AM. CHEM. Soc.
  • Nucleic acid-templated chemistry is combined with in vitro selection and PCR amplification in certain embodiments to efficiently search for novel bond-forming reactions independent of reactant structures.
  • the ability to select directly for covalent bond formation, the minute scale required for analysis, and compatibility of nucleic acids with a wide variety of reaction conditions may permit the first search for unprecedented reactivity that can examine thousands of combinations of reactants and reaction conditions in one or several experiments.
  • DNA-linked reactants i.e., templates and/or transfer units
  • pool A and pool B DNA-linked reactants suitable for in vitro selection for bond formation exist in one or two forms designated pool A and pool B in Figure 9.
  • Each reactant in pool B contains a functional group being tested linked to a short segment of biotinylated DNA (a coding region) encoding that functional group.
  • Each reactant in pool A contains a functional group being tested, a conesponding coding region, and an "annealing region" or anti-codon that complements one of the pool B coding regions.
  • Each functional group in pool A is linked to one of every possible annealing region.
  • inventive DNA-templated small molecule libraries may be contacted with other solution or solid-phase libraries of potential target compounds such that small molecules within the inventive library that bind or interact with one or more compounds in the target libraries are identified.
  • bound pairs may be identified by selection (e.g., by tagging one ofthe components, combined with PCR to identify the other).
  • the target library or ' libraries comprise polypeptides and/or proteins. , , ⁇
  • the present invention also provides new modes of nucleic acid-templated synthesis, including simultaneous incompatible reactions and one pot multi-step ordered synthesis (e.g., incubating three DNA-linked amino acids and one template so that only a single tripeptide, of specified sequence, is produced).
  • the invention also provides nucleic acid- templated synthesis in organic solvents (e.g., methylene chloride, dimethylformamide).
  • Yet another application ofthe inventive system is to identify and/or eVolve new templates for nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • the present invention allows identification of nucleic acid templates that, when contacted with reagents that are sufficient to participate in a reaction to generate a selectable product, most efficiently lead to production of that product.
  • the invention also provides information useful to inform the development of chemical reaction pathways. For instance, according to the present invention, a researcher can select from within a library of nucleic acid-templated substrates those that permit a complex chemical reaction to take place (e.g., macrocyclization, which can be selected for by, for example, loss of a biotin leaving group). When successful reaction conditions have been identified, the inventive system allows ready identification of participating components. Thus, new chemistries can be developed without prior knowledge ofthe reagents and/or pathways likely to be useful in the reaction.
  • kits and compositions for use in the inventive methods.
  • the kits may contain any item or composition useful in practicing the present invention.
  • the kits may include, but are not limited to, templates, (e.g., end-of-helix, hai ⁇ in, omega, and T architectures), anticodons, transfer units, monomer units, building blocks, reactants, small molecule scaffolds, buffers, solvents, enzymes (e.g., heat stable polymerase, reverse transcriptase, ligase, restriction endonuclease, exonuclease, Klenow fragment, ' polymerase, alkaline' phosphatase, polynucleotide kinase), linkers, protectirig groups,, polynucleotides, nucleosides, nucleotides, salts, acids, bases, solid supports, or any combinations thereof.
  • templates e.g., end-of-helix, hai ⁇ in, omega, and T architectures
  • anticodons transfer units, mono
  • kits for preparing unnatural polymers should contain items needed to prepare , unnatural polymers using the methods described herein.
  • a kit may include templates,, anti-, codons, transfer units, monomers units, or combinations thereof.
  • a kit for synthesizing small molecules may include templates, anti-codons, transfer units, building blocks, small molecule, scaffolds, or combinations thereof.
  • the inventive kit can also be, .equipped with items needed to amplify and/or evolve a polynucleotide template such as a heat stable polymerase for PCR, nucleotides, buffer, and primers.
  • the inventive kit includes items commonly used in performing DNA shuffling such as polynucleotides, ligase, and nucleotides.
  • the present ' invention in addition to the templates and transfer units described herein, the present ' invention also includes compositions comprising complex small molecules, scaffolds, or unnatural polymer prepared by any one or more ofthe methods ofthe invention as described ⁇ herein.
  • a kit for identifying new chemical reactions or functionality may include template associated with reactive units (reactants), transfer units associated with reactive units (reactants), reagents, acids, bases, catalysts, solvents, biotin, avidin, avidin beads, etc.
  • the kit can also include reagents for generating the template associated with a reactive group (e.g., biotin, polynucleotides, reactive units, Klenow fragment of DNA pol I, nucleotides, avidin beads, etc.).
  • the kit can also include reagents for PCR (e.g., buffers, heat stable polymerase, nucleotides, primers, etc.).
  • Examples 1 and 2 describe the preparation of materials for use in nucleic acid- templated synthesis and describe specific synthetic reactions.
  • Example 3 discusses multi-step
  • Example 10 describes the synthesis of exemplary compounds and libraries.
  • Example 10 describes the use of polymerases to translate DNA into nonnafural polymers.
  • Example 11 describes in vitro selection protocols.
  • Example 12 describes the application of DNA-ten plated synthesis toward the discovery of new chemical reactions.
  • Example 1 The Generality of DNA-Templated Synthesis [0305] Nucleic acid-templated synthesis is extremely versatile and permits the synthesis of a variety of chemical compounds. This Example demonstrates that it is possible to perform DNA-templated synthesis using two different DNA template architectures.
  • both DNA templates support a sequence-specific DNA- templated reaction even though the structures ofthe resulting products differ markedly from the structure ofthe natural DNA backbone. Little or no non-templated intermolecular reaction products were observed under the reaction conditions (pH 7.5, 25 °C, 250 mM NaCI, 60 nM template transfer unit), demonstrating the specificity ofthe DNA-templated reaction.
  • Reactions with thiol reagents were conducted at pH 7.5 under the following conditions: SLAB and SBAP: 37°C, 16 hours; SIA: 25°C, 16 hours, SMCC, GMBS, BMPS, SVSB: 25°C, 10 minutes. .Reactions with amine reagents were conducted at 25°C, pH 8.5 for 75 minutes. Expected product masses were verified by mass spectrometry. In each case, matched but not mismatched reagents afforded ⁇ product efficiently despite considerable variations in their transition state geometry, steric hindrance, and conformational flexibility.
  • nucleic acid- templated synthesis is a general phenomenon capable of supporting a range of reaction types, and is not limited to the creation of structures resembling nucleic acid backbones.
  • Sequence discrimination is important for the faithful translation of a nucleic acid into a synthetic reaction product.
  • hai ⁇ in templates linked to an iodoacetamide group were reacted to thiol-bearing transfer units containing 0, 1, or 3 mismatches.
  • the distance independent reaction rates may be explained if the bond-forming events in a DNA-templated format are sufficiently accelerated relative to their nontemplated counte ⁇ arts such that DNA annealing, rather than bond formation, is rate-determining. If DNA annealing is at least partially rate limiting, then the rate of product formation should decrease as the concentration of reagents is lowered because annealing, unlike templated bond formation, is a bimolecular process.
  • Figure 20 shows that decreasing thd concentration of reactants in the case ofthe E template with one or ten intervening bases between reactive groups resulted in a marked decrease in the observed reaction rate.
  • This observation suggests that proximity effects in DNA-templated synthesis can enhance bond formation rates to the point that DNA annealing becomes rate-determining. . ' , [0314] ,
  • These findings raise the possibility o using DNA-templated synthesis to translate in one pot libraries of DNA into solution-phase libraries of synthetic molecules suitable for PCR amplification and selection.
  • the sequence specificity described above suggests that mixtures of reagents may be able to react predictably with complementary mixtures of templates.
  • the observed distance independence suggests that different template codons can be used to encode different reactions without impairing reactions rates.
  • DNA sequencing traces ofthe amplified templates before and after selection are also shown, together with the sequences ofthe non- biotin-encoding and biotin-encoding templates.
  • the results summarized in Figure 22A represent a 1, 000-fold enrichment compared with the unselected library.
  • DNA sequencing ofthe PCR amplified pool before and after selection suggested a similar degree of enrichment and indicated that the biotin-encoding template is the major product after selection and amplification ( Figure 22A).
  • the ability of DNA-templated synthesis to support the simultaneous sequence- specific reaction of 1,025 reagents, each of which faces a 1,024:1 ratio of non-partner to, partner templates demonstrates its potential as a method to create synthetic libraries in one pot. '
  • nucleic acid-templated synthesis is a su ⁇ risingly general phenomenon capable of directing, rather than simply encoding, a range of chemical reactions to form products unrelated jn structure to nucleioacid backbones.
  • the DNA-templated format accelerates the rate of bond f 'ormation ' ' beyond the rate of a 10-base DNA oligonucleotide annealing to its complement, resulting in su ⁇ rising distance independence.
  • DNA-templated reactions may also arise in part from the tendency of water to contract the volume of nonpolar reactants (see, C.-J. Li et al. Organic Reactions in Aqueous Media, Wiley and Sons: New York, 1997) and from possible compactness ofthe intervening single-stranded DNA between reactive groups.
  • DNA Synthesis DNA oligonucleotides were synthesized on a PerSeptive
  • Phosphoramidites enabling the synthesis of 5'-NH 2 -dT, 5' tetrachlorofluorescein, abasic backbone spacer, C3 backbone spacer, 9-bond polyethylene glycol spacer, 12-bond saturated hydrocarbon spacer, and 5' biotin groups were purchased from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA. Thiol-linked oligonucleotide reagents were synthesized on C3 disulfide controlled pore glass from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA. [0319] Template Functionalization.
  • Templates bearing 5'-NH 2 -dT groups were transformed into a variety of electrophilic functional groups by reaction with the appropriate electrophile-N-hydroxysuccmimide ( ⁇ HS) ester (Pierce, Rockford, IL, USA). Reactions were . performed in 200 mM sodium phosphate' pH 7.2 with 2 mg/mL electrophile- ⁇ HS ester, 10% dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO), and up to 100 ⁇ g of 5'-amin ⁇ template at 25 °C for 1 hours. 1 Desired products were purified by reverse-phase HPLC and characterized by gel electrophoresis and . MALDI mass spectrometry.
  • ⁇ HS electrophile-N-hydroxysuccmimide
  • the eluted molecules were isolated by ethanol precipitation and amplified by standard PCR protocols (2 mM MgCl 2 , 55 °C annealing, 20 cycles) using the primers 5 - TGGTGCGGAGCCGCCG [SEQ ID NO: 35] and 5'-
  • This Example demonstrates that DNA-templated synthesis can direct a modest collection of chemical reactions without requiring the precise alignment of reactive groups into DNA-like conformations. Furthermore, this Example also demonstrates that it is possible to ⁇ simultaneously translate in one-pot a library of more than 1,000 templates into the conesponding thioether products, one of which could be enriched by in vitro selection for binding to streptavidin and amplification by PCR.
  • DNA- templated organometallic couplings and carbon-carbon bond forming reactions other than pyrimidine photodimerization can be utilized to construct small molecules. These reactions represent an important step towards the in vitro evolution of non-natural synthetic molecules by permitting the DNA-templated construction of a diverse set of structures.
  • DNA-linked activator, catalyst or other reagent in addition to the principal reactants has also been demonstrated herein.
  • DNA-templated reductive animations between an amine-linked template (1) and benzaldehyde- or glyoxal-linked reagents (3) with millimolar concentrations of sodium cyanoborohydride (NaBH 3 CN) at room temperature in aqueous solutions can be performed (see, Figure 23 A).
  • DNA-templated amide borid formations between amine-linked templates 4 and 5 and carboxylate-linked reagents 6-9 mediated by l-(3- dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide (EDC) and N-hydroxylsulfosuccinimide (sulfo- NHS) generated amide products in good yields at pH 6.0, 25°C.
  • Product formatiori was (i) sequence-specific, (ii) dependent on th ⁇ ipresence of EDC, and (iii) insensitive to the steric, encumbrance ofthe amine or carboxylate.
  • organometallic coupling reactions can also be utilized in the present invention.
  • DNA-templated Heck reactions were performed in the presence of water-soluble Pd precatalysts.
  • aryl iodide-linked reagent 19 and a variety of olefin-linked templates including maleimide 12, acrylamide 17, vinyl sulfone 18 or cinnamamide 20 yielded Heck coupling products in modest yields at pH 5.0, 25°C ( Figures 23D and 24).
  • Example 1 above shows that certain DNA-templated reactions demonstrate distance independence. Distance independence may arise when the rate of bond formation in the DNA-templated reaction is greater than the rate of template-reagent annealing. Although only a subset of chemistries fall into this category, any DNA-templated reaction that affords corhparable product yields when the reagent is annealed at various distances from the reactive end ofthe template is of special interest because it can be encoded at a variety of template positions.
  • Figure 26B shows the results of denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis of a DNA-templated Wittig olefination between complementary 11 and 13 with either zero bases (lanes 1-3) or ten bases (lanes 4-6) separating the annealed reactants.
  • aqueous DNA-templated synthetic reactions including, but not limited to, the Lewis acid-catalyzed aldol addition, Mannich reaction, Robinson annulati ⁇ h reactions, additions of allyl mdiun , zinc and tin to ketones and aldehydes; Pd-assisted allylic substitution, Diels-' Alder, cycloadditions, and hetero-Diels- Alder reactions can be utilized efficiently, in aqueous solvent and are important complexity-building reactions. [0331] Taken together, these results expand considerably the reaction scope of DNA-
  • Functionalized templates and reagents were typically prepared by reacting 5 ' -NH terminated oligonucleotides (for template 1), 5'-NH 2 -(CH 2 O) 2 terminated oligonucleotides (for all other templates) or 3'-OPO 3 -CH 2 CH(CH 2 OH)(CH 2 ) 4 NH 2 terminated nucleotides (for all reagents) with the appropriate NHS esters (0.1 volumes of a 20 mg/mL solution in DMF) in 0.2 M sodium phosphate buffer, pH 7.2, 25°C, for 1 hour to provide the template and reagent structures shown in Figures 23A-23D and 25A-25B.
  • Figure 24 depicts the analysis by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis of representative DNA-templated reactions listed in Figures 23A-23D and 25A-25B.
  • the structures of reagents and templates conesp ⁇ nd to the numbering in Figures 23A-23D and 25A- 25B.
  • Lanes 1, 3, 5, 7, 9, 11 reaction of matched (complementary or "M") reagents and templates under conditions listed in Figures 23A-23D and 25A-25B (the reaction between 4 and
  • Lanes 2, A, 6, 8, 10, 12 reaction of mismatched (non- ' • complementary or "X") reagents and templates under conditions identical to those in lanes l 1 , 3,
  • n refers to the number of bases between reactive groups when template and reagent are annealed as shown in Figure 26A.
  • 1 TGGTACGAATTCGACTCGGG [SEQ LD NO: 45]; 2 and 3 matched: GAGTCGAATTCGTACC [SEQ LD NO: 46]; 2 and 3 mismatched: GGGCTCAGCTTCCCC A [SEQ LD NO: 47] ; 4 and 5: '
  • DNA-templated synthesis can direct ,'a wide Variety of powerful chemical , reactions with high sequence-specificity and' without requiring structural mimicry of the DNA backbone.
  • the application of this approach to synthetic molecules of useful complexity requires the development of general methods to permit the product of a DNA- templated reaction to'uridergo subsequent DNA-templated transformations. ⁇
  • an ideal reagent-oligonucleotide linker for DNA-templated synthesis positions the oligonucleotide as a leaving group of the reagent. Under this '
  • Ribosomal protein biosynthesis uses aminoacylated tRNAs in a similar autocleaving linker format to mediate RNA-templated peptide bond formation.
  • biotinylated reagent oligonucleotides and washing crude reactions with streptavidin-linked magnetic beads were utilized. Although this approach does not separate reacted templates from unreacted templates, unreacted templates can be removed in subsequent DNA-templated reaction and purification steps.
  • linker cleavage generates a "useful scar" that can be functionalized in subsequent steps ( Figure 28C).
  • amino acid reagents such as the (L)-Phe derivative 10 were generated linked through 1,2-diols (Fruchart et al. (1999) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 40: 6225) to their decoding DNA oligonucleotides.
  • this linker was quantitatively cleaved by oxidation with 50 mM aqueous sodium periodate (NaIO 4 ) at pH 5.0 to afford product 12 containing an aldehyde group appropriate for subsequent functionalization (for example, in a DNA-templated Wittig olefination, reductive amination, or nitrolaldol addition).
  • Figure 29 shows the results of exemplary DNA-templated synthesis experiments using autocleaving linkers, scarless linkers, and useful scar linkers.
  • the depicted reactions were analyzed by denaturing PAGE. Lanes 1-3 were visualized using UV light without DNA staining; lanes 4-10 were visualized by staining with ethidium bromide following by UV transillumination. Conditions for 1 to 3 were: one equivalent each of reagent and template, 0.1
  • Desired products generated from DNA ,emplated reactions using the scarless, or useful scar linkers can be readily purified using biotinylated reagent oligonucleotides (Figure 30B).
  • Reagent oligonucleotides together with desired products are first captured on streptavidin- linked magnetic beads. Any unreacted template bound to reagent by base pairing is removed by washing the beads with b ⁇ ffer containing 4 M guanidinium chloride. Biotinylated molecules remain bound to the streptavidin beads under these conditions.
  • Desired product then is isolated in pure form by eluting the beads with linker cleavage buffer (in the examples above, either pH 11 or sodium periodate (NaIO )-containing buffer), while reacted and unreacted reagents remain bound to the beads.
  • linker cleavage buffer in the examples above, either pH 11 or sodium periodate (NaIO )-containing buffer
  • EDC 15 mM sulfo-NHS, 0.1 M MES buffer pH 5.5, and 1 M NaCI, for 10 minutes at 25 °C.
  • the template then was added in 0.1 M MOPS pH 7.5, and IM NaCI, at 25°C and was allowed to react for 1 hour.
  • the free amine group in 14 then was elaborated in a second and third round of DNA-templated amide formation and linker cleavage to afford dipeptide 15 and tripeptide 16 using the following conditions: two equivalents of reagent, 50 mM DMT-MM, 0.1 M MOPS buffer pH 7.0, 1 M NaCI, at 25 °C for 6 hours. Desired product after each step was purified by capture on avidin-linked beads and elution with 0.1 M CAPS buffer pH 11.8, 60 mM BME, at 37
  • amide 18 Two equivalents 17 in 20 mM EDC, 15 mM sulfo-NHS, 0.1 M MES buffer pH 5.5, 1 M NaCI, 10 minutes, 25 °C, then add to template in 0.1 M MOPS pH 7.5, IM NaCI at 16°C for 8 hours).
  • the desired product then was isolated by capturing the crude reaction on streptavidin beads followed by cleaving the linker with NaIO to generate aldehyde 19.
  • fumaramide 21 was subjected to a DNA-templated conjugate addition (Gartner et al. (2001) J. AM. CHEM. Soc.
  • DNA-templated reactions can occur in aqueous media. It has also been discovered that DNA-templated reactions can occ ⁇ r in organic solvents, thus greatly expanding the scope of DNA-templated synthesis. Specifically, DNA templates and reagents have been complexed with long chain tetraalkylammonium cations (see, Jost et al. (1989) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 17: 2143; Mel'nikov et al (1999) LANGMUIR 15: 1923- 1928) to permit quantitative dissolution of reaction components in anhydrous organic solvents including CH 2 G 2 , CHC1 3 , DMF and methanol. Su ⁇ risingly, it was found that DNA-templated synthesis can indeed occur in anhydrous organic solvents with high sequence selectivity.
  • Figure 33 shows DNA-templated amide bond formation reactions where the reagents and templates are complexed with dimethyldidodecylammonium cations either in separate vessels or after preannealing in water, lyophilized to dryness, dissolved in CH 2 CI 2 , and mixed together. Matched, but not mismatched, reactions provided products both when reactants were preannealed in aqueous solution and when they were mixed for the first time in CH 2 C1 2 ( Figure 33). DNA-templated amide formation and Pd-mediated Heck coupling in anhydrous DMF also proceeded sequence-specifically.
  • Some exemplary reactions to utilize in organic solvents include, but are not limited to 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition between nitrones and olefins which can proceed through transition states that are less polar than ground state starting materials.
  • Example 5 New Architectures for Nucleic Acid-Templated Synthesis
  • This Example discloses two different template architectures that further expand the scope of nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • templates During a nucleic acid-templated chemical reaction a portion of a template anneals to a complementary sequence of an oligonucleotide-linked reagent, holding functional groups on the template and transfer unit in reactive proximity. Template architecture can have a profound effect on the nature ofthe resulting reaction, raising the possibility of manipulating reaction conditions by rationally designing template-reagent complexes with different secondary structures.
  • the template oligonucleotide contains a small number of constant bases at, for example, the reactive 5' end ofthe template in addition to distal coding regions.
  • the oligonucleotide of the transfer unit for the ⁇ architecture contains at its reactive 3' end the bases that complement the constant region ofthe template followed by bases that complement a coding region anywhere on the template.
  • the constant regions were designed to be of insufficient length to anneal in the absence of a complementary coding region. When the coding region of the template and transfer unit are complementary and anneal, the elevated effective molarity ofthe constant regions induces their annealing.
  • Constant region annealing forms a bulge (resembling an ⁇ ) in the otherwise double-stranded template-reagent complex and places groups at the ends ofthe template and reagent in reactive proximity.
  • This design permits distance-dependent DNA- templated reactions to be encoded by bases distal from the reactive end ofthe template.
  • the efficiency of DNA-templated synthesis using the ⁇ architecture was compared with that ofthe standard E and H architectures.
  • the ⁇ architectures studied comprise (i) three to five constant bases at the 5' end ofthe template followed by (ii) a five- to 17-base loop and (iii) a ten-base coding region.
  • four different classes of DNA-templated reactions were performed that collectively span the range of distance dependence observed to date.
  • Amine acylation reactions are representative of distance independent reactions that proceed efficiently even when considerable distances (e.g., 30 bases) separate the amine and carboxylate groups.
  • amine acylation (20 mM DMT-MM, pH 7.0, at 30 °C for 12 hours) proceeded efficiently (46-96% yield) in all architectures with both small and large distances between reactive groups on the reagent and template ( Figure 34, lanes 1-5; and Figure 35A).
  • DNA templates of arbitrary length are easy to synthesize and undesired cross reactivity between reactants in the same solution can be avoided using concentrations that are too low to allow non-complementary reactants to react intermolecularly.
  • This "T” architecture (see, Figure 7G) was designed to permit two DNA-templated reactions, one with a ' reagent coupled to the 5 1 end ofthe oligonucleotide of a first transfer unit arid one with a reagent coupled to the 3 1 end ofthe oligonucleotide of a second transfer unit, to take place sequence- specifically 1 in the sarrie solution on a single template.
  • T architecture permits two sequence-specific DNA-templated reactions to take place on one template in one solution.
  • the T architecture templates described above were accepted as efficient templates for, both a single cycle of primer extension as well as standard PCR amplification ' using Taq DNA polymerase, consistent with the known tolerance of several DNA polymerases for modifications to the non- Watson-Crick face of DNA templates.
  • this architecture may also permit three-component reactions commonly used to build structural complexity in synthetic libraries to be performed in a DNA-templated format.
  • the ⁇ and T architectures significantly expand the scope of DNA- templated synthesis.
  • the omega architecture expands the types of reactions that can be encoded anywhere on a DNA template.
  • the T architecture permits two DNA-templated reactions to take place on a single template in one step.
  • Oligonucleotide synthesis Unless otherwise specified, DNA oligonucleotides were synthesized and functionalized as previously described using 2-[2-(4-monomethoxytrityl) aminoethoxy]ethyl-(2-cyanoethyl)-N,N-diisopropyl- ⁇ hosphoramidite (Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA) for 5'-functionalized oligonucleotides, and using (2-dimethoxytrityloxymethyl-6- fluorenylmethoxycarbonylamino-hexane-l-succinoyl)-long chain alkylamino-CPG (Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA) for 3'-functionalized oligonucleotides (Calderone et al.
  • Amine-labeled arid carboxylic acid-labeled DNA were combined in aqueous 100 mM MOPS buffer, 1 ,M NaCl/pH 7.0 (60 nM in template DNA, 120 ' ' nM in reagent DNA) in the presence of 20 mM DMT-MM. Reactions proceeded for 12 hours at
  • N-methylhydrpxylamine hydrochloride for 1 hour at room temperature (Gartner et al. (2002) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 124: 10304). It was subsequently combined with succinimide-labeled DNA in aqueous 50 mM MOPS, 2.8 M NaCI, pH 7.5 ,(final concentrations of N-methylhydroxylamine hydrochloride 0.75 mM, 60 M in template DNA and 9,0 nM in reagent DNA). Reactions proceeded for 12 hours at 37°C. ,
  • SIA N-succinimidyliodoacetate
  • Aldehyde-labeled template (1) was prepared by reacting the "T template” oligonucleotide (see below) with j r ⁇ -formyl benzoic acid N-hydroxysuccinimidyl ester as described previously (Gartner et al. (2002) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 41: 1796; (2002) ANGEW. CHEM. 114: 1874).
  • Template 1 was combined with reagents 2 and 3 in aqueous 200 mM N-(2- hydroxyethyl)piperazine-N'-(2-ethanesulfonic acid) (HEPES) buffer at pH 8.5 with 1 M NaCI, (63 nM template and 125 nM of each reagent). Reactions proceeded for up to 1 hour at 25 °C. [0382] The results of denaturing polyacr ia ⁇ iide gel electrophoresis analysis of these reactions is shown in Figure 38B. The 30-base T architecture template (1) containing ari aldehyde group was present in lanes 1-2 and ⁇ anes 5-10.
  • HEPES N-(2- hydroxyethyl)piperazine-N'-(2-ethanesulfonic acid)
  • a template lacking the aldehyde group but otherwise identical to (1) was present in lane's 3 and 4.
  • DNA-linked phosphine reagent (2) was present, in lanes 3-6 and lanes 9-10.
  • DNA-linked ⁇ -iodoamide reagent (3) was present in lanes 3-4 and laries 7-10.
  • Lanes 1, 3, 5, 7, and 9 show, reactions after 30 minutes.
  • T Architecture-mediated Conversion of, Compound 5 to 8.
  • the 3'-azido linked oligonucleotide (7) was generated by combining the T (ra - 1) amine-linked reagent oligonucleotide (see below) with 2 mgmL (N- hydroxysuccinimidyl)-4-azidobenzoate in 9: 1 200 mM sodium phosphate pH 7.2:DMF for, 2 hours at 25 °C.
  • Reagents 6 and 7 were purified by gel filtration and reverse-phase HPLC.
  • Template 5 and reagents 6 and 7 were combined in aqueous 100 mM MOPS pH 7.0 in the presence of 1 M NaCI and 20 mM DMT-MM for 2 hours (60 nM template, 120 nM reagents) at 25 °C. Copper (II) sulfate pentahydrate and sodium ascorbate were then added to 500 ⁇ M each. After 1 hour at 25 °C, reactions were quenched by ethanol precipitation.
  • H template 5'-H 2 N-CGC GAG CGT ACG CTC GCG GGT ACG AAT TCG ACT CGG GAA TAC CAC CTT [SEQ LD NO: 59].
  • T template 5'- GGT ACG AAT TCG AC(dT-NH 2 ) CGG GAA TAC CAC CTT [SEQ ID NO: 60].
  • E or H reagent (ra 1): 5'-AAT TCG TAC C-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 61].
  • E or H reagent (n 10): 5'-TCC CGA GTC G-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 62].
  • E or H reagent (ra 20): 5'- AAG GTG GTA T-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 63]. Mismatched E or H reagent: 5'-TCC CTG ATC G- NH 2 [SEQ ID NO: 64].
  • ⁇ -3 reagent (ra 10): 5'-TCC CGA GTC GAC C-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 65].
  • ⁇ -4 reagent (ra 10): 5'-TCC CGA GTC GTA CC-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 66].
  • ⁇ -5 reagent (ra 10): 5'-TCC CGA GTC GGT ACC-NH 2 [SEQ ID NO: 67].
  • ⁇ -3 reagent (ra 20): 5'-AAG GTG GTA TAC C-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 68].
  • ⁇ -4 reagent (ra 20): 5'-AAG GTG GTA TTA CC- NH 2 [SEQ ID NO: 69].
  • ⁇ -5 reagent (ra 20): 5'-AAG GTG GTA TGT ACC- NH 2 [SEQ ID NO: 70].
  • Mismatched ⁇ -3 reagent 5'-TCC CTG ATC GAC C-NH 2 [SEQ ID NO: 71].
  • Mismatched ⁇ -4 reagent 5'-TCC CTG ATC GTA CC-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 72].
  • T reagent (ra 1): 5'-GGT ' ATT CCC G-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 74].
  • T reagent (ra 2): 5 '-TGG TAT TCC C-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 75].
  • T reagent (ra 3): 5'-GTG GTA TTC C-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 76].
  • T reagent (ra 4): 5'-GGT GGT ATT C-NH 2 [SEQ LD NO: 77].
  • T reagent (ra 5): 5'-AGG TGG TAT T-NH 2 , [SEQ LD NO: 78].
  • Reaction yields were quantitated by denaturing polyacrylamide gql electrophoresis followed by ethidium bromide staining, UV visualization, and CCD-based densitometry of product and template starting material bands.
  • reaction products were denatured and, therefore, stained with comparable intensity per base; for those cases in which products are partially double-stranded during quantitati ⁇ n, changes in staining intensity may result in higher apparent yields.
  • Representative reaction products were characterized by MALDI mass spectrometry in addition to denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis.
  • Example 6 Stereoselectivity in Nucleic Acid-Templated Synthesis
  • This Example demonstrates that it is possible to perform stereoselective nucleic acid-templated syntheses.
  • the chiral nature of DNA raises the possibility that DNA-templated synthesis can proceed stereoselectively without the assistance of chiral groups beyond those present in DNA, thereby transferring not only sequence but also stereochemical information from the template to the product.
  • Stereoselectivity was examined in the context of DNA-templated nucleophilic substitution reactions.
  • Double-stranded DNA sequences rich in (5-Me- C)G repeats can adopt a left-handed helix (Z-form) rather than the usual right-handed helix (B- form) at high salt concentrations (Rich et al. (1984) J. ANNU. REV. BIOCHEM. 53: 791-846; Behe et al. (1981) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 78: 1619-1623; Mao et al. (1999) NATURE 397: 144- 146).
  • C* 5-methyl cytosine.
  • the thiols in both the mixed and (5-Me-C)G-rich sequences were protected as disulfides (-(CH 2 ) 3 S-S(CH 2 ) 3 OH) for circular dichroism measurements.
  • DNA oligonucleotides were synthesized on a PerSeptive Biosystems Expedite
  • Figure 43 shows modified template or reagent structures that result in loss of stereoselectivity during DNA-templated SN2 reactions. In all cases, values fell within the range of 0.95 to 1.09 ( ⁇ 0.09), which reflects the mean and standard deviation of at least three independent experiments.
  • the exact structures ofthe templates containing achiral linkers and their conesponding reagents were as follows:
  • Figure 43A Template 5 , -BrCH(CH 3 )CONH-[(CH 2 ) 2 O] 2 OPO 3 ' - ⁇ [(CH 2 ) 2 O] 6 OPO 3 ' ⁇ 3 -GGT ACG
  • Figure 43E Template: 5'- BrCH(CH 3 )CONH-TAC GCT CGC GAT GGT ACG AAT TC-3'
  • Figure 44A shows circular dichroism (CD) spectra of template-reagent complex es'containing normal (mixed composition) sequences which are characteristic qf B—
  • Figu re 44B shows CD spectra of (5 -Me-C)G-rich complexes having a B-DN A conformation at low salt concentrations, and haying a Z-DNA conformation at high salt ' concentrations.
  • Thp exact structures ofthe templates containing mixed and (5-Me-C)G-rich sequence, and their conesponding reagents used, are as follows: [0422] Mixed sequence:
  • Figure 45 shows a representative denaturing gel electrophoresis analysis of reactions using the CG-rich sequences at 100 mM NaCI (lanes 1-3) or at 5 M NaCI (lanes 4-6) (6 hour time point). Lanes 1 and 4: racemic bromide; lanes 2 and 5: (R)-bromide; lanes 3 and 6: (S)-bromide. The bromide-linked reagent is not visible. Similar results were observed using Na 2 SO 4 instead of NaCI. DNA-templated Reactions in the Presence ofNa 2 S04 instead of NaCI
  • the lengths of template oligonucleotides were varied to include 11, 17, or 23 bases and the lengths of reagent oligonucleotides were varied to include 14, 16, or 18 bases. Differences in oligonucleotide length were achieved using extensions distal from the reactive groups that did not significantly affect the efficiency of DNA-templated reactions. This design permitted all nine possible reaction products (linked to 25, 27, 29, 31, 33, 35, 37, 39, or 41 bases of DNA) to be distinguished by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis.
  • the above three examples each diversified a single functional group (maleimide, aldehyde, or amine) into products of different reaction types.
  • a more general format for the one- pot diversification of a D ⁇ A-templated synthetic library into products of multiple reaction types would involve the simultaneous reaction of different functional groups linked to both reagents and templates.
  • six D ⁇ A-linked nucleophile templates (15-20) and six D ⁇ A-linked electrophile reagents (21-25) collectively encompassing all ofthe functional groups used in the above three examples (amine, 1 aldehyde;, maleimide, carboxylic acid, nitroalkane, phosphorane, and thiol) wereb prepared,(Fig ⁇ ire 47).
  • DNA-templated synthesis (i) allows the direct in vitro selection (as opposed to screening) and amplification of synthetic molecules with desired properties, (ii) permits the preparation of synthetic libraries of unprecedented diversity, and (iii) requires only minute quantities of material for selection and identification of active library members.
  • this Example demonstrates that potentially useful modes of reactivity not possible using cunent synthetic methods can be achieved in a DNA-templated format. For example, six different types of reactions can be performed simultaneously in one solution, provided that required non-DNA-linked accessory reagents are compatible. This reaction mode permits the diversification of synthetic small molecule libraries using different reaction types in a single solution.
  • Oligonucleotides were synthesized using standard automated solid-phase techniques. Modified phosphoramidites and controlled-pore glass supports were obtained from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA. Unless otherwise noted, functionalized templates and reagents were synthesized by reacting 5'-H N(CH 2 O) 2 terminated oligonucleotides (for templates) or 3 '-OPO 3 -CH 2 CH(CH 2 OH)(CH2) NH 2 terminated oligonucleotides (for reagents) in a 9:1 mixture of aqueous 200 mM pH 7.2 sodium phosphate buffe ⁇ DMF containing 2 mg/mL of the appropriate N-hydroxysuccinimide ester (Pierce, Rockford, IL, USA) at 25 °C.
  • the NHS esters were generated by combining the appropriate carboxylic acid (900 mM in DMF) with equal volumes of dicyclohexylcarbodiimide (900 mM in DMF) and NHS (900 mM in DMF) for 90 minutes.
  • Phosphorane-linked oligonucleotides (2b and.20, Figures 46 and 47) were prepared by a 90 minute reaction ofthe appropriate amino- terminated oligonucleotide with 0.1 voluiries of a 20 mg/mL DMF solution of the NHS ester of
  • CPG controlled-pore glass
  • Linkers between DNA oligonucleotides and the functional groups in 1 a-6c are as follows.
  • ' lb and lc DNA-5'-NH 2 ; la, 2a-2c, 3a, and 3c: DNA-5'-O(CH 2 ) 2 O(CH 2 ) 2 -NH-; 5a: DNA-3'-O-(CH 2 ) 3 SH; 4a-4c, 5b, 5c, 6a, and 6c : DNA-3*-O-CH 2 CH(CH 2 OH)(CH 2 ) 4 NH-.
  • DNA-templated functional group transformations can significantly expand the types of struc ⁇ ires that can be generated.
  • DNA-templated synthesis can be used to transform' functional groups by unmasking or interconverting functionalities used in coupling reactions.
  • DNA-templated synthesis can be used to transform' functional groups by unmasking or interconverting functionalities used in coupling reactions.
  • DNA- templated functional group interconversions permit lib , rary diversity to be generated by sequential unmasking (Figure 49).
  • PG1 - PG3 represent three different protecting groups
  • arid A-F represent reactants capable of reacting with deprotected functionalities, of a scaffold molecule.
  • sequential unmasking approach offers the major advantage of permitting reactants that would normally lack the ability to be linked to DNA (for example, simple alkyl halides) to contribute to library diversity by reacting with a sequence-specified subset of templates in an intermolecular, non-templated reaction mode.
  • This advantage significantly increases the types of structures that can be generated.
  • sequential unmasking has the drawback of requiring more manipulations per "step” because previously used small molecule reactants must be removed between DNA-templated functional group unmaskings. This removal can be rapidly performed on the entire library using a simple gel filtration cartridge.
  • DNA-Templated Deprotection [0450] The first class of DNA-templated functional group transformations sequence- specifically unmask amine, thiol, alcohol, carboxylate, or aldehyde groups from protected forms.
  • DNA-templated amine deprotection reactions can be extended to include deprotection reactions for alcohols and thiols.
  • Kusumoto and co-workers have reported that 4-aminobutyryl esters undergo spontaneous intramolecular lactam formation to afford 2- pynolidinone and the liberated hydroxyl group in excellent yields (Kusumoto et al. (1986) BULL. CHEM. SOC. JPN. 59: 1296-1298). Kahne and co-workers have used this reaction effectively in aqueous media (Thomson et al. (1999) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 121: 1237-1244).
  • a DNA-templated hydroxyl group deprotection is shown in Figure 50C. If lactam formation is slow, the reaction can be heated or Lewis acids can be added since sequence specificity is not required after amine deprotection.
  • An analogous DNA-templated thiol deprotection that uses 4-azidobutyryl thioesters is shown in Figure 50C. It is contemplated that these groups will be stable to hydrolysis under a wide range of conditions. [0452] Palladium-mediated deallylation can also be used in DNA-templated carboxylate, amine, hydroxyl, or thiol deprotections.
  • Allyloxycarbonyl (Alloc) esters, carbonates, thiocarbonates, and carbamates are treated with DNA-linked Pd ligands such as the 2, 2'- bis(diphenylphosphino)-l, l'-binaphthyl (BINAP) reagent as shown in Figure 50D (prepared from the known BINAP-6-butanoic acid) in the presence of pM to ⁇ M concentrations of water- soluble Pd sources such as Na 2 PdCl (Bayston et al (1998) J. ORG. CHEM. 63: 3137-3140).
  • DNA-linked Pd ligands such as the 2, 2'- bis(diphenylphosphino)-l, l'-binaphthyl (BINAP) reagent as shown in Figure 50D (prepared from the known BINAP-6-butanoic acid) in the presence of pM to ⁇ M concentrations of water- soluble Pd sources such
  • the DNA-linked Pd ligands increase the effective molarity of Pd at complementary templates, but not at mismatched templates, to permit the sequence-specific deprotection of carboxylate, hydroxyl, thiol, and amine groups from the conesponding Alloc esters, carbonates, thiocarbonates, and carbamates, respectively (Figure 50D) (Genet et al. (1994) TETRAHEDRON 50: 497-503). It is particularly encouraging that the rates of BINAP ligand dissociation from Pd have been measured during Pd-mediated aryl aminations and found to be much slower than the rates of association and dissociation of substrate and products (Singh et ⁇ /. (2002) J. AM. CHEM.
  • transition metal salts including Sc and Yb are known to catalyze acetal hydrolysis to yield aldehydes (Fukuzawa t ⁇ (2001) CHEM. LETT! 5: 430-436).
  • ' Conjugating the crown ether shown in Figure 50E to oligonucleotides permits DNA-templated ' aldehyde deprotections in the presence of lanthanide triflates.
  • These crown ether-Ln 3+ complexes have been previously reported to catalyze aqueous aldol reactions while completely sequestering one equivalent of Ln ⁇ + (Kobaya ' 'sh 'i et a ' l (2001) ORG. LETT. 3).
  • Aldehyde deprotection is' highly sequence-specific because the co ' ncentrati •on of free Ln 3+ should be ' l ' negligible.
  • the second class of DNA-templated functional group transformations interconverts groups generated from or used by DNA-templated reactions. Two functional group interconversions are shown in Figure 51. Ruthenium(II) porphyrins in the presence of 2,6- disubstituted pyridine N-oxides catalyze the remarkably efficient epoxidation of a wide variety of simple and electron-deficient olefins (Higuchi et al. (1989) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 30: 6545- 6548; Groves et al. (1985) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 107: 5790-5792; Zhang et al. (2002) ORG. LETT.
  • DNA- templated olefin epoxidations using DNA-linked Ru(II) porphyrin catalysts are shown in Figure 51 A, which are prepared by coupling commercially available tetrakis(4-carboxyphenyl) porphyrin to amine-terminated oligonucleotides (Holmlin et al. (1999) BIOCONJUG. CHEM. 10: 1122-1130).
  • the resulting DNA-linked porphyrin is metalated with Ru 3 (CO) 12 as described previously to afford the reagent shown in Figure 51 A.
  • This functional group interconversion bridges several versatile reactions by permitting products of DNA-templated Wittig olefmations and Heck couplings to become substrates for epoxide addition reactions.
  • This Example demonstrates a strategy for producing an amplifiable polycarbamate library.
  • the dinucleotide moiety exists as the activated 5 '-2-methylimidazole phosphate, that has been demonstrated to serve as an excellent leaving group for template-directed oligomerization of nucleotides yet is relatively stable under neutral or basic aqueous conditions (Inoue et al. (1982) J. MOL. BIOL. 162: 201; Rembold et al. (1994) J. MOL. EVOL. 38: 205; Chen et al (1985) J. MOL. BIOL. 181: 271; Acevedo et al. (1987) J. MOL. BIOL. 197: 187; Inoue et al. (1981) J. AM. CHEM. SOC.
  • the dicarbamate' moiety exists in a cyclic form linked through a vinyloxycarbonate linker.
  • the vinylcarbonate group has been demonstrated to be stable in neutral or basic aqueous conditions and further has been sbown to provide carbamates in very high yields upon the addition of amines Ol ⁇ fson et al. (197,7) TETRAHEDRON LETT, 18: 1563; Olofson et al. (1977) ,
  • the polycarbamate can be cleaved from the phosphate backbone ofthe DNA upon treatment with fluoride. Desilylation ofthe enol ether linker and the elimination ofthe phosphate driven by the resulting release of phenol provides the polycarbamate covalently linked at its carboxy terminus to its encoding single-stranded DNA ( Figure 54). [0463] At this stage, the polycarbamate may be. completely liberated from the DNA by base hydrolysis ofthe, ester linkage.
  • the liberated polycarbamate can be purified by HPLC and retested to verify that its desired, properties are intact:
  • the free DNA can be amplified using PCR, mutated with enor-prone PCR (Cadwell et al. (1992) PCR METHODS APPL. 2: 28) or DNA shuffling (Stemmer (1994) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 91: 10747; Stemmer (1994) NATURE 370: 389; U-S. 'Patent 5,811,238), and/or sequenced to reveal the primary structure ofthe ' ⁇ polycarbamate polymer. ' . ' ' " , ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' '
  • the syn hydroxyl groups are protected as the/?-meth'oxybenzylidene, and remaining hydroxyl gro ⁇ p as the tert-butyldimethylsilyl ether to afford 2.
  • the carboxylate moiety ofthe protected shikimic acid then is completely reduced by lithium aluminum hydride (LAH) reduction, tosylation ofthe resulting alcohol, and further reduction with LAH to provide 3.
  • LAH lithium aluminum hydride
  • N-protected amino acids can serve as the starting materials for the dicarbamate moiety of each monomer. Reactive side chains are protected as photolabile ethers, esters, acetals, carbamates, or thioethers. Using chemistry previously developed (Cho et al. (1993) SCIENCE 261: 1303), a desired amino acid 4 is converted to the conesponding amino alcohol 5 by mixed anhydride formation with isobutylchloroformate followed by reduction with sodium borohydride.
  • amino alcohol then is converted to the activated carbonate by treatment with -nitrophenylchloroformate to afford 6, which then is coupled to a second amino alcohol 7 to provide, following hydroxyl group silylation and FMOC deprotection, carbamate 8. ,
  • Coupling of carbamate 8 onto the shikimic acid-derived linker proceeds as follows.
  • the allylic hydroxyl group of 3 is deprotected with tetra-butylammonium fluoride (TBAF), treated with triflic anhydride to form the secondary triflate, then displaced with aminocarbamate 8 to afford 9.
  • TBAF tetra-butylammonium fluoride
  • Presence ofthe vinylic methyl group in 3 should assist in minimizing the amount of undesired product resulting from S 2' addition (Magid (1980) TETRAHEDRON 36: 1901).
  • 3-unsaturated esters have been well documented (Collado et al. (1994) TETRAHEDRON LETT.
  • Ketone 10 the precursor to the fluoride-cleavable carbamate-phosphate linker, may be synthesized from 2 by one pot decarboxylation (Baijton et al.
  • TMSC1 Johansson et al (1984) J. CHEM. SOC. 2371
  • TES group deprotected with 2% HF conditions that should not affect the TBS ether (Boschelli et al. (1985) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 26: 5239)) to provide 13.
  • the PMB group following precedent (Johansson et al. (1984) J. CHEM. SOC. 2371; Sutherlin et al. (1993) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 34: 4897), should remain on the more hindered secondary alcohol.
  • the two free hydroxyl groups may be macrocyclized by very slow addition of 13 to a solution of j-nitrophenyl chloroformate (or another phosgene analog), providing 14.
  • the PMB ether is deprotected, and the resulting alcohol is converted into a triflate and eliminated under kinetic conditions with a sterically hindered base to afford vinyloxycarbonate 15.
  • Photodeprotection ofthe nitrobenzyl either and nitrobenzyl carbamate yields alcohol 16.
  • Chlorodiisopropylaminophosphine 17 is synthesized by the reaction of PC1 3 with diisopropylamine (King et al. (1984) J. ORG. CHEM. 49: 1784). Resin-bound (or 3'-o- nifrobenzylether protected) nucleoside 18 is coupled to 17 to afford phosphoramidite 19. Subsequent coupling of 19 with the nucleoside 20 (Inoue et al. (1981 ) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 103 : 7666) provides 21.
  • Alcohol 16 then is reacted with 21 to yield, after careful oxidation using m- chloroperbenzioc acid (MCPBA) or I 2 followed by cleavage from the resin (or photodeprotection), the completed monomer 22.
  • MCPBA m- chloroperbenzioc acid
  • I 2 cleavage from the resin (or photodeprotection)
  • This strategy of sequential coupling of 17 with alcohols has been successfully used to generate phosphates bearing three different alkoxy substituents in excellent yields (Bannwarth et al. (1987) HELV. CHIM. ACTA 70: 175).
  • the library synthesis scheme employs robust DNA-templated amine acylation and intramolecular Wittig olefination reactions to generate diverse and partially rigid macrocyclic ramaramides.
  • the fumaramide group is stable to neutral solutions but is sufficiently electrophilic to covalently capture nucleophiles when presented at elevated effective molarities. Nucleophilic side chains found in target protein active sites may, therefore, be covalently trapped by the fumaramide functionality.
  • the key steps in the library synthesis are (i) DNA-templated amine acylation using the sulfone linker, (ii) DNA-templated amine acylation using the diol linker, (Hi), DNA-templated amine acylation using a phosphorane linker, and (iv) intramolecular Wittig olefinaton to afford macrocyclic fumaramides linked to their conesponding DNA templates ( Figure 55). [0472] Macrocyclization is potentially the most challenging step ofthe library synthesis.
  • model step 3 substrates were prepared to validate the third DNA-templated i' . v ' . • • ' ' ' step arid the subsequent macrocyclizatiori ( Figure 56).
  • Each substrate contained a variety of Ri and R 2 groups of varying steric hindrances, stereochemistries, and backbone chain lengths.
  • the model substrates were each mixed with one of four biotinylated DNA-linked reagents containing both a carboxylic acid and a phosphorane under DNA-templated amine acylation conditions. To evaluate both amide bond formation and Wittig macrocyclization, a two-stage purification 'strategy was implemented.
  • a DNA-templated macrocyclic fumaramide library was synthesized.
  • Reagent oligonucleotides consisted ofthe six-base codons flanked by two constant bases on either side conjugated at their 3' ends to aminoacyl donors through the sulfone, diol, or phosphorane linker as previously reported.
  • Multi- ⁇ g quantities of each ofthe 19 DNA-linked amine acylation reagents shown in Figure 57 were created in a single day starting from commercially available free amino acids, linker precursors, and reagent oligonucleotides as described previously.
  • the building blocks were chosen to sample structural and functional group diversity and include (L) and (D) ⁇ -amino acids, ⁇ , ⁇ '-disubstituted amino acids, and ⁇ - amino acids bearing alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, polar, heterocyclic, negatively charged, and positively charged side chains (Figure 57).
  • Each ofthe 19 reagents was successfully tested in single template reactions and generated product with ⁇ 30% variance in efficiency. All 19 reagents reacted with high sequence-specificity, generating no significant product with mismatched teriiplates even when five equivalents of r'eagent were used. '
  • the macrocyclic fumaramide-encoding template library was prepared from modular coding region cassettes in a single solution ( Figure 58). Oligonucleotides representing all reagent annealing regions were combined together with T4 DNA ligase in a single solution. Due to the sequence design ofthe oligonucleotide termini, the desired assembled template library is the only possible product when the ligation is complete. Excellent yields ofthe desired template library resulted from a 4 hour ligation reaction. Following ligation, T7 exonuclease was added to degrade the non-coding template strand (the desired coding strand is protected by its non-natural 5'-aminoethylene glycol linker).
  • DNA-linked Alloc carbamates was executed with excellent efficiency as judged by the liberation of ⁇ 1 equivalent of free amine groups.
  • the products from each library synthesis step were analyzed by mass spectrometry.
  • the necessity of protecting and deprotecting the side chain amine in the starting material was tested because the lower pK a ofthe ⁇ -amine may permit selective reaction ofthe ⁇ -amine at a pH that ensures protonation ofthe side chain amine. It was found that the ⁇ -amine group indeed could be selectively and efficiently acylated in a DNA-templated reaction in the presence of unprotected side-chain amine at pH 6.0.
  • model substrates then were synthesized to validate the third DNA- templated step and the subsequent macrocyclization.
  • Each model substrate consisted of a template-linked intermediate containing a free amine group and a diol linker separated by varying numbers of bonds to simulate groups pf, differing, sizes during library synthesis.'
  • the ' model substrates were each mixed with one 'of several biotinylated DNA-linked reagents containing both a carboxylic acid and a phosphorane under DNA-templated amide formation conditions' (pH 6.0, 0 mM EDC, 15 mM sulfo-NHS).
  • DNA-templated amide formatiqn proceeded in >60% yields and products were' 1 captured with avidin-linked magnetic beads.
  • Bead- bound product was treated with 10 mM NaIO 4 at pH 8.5'to effect diol cleavage.
  • the resulting aldehyde group reacted with the phosphorane in a spontaneous Wittig olefination reaction to furnish a cyclic fumaramide, free from the biotin group, that self-elutes from the ayidin-linked , beads ( Figure 59).
  • the minimal requirements of a system for synthetic polymer evolution are: (i) distance-dependent nucleic acid-templated monomer coupling reactions to ensure that oligomerization proceeds exclusively between adjacently annealed monomers; (ii) efficient nucleic acid-templated oligomerization to provide sufficient yields of full-length products for in vitro selections; (iii) stable linkage of each synthetic polymer to its encoding template to ensure the survival ofthe appropriate template during polymer selection; and (iv) a readily functionalized synthetic monomer backbone to introduce tailor made functionality into the polymer. [0479] In order to test the feasibility of producing polymers by DNA templated synthesis,
  • PNA peptide nucleic acid
  • PNAs containing functionalized side chains are known to retain their ability to hybridize to DNA sequence-specifically (Haaima et al. (1996) supra; Puschl et al. ' (199%) supra).
  • ' ' [0480] In the first strategy, PNA serves as the backbone ofthe functional polymer and displays the functional groups of each monomer.
  • the DNA-templated PNA polymerizations organize reactive functional groups, enabling a second polymerization reaction between these functional groups (for example, an olefin metathesis or Wittig olefination reaction) to form the synthetic polymer backbone of interest.
  • templates consist of 5'- functionalized, single-stranded DNA libraries 50-200 bases long that contain a central region of variable bases. These templates are made by standard solid-phase oligonucleotide synthesis combined with enzyme-catalyzed ligation for longer templates.
  • Monomer structures are chosen to provide chemical functionalities includirig (i) Br ⁇ nsted acidic and basic groups, (ii) nucleophilic and electrophilic groups, (iii) conjugated olefins suitable for post-PNA polymerization metathesis, and (iv) metal-binding groups capable of forming complexes with chemically potent transition metals. Representative monomer structures containing these functionalities are shown in Figure 60.
  • the DNA bases encoding each monomer are chosen from the examples shown in Table 10 to preclude the possibility of out-of-frame annealing. These genetic codes should prevent undesired frameshifted DNA-templated polymer translation.
  • Selections for target binding can be conducted by incubating the solution-phase polymer library with either immobilized target or with biotinylated target followed by , streptavidin-linked beads. Non-binders are removed by washing, and polymers with desired binding properties are eluted by chemical denaturation or by adding excess authentic free ligand.
  • the DNA templates conesponding to the desired'PNA library members are amplified by PCR using one primer containing the 5'- functionalized hai ⁇ in primer and a biotinylated second primer, optionally diversified by enor- prone PCR (Caldwell et al. (1992) PCR METHODS APPLIC.
  • the other substrate ofthe reaction is synthesized as a derivative linked to biotin.
  • those library members that catalyze bond formation induce self-biotinylation.
  • Active bond forming catalysts then are separated from inactive library members by capturing the former with immobilized streptavidin.
  • functionalized PNAs that catalyze bond cleavage reactions such as retro-aldol reactions, amide hydrolysis, elimination reactions, or olefin dihydroxylation followed by sodium periodate cleavage can also be selected.
  • library members are linked to biotinylated substrates such that the bond breakage reaction causes the disconnection ofthe biotin moiety from the library members.
  • Active catalysts self-elute from streptavidin-linked beads while inactive catalysts remain bound.
  • PNAs Peptide nucleic acids
  • a DNA template containing a 5'-amine-terminated hai ⁇ in and five successive repeats ofthe "codon" complementary to 1 (5'-AGTC-3') was combined with 8 ⁇ M 1 in aqueous pH 8.5 buffer.
  • the reactants were annealed (95°C to 25°C) and NaCNBH 3 was added to 80 mM.
  • the reactions were quenched by buffer 'exchange with a Sephadex column, and subjected to denaturation (95°C for 10 rhinutes, in 50% fbrmamide) and 15% denaturing PAGE:
  • lanes i 1 and 2 show, that the starting template was almost entirely consumed, and the higher molecular weight product was formed in >90% yield.
  • oligomerization at the first mismatched codon indicates that the DNA-templated PNA aldehyde coupling requires functional group , adjacency (i.e., is highly distance dependent), and, therefore, is ideally suited for templated polymerization.
  • sequence specificity of this system was probed by performing oligomerization experiments using DNA templates containing eight different mismatched codons (ATTC, ATGC, ATCC, AGGC, AGCC, ACTC, ACGC, or ACCC) in the third coding region. Even though four of these codons differ from the matched sequence (ATGC) in only one base, in each case only two copies of 1 were coupled to the template (see Figure 62, lanes 5-12). This high degree of sequence specificity raises the possibility that libraries of different DNA sequences may be faithfully translated into libraries of conesponding polymers using this system, analogous to DNA-templated small molecule synthesis.
  • Reaction conditions were identical to those from Figure 63, except that the reaction time with NaCNBH 3 was further shortened to 5 minutes and incubation was carried out at 37°C.
  • the first two lanes of each panel in Figure 64 show a positive control polymerization.
  • Each additional set of four lanes conesponds to: (i) 20 pmol template, (ii) reaction with 14.4 ⁇ M gact, (iii) reaction with 14.4 ⁇ M gact plus 1.6 ⁇ M PNA aldehyde complementary to the highlighted codon, and (iv) reaction with 14.4 ⁇ M gact plus 0.2 ⁇ M of each PNA aldehyde of the sequence gwt except the PNA complementary to the highlighted codon.
  • a nucleic acid e.g., DNA, RNA, derivative thereof
  • the synthesized polymers may be selected for specific properties such molecular, weight, density, hydrophobicity, tacticity, stereoselectivity, etc., and the nucleic acid which formed an integral part ofthe catalyst which directed its synthesis may be amplified and evolved ( Figure 65A). Iterated cycles of ligand diversification, selection, and amplification allow for the true evolution of catalysts and polymers towards desired properties.
  • a library of DNA molecules is attached to Grubbs' ruthenium-based ring opening metathesis polymerization (ROMP) catalyst through a dihydroimidazole ligand (Scholl et al. (1999) ORG. LETT.
  • DNA- DHI DNA-dehydroimidazole
  • Figure 65B Functionalizing the catalyst with a relatively large DNA-dehydroimidazole (DNA- DHI) ligand can alter the activity ofthe catalyst.
  • Each DNA molecule has the potential to fold into a unique stereoelectronic shape which potentially has different selectivities and/or activities in the polymerization reaction ( Figure 66). Therefore, the library of DNA ligands can be "translated" into a library of plastics upon the addition of various monomers.
  • DNA-DHI ligands capable of covalently inserting themselves into the growing polymer, thus creating a polymer tagged with the DNA that encoded its creation, are used.
  • dehydroimidazole (DHI) ligands are produced containing two chemical handles, one used to attach the DNA to the ligand, the other used to attach a pedant olefin to the DHI backbone.
  • Rates of metathesis are known to vary widely based upon olefin substitution as well as the identity ofthe catalyst. Through alteration of these variable, the rate of pendant olefin inco ⁇ oration can be modulated such that pendant oie f m metathesis « & ROMP , thereby, allowing polymers of moderate to high molecular weights to be formed before insertion ofthe DNA tag and conesponding polymer termination.
  • Vinylic ethers are commonly used in RQMP to functionalize the polymer termini (Gordon et al (2000) CHEM. ' BIOL. 7: 9-16), as well as produce polymers of decreased molecular weight.
  • a polymer from the library is subsequently selected based on a desired property by electrophoresis, gel filtration, centrifugal sedimentation, partitioning into solvents of different hydrophobi cities, etc. t Amplification and diversification ofthe coding nucleic acid via >
  • Non-natural nucleic acids augmented with the ability to bind chemically potent, water-compatible metals such Cu, La, Ni, Pd, Rh, Ru, or Sc may possess greatly expanded catalytic properties.
  • a Pd-binding oligonucleotide folded into a well-defined structure may possess the ability to catalyze Pd-mediated coupling reactions with a high degree of regiospecificity or stereospecificity.
  • non-natural nucleic acids that form chiral Sc binding sites may serve as enantioselective cycloaddition or aldol addition catalysts.
  • the ability of DNA polymerases to translate DNA sequences into these non-natural polymers coupled with in vitro selections for catalytic activities would therefore permit the direct evolution of desired catalysts from random libraries.
  • Evolving catalysts in this approach addresses the difficulty of rationally designing catalytic active sites with specific chemical properties that has inspired recent combinatorial approaches (Kuntz et al. (1999) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 3: 313-319; Francis et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 422-8) to organometallic catalyst discovery.
  • Hoveyda and co-workers identified Ti-based enanti ⁇ selective epoxidation catalysts by serial screening of peptide ligands (Shimizu etal. (1997), ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 36).
  • the cunent approach differs fundamentally from previous combinatorial catalyst discovery efforts in that it permits catalysts with desired properties to spontaneously emerge , from one pot, solution-phase libraries after evolutionary cycles of diversification, amplification, translation, and selection.
  • This strategy allows up to 10 15 different catalysts to be generated and selected for, desired properties in a single experiment.
  • the compatibility of this approach with one-pot i f i 'vitro selections allows the direct selection for reaction catalysis rather than screening for a phenomenon associated with catalysis such as metal binding or heat generation.
  • properties difficult to screen rapidly such as substrate stereospecificity or metal selectivity can be directly selected using approaches disclosed herein.
  • FIG. 68 A strategy for synthesizing metal-binding uridine and 7-deazaadenosine analogs is shown in Figure 68. Both routes end with amide bond formation between NHS esters of metal-binding functional groups and amino modified deoxyribonucleotide triphosphates (7 and 13). Analogs 7 and 13 as well as acetylated derivatives of 7 have been previously shown to be tolerated by DNA polymerases, including thermostable DNA polymerases suitable for PCR (Perrin et al. (2001) supra; Perrin et al. (1999) supra; Latham et al (1994) NUCLEIC ACIDS 12V1PRE 22: 2817-22; Gouriain et al.
  • C7-modified 7-deazaadenosine intermediate 13 the key intermediate for 7- deazaadenosine analogs, has been synthesized.
  • diethoxyethylcyanoacetate 24 was synthesized frombromoacetal 25 and ethyl cyanbacetate 26 following a known protocol (Davoll (1960) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 82: 131-138). Condensation of 24 with thiourea provided pyrimidine 27, which was desulfurized with Raney nickel and then cyclized to pynolopyrimidine 28 with dilute aqueous HCl.
  • Figure 71 shows glycosylation of compound 30 with protected deoxyribosyl chloride 38 (generated from deoxyribose as shown in Figure 72), followed by ammonolysis afforded 7-iodo-adenosine 39 (Gouriain et al (2001) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 29: 1898-1905)1 Pd- mediated Sonogashira coupling (Seela et al. (1999) HELV. CHEM.
  • a variety of metal-binding groups as NHS esters can be coupled to C5-modified uridine intermediate 7 and C7-modified 7-deazaadenosine intermediate 13.
  • Exemplary metal-binding groups are shown in Figure 68 and include phosphines, thiopyridyl groups, and hemi-salen moieties.
  • Additional deoxyadenosine derivatives such as, for example, compounds 41 and 42 shown in Figure 73, can be prepared by coupling alkyl- and vinyl trifluoroacetamides to 8- bromo-deoxyadenosine (31). These intermediates then are coupled with the NHS esters shown in Figure 68 to generate a variety of metal-binding, 8 -functionalized deoxyadenosine triphosphates.
  • Methyl-, (32), ethyl-' (33), and vinyladenosine (34) were synthesized by Pd-mediated Stille coupling ofthe conesponding alkyl tin reagent and 31 (Mamos et al. (1992) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 33: 2413-2416).
  • Methylamino- (35) (Nandanan et al. (1999) J. MED. CHEM. 42: 1625-1638), ethylamino- (36), and histaminoadenosine (37) were prepared by treatment of 23 with the conesponding amine in water or ethanol.
  • the 5 '-nucleotide triphosphates of 32-37 were synthesized as descnbed above.
  • V ' " 1 . ' ⁇ ' ' ⁇ ⁇ i containing the imidazole-linked thymine base shown in Figure 76 have been created. These libraries were efficiently generated by three methods; standard PCR, enor-prone PCR, and , primer extension using large quantities of template and stoichiometric quantities of only one , primer. The resulting double-stranded libraries were denatured and the desired strand isolated using the avidin-based purification system described hereinabove. Two rounds of in vitro selection on this library for polymers that fold only in the presence of Gu 2+ have been performed using the gel electrophoresis selection for folded nucleic acids as described herein.
  • Libraries of nucleic acids containing the most promising polymerase-accepted metal-binding nucleotides, including 28-30 can also be generated.
  • Libraries can be generated by PCR amplification or by primer extension of a synthetic D ⁇ A template library consisting of a random region of 20 or 40 nucleotides flanked by two 15-base constant priming regions ( Figure 77).
  • the priming regions contain restriction endonuclease cleavage sites to allow D ⁇ A sequencing of pools or individual library members.
  • One primer contains a primary amine group at its 5' terminus and will become the coding strand ofthe library.
  • the other primer contains a biotinylated 5' terminus and will become the non-coding strand.
  • the PCR reaction includes one or two non-natural metal-binding deoxyribonucleotide triphosphates, three or two natural deoxyribonucleotide triphosphates, and a D ⁇ A polymerase compatible with non- natural nucleotides.
  • library members then are denatured and the non-coding strands removed by washing with streptavidin- linked magnetic beads to ensure that no biotinylated strands remain in the library. Libraries of up to 10 15 different members can be generated by this method, far exceeding the combined diversity of previously reported combinatorial metal-binding catalyst discovery efforts.
  • Each library then is incubated in aqueous solution with a metal of interest from the following non-limiting list of water compatible metal salts: ScCl 3 , CrCl 3 , MnCl 2 , FeCl 2 , FeCl 3 , CoCl 2 , ⁇ iCl 2 , CuCl 2 , ZnCl 2 , GaCl 3 , YC1 3 , RuCl 3 , RhCl 3 , Na 2 PdCl 4 , AgCl, CdCl 2 , InCl 3 , SnCl 2 , La(OTf) 3 , Ce(OTf) 3 , Pr(OTf) 3 , Nd(OTf) 3 , ,Sm(OTf) 3 , Eu(OTf) 3 , Gd(OTf) 3 , Tb(OTf) 3 , Dy(OTf) 3 , Ho(OTf) 3 , Er(OTf) 3 , Tm(OTf) 3 , Ho(
  • the metals are chosen in part based on the , specific chemical reactions to be catalyzed. For example, libraries aimed at reactions such as aldol condensations or hetero Diels-Alder reactions that are known to be catalyzed by Lewis acids are incubated with ScCl 3 or with one ofthe lanthanide triflates (Fringuelli et al. (2001)
  • metals not previously known to. catalyze the transformations of interest are also used to evolve polymers with unprecedented activity.
  • the metal-incubated library is purified away from unbound metal salts using gel filtration cartridges (available from, for example, Princeton Separations) that separate DNA oligonucleotides 25 bases or longer from unbound smaller reaction components.
  • the ability ofthe polymer library (or of individual library members) to bind metals of interest is verified by treating the metalated library free of unbound metals with metal staining reagents, such as dithiooxamide, dimethylglyoxime, or potassium isothiocyanate (KSCN) (Francis et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 422-8) or EDTA (Zaitoun et al (1997) J. PHYS. CHEM. B 101: 1857-1860), that become distinctly colored in the presence of different metals.
  • metal staining reagents such as dithiooxamide, dimethylglyoxime, or potassium isothiocyanate (KSCN) (Francis et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 422-8) or EDTA (Zaitoun et al (1997) J. PHYS. CHEM. B 101: 1857-
  • the approximate level of metal binding is measured by spectrophotometric comparison with solutions of free metals of known concentration and with solutions of positive control oligonucleotides containing an EDTA group (which can be introduced using a commercially available phosphoramidite from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA).
  • Non-denaturing gel electrophoresis can be used as a simple selection, to be applied to inventive libraries of modified nucleic acids, to select for nucleic acid folding in the presence of specific metals of interest.
  • three 60-base DNA oligonucleotides known Schotze et al. (1994) J. MOL. BIOL. 235: 1532-1547
  • predicted SurreaLucia (1998) PROC NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 95: 1460-1465) to have very different folded states were synthesized.
  • Each oligonucleotide contained a core 30-base sequence, flanked by two 15-base primer binding sequences.
  • the unstructured control oligonucleotide contained a poly T core and an EcoR I restriction site.
  • the second core sequence contained a perfect inverted repeat predicted to form a highly stable hai ⁇ in, while the third core sequence contained a poly G core known to fold in solution into , an intramolecular G-quartet (Cheng etal. (1997) GENE 197: 253-260).
  • Th ⁇ three DNA sequences were combined in equimolar ratios and the mixture subjected to preparative ' non-denaturing gel electrophoresis. The highriidbility portion ofthe DNA was captured and ' compared'by analytic electrophoresis to authentic poly T, hai ⁇ in, and poly G oligonucleotides.
  • Non-binders are removed by washing, and polymers, with desired binding properties are eluted by chemical denaturation or by adding excess authentic free ligand.
  • the DNA templates are amplified by PCR using one primer containing the 5 '-functionalized hai ⁇ in primer and a biotinylated second primer, optionally diversified by enor-prone PCR (Caldwell (1992) PCR METHODS APPLIC. 2: 28-33) or by nonhomologous random recombination method, and then denatured into single stranded DNA and washed with streptavidin beads to remove the non- coding template strand.
  • the resulting pool of selected single-stranded, 5 '-functionalized DNA completes the evolution cycle and enters subsequent rounds of DNA-templated translation, selection, diversification, and amplification.
  • library members that catalyze bond cleavage reactions such as retro-aldol reactions, amide hydrolysis, elimination reactions, or olefin dihydroxylation followed by periodate cleavage can also be selected, as illustrated in Figure 13.
  • metalated library members are covalently linked to biotinylated substrates such that the bond breakage reaction causes the disconnection ofthe biotin moiety from the library members.
  • active catalysts but not inactive library members, induce the loss of their biotin groups.
  • Streptavidin-linked beads can then be used to capture inactive polymers, while active catalysts are able to elute from the beads.
  • RNAs and DNAs selected in this manner have in general proven to be multiple turnover catalysts when separated from their substrate moieties (Jaschke et al. (2000) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 4: 257-62; Jaeger et al. (1999) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 96: 14712-7; Bartel et al. (1993) SCIENCE 261: 1411-8; Sen et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 680-7).
  • active library members can be amplified directly by PCR with the non-natural nucleotides and subjected to additional rounds of selection to enrich the library for desired catalysts.
  • Libraries may ' be diversified by random mutagenesis using enor-prone PCR or by nonhomologous recombination and characterized by DNA sequencing before and after selection: Because enor-prone PCR is inherently less efficient than normal PCR, enor-prone PCR diversification is conducted with only natural nucleotides. The mutagenized DNA templates then are translated into non-natural nucleic acid polymers as described above.
  • the in vitro selections descnbed herein may be used to evolve catalysts with properties difficult to achieve using cunent catalyst discovery approaches.
  • substrate specificity among catalysts can be evolved by selecting for active catalysts in the presence ofthe desired substrate and then selecting for inactive catalysts in the presence of one or rri ⁇ re undesired substrates. Using this strategy, it is contemplated that it will be possible to evolve libraries of catalysts with unprecedented regio- and stereoselectivity.
  • four types of substrate specificity cunently unachievable by known catalysts nor likely to be solvable by cunent catalyst discovery methods include: (i) Heck catalysts that operate on para- but not meta- aryl chlorides, (ii) aldol catalysts that accept ketones but not aldehydes as enolate acceptors, (iii) hetero Diels-Alder catalysts that reject olefin dienophiles, and (iv) hetero Diels-Alder catalysts that accept trans-trans but reject cis-trans or terminal dienes.
  • Metal-binding polymers containing well-ordered, three-dimensional dispositions of key steric and electronic groups may be ideally suited to solving these problems.
  • metal selectivity can be evolved by selecting for active catalysts in the presence of desired metals and selecting against activity in the presence of undesired metals.
  • Catalysts with broad substrate tolerance may be evolved by varying substrate structures between successive rounds of selection. Characterizing catalysts evolved by the above methods may provide new insights into developing analogous small molecule catalysts with powerful and unprecedented selectivities.
  • This Example demonstrates that it is possible to perform in vitro selections for nucleic acid-linked synthetic small molecules.with protein binding affinity. These selections (i) offer much greater sensitivities (10 "20 mol) than previously reported synthetic molecule screens for protein binding, (ii) can be rapidly iterated to achieve 10 6 -fold net enrichments of aptive molecules, and (iii) can be adapted to select for binding specificity. ⁇
  • DNA oligonucleotides (see, Figure 79) were synthesized such that each small molecule was linked to a unique DNA sequence.
  • the small molecules were chosen either for their known binding affinities to six proteins (see, Figure 79), or as nonbinding negative controls. Solutions containing mixtures of DNA-linked protein ligands and DNA-linked negative controls were used to simulate DNA-templated synthetic small molecule libraries containing small fractions of library members with protein binding activities.
  • binding specificity is a broadly important property of synthetic molecules.
  • Library screening methods for binding specificity typically require duplicating the entire screen for each target or non-target of interest.
  • selections for specificity in principle can be performed in a single experiment by selecting for target binding as well as for the inability to bind one or more non-targets.
  • DNA-linked biotin (4), DNA-linked chymostatin (5), and DNA-linked antipain (6) were combined into a single solution in a 24:4:1 ratio, respectively.
  • this mixture simulates a library containing predominantly nonbinding molecules with a minor fraction of nonspecific binders and an even smaller fraction of a target-specific binder.
  • DNA-linked synthetic molecules from a single solution suggests their use to discover synthetic molecules that exclusively bind a single member of a large family of related proteins (e.g. , kinases, proteases, or glycotransferases), and that do not bind proteins that cornmonly reduce the biological efficacy of small molecules (e.g. by sequestering, exporting, or metabolizing them).
  • kinases e.g., kinases, proteases, or glycotransferases
  • this Example demonstrates the feasibility of performing in vitro selections for DNA-linked synthetic small molecules with protein binding activities.
  • the application of methods developed here to nucleic acid-templated (or nucleic acid-conjugated) libraries may play an important role in the discovery of synthetic molecules with desired properties using powerful selection and amplification strategies previously available only to biological molecules.
  • DNA oligonucleotides were synthesized on a PerSeptive Biosystems Expedite
  • N-Boc protecting group was removed using two 3 minute gashes of trifluoroacetic acid (TFA):m-cresol (95 :5).
  • the resin then.was washed with' DMF :CH 2 C1 2 (1 : 1) and DMF,: ⁇ yridine (1 : 1).
  • N,N,N',N'-tetramethylufonium hexafluoro ⁇ hosphate (Aldrich, 720 ⁇ mol, 274 mg), 2,6-lutidine (1.2 mmol,' 131 ⁇ l) and NN-diisopropyiethylamin (DIPEA, 750 ⁇ mol, 131 ⁇ l) in 800 ⁇ L of 1- methyl-2pynohdmone was stined for 15 minutes and then added to the resini, stirring for 30 minutes. The resin then was washed with DMF/CH 2 C1 2 (1 :1).
  • TMS-Otf trimethylsilyl triflate
  • N-formyl-Met-Leu-Phe was purchased from Sigma and coupled to 5'- amino-terminated protected D ⁇ A on CPG beads using the conditions described for compound
  • MLF (10-100 ⁇ mol, 0.17 M) was dissolved in dry DMF with 1 equiv. 1- hydroxybenzotriazole ( ⁇ ovabiochem), 0.9 equiv. 0-Benzotriazol-l-yl-N,N,N',N'- tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate (Aldrich), and 2.3 equivalents of DIPEA.
  • the solution was. agitated at room temperature for 1 hour and then added to a unique sequence of 5 '-amino- terminated protected DNA on CPG beads'. The mixture was agitated for 1 hour at room
  • Fmoc-Phg-OH (Novabiochem) was attached to the ⁇ -amine ofthe Lys-linked DNA using the method described for compound (2b). After removal ofthe Fmoc protecting group, 4- carboxybenzenesulfonamide (Aldrich) was attached to the beads using the method described for compound (2b). The beads were washed with DMF, then with CH 3 CN, and dried with nitrogen.
  • NHS-activated Sepharose 4 Fast Flow was prepared in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. Equine GST, bovine carbonic anhydrase (CA), papain, N ⁇ -p-tosyl-L-lysine chloromethyl ketone (TLCK)-treated bovine chymotrypsin, and N- -tosyl-L-phenylalanine chloromethyl ketone (TPCK)-treated bovine trypsin were purchased from Sigma. Typically, proteins were dissolved in phosphate buffered saline (PBS) buffer pH 7.4-7.6 at concentrations of 20-100 ⁇ M. Protein concentrations were determined using UV-Vis spectrometry.
  • PBS phosphate buffered saline
  • Proteins were incubated with beads for 16 hours at 4 °C.
  • the beads were capped for two hours with Tris buffer, then washed extensively with the appropriate selection buffer containing 1 M NaCI and then exchanged into the appropriate selection buffer (see, Table 14).
  • Beads were stored for up to 1 month at 4 °C in a volume of selection buffer equal to the initial volume of beads used.
  • papain beads were activated using a solution of 5.5 mM cysteine HCl, 1.1 mM EDTA, and 0.067 mM ⁇ -mercaptoethanol for 30 minutes at 4 °C.
  • Streptavidin magnetic particles (Roche) were washed 3x with selection buffer before use.
  • the bound ligands were eluted by agitating the beads with 100 ⁇ L 0.1 M glutathione (Sigma) at room temperature.
  • the eluant was ethanol precipitated with 3 M sodium acetate and 1 ⁇ L glycogen. The precipitate was used directly for PCR.
  • the beads were washed with papairi wash buffer (3 x 100 ⁇ L) and once with 100 ⁇ L' papain selection buffer.
  • the beads were removed from the spin filter with 30 ⁇ L of double ' distilled H 2 O.
  • a 3 ⁇ L aliquot of resuspended beads were removed for PCR.
  • the DNA conjugates were eluted from the beads by adding 70 ⁇ L 6 M guanidinium HCl and heating the mixture to 90°C for 15 minutes.
  • the eluted material was buffer exchanged as described in the • , iterated carbonic anhydrase selection.
  • the agarose beads were removed from the spin filter using 30 ⁇ L H 2 O and 15 ⁇ L of resuspended beads were used for PCR.
  • the small molecule-DNA conjugates were eluted and buffer exchanged as described, incubated with 15 ⁇ L 100 ⁇ M chymotrypsin for 1 hour and then subjected to a second round of selection.
  • the beads were removed from the spin filter with 30 ⁇ L of H 2 O and 15 ⁇ L were used for PCR. Contamination Controls
  • PCR conditions were step 1: 94°C, 2'; step 2: 94°C, 30 s; step 3: 55°C, 1"; step
  • step 5 go to step 2, x29; step 6: 72°C,' 5'; ' step 7: hold at 4°C.
  • the agarose beads (3-15 ⁇ L) w,ere used directly in the PCR reaction with Taq polymerase (Promega). PCR conditions were step 1: 94°C, 2' step 2: 94°C, 30 s- step 3: 55°C,
  • step 4 72°C, 30 s; step 5: go to step 2, x24; step 6: 4°C.
  • Enrichment ratios are calculated as the ratio ofthe fraction of binding ligand surviving the selection as determined by restriction digestion to the fraction of binding ligand entering the selection as determined by the known concentrations ofthe stock solutions.
  • GSH-template (1) 5 '-GCC TCT GCG ACC GTT CGG AAG CTT CGC GAG TTG CCC AGC GCG (Hind III) [SEQ ID NO: 112]
  • Primer 1 5'-GCC TCT GCG ACC GTT CGG [SEQ ID NO: 114]
  • Primer 2 5'-CGC GCT GGG CAA CTC GCG
  • SEQ ID NO: 115 DNA Sequences for Carbonic Anhydrase Selections: [0564] Phenyl sulfonamide-template O): 5'-CGA TGC TAG CGA AGG AAG CTT
  • Primer 1 5'CGA TGC TAG CGA AGG [SEQ ID NO: 119]
  • Primer 2 5'-GCA GAC GTG CAG TGG [SEQ ID NO: 120]
  • Chymostatin-template (5) 5 '-GCA GTC GAC TCG ACC GGA TCC GGC TAC
  • Primer 1 5 '-GCA GTC GAC TCG ACC [SEQ ID NO: 124]
  • Primer 2 5'-GTG CAC GTC GTA GCC. [SEQ ID NO: 125]
  • This Example demonstrates that it is possible to identify the existence of new chemical reactions via nucleic acid-templated synthesis. New chemical reactions have been identified as a result of experiments to select for, and characterize, bond forming reactions.
  • FIG. 85 A one-pot selection scheme to identify new bond forming reactions is summarized in Figure 85. Briefly, when n pool A reactants and combined with m pool B biotinylated reactants, n x m possible reaction combinations are available.
  • the templated reaction is performed under a particular set of reaction conditions certain combinations ofthe template (e.g., reactant A27) reacts with certain combinations ofthe transfer unit (e.g., the reactant biotinylated Bl 1).
  • the reaction products are captured by avidin linked beads.
  • the avidin captured reaction product can then be amplified,' for exarhple, by PCR, and the template sequenced 'to determine its codon sequence.
  • the amplified template included, a sequence tag (coding region) for reactant A27 and a codon sequence (annealing region) for ' ' reactant Bll. ' , ' ' ' '
  • Figure 86 provides a schematic overview of a scheme for producing a library, of ' compounds, members of which were, created by new identified chemical reactions.
  • four pool A reactants presenting either a phenyl group (AlBl and A1B2) or a primary amine (A2B1 and A2B2) and two biotinylated pool B reactants presenting either a carboxylic acid (Bl) or a methyl ester (B2) were prepared.
  • the two coding and two annealing regions contained different restriction digestion sites to permit the relative quantitiation of each of the four pool A members from within a mixture.
  • Example B Validation of New Reaction Discovery (Example B)
  • This Example shows that the reaction identified in Example A can also be identified in a 96-reaction matrix. Briefly, a 96-reaction matrix containing the DNA-linked functional groups shown in Figure 88 was generated. ,Pool A contained 12 reactants (A1-A12) and pool B contained 8 biotinylated reactants (B1-B8). When combined, 96 different reactions were possible. [0582] The reactants (10 finol each) were combined in the presence of 500 ⁇ M Cu (I) at pH 6.0. Following reaction selection and amplification, one oligonucleotide sequence was enriched.
  • Example C shows another example that it is possible to discover new chemical reactions using nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
  • this Example demonstrates the discovery of a novel Pd-mediated coupling reaction.
  • a library of reactants were created and combined to test for the ability of nucleic acid-templated Pd-mediated coupling reactions.
  • Two pools of reactants (see, Figure 89) were synthesized to give 12 pool A reactants (A1-A12) and 8 biotinylated pool B reactants (B1-B8). When combined, 96 different reactions were possible. The reactants (10 finol each) were combined in the presence of 1 mM Pd(II) at pH 7.0.
  • the identity ofthe oligonucleotide sequences attached to the reaction products ' were determined by microarray analysis (see, Figure 90).
  • a library of anti-sense oligonucleotides complementary to eac ofthe templates to be included in the reaction matrix are synthesized.
  • individual antisense oligonucleotides (1 ' - 9' in Figure 90) complementary to each template are immobilized at , sep&rate addressable locations of a microanay.
  • the 1 sequence of each anti-sense Oligonucleotide immobilized in the microanay is known.
  • the oligonucleotides attached to the resulting reaction products for example, PI attached to template
  • oligonucleotide 1 and product P8 attached to template 8 in Figure 90 are amplified under conditions to permit inco ⁇ oration of a detectable moiety, for example, a fluo ⁇ hore, into the amplified template.
  • the amplified oligonucleotides then are denatured and combined with the microanay under conditions to permit the template oligonucleotide (for example, oligonucleotide 1 and oligonucleotide 8 in Figure 90) to hybridize to its immobilized, complementary oligonucleotide.
  • the microanay may then be scanned to detect a specific binding event via detection ofthe detectable moiety at a particular location. Based on the location ofthe detectable moiety and the known sequence ofthe complementary oligonucleotide immobilized at that location, it is possible to determine the sequence ofthe bound template and thus the reactants that produced the reaction product.
  • Figure 91 summarizes which reactants in pool A reacted with which biotinylated reactants in pool B to create a product.
  • Figure 91 also summarizes the level of signal over background and DNA- templated reaction yield for each product.
  • sequence analysis approaches of a bond-forming reaction between DNA-linked terminal alkyne A2 and DNA-linked acrylamide B8 in the presence of 1 mM Pd(II) at pH 7 see, Figures 89 and 91).

Landscapes

  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Microbiology (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Computational Biology (AREA)
  • Crystallography & Structural Chemistry (AREA)
  • Analytical Chemistry (AREA)
  • Plant Pathology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Measuring Or Testing Involving Enzymes Or Micro-Organisms (AREA)
  • Saccharide Compounds (AREA)
  • Preparation Of Compounds By Using Micro-Organisms (AREA)
  • Organic Low-Molecular-Weight Compounds And Preparation Thereof (AREA)

Abstract

Nature evolves biological molecules such as proteins through iterated rounds of diversification, selection, and amplification. The power of Nature and the flexibility of'organic synthesis are combined in nucleic acid-templated synthesis. The present invention provides a variety-of template architectures for performing nucleic acid-templated synthesis, methods for increasing the selectivity of nucleic acid-templated reactions, methods for performing stereoselective nucleic acid-templated reactions, methods of selecting for reaction products resulting from nucleic acid-templated synthesis, and methods of identifying new chemical reactions based on nucleic acid-templated synthesis.

Description

EVOLVING NEW MOLECULAR FUNCTION
PRIORITY INFORMATION
[0001 ] This application claims the benefit of (i) U. S . Provisional Patent Application No.
60/404,395, filed August 19, 2002, (ii) U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/419,667, filed October 18, ,2002, (iii) U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/432,812, filed December 11,.
2002, (iv) U.S. Provisional Patent Application No., 6.0/444,770, filed February 4, 2003, (v) U.S. '
Provisional Patent Application No. 60/457,789, filed March 26, 2003, (vi) U.S. Provisional ,
Patent Application No. 60/469,866, filed May 12, 2003, and (vii) U.S. Provisional Patent
Application No. 60/479,494, filed June 18, 2003, the disclosures of each of which are incorporated by reference herein. The application is also related to United States Provisional Patent Application Nos. 60/277,081 (filed March 19, 2001), 60/277,094 (filed March 19, 2001),' 60/306,691 (filed July 20, 2001), and 60/353,565 (filed February 1, 2002), as well as to United States Patent Application Nos. 10/101,030 (filed March 19, 2002) and 10/102,056 (filed March 19, 2002), and to International Patent Application, serial number US02/08546 (filed March 19, 2002).
GOVERNMENT FUNDING
[0002] The research described in this application was sponsored, in part, by the Office for Naval Research under Contract No. N00014-00-1-0596 and Grant No. 00014-03-1-0749. The United States Government may have certain rights in the invention.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
[0003] The classic "chemical approach" to generating molecules with new functions has been used extensively over the last century in applications ranging from drug discovery to synthetic methodology to materials science. In this approach, researchers synthesize or isolate candidate molecules, assay these candidates for desired properties, determine the structures of active compounds if unknown, formulate structure-activity relationships based on available assay and structural data, and then synthesize a new generation of molecules designed to possess improved properties. While combinatorial chemistry methods (see, for example, Eliseev et al (1999) COMBINATORIAL CHEMISTRY IN BIOLOGY 243: 159-172; Kuntz et al. (1999) CURRENT OPINION IN CHEMICAL BIOLOGY 3: 313-319; Liu et al. (1999) ANGEW. CHEM. INTL.,ED. ENG. 38: 36) have increased the throughput of this approach, its fundamental limitations remain unchanged. Several factors limit the effectiveness ofthe chemical approach to generating molecular function. First, the ability to accurately predictthe structural changes that will lead to new function is often inadequate due to subtle conformational rearrangements of molecules, unforeseen solvent interactions, or unknown stereochemical requirements of binding or reaction events. The resulting complexity of structure-activity relationships frequently limits the success Of rational ligand or catalyst design, including those efforts conducted in a high-throughput manner. Second, the need to assay or screen, rather than select, each member of a collection of candidates limits the number of molecules that can be searched in each experiment.' Finally, the lack of a way to amplify synthetic molecules places requirements on the minimum amount of material that must be produced for characterization, screening, and structure elucidation. As a result, it can be difficult to generate libraries of more than roughly 106 different synthetic compounds. [0004] hi contrast, Nature generates proteins with new functions using a fundamentally different method that overcomes many of these limitations. In this approach, a protein with desired properties induces the survival and amplification ofthe information encoding that protein. This information is diversified through spontaneous mutation and DNA recombination, and then translated into a new generation of candidate proteins using the ribosome. Unlike the linear chemical approach described above, the steps used by Nature form a cycle of molecular evolution. Proteins emerging from this process have been directly selected, rather than simply screened, for desired activities. Because the biomolecules that encode evolving proteins (e.g., DNA) can be amplified, a single protein molecule with desired activity can in theory lead to the survival and propagation ofthe DNA encoding its structure. [0005] Acknowledging the power and efficiency of Nature's approach, researchers have used molecular evolution to generate many proteins and nucleic acids with novel binding or catalytic properties (see, for example, Minshull et al. (1999) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 3: 284- 90; Schmidt-Dannert et al. (1999) TRENDS BIOTECHNOL. 17: 135-6; Wilson et al. (1999) ANNU. REV. BIOCHEM. 68: 611-47). Proteins and nucleic acids evolved by researchers have demonstrated value as research tools, diagnostics, industrial reagents, and therapeutics, and have greatly expanded the understanding ofthe molecular interactions that endow proteins and nucleic acids with binding or catalytic properties (see* Famulok et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 320-7).
[0006] Despite Nature's efficient approach to generating function, Nature's molecular evolution is limited to two types of "natural" molecules (proteins and nucleic acids) because thus far the information in nucleic acids can only be translated into proteins or into other nucleic acids. Unfortunately, many synthetic molecules of interest do not in general1 have nucleic acid or protein backbones. An ideal approach to generating functional molecules merges the most powerful aspects of molecular evolution with the flexibility of synthetic chemistry. Clearly,, enabling the evolution of non-natural synthetic small molecules and polymers, much as Nature evolves biomolecules, would lead to much more effective methods of discovering new synthetic ligands, receptors, and catalysts difficult or impossible to generate using rational design.
[0007] Although these concepts have been broμght together to permit nucleic acid- templated synthesis of small molecules (see, for example, Gartner & Liu (2001) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 123: 6961-6963) there is still an ongoing need for improvements in these core technologies to permit the more efficient synthesis, selection, amplification, and evolution of molecules of interest.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
[0008] The invention provides a variety of methods and compositions that expand the scope of template-directed synthesis, selection, amplification and evolution of molecules of interest. During nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the information encoded within a nucleic acid template is used to bring two or more reactants together into reactive proximity. These methods permit the creation of, for example, small molecule and polymer libraries that have not been possible to create to date using conventional combinational chemistries.
[0009] In one aspect, the invention provides a method of performing nucleic acid- templated synthesis using a template having an "omega" or " Ω" type architecture. This type of template permits distance-dependent nucleic acid-templated reactions to be encoded by bases far removed from the associated reactive unit. The method involves providing (i) a template comprising a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a codon and (ii) a transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon that is capable of annealing to the codon. The codon and/or the anti- codon include first and second regions spaced apart from one another. The oligonucleotides then are annealed together to bring the reactive units into reactive proximity. When the oligonucleotides anneal to one another, the codon (or anti-codon) with the spaced-apart regions produce a loop of oligonucleotides not annealed to the corresponding anti-codon (or codon). A covalent bond-forming reaction then is induced between the reactive units to produce the reaction product.
[0010] In one embodiment, at least one ofthe reactive units are attached adjacent a terminal region of its corresponding oligonucleotide. In another embodiment, the codon or anti- codon is disposed more than one base away (for example, 10, 20, 30 bases or more) from its corresponding reactive unit. The first spaced apart region typically is disposed directly adjacent a terminus of its corresponding oligonucleotide. The first spaced apart region preferably includes, for example, three, four, or five nucleotides, although other embodiments (e.g., more than five nucleotides) are also envisioned. The second region may be disposed, for example, at least twenty or at least thirty bases away from its corresponding reactive unit. More particularly, the end ofthe second region closest to the reactive unit may be disposed, for example, at least ten, twenty, thirty or more bases from the end ofthe oligonucleotide attached to its reactive unit. The template may include additional (e.g., 2, 3, A, or more than 4) codons, in which case a corresponding number of transfer units can be annealed to the template, optionally permitting multi-step or alternative syntheses. [0011] In another aspect, the invention provides a method of performing a nucleic acid- templated synthesis using a template having a "T" type architecture. The T architecture permits two nucleic acid-templated reactions to take place on a single template in a single step. The method involves providing (i) a template comprising a first reactive unit (e.g., a scaffold molecule) associated with a first oligonucleotide having a codon, and (ii) a transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide having an anti-codon capable of annealing to the codon. The first reactive unit is attached, preferably covalently, to an attachment site intermediate the proximal and distal ends ofthe first oligonucleotide ofthe template. During synthesis, the oligonucleotides ofthe template and transfer unit are annealed to one another to bring the reactive units into reactive proximity, and a covalent bond-forming reaction between the reactive units is induced. [0012] In one embodiment ofthe T type architecture, the template also includes a second, different codon capable of annealing to a' second, different anti-codon sequence of a second, different transfer unit. In this embodiment, the first codon is located proximal to the attachment site and the second codon, if present, is located distal to the attachment site. If a second transfer unit comprising a third reactive unit associated with a third oligonucleotide having a second, different anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the second codon is provided, the second transfer unit may bind to the template at the second codon position. Accordingly,' when the first 'and .second transfer units are combined with the template, the first anti-codon of Jhe first transfer unit anneals to the first codon ofthe template and the second anti-codon ofthe second transfer unit anneals to the second codon ofthe template. This, system permits two reactions to occur simultaneously or sequentially on a single template in a single step.
[0013] In another aspect, the invention provides a series of methods for increasing reaction selectivity between reactants in a templated synthesis. In one approach, the method comprises providing a template and at least two transfer units. The template comprises a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a predetermined codon sequence. The first transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the codon sequence. The second transfer unit comprises a third reactive unit, different from the second reactive unit. The third reactive unit, however, is associated with a third oligonucleotide that lacks an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the codon sequence. The template and transfer units are mixed under conditions to permit annealing ofthe second oligonucleotide to the first oligonucleotide, thereby to enhance covalent bond formation between the second and first reactive units relative to covalent bond formation between the third and first reactive units.
[0014] This method may be particularly helpful when the second and third reactive units are each capable of reacting independently with the first reactive unit. Furthermore, the method may also be helpful when the second and third reactive units are capable of reacting with one another, for example, to modify or inactivate one another. Accordingly, this type of method permits a series of otherwise incompatible reactions to occur in the same solution, for example, where a reaction between the second and third reactive units is incompatible with a reaction between the second reactive unit and the first reactive unit. The method may enhance covalent bond formation between the first and second reactive units by at least 2-fold, at least 5-fold, at least 10-fold, or at least 50-fold relative to cbvalentjbond formation between the first and third reactive units. Collectively, these advantages permit a one-pot ordered multi-step synthesis, in ' which a sequence of reactions is programmed by the sequence of a template oligonucleotide. Thus, a sequence of at least 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or more reactions can take place in an ordered manner in a single solution, even when the reactants would interfere with each other using conventional, non-templated chemistries. , " . ' ' , , , '
[0015] i In one embodiment, the template, the, first transfer unit, and/or the second transfer, unit are associated with a capturable moiety for example, biotin, avidin, or streptavidin. If a , capturable moiety is present, the method may include capturing the capturable moiety as a way to enrich a reaction product from a reaction mixture.
[0016] In another approach, the method comprises providing (i) a template comprising a first oligonucleotide having first and second codόn seqμences (ii) a first transfer unit, (iii) a second transfer unit, and (iv) a third transfer unit. The first transfer unit comprises a first reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising a first anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the first codon sequence. The second transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a third oligonucleotide comprising a second anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the second codon sequence. The third transfer unit comprises a third reactive unit associated with a fourth oligonucleotide sequence that lacks an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to the first or second codon sequences. The template, first transfer unit, second transfer unit, and third transfer unit then are mixed under conditions to permit (i) annealing ofthe first anti-codon sequence to the first codon sequence and (ii) annealing ofthe second anti-codon sequence to the second codon sequence thereby to enhance covalent bond formation between the first and second reactive units relative to covalent bond formation between the third reactive unit and the first reactive unit and/or between the third reactive unit the second reactive unit. This type of method may be particularly useful for producing non- natural polymers by nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
[0017] In one embodiment, the template is associated with a capturable moiety, for example, biotin, avidin, or streptavidin. The capturable moiety may also be a reaction product resulting from a reaction between the first and second reactive units when the first and second reactive units are annealed to a template. If a capturable moiety is present, the method may include capturing the capturable moiety as a way to enrich a reaction production from the reaction mixture.
[0018] , This type of method is also helpful when the third reactive unit is capable of reacting with the first and/or second reactive units. In other words, the reaction between the first and third reactive units and/or between the second and third reactive units may be incompatible with the reaction between the first and second reactive units. The method may enhance covalent bond formation between the first and second reactive units by at least 2-fold, at least 5-fold, at ieast 10- fold, or at least 50- fold relative to covalent bond formation between the first and third reactive units. [0019] In another aspect, the invention provides a series of methods for performing stereoselective nucleic acid-templated synthesis. The stereoselectivity ofthe synthesis may result from the choice of a particular template, transfer unit, reactive unit, hybridized template and transfer unit, stereoselective catalyst, or any combination ofthe above. The resulting product may be at least 60%, at least 70%, at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 98%, or at least 99% stereochemically pure.
[0020] Generally, the method involves providing (i) a template comprising a first oligonucleotide that optionally is associated with a reactive unit and (ii) one or more transfer units, each comprising a second oligonucleotide associated with a reactive unit. Annealing 'of the first and second oligonucleotides brings at least two reactive units into reactive proximity and to react to produce a reaction product where the reaction product contains a chiral center and is of at least 60%, more preferably at least 80%, and more preferably at least 95% stereochemically pure at the chiral center. It is contemplated that this method can be accomplished when one reactive unit is associated with the template and the other reactive unit is associated with the transfer unit. Also, it is contemplated that this method can be accomplished when the template does not provide a reactive unit and two transfer units when they anneal to the template provide the two reactive units that come into reactive proximity to produce the reaction product.
[0021] In one approach, the method involves providing at least two templates and at least one transfer unit. One template includes a first oligonucleotide associated with a first reactive unit comprising a first stereochemical configuration, and the other template includes another first oligonucleotide associated with another first reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration. The transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide including a sequence complementary to a sequence ofthe first oligonucleotide ofthe template. The first and, second oligonucleotides then are annealed under conditions to permit the second reactive unit ofthe transfer unit to react preferentially with either, the first reactive unit ofthe first stereochemical configuration or the first reactive unit ofthe second stereochemical configuration to produce a reaction product. ' ,
[0022] ■ The resulting reaction product may have a particular stereochemical configuratiqn. In one embodiment, a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation ofthe first oligonucleotide ofthe template determines which one ofthe first , reactive units reacts with the second reactive unit. , [0023] In a second approach, the method involves providing at least one template and at least two transfer units. The template includes a first oligonucleotide associated with a first reactive unit. One transfer unit comprises a second oligonucleotide associated with a second , reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration, and the other transfer unit, comprises another second oligonucleotide associated with a second reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration. A sequence ofthe second oligonucleotides is complementary to a sequence ofthe first oligonucleotide. The first and second oligonucleotides then are annealed under conditions to permit the first reactive unit ofthe template to react preferentially with either the second reactive unit having the first stereochemical configuration or with the second reactive unit having the second stereochemical configuration to produce a reaction product. [0024] The resulting reaction product may have a particular stereochemical configuration. In one embodiment, a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation ofthe second oligonucleotide determines which ofthe second reactive units reacts with the first reactive unit.
[0025] In a third approach, the method involves providing at least one template and at least two transfer units, wherein one or optionally both ofthe transfer units comprise a pair of reactive units with one reactive unit ofthe pair having a first stereochemical configuration and the other reactive unit ofthe pair having a second, different stereochemical configuration. The template comprises a first oligonucleotide comprising a first codon sequence and a second codon sequence. One transfer unit of a first pair of transfer units includes a second oligonucleotide with a first anti-codon sequence associated with a first reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration. The other transfer unit ofthe first pair of transfer units includes another second oligonucleotide associated with a second stereochemical configuration ofthe first reactive unit.
The second transfer unit includes a third oligonucleotide with a second anti-codon sequence associated with a second reactive unit. The template, the first pair of transfer units, arid the second transfer unit are annealed to permit a member of the first pair of transfer units to react . preferentially with the second transfer unit to produce a reaction product. The resulting reaction product may have a particular stereochemical configuration.
[0026] In one embodiment, a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation of the second oligonucleotide determines which member of the first .pair of transfer units reacts preferentially to produce the reaction product. [0027] In one embodiment, the method involves providing a template and at least two pairs of transfer units. The template comprises a first oligonucleotide comprising first and second codon sequences. One transfer unit ofthe first pair comprises a second oligonucleotide with a first anti-codon sequence associated with a first reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration. The other transfer unit ofthe first pair comprises the second oligonucleotide with the first anti-codon sequence associated with a first reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration. One transfer unit ofthe second pair of transfer units comprises a third oligonucleotide having a second, different anti-codon sequence associated with a second reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration. The other transfer unit ofthe second pair comprises the third oligonucleotide with the second anti-codon sequence associated with the second reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration. The template, the first pair of transfer units and the second pair of transfer units are annealed to permit a member ofthe first pair of transfer units to react preferentially with a member ofthe second pair of transfer units to produce a reaction product.
[0028] In one embodiment, a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation ofthe second oligonucleotide determines which member ofthe first pair of transfer units reacts preferentially to produce the reaction product. In addition, a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation ofthe third oligonucleotide determines which member ofthe second pair of transfer units reacts preferentially to produce the reaction product.
[0029] In another aspect, the invention provides a method for enriching a product of a templated synthesis reaction. The method comprises providing a first library of molecules comprising a plurality of reaction products associated with a corresponding plurality of oligonucleotides, wherein each oligonucleotide comprises a nucleotide sequence indicative ofthe , associated reaction product. A portion of the reaction products in the first library are capable of binding to a preselected moiety. ,The first library theri is exposed to the binding moiety under conditions to permit reaction product capable of binding the binding moiety to do so. Unbound reaction products are' removed, and bound reaction product then is eluted from the binding moiety to produce a second library of molecules enriched at least 10-fold, more preferably at' least 50-fold, relative to the first library, for reaction products that bind the binding moiety. '
[0030] In one embodiment, the binding moiety, for example, a target biomolecule, for example, a protein, is immobilized on a solid support. In another embodiment, the second library is enriched at least 100-fold or at least 1 ,000-fold for reaction products that bind to the binding moiety. Furthermore, it is contemplated that the steps of exposing the library to the binding moiety, removing unbound reaction products, and eluting bound reaction products can be repeated (e.g., repeated one, two, three or more times). Repetition of these steps preferably yields a second library enriched at least 1, 000-fold, more preferably, at least 10,000-fold, or, more preferably, at least 100, 000-fold, for reaction products that bind to the binding moiety.
[0031] In one embodiment, the oligonucleotide attached to the selected library member includes a first sequence that identifies a first reactive unit that produced the reaction product bindable by the preselected binding moiety. Prefέrably, the oligonucleotide also includes a second sequence that identifies a second reactive unit that produced the reaction product bindable by the preselected binding moiety. By sequencing the oligonucleotide attached to the selected library member it is possible to determine what reactants reacted with one another to produce the reaction product. Accordingly, using this approach it is possible to deduce the structure ofthe selected library member from the reaction history.
[0032] The method may further comprise the step of amplifying the oligonucleotide associated with the enriched reaction product and, preferably, determining the sequence ofthe amplified oligonucleotide. Furthermore, the reaction product can be further characterized by using information encoded within the sequence ofthe oligonucleotide. For example, the sequence ofthe oligonucleotide may be determined and then from the sequence it is possible to determine what reactive units reacted to produce the reaction product. Using a similar approach, it is possible to identify the existence of new chemical reactions that produced the reaction product. [0033] In another aspect, the invention provides a variety of methods for identifying the existence of new chemical reactions. One approach invblves, providing a library of molecules ' comprising a plurality of reaction products associated with a corresponding plurality of oligonucleotides, wherein each oligonucleotide includes a nucleotide sequence indicative of an associated'reaction product. A particular reaction product associated with its corresponding oligonucleotide, then is selected, and characterized. Following characterizatipn ofthe reaction ' product and identification ofthe reactive units that reacted to create the reaction product, it iό possible to identify one or more new chemical' reactions necessary to produce the reaction product. ' , . . . [0034] In one embodiment, the method further includes, after selecting the reaction product, amplifying its corresponding oligonucleotide. The amplified oligonucleotide can then be sequenced to identify what reactive units reacted to produce the reaction product1 The oligonucleotide may also be amplified for use in preparing more ofthe selected reaction product. In other embodiments, the oligonucleotide niay be mutated, and the resulting mutated oligonucleotide may be used in the creation of a second generation library.
[0035] A second approach involves providing (i) a template and (ii) a first transfer unit.
The template comprises a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a codon. The transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon capable of annealing to the codon. The oligonucleotides are annealed to bring the first and second reactive units into reactive proximity. A covalent bond-forming reaction is induced between the reactive units to produce a reaction product. The reaction product then is characterized, and a new chemical reaction necessary to make the reaction product is identified using information encoded by the template to identify the first and second reactive units that reacted to produce the reaction product. The method may also include the step of selecting the reaction product prior to its characterization.
[0036] In a third approach, the invention involves providing at least (i) a template, (ii) a first transfer unit and (iii) a second transfer unit. The first transfer unit comprises a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide. The second transfer unit comprises a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide. The template includes sequences capable of annealing to the first and second oligonucleotides. During the method, the oligonucleotides are annealed to the template to bring the reactive units into reactive proximity and a covalent bond- forming reaction is induced between the reactive units to produce a reaction product: The reaction product then is characterized, for example, by using information encoded by the template to identify the first and second reactive units that reacted with one another to produce the reaction product. Based on the characterization, it is then possible to identify one or more , new chemical reactions that were necessary to make the reaction product. The method may also include the step of selecting the reaction product prior to its characterization.
[0037] Although the methods ofthe invention are useful with small numbers of templates and transfer units, use of larger numbers of templates (e.g., 10, 50, 100, 1000, or more) and of transfer units for each codon (e.g., 10, 20, 30, 50, or more) permits the synthesis of large libraries of molecules that can be screened simultaneously using the sensitivity afforded by amplification.
DEFINITIONS
[0038] The term, "associated with" as used herein describes the interaction between or among two or more groups, moieties, compounds, monomers, etc. When two or more entities are "associated with" one another as described herein, they are linked by a direct or indirect covalent or non-covalent interaction. Preferably, the association is covalent. The covalent association may be, for example, but without limitation, through an amide, ester, carbon-carbon, disulfide, carbamate, ether, thioether, urea, amine, or carbonate linkage. The covalent association may also include a linker moiety, for example, a photocleavable linker. Desirable non-covalent interactions include hydrogen bonding, van der Waals interactions, dipole-dipole interactions, pi stacking interactions, hydrophobic interactions, magnetic interactions, electrostatic interactions, etc. Also, two or more entities or agents may be "associated with" one another by being present together in the same composition.
[0039] The term, "biological macromolecule" as used herein refers to a polynucleotide
(e.g., RNA, DNA, RNA/DNA hybrid), protein, peptide, lipid, or polysaccharide. The biological macromolecule may be naturally occurring or non-naturally occurring. In a preferred embodiment, a biological macromolecule has a molecular weight greater than about 5,000 Daltons.
[0040] The terms, "polynucleotide," "nucleic acid", or "oligonucleotide" as used herein refer to a polymer of nucleotides. The polymer may include, without limitation, natural nucleosides (i.e., adenosine, thymidine, guanosine, cytidine, uridine, deoxyadenosine, deoxythymidine, deoxyguanosine; and deoxycytidihe), nucleoside analogs1 (e.g., 2- aminoadenoisine, 2-thi,othymidine, ihosihe, pyrrolo-pyrimidine, 3-methyl adenosine, 5- ' methylcytidine, C5-bromouridine, C5-fluorduridine, C5-iodouridine, C5-pfopynyl-uridine, C5-proρynyl-cytidine, C5-methylcytidine, 7-deazaadenosine, 7-deazagιianosine, 8-oxoaden sine, 8-oxoguanosine, O(6)-methylguanine, and 2-thiocytidine), chemicall^modified bases, biologically modified bases (e.g. , methylated bases), intercalated bases, modified sugars i , ' ' ' ' . . ' ', '.
(e.g., 2'-fluororibose, ribose, 2'-deoxyribose, .arabinose, and hexose), or modified phosphate ' groups (έ.g., phosphorothioates and 5' -N-phosphoramidite linkages). Nucleic acids and . oligonucleotides may also include other polymers of bases having a modified backbone, such as > a locked nucleic acid (LNA), a peptide nucleic acid (PNA), a threose nucleic acid (TNA) and any other polymers capable of serving as a template for an amplification reaction using an amplification technique, for example, a polymerase chain reaction, a ligase chain reaction, or non-enzymatic, template-directed replication. ' ι '
[0041] , . The term, "small molecule" as used herein,, refers to an organic compound either synthesized in the laboratory or found in nature having a molecular weight less than 10,000 grams per mole, optionally less than 5,000 grams per mole, and optionally less than 2,000 grams per mole.
[0042] The terms, "small molecule scaffold" or "molecular scaffold" as used herein, refer to a chemical compound having at least one site or chemical moiety suitable for functionalization. The small molecule scaffold or molecular scaffold may have two, three, four, five or more sites or chemical moieties suitable for functionalization. These functionalization sites may be protected or masked as would be appreciated by one of skill in this art. The sites may also be found on an underlying ring structure or backbone.
[0043] The term, "transfer unit" as used herein, refers to a molecule comprising an oligonucleotide having an anti-codon sequence associated with a reactive unit including, for example, but not limited to, a building block, monomer, monomer unit, molecular scaffold, or other reactant useful in template mediated chemical synthesis.
[0044] The term, "template" as used herein, refers to a molecule comprising an oligonucleotide having at least one codon sequence suitable for a template mediated chemical synthesis. The template optionally may comprise (i) a plurality of codon sequences, (ii) an amplification means, for example, a PCR primer binding site or a sequence complementary thereto, (iii) a reactive unit associated therewith, (iv) a combination of (i) and (ii), (v) a combination of (i) and (iii), (vi) a combination of (ii) and (iii), or a combination of (i), (ii) and ,
(in). (
[0045] The terms, "codon" and "anti-codon" as used herein, refer to complementary oligonucleotide sequences in the template and in the transfer unit, respectively, that permit the transfer unit to anneal to the template during template mediated chemical synthesis. •
[0046] Throughout the description, where compositions are described as having, including, or comprising specific components, or where processes are described as having, including, or comprising specific process steps, it is contemplated that compositions ofthe present invention also consist essentially of, or consist of, the recited components} and that the processes ofthe present invention also consist essentially of, or consist of, the recited processing steps. Further, it should be understood that the order of steps or order for performing certain actions are immaterial so long as the invention remains operable. Moreover, two or more steps or actions may be conducted simultaneously. DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0047] i Figure 1 depicts known sequence-specific oligomerizations of complimentary oligonucleotides catalyzed by single-stranded nucleic acid templates.
[0048] Figure 2 is a schematic representation of one embodiment of nucleic acid- templated synthesis where a reactive unit is attached to a template at the start of synthesis. [0049] Figure 3 is a schematic representation of a second embodiment of nucleic acid- templated synthesis where a reactive unit is not attached to the template at the start of synthesis.
[0050] Figure 4 is a schematic representation of a third embodiment of nucleic acid- templated synthesis suitable for polymer synthesis.
[0051] Figures 5A-F are schematic representations of various exemplary templates useful in nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
[0052] Figures 6A-E are schematic representations of desirable and undesirable possible interactions between a codon of a template and an anti-codon of a transfer unit.
[0053] Figures 7A-G are schematic representations of various template architectures useful in nucleic acid-templated synthesis. [0054] Figure 8 is a schematic representation of a method for producing a template,
' ' •', ' ,' ' . .' ' ' ' containing, from the 5,'-end to the 3'-erid, a small moledule functional group,1 a DNA hairpin, ah annealing region, a coding region, and a PCR primer binding site.
[0055] , Figure 9 is a schematic representation, of a general method for making a library of reaction products. '. . , '
[0056] Figure110 is a graph showing the, relationship between the effective concentration of target protein and the fraction of ligand that, binds the target.
[0057] Figures 11A-B are schematic representations of methods for screening a library , for bond-clea age (Figure 11 A) and bond-formation (Figure 11B) catalysts. [0058] Figure 12 is a schematic representation of an in vitro selection scheme for identifying non-natural polymer catalysts of bond-forming reactions. ,
[0059] ' Figure 13 is a schematic representation of an in vitro selection scheme for identifying non-natural polymer catalysts of bond-cleaving reactions.
[0060] Figure 14 is a schematic representation of exemplary reagents and their use in a recombination method for diversifying a template ' library.
[0061] Figure 15 depicts synthetic reactions directed by hairpin (H) and end-of-helix (E)
DNA templates. Reactions were analyzed by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis (PAGE) after the indicated reaction times. Lanes 3 and 4 contained templates quenched with excess β-mercaptoethanol prior to reaction. [0062] Figure 16 depicts the results of reactions between matched (M) or mismatched
(X) reagents linked to thiols (S) or primary amines (N) and templates functionalized with the variety of electrophiles.
[0063] Figures 17A-17B depict various mismatch reactions analyzed by denaturing
PAGE. Figure 17A depicts results of reactions in which H templates linked to an iodoacetamide group were reacted with thiol reagents containing 0, 1, or 3 mismatches at 25°C. Figure 17B depicts results of reactions in which the reactions in Figure 17A were repeated at the indicated temperatures for 16 hours.
[0064] Figure 18 depicts a reaction performed using a 41-base E template and a 10-base reagent designed to anneal 1-30 bases from the 5' end ofthe template. [0065] Figure 19 depicts a repeat ofthe n = 10 reaction in Figure 18 in which the nine bases following the 5 '-NH2-dT were replaced with various backbone analogues.
[0066] , Figure 20 depicts the n - 1, n = 10, and n = 1 mismatched (mis) reactions described in Figure 18 which were repeated with template and reagent concentrations of 12.5, ' 25, 62.5 or 125 nM. . ,
, [0067] Figures 21 A-21B are a schematic representation of a method for translating, selecting, and amplifying a synthetic molecule that binds streptavidin from a DNA-encoded library. ' . .
[0068] Figure 22A depicts DNA sequencing results of a PCR amplified pool of nucleic acid templates of Figures 21 A-21B before and after selection.
[0069] Figure 22B is a schematic representation of a method for creating and evolving libraries of non-natural molecules using nucleic acid-templated synthesis, where — Ri represents the library of product functionality transferred from reagent library 1 and -RI B represents a selected product. [0070] Figures 23 A-23D are schematic representations of exemplary DNA-templated reactions.
[0071] Figure 24 depicts analysis by denaturing PAGE of representative DNA-templated reactions listed in Figures 23 and 25.
[0072] Figures 25A-25B are schematic representations of DNA-templated amide bond formation reactions mediated by EDC and sulfo-NHS or by DMT-MM for a variety of substituted carboxylic acids and amines.
[0073] Figure 26A-26B depict an analysis ofthe distance independent nature of certain nucleic acid-templated reactions. Figure 26A is a schematic representation showing a model for distance-independent nucleic acid-templated synthesis. Figure 26B depicts the results of denaturing PAGE of a DNA-templated Wittig olefination between complementary aldehyde- linked template 11 and phosphorous ylide reagent 13 from Figure 23B with either zero bases (lanes 1-3) or ten bases (lanes 4-6) separating annealed reactants.
[0074] Figure 27 is a schematic representation of exemplary nucleic acid-templated complexity building reactions. [0075] Figures 28A-28B depict strategies for DNA-templated synthesis using autocleaving linkers (Figures 28A and 28B), scarless linkers (Figure 28C), and useful scar linkers (Figure 28D).
[0076] Figure 29 depicts results from nucleic acid-templated reactions with various ' linkers.
[0077] Figures 30A-30B are schematic representations depicting strategies for purifying products of DNA-templated synthesis, using an autocleaving reagent linker (Figure 30A) or scar and non scar linkers (Figure 30B).
[0078] Figures 31 A-B depict an exemplary DNA-templated multi-step tripeptide synthesis. '
[0079] Figures 32A-B depict an exemplary DNA-templated multi-step synthesis.
[0080] Figure 33 depicts DNA-templated amide bond formation reactions in which reagents and templates are complexed with dimethyldidodecylammonium cations. •
[0081] Figure 34 shows denaturing PAGE gels with representative DNA-templated amine acylation, Wittig olefination, 1,3-diρolar cycloaddition, and reductive amination reactions using the end-of-helix (E) and omega (Ω) architectures.
[0082] Figures 35A-35D are bar charts showing a comparison of end-of-helix (E)j haiφin (H), and omega (Ω) architectures for mediating DNA-templated amine acylation (Figure 35A), Wittig olefination (Figure 35B), 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition (Figure 35C), or reductive amination reactions (Figure 35D).
[0083] Figure 36 is a table showing the melting temperatures of selected template- reagent combinations using the omega (Ω) and end-of-helix (E) architectures.
[0084] Figure 37 is a bar chart showing the efficiencies of DNA-templated reactions mediated by a template having the T architecture. [0085] Figures 38A-38C depict two DNA-templated reactions on a single template in one solution mediated by templates having a T architecture.
[0086] Figure 39A-39C are schematic illustrations showing the relative rates of product formation from (S)-and (R)-bromides in H template (Figure 39 A) or E template (Figures 39B and 39C) mediated stereoselective DNA-templated substitution reactions. [0087] Figures 40A-40D depict results on' reaction stereoselectivity when aromatic bases between the reactive groups are deleted and restored. The Figures show changes in stereoselectivity as a result of restoring aromatic DNA bases from the 5' end (Figures 40A-40C) or from the 3' end (Figure 40D) ofthe 12-base intervening region. [0088] Figures 41A-41B show the stereofeelectivities of DNA-templated reactions mediated by right-handed helix (B-fόrm) (Figure 4iA) or left-handed helix (Z-forrn) (Figures 41 A and 41B) haiφin architectures. , ' ' ', '
[0089] Figures 42A-42D shows graphical .representations of product yield versus time for exemplary stereoselective DNA-templated reactions used to calculate IS/IR. Figure 42A ■ corresponds to the reaction shown in Figure 39A; Figure 42B corresponds to the reaction shown in Figure 39B; Figure 42C corresponds to the.reaction shown in Figure 44A arid Figure 42D corresponds to the reaction shown in Figure ,44B. t ' ι , .
[0090] Figures 43A-43F are a schematic representations showing template' and reagent structures that incoφorate achiral, flexible linkers. [0091] Figure 4 A-44B are graphical representations of circular dichroism spectra obtained for B-form (Figure 44A) and Z-form (Figure 44B) template-reagent complexes.
[0092] Figure 45 shows a representative denaturing PAGE analysis of reactions using the CG-rich sequences at low and high salt concentrations.
[0093] Figure 46 is a schematic representation of a DNA-templated synthesis in which maleimides, aldehydes, or amines are subjected to multiple DNA-templated reaction types in a single solution.
[0094] Figure 47 depicts templates and reagents used pairwise in 12-reactant one-pot
DNA-templated reactions.
[0095] Figure 48 depicts a "one-pot" DNA-templated reaction containing 12 reactants and at least seven possible reaction types which generates only 6 sequence-programmed products out of at least 28 possible products.
[0096] Figure 49 is a schematic representation of a method for diversifying a DNA- templated library by sequentially exposing or creating reactive groups. [0097] Figures 50A-50E are schematic representations of exemplary nucleic acid- templated deprotections useful in the practice ofthe invention.
! '
[0098], Figures 51A-51B are schematic representations of exemplary nucleic acid- templated functional group interconversions useful in th practice ofthe invention. ' [0099] Figure 52 is a schematic representation showing the assembly of transfer units along a nucleic acid template.
, [0100] Figure 53 is a schematic representation showing the polymerization of dicarbamate units along a nucleic acid template to form a polycarbamate.
[0101] Figure 54 is a schematic representation showing cleavage of a polycarbamate polymer from a nucleotide backbone.
[0102] Figure 55 is a schematic representation showing the synthesis of a DNA- templated macrocyclic fumaramide library.
[0103] Figure 56 is a schematic representation ofthe amine acylation and cyclization steps of various fumaramide library members of Figure 55. [0104] Figure 57 shows exemplary amino acid building blocks for the synthesis of a
DNA-templated macrocyclic fumaramide library.
[0105] Figure 58 is a schematic representation of a method of creating a template used in the synthesis of a DNA-templated macrocyclic fumaramide library.
[0106] Figure 59 is a schematic representation of an amine acylation and cyclization reaction useful in the synthesis of macrocyclic fumaramide library.
[0107] Figure 60 depicts representative monomer structures that can be incoφorated into a PNA polymer.
[0108] Figure 61 is a schematic representation of a method for making functional polymers. As shown the polymer is still associated with the template. [0109] Figure 62 depicts a DNA-templated aldehyde polymerization reaction.
[0110] Figure 63 depicts PNA polymerization reactions using a 40 base template with mismatched codons located at certain positions ofthe template.
[0111 ] Figure 64 shows the specificity of DNA-templated polymerization reactions. [0112] Figure 65A is a schematic representation, showing a method of using a nucleic acid to direct the synthesis of new polymers, and plastics., Figure 65B is a schematic representation showing the use of Grubbs' ring-opening metathesis polymerization catalysis to evolve plastics. [0113] Figure 66 is a schematic representation showing the evolution of plastics through iterative cycles of ligand diversification, selection, and, amplification to create polymers with desired properties. ' ", : ■• ,
' ' '
[0114] Figure 67 depicts exemplary' functionalized nucleotides that can be incoφorated by DNA polymerase. I I ' [0115] Figure 68 depicts exemplary metal binding uridine and 7-deazaadenosine analogs. , '
[0116] ■ Figure 69 depicts an exemplary synthesis of analog 7 from Figure 67.
[0117] ' Figure 70 depicts an exemplary synthesis of compound 30, a precursor to compound 13 from Figure 67. , [0118] Figure 71 depicts an exemplary synthesis of compound 40, a precursor to compound 13 from Figure 67.
[0119] Figure 72 depicts an exemplary synthesis of compound 38, a precursor to compound 40 from Figure 71.
[0120] Figure 73 depicts exemplary deoxyadenosine derivatives. [0121] Figure 74 depicts an exemplary synthesis of modified deoxyadenosine triphosphates.
[0122] Figure 75 depicts a summary of modified nucleotide triphosphates containing metal-binding functionalities which are or are not incoφorated by DNA-polymerase.
[0123] Figure 76 depicts a non-natural polymer library containing a synthetic metal- binding nucleotide that is compatible with DNA polymerases.
[0124] Figure 77 is a schematic representation showing the generation of libraries of nucleic acids containing polymerase-accepted metal-binding nucleotides. [0125] Figures 78A-78C show reaction schemes for identifying certain reaction catalysts. Figure 78A is a schematic rep'resentation of an exemplary scheme for the in vitro selection of synthetic polymers containing polymerase-accepted metal-binding nucleotides that
I catalyze Heck reactions. Figure 78B is a schematic representation of an exemplary scheme for the in vitro selection of synthetic polymers containing polymerase-accepted metal-binding nucleotides that catalyze hetero Diels- Alder reactions. Figure 78C is a schematic representation of an exemplary scheme for the in vitro selection of synthetic polymers containing polymerase- i accepted metal-binding nucleotides that catalyze aldol reactions.
[0126] Figure 79 depicts exemplary DNA-linked synthetic molecules subjected to protein binding selections, and enrichment factors for a single round of selection.
[0127] Figure 80 depicts the results of an exemplary selection scheme.
[0128] Figure 81 depicts the net, enrichment realized by three rounds of enrichment.
[0129] Figure 82 depicts the separation of target-specific and non-specific DNA-linked synthetic molecules from a single solution. [0130] Figure 83 depicts exemplary specific DNA-linked synthetic molecules selected in
Figure 79.
[0131] Figure 84 depicts an exemplary iterated carbonic anhydrase selection scheme.
[0132] Figure 85 is a schematic representation of a method for performing one-pot selections for bond-forming reactions. [0133] Figure 86 is a schematic representation of a method for validating the discovery of new bond-forming reactions using DNA-templated synthesis.
[0134] Figure 87 depicts an example of reaction discovery using nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
[0135] Figure 88 depicts the discovery of Cu-mediated coupling reactions identified using nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
[0136] Figure 89 depicts the discovery of Pd-mediated coupling reactions identified using nucleic acid-templated synthesis. ,
[0137] Figure 90 is a schematic representation of a microarray based sequence analysis protocol. [0138] Figure 91 depicts the analysis ,of the Pd^mediated reactions identified via microarray based sequence analysis. ' ' , , , , ' , , , '
DESCRIPTION OF CERTAIN EMBODIMENTS OF THE INVENTION
[0139] , Nuclςic-acid templated syntheβjs as described herein permits the production, selection, amplification and evolution of a broad variety of chemical compounds such as , , synthetic small molecules and non-naturaϊ polymers. In nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the information encoded by a DNA or other nucleic acid sequence is translated into the synthesis of a reaction product. The nucleic acid template typically comprises a plurality of coding regions which anneal to complementary anti-codon sequences, associated with reactive units, thereby bringing the reactive Units together in a sequence-specific manner to create a reaction product. Since nucleic acid hybridization is sequenceτspeci'fic, the result of a nucleic acid-templated reaction is the translation of a specific nucleic acid sequence into a corresponding re'action ' ι product. '
[0140] As shown in Figure 1, the ability of single-stranded nucleic acid templates to catalyze the sequence-specific oligomerization of complementary oligonucleotides has been demonstrated (Inoue et al. (1981) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 103: 7666; frioue et al. (1984) J. MOL. BIOL. 178: 669-76). This discovery was soon followed by findings that DNA or RNA templates can catalyze the oligomerization of complementary DNA or RNA mono-, di-, tri-, or oligonucleotides (Inoue et al. (1981) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 103: 7666; Orgel et al. (1995) Ace. CHEM. RES: 28: 109-118; Rembold et al. (1994) J. MOL. EVOL. 38: 205; Rodriguez et al. (1991) J. MOL. EVOL. 33: 477; Chen βt al (1985) J. MOL. BIOL. 181: 271). DNA or RNA templates have since been shown to accelerate the formation of a variety of non-natural nucleic acid analogs, including peptide nucleic acids (Bohler et al. (1995) NATURE 376: 578), phosphorothioate- (Herrlein et al. (1995) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 117: 10151-10152), phosphoroselenate- (Xu et al. (2000) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 122: 9040-9041 ; Xu et al. (2001) NAT. BIOTECHNOL. 19: 148-152) and phosphoramidate- (Luther et al. (1998) NATURE 396: 245-8) containing nucleic acids, non-ribose nucleic acids (Bolli et al. (1997) CHEM. BIOL. 4: 309-20), and DNA analogs in which a phosphate linkage has been replaced with an aminoethyl group (Gat et al. (1998) BIOPOLYMERS 48: 19-28). Nucleic acid templates can also catalyze amine acylation between nucleotide analogs (Bruick et al. (1996) CHEM. BIOL. 3: 49-56). [0141] Although nucleic acid templates have been1 demonstrated to accelerate the formation of a variety of non-natural nucleic acid/analogues, nearly all of these reactions Were' designed to proceed through transition states closely resembling the natural nucleic acid backbone (Figure 1), typically affording products that preserve the same six-bond backbone spacing between nucleotide units. The motivation behind this design presumably was ,the assumption that the rate enhancement provided by nucleic acid templates depends on a precise alignment of reactive groups, and the precision' of this alignment is maximized when the ' reactants and products mimic the structure ofthe DNA and RNA backbones. Evidence in support ofthe hypothesis that nucleic acid-templated synthesis can only generate products that . resemble the hucleic acid backbone comes from the well-known difficulty of macrocyclization in organic synthesis (Ilmrriinati et al (1981) Ace. CHEM.' RES. 14: 95-102; Woodward et al. (1981) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 103: 3210-3213). The rate enhancement of intramolecular ring closing reactions compared with their intermolecular counterp1 arts is known to diminish quickly as ' rotatable bonds are added between reactive groups, such that linking reactants witti a flexible 14- carbon linker hardly affords any rate acceleration (Uluminati et al. (1981) supra).
[0142] Because synthetic molecules of interest do not in general resemble nucleic acid backbones, the use of nucleic acid-templated synthesis to translate nucleic acid sequences into synthetic molecules is useful broadly only if synthetic molecules other than nucleic acids and nucleic acid analogs can be synthesized in a nucleic acid-templated fashion. Significantly, as shown herein, nucleic acid-templated synthesis is indeed a general phenomenon and can be used for a variety of reactions and conditions to generate a diverse range of compounds, specifically including compounds that are not, and do not resemble, nucleic acids or nucleic acid analogs. More specifically, the present invention extends the ability to amplify and evolve libraries of chemical compounds beyond natural biopolymers. The ability to synthesize chemical compounds of arbitrary structure allows researchers to write their own genetic codes incoφorating a wide range of chemical functionality into novel backbone and side-chain structures, which permits the development of novel catalysts, drugs, and polymers, to name a few examples. For example, the direct amplification and evolution of molecules by genetic selection permits the discovery of entirely new families of artificial catalysts which possess activity, bioavailability, solvent, or thermal stability, or other physical properties (such as fluorescence, spin-labeling, or photolability) that may be difficult or impossible to achieve using the limited set of natural protein and nucleic acid building blocks. Similarly, developing methods to amplify and directly evolve synthetic small molecules by iterated cycles of mutation and selection permits the isolation of novel ligands or drugs with properties superior to those isolated by traditional rational design or combinatorial screening drug discovery methods. Additionally, applying this approach to the identification and development of polymers of significance1 in material science can permit the evolution of new plastics or other polymers.
[0143] In' general, nucleic acid-templated synthesis as performed herein involves ,1) providing one, or more nucleic acid templates optionally associated with a reactive unit, and 2)' contacting the one or more nucleic acid templates with one or more transfer units including an anti-codon associated with a reactive unit. The anti-codons ofthe transfer units are designed to hybridize to the nucleic acid template. In certain embodiments ofthe invention, the transfer unit comprises a single moiety simultaneously incoφorating the hybridization capability ofthe anti- codon unit and the chemical functionality ofthe reaction unit. After the transfer units have hybridized to the nucleic acid template in a sequence-specific manner, the reactive units present on the transfer units and/or the nucleic acid template come into reactive proximity to react and generate a reaction product. Preferably, the oligonucleotide portion ofthe transfer unit is removed once the reactive units have reacted to generate the reaction product or an intermediate ofthe reaction product. Significantly, the sequence ofthe nucleic acid template can later be determined, to permit decoding ofthe synthetic history ofthe attached reaction product and, thereby, its structure. This method may be used to synthesize one molecule at a time or may be used to synthesize thousands to millions of compounds using combinatorial methods.
[0144] In one embodiment, the template molecule optionally is associated with a reactive unit prior to interaction with any transfer units. Thus, as shown in Figure 2, the template can be connected by a covalent bond to a reactive unit, either directly or via a linker. Alternatively, the template can be connected by a noncovalent linkage. For example, the template can be biotinylated, generally at a fixed location on the molecule, and can stably interact with a reactive unit associated with an avidin or streptavidin moiety. For ease of synthesis, the reactive unit is preferably placed at or near the 5' end ofthe template in some embodiments as shown in Figure 2. In other embodiments, placement ofthe reactive unit at an internal position ofthe template or at the 3' end is preferred. The template molecule also includes at least one codon capable of annealing to an anti-codon of a transfer unit. During synthesis, the transfer unit anneals to the codon, bringing its reactive unit into reactive proximity, with the reactive unit ofthe template to produce a reaction prqduct. ' . , . , ' . ,
[0145] 'In another embodiment, as shown in Figure 3, the template is not initially associated with a reactive unit, but permits the nucleic acid-templated synthesis of at least two reactive units disposed with two transfer units. The template molecule includes at least1 two codons, each capable of annealing to a different anti-codon disposed within each transfer unit. ,
The anti-codon in each transfer unit anneals to the corresponding codon in the template to bring, the reactive units of each transfer unit into reactive proximity with one another to produce a , reaction product. ' ' [0146] In another embodiment, as shown in Figure 4, the template can bring together, either simultaneously or sequentially, a plurality of transfer units in a sequence-specific manner. The reactive units on each annealed transfer unit: can then be reacted with one another in a polymerization process to produce a polymer. Using this approach it is possible to generate a variety of noή-natural polymers. The polymerization may' be a step-by-step process or may be a simultaneous process whereby all the annealed monomers are reacted in one reaction sequence.
I. TEMPLATE CONSIDERATIONS
[0147] The nucleic acid template can direct a wide variety of chemical reactions without obvious structural requirements by sequence-specifically recruiting reactants linked to complementary oligonucleotides. As discussed, the nucleic acid mediated format permits reactions that may not be possible using conventional synthetic approaches. During synthesis, the template hybridizes or anneals to one or more transfer units to direct the synthesis of a reaction product, which during certain steps of templated synthesis remain associated with the template. A reaction product then is selected or screened based on certain criteria, such as the ability to bind to a preselected target molecule. Once the reaction product has been identified, the associated template can then be sequenced to decode the synthetic history ofthe reaction product. Furthermore, as will be discussed in more detail below, the template may be evolved to guide the synthesis of another chemical compound or library of chemical compounds.
(i) Template Format
[0148] The template may be based on a nucleic acid sequence, for example, a DNA, an RNA, a hybrid of DNA and RNA, or a derivative of DNA and RNA, and may be single- or double-stranded. The design of a particular template may vary depending upon the type of nucleic acid templated synthesis contemplated.
[0149] , Figure 5 shows a variety of templates that may be useful in the practice ofthe invention. Figures 5 A-C are schematic representations of templates including two codons for ' interaction with complementary anti-codons of two transfer units. These templates can be used in the type of nucleic acid-templated synthesis where no reactive units are linked to the template at the initiation of synthesis; for example, when two transfer units anneal to the template to bring their reactive units into reactive proximity to create a reaction product. One such example is polymerization. Nevertheless, the templates can be associated with a reactive unit prior to annealing ofthe transfer units. Figures 5D-F are schematic representations of templates that can be used in the type of nucleic acid-templated synthesis where one reactive unit is linked to the template at the initiation of synthesis, for example, when one transfer unit anneals to the template to bring its reactive unit into reactive proximity with the other reactive unit linked to the template to create a reaction product. [0150] Figure 5A shows a template comprising in a 5 ' to 3 ' direction, a nucleotide sequence encoding a first primer binding site (PBS1) or a sequence complementary thereto, a nucleotide sequence encoding a first codon (Cl) that anneals to an anti-codon sequence of a first transfer unit, a nucleotide sequence encoding a second codon (C2) that anneals to an anti-codon sequence of a second, different transfer unit, and a nucleotide sequence encoding a second primer binding site (PBS2) or a sequence complementary thereto. The primer binding sites, although optional, are preferred in some embodiments to facilitate PCR-based amplification of templates. As will be discussed in more detail below, the Cl sequence is selected so as to minimize cross-reactivity with the anti-codon sequence ofthe second transfer unit, and the C2 sequence is selected so as to minimize cross-reactivity with the anti-codon sequence ofthe first transfer unit. As shown in Figure 5 A, the Cl and C2 sequences are separated by one or more intervening bases. In other words, the Cl and C2 sequences do not directly abut one another. During nucleic acid templated synthesis, both the first and second transfer units are capable of binding to the template at the same time.
[0151] Figure 5B shows a template similar to that shown in Figure 5A, except there are no intervening bases disposed between Cl and C2. In other words, the Cl and C2 sequences directly abut one another. As with the template of Figure 5A, during nucleic acid templated synthesis, both the first and second transfer units ate capable to binding to the template at the same time. " ,■ ' • , , , , ' ,
[0152] Figure 5C shows1 a template similar, to those shown in Figures 5A and 5B, except ' that the, sequence of Cl overlaps the sequence of C2. ,Unlike the templates of Figures 5A and 5B, during nucleic acid templated synthesis, the first and second transfer units cannot both bind to the template at the same time. Thus, unless the template is associated with a reactive unit prior to the initation of synthesis, a third icodon' should normally be present, so that two reactive , units can anneal simultaneously to the template to permit the reaction to proceed. This type of template can require a step-by-step approach to the synthesis of the reaction product. For example, the transfer units with anti-codons to Cl are added first, allowed to hybridize and react, and then removed before the transfer units with anti-codons to C2 are added.
[0153] Figures 5D-5F show templates similar |to the template shown in Figure 5 A, except that the template also includes a reactive unit (R) associated with, for example, covalently linked to, the template. It is understood, however, that the' templates shown in both Figure 5B and Figure 5C may also comprise a reactive unit (R) associated with the corresponding > template, as shown in Figures 5D-5F. To the extent that a template is associated with a reactive unit, the nucleotide sequence ofthe template further comprises a sequence of nucleotides or sequence tag that uniquely identifies the reactive unit associated with the template. Following template mediated synthesis, the reactive unit actually attached to the template that participated in the reaction to generate the reaction product may be identified by reading the sequence ofthe sequence tag.
[0154] In Figure 5D, R is linked to the template at a location in the vicinity ofthe 5' terminal end, for example, at the 5' end ofthe template or downstream ofthe 5' end ofthe template. In Figure 5E, R is linked to the template at a location between the 5' terminal end and the 3' terminal end. In this particular case, R is located at a position between Cl and C2, and represents an example ofthe T type template architecture discussed in more detail below. In Figure 5F, R is linked to the template at a location in the vicinity ofthe 3' terminal end, for example, at the 3' end ofthe template or upstream ofthe 3' end ofthe template.
[0155] It is contemplated that each ofthe templates shown in Figures 5A-F, may comprise one or more restriction endonuclease sites. For example, with reference to Figure 5A, the template may comprise a restriction endonuclease site disposed between (i) PBS1 and Cl, (ii) Cl arid C2, and (iii) C2 and PBS2. The restriction endonuclease sites facilitate the use of nucleic acid cassettes to easily introduce various sequences to replace the PBS1 sequence, the Cl ' sequence, the C2 sequence, the PBS2 sequence, or any combination thereof.
[0156] In addition, the template may also incoφor'ate a haiφin loop on one end terminating in a reactive unit that can interact with one or more reactive units associated with transfer units. For example, a DNA template can comprise a haiφin loop terminating in a 5'- amino group, which may or may not be protected. The amino group may act as an initiation, point for formation of an unnatural polymer, or may be modified to bind a small molecule scaffold for subsequent modification by reactive units of other transfer units. [0157] The length of the template may vary greatly depending upon the type of the nucleic acid-templated synthesis contemplated. For example, in certain embodiments, the template may be from 10 to 10,000 nucleotides in length, from 20 to 1,000 nucleotides in length, from 20 to 400 nucleotides in length, from 40 to 1,000 nucleotides in length, or from 40 to 400 nucleotides in length. The length ofthe template will of course depend on, for example, the length ofthe codons, the complexity ofthe library, the complexity and/or size of a reaction product, the use of spacer sequences, etc.
(ii) Codon Usage
[0158] It is contemplated that the sequence ofthe template may be designed in a number of ways without going beyond the scope ofthe present invention. For example, the length ofthe codon must be determined and the codon sequences must be set. If a codon length of two is used, then using the four naturally occurring bases only 16 possible combinations are available to be used in encoding the library. If the length ofthe codon is increased to three (the number Nature uses in encoding proteins), the number of possible combinations increases to 64. If the length ofthe codon is increased to four, the number of possible combinations increases to 256. Other factors to be considered in determining the length ofthe codon are mismatching, frame- shifting, complexity of library, etc. As the length ofthe codon is increased up to a certain point the number of mismatches is decreased; however, excessively long codons likely will hybridize despite mismatched base pairs.
[0159] Although the length ofthe codons may vary, the codons may range from 2 to 50 nucleotides, from 2 to 40 nucleotides, from 2 to 30 nucleotides, from 2 to 20 nucleotides, from 2 to 15 nucleotides, from 2 to 10 nucleotides, from 3 to 50 nucleotides, from 3 to 40 nucleotides, from 3 to 30 nucleotides, from 3 to 20 nucleotides, from 3 to 15 nucleotides, from 3 to 10 nucleotides, from 4 to 50 nucleotides, frdm 4 to 40 nucleotides, from 4 to 30 nucleotides, from 4 to 20 nucleotides, from 4 to 15 nucleotides, from 4 to 10 nucleotides, from 5 to 50 nucleotides, from 5 to 40 nucleotides, from 5 to 30 nucleotides, from 5 to 20 nucleotides, from 5 to 15 nucleotides, from 5 to 10 nucleotides, from 6 to 50 nucleotides, from 6 to 40 nucleotides, from 6 to 30 nucleotides, from 6 to 20 nucleotides, from 6 to 15 nucleotides, from 6 to 10 nubleotides, from 7 to 50 nucleotides, from 7 to 40 nucleotides, from 7 to 30 nucleotides, from 7 to 20 nucleotides, from 7 to 15 nucleotides, from 7 to 10 nucleotides, from 8 to 50 nucleotides, from 8 to 40 nucleotides, from 8 to 30 nucleotides, from 8 to 20 nucleotides, from 8 to 15 nucleotides, from 8 to 10 nucleotides, from 9 to 50 nucleotides, from 9 to 40 nucleotides, from 9 to 30 nucleotides, from 9 to 20 nucleotides, from 9 to 15 nucleotides, from 9 to 10 nucleotides. Codons, however, preferably are 3, A, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 or 10 nucleotides in length.
[0160] In one embodiment, the set of codons used in the template maximizes the number of mismatches between any two codons within a codon set to ensure that only the proper anti- codons ofthe transfer units anneal to the codon sites ofthe template. Furthermore, it is important that the template has mismatches between all the members of one codon set and all the codons of a different codon set to ensure that the anti-codons do not inadvertently bind to the wrong codon set. For example, with regard to the choice of codons n bases in length, each ofthe codons within a particular codon set (for example, Cl in Figure 5 A) should differ with one another by k mismatches, and all ofthe codons in one codon set (for example, Cl in Figure 5A) should differ by m mismatches with all ofthe codons in the other codon set (for example, C2 in Figure 5A). Exemplary values for n, k, and m, for a variety of codon sets suitable for use on a template are summarized in Table 1.
TABLE 1
Figure imgf000030_0001
Figure imgf000031_0001
Figure imgf000032_0001
Figure imgf000033_0001
Figure imgf000034_0001
Figure imgf000035_0001
Figure imgf000036_0001
Figure imgf000037_0001
Figure imgf000038_0001
Figure imgf000039_0001
Figure imgf000040_0001
Figure imgf000041_0001
Figure imgf000042_0001
Figure imgf000043_0001
Figure imgf000044_0001
Figure imgf000045_0001
Figure imgf000046_0001
Figure imgf000047_0001
Figure imgf000048_0001
[0161] Using an appropriate algorithm, it is possible to generate sets of codons that maximize mismatches between any two codons within the same set, where the codons are n bases long having at least k mismatches between any two codons. Since between any two codons, there must be at least k mismatches, any twn subcodons of n - (k- 1) bases must have at least one mismatch. This sets an upper limit of 4""A+1 on the size of any (n, k) codon set. Such an algorithm preferably1 starts with the A"'M possible subcodons of length n - (k- 1) and then tests all combinations of adding k - 1 bases for those that always maintain k mismatches. All possible (n, k) sets όan be generated for n < 6. For n > 6, the An'm upper limits of codons cannot be met and a "full" packing of viable codons is mathematically impossible. In addition to there being at least one mismatch & between codons within the' same codon set, there should also be at least' one mismatch m between all the codons of one codon set and all the codons of another codon set. Using this approach, different sets of codons can be generated so that no codons are repeated. [0162] By way of example, four (n=5, k=3, m=l) sets, each with 64 codons, can be chosen that always have at least one mismatch between any two codons in different sets and at least three mismatches between codons in the same set. ' ,
I
TABLE 2: Sequences of (5,3,1) Codon Set 1
Figure imgf000049_0001
TABLE 3: Sequences of (5,3,1) Codon Set 2
Figure imgf000049_0002
Figure imgf000050_0001
TABLE 4: Sequences of (5,3,1) Codon Set 3
Figure imgf000050_0002
TABLE 5: Sequences of (5,3,1) Codon Set 4
Figure imgf000050_0003
Figure imgf000051_0001
Figure imgf000051_0002
Figure imgf000052_0001
[0164] Codons can also be chosen to increase control over the GC content and, therefore, the melting temperature ofthe codon arid anti-codon. Cbdons sets with a wide range in GC content versus AT content may rpsult in reagents that anneal with different efficiencies due to different melting temperatures. By screening for GC content among different (n, k) sets, the GC content for1 the codon sets can be optimized. For example, the four (6, 4, 2) cόdon sets βet forth in Tables 6 9 each contain 40 codons with identical GC content (i.e., 50% GC content). , By ' ' using only these 40 codons at each position, all, the reagents in theory will have comparable ' melting temperatures, removing potential biases in annealing that might otherwise affect 'library , synthesis. Longer codons that maintain a large number of mismatches such as those appropriate > for certain applications such as the reaction discovery system can also be chosen using this approach. For example, by combining two (6, 4) sets together while matching low GC to high
GC codons, (12, 8) sets with 64 codons all with 50% GC content can be generated for use in reaction discovery selections as well as other application where multiple mismatches might be ' advantageous. These codons satisfy the requirements for encoding a 30 x 30 matri of functional group combinations for reaction discovery.
[0165] Although an anti-codon is intended to bind only to a codon, as shown in Figure
6A, an anti-codon may also bind to an unintended sequence on a template if complementary sequence is present. Thus, an anti-codon may inadvertently bind to a non-codon sequence as shown in Figure 6B. Alternatively, as shown in Figures 6C and 6D, an anti-codon might inadvertently bind out-of-frame by annealing in part to one codon and in part to another codon (Figure 6C) or to a non-codon sequence (Figure 6D). Finally, as shown in Figure 6E, an anti- codon might bind in-frame to an incorrect codon, an issue addressed by the codon sets described above by requiring at least one base difference distinguishing each codon. In Nature, the problems of noncoding sequences and out-of-frame binding (Figures 6B-D) are avoided by the ribosome. The nucleic acid-templated methods described herein, however, do not take advantage ofthe ribosome's fidelity. Therefore, in order to avoid erroneous annealing as in Figures 6B-D, the templates can be designed such that sequences complementary to anti-codons are found exclusively at in-frame codon positions. For example, codons can be designed to begin, or end, with a particular base (e.g., "G"). If that base is omitted from all other positions in the template (i.e., all other positions are restricted to T, C, and A), only perfect codon sequences in the template will be at the in-frame codon sequences. Similarly, the codon may be designed to be sufficiently long such that its sequence is Unique and does not appear elsewhere in a template. , '' ■ ,
[0166] When the nucleic acid-templated synthesis is used to produce a polymer, spacer sequences may also be placed between the codons to prevent frame shifting. More preferably, the bases ofthe template that encode each polymer subunit (the "genetic code" for the p'olymer) may be chosen from Table 10 to preclude or minimize the possibility of out-όf-frame annealing.
These genetip codes reduce undesired frameshifted nucleic acid-templated polymer translation and differ in the range of expected melting temperatures, and in the minimum number of ' mismatches that result during out-of-frame annealing.
TABLE 10: Representative Genetic Codes for Nucleic Acid-templated Polymers That Preclude Out-Of-Frame Annealing
Figure imgf000054_0001
where, V = A, C, or G, S= C or G, W = A or T, and N = A, C, G, or T
[0167] As in Nature, start and stop codons are useful, particularly in the context of polymer synthesis, to restrict erroneous anti-codon annealing to non-codons and to prevent excessive extension of a growing polymer. For example, a start codon can anneal to a transfer unit bearing a small molecule scaffold or a start monomer unit for use in polymer, synthesis; the start monomer unit can be masked by a photolabile protecting group as shown in Example 9A. A stop codon, if used to terminate polymer synthesis, should not conflict with any other Codons used in the synthesis and should be ofthe same general format as the other codons. Generally, a stop codon, can encode a monomer unit that terminates polymerization by not providing a reactive group for further attachment. For example, a stop monomer unit may contain a blocked reactive group such as an acetamide rather than a primary amine as shown in Example 9A. In other embodiments, the stop monomer unit can include a biotinylated terminus that terminates the polymerization and facilitates purification ofthe resulting polymer. (iii) Template Architecture
[0168] As discussed previously, depending upon the type of nucleic acid-templated synthesis contemplated, the template may be further associated (for example, covalently coupled) with a particular reactive unit. Various templates useful in nucleic acid-templated synthesis are shown in Figures 7A-7G, and include templates referred to as the "end-όf helix" or "E" templates (see, Figure 7A-C), "Haiφin" or "H" templates (see, Figure 7D), "Omega" or "Ω" templates (see, Figure 7E-F), or "T" templates (see, Figure 7G).
[0169] Figures 7A-C show E type template architectures where the reactive units on the annealed templates (denoted by A) and transfer units (denoted by B) are separated by 1 base (Figure 7A), 10 bases (Figure 7B) and 20 bases (Figure 7C). Figure 7D, shows a H type template architecture where the reactive unit is attached to the template (denoted by A) and the template folds back on itself to create a haiφin loop stabilized by a plurality of intramolecular bonds. As shown, the reactive units on the annealed template (denoted by A) and the transfer unit (denoted by B) are separated by 1 base. Figures 7E-F show omega type template architecture where the codon for the transfer unit, bearing reactive unit B, is separated from reactive unit A on the template by 10 intervening template bases (Figure 7E) or by 20 bases (Figure 7F). In Figure 7E, the omega template comprises a three base constant region (Ω-3) and creates a seven base loop when the transfer unit anneals to the template. In Figure 7F, the omega template includes a five base constant region (Ω-5) and creates a fifteen base loop when the transfer unit anneals to the template. The loop gets larger as transfer units anneal to codons further away from the constant region ofthe template. Figure 7G shows a T-type template architecture where the reactive units on the annealed template (denoted by A) and the transfer unit (denoted by B) are separated by 1 base. In Figure 7G; reactive unit A is attached at a location intermediate the 5' and 3' terminal erids. of the template. Using this architecture, it is ' contemplated that the reactive unit may be attached to the template at a location at least 10, 20, ,
30, 40/ 50, 60, 70 bases or more downstream ofthe 5' end ofthe template and/or at least 10, 20, 30, 40, 50/ 60, 70 bases or more upstream ofthe 3? end ofthe template. , ' '' ' ' , ' ' .
[0170] The abfiity ofthe E type template architecture and the H type 'template ' architecture to facilitate nucleic acid mediated chemical syntheses is described in detail in
Example 1. However, as a result of performing nuclejς acid mediated syntheses, it has been discovered that certain reactions, referred to as distance dependent reactions, do not proceed , efficiently when the annealed reactive units on the template and transfer unit are separated by even small numbers of bases. Using the E arid H type templates, certain distance' dependent reactions may only be encoded by template bases at the reactive end ofthe templatef The new Ω type template overcomes the distance dependence problems that can be experienced with the E and H type templates (see, Example 5). Furthermore, it has been discovered that the presence of double-stranded nucleic acids between annealed reactive units can greatly reduce the efficiency of templated reactions because the flexibility of a single-stranded template is required. This may hinder performing two or more reactions in a single nucleic acid templated step using the E or H architectures even though the template may contain enough bases to encode multiple reactions. The new T type template overcomes this problem that can be experienced with the E and H type templates (see, Example 5).
Ω Templates
[0171] The omega architecture permits distance dependent reactions to be directed efficiently by nucleotide bases far away from the reaction end of the template, effectively overcoming their distance dependence. By way of example, in the omega architecture, five bases ofthe template are held constant at the 5 '-end ofthe template (see, Figure 7F). The transfer units contain at their 3 '-ends the complementary five bases but otherwise possess sequences that complement distal coding regions ofthe template. This permits the transfer unit to anneal to the distal coding regions ofthe template while still placing the reactive group ofthe transfer unit in close proximity by looping out large numbers of template bases that would ordinarily prevent a distance dependent reaction from proceeding. The omega architecture retains sequence specificity because the .five bases ofthe transfer unit that complement the end of the template are insufficient by themselves to anneal to the template at room temperature.
[0172] , The usefulness of this type of template architecture is apparent, for example, in nucleic acid-templated reductive amination reactions. These reactions are strongly distance dependent and very little product is produced when the reaction is attempted using the haiφin or end-of-helix architectures with more than one base of distance between the annealed amine and aldehyde groups. In contrast, product forms efficiently using the omega architecture even when a region qf the template 20 bases away from the reactive end is used to recruit the.reagent (see, Example 5). No product is observed when the coding region ofthe transfer unit is mismatched, despite the presence of five bases at the end of the transfer unit that are complementary to the end of the template.
[0173] By enabling distance-dependent nucleic acid mediated reactions to be encoded by bases far away from the reactive end ofthe template, the omega architecture expands the types of reactions that can be encoded anywhere on the template. T Templates
[0174] , The T architecture permits a single template to encode two distance-dependent reactions and in addition permits a template to undergo two different nucleotide-templated reactions in a single solution or in "one-pot." Using this architecture, the template can present a molecular scaffold through the non- Watson-Crick face of a base located in the center, rather than the end, ofthe template (see, Figure 7G). This permits two transfer units to anneal to either side ofthe reactive unit attached to the template and react either simultaneously or in successive steps to give the product of two nucleotide-templated transformations. As expected, distance dependent reactions tolerate this architecture when reactive groups are proximal. Thus, the T- type architecture permits two sequence-specific nucleic acid-templated reactions to take place on one template in one solution, i.e., in one step. In addition to reducing the number of separate DNA-templated steps needed to synthesize a target structure, this architecture may permit three- or more component reactions commonly used to build structural complexity in synthetic libraries.
[0175] The omega and T architectures permit a broader range of template mediated reactions that can be performed in fewer steps with other template architectures and are especially useful in distance-dependent reactions. The variety of available architectures provide significant flexibility in the placement of reactive units on templates, particularly for the synthesis of small molecules. It is contemplate, d that the reactive unit including, for example, ' molecular scaffold rilay, be associated with. a, template at any site along the template including the , 5'-end (e.g., end-of-helix architecture, omega architecture), the 3'-end (e.g., end-of-helix architecture, omega architecture), at the end of a hairpin. loop (e.g., haiφin architecture), or in the middle of the template (e.g., T architecture). Preferably,, the molecular scaffqld is attached ' covalently to the template. However, in certain 'embodiments, the molecular scaffold, like the other reactive units, can be brought to the template using transfer unit, in which case the molecular scaffold is only associated with the template through a non-covalent (here, hydrogen ■ bonding) interaction. It is contemplated, however, that under certain circumstances it may be advantageous to covalently link the molecular scaffold or another reactive unit to the template to produce a T- or E-type template architecture.' For reactions that are not distance dependent, the position ofthe molecular scaffold along the template is' more flexible because the reactive units ' brought to the template by the transfer units are able to react with the scaffold even if the scaffold and reactive group are separated by many bases.
(iv) Template Synthesis
[0176] The templates may be synthesized using methodologies well known in the art.
For example, the nucleic acid sequence may be prepared using any method known in the art to prepare nucleic acid sequences. These methods include both in vivo and in vitro methods including PCR, plasmid preparation, endonuclease digestion, solid phase synthesis (for example, using an automated synthesizer), in vitro transcription, strand separation, etc. Following synthesis, the template, when desired may be associated (for example, covalently or non covalently coupled) with a reactive unit of interest using standard coupling chemistries known in the art. [0177] By way of example, it is possible to create a library of templates via a one-pot modular ligation reaction using oligonucleotide cassettes shown as discussed, for example, in Example 9C. Specifically, it is possible to combine short oligonucleotides representing all transfer unit annealing regions together with T4 DNA ligase in a single solution. Due to the sequence design ofthe oligonucleotide termini, the desired assembled template library is the only possible product when the ligation is complete. This strategy requires 2n x m short oligonucleotides to assemble a library of nm templates, where n refers to the number of different sequences per codon position and m refers to the number of. codons per library member. Thus, . for a two-codon template with 64 possible sequences per codon, 2 x 64 x 2 (256) oligonucleotides are required to assemble a library of 642 (4096) templates. The one-pot assembly ofthe templates for the 83-membered macrocyclic fumaramide library is discussed in Example ,9B. Excellent yields of the desired template library resulted from a 4 hour ligation reaction. Following ligation, T7 exonuclease was added to degrade the non-coding template strand (the desired coding strand is protected by its non-natural 5'-aminoethylene glycol linker). This procedure can provide 20 nmoles ofthe 5' functionalized single-stranded template library (sufficient material for thousands of DNA-templated library syntheses and selections) in about 6 hours. The constant 10-base primer binding regions at the ends of each template were sufficient to permit PCR amplification of as few as 1 ,000 molecules (10" mol) of template from this assembled material.
[0178] Another approach for synthesizing templates is shown in Figure 8. In particular,
Figure 8 shows a protocol for producing a template containing in a 5' to 3' direction,, a small molecule reactant, a haiφin loop, an annealing region, a coding region, and a primer binding site. This type of protocol may be used to synthesize a wide variety of templates, in particular, H type templates useful in the practice ofthe invention.
[0179] An efficient method to synthesize a large variety of templates is to use a "split- pool" technique. The oligonucleotides are synthesized using standard 3' to 5' chemistries. First, the constant 3' end is synthesized. This is then split into n different vessels, where n is the number of different codons to appear at that position in the template. For each vessel, one ofthe n different codons is synthesized on the (growing) 5' end ofthe constant 3' end. Thus, each vessel contains, from 5' to 3', a different codon attached to a constant 3' end. The n vessels are then pooled, so that a single vessel contains n different codons attached to the constant 3' end. Any constant bases adjacent the 5 ' end ofthe codon are now synthesized. The pool then is split into m different vessels, where m is the number of different codons to appear at the next (more 5') position ofthe template. A different codon is synthesized (at the 5' end ofthe growing oligonucleotide) in each ofthe m vessels. The resulting oligonucleotides are pooled in a single vessel. Splitting, synthesizing, and pooling are repeated as required to synthesize all codons and constant regions in the oligonucleotides. I TRANSFER UNITS
[0180] A transfer unit, comprises , an oligonucleotide containing an anti-codon sequence • and a reactive unit. The anti-codons are designed to be complementary to the codons present in the template. Accordingly, the sequences used in the template and the codon lengths should be considered when designing the anti-codons. Any molecule complementary to a codon used in the template may be used, including natural or non-natural nucleotides. In certain embodiments, the codons include one or more bases found in nature (i.e., thymidine, uracil, guanidine, cytosirie, ,and adenine). Thus, the anti-codon can include one or more nucleotides normally found in Nature with a base, a sugar, and an optional phosphate group. Alternatively, the bases may be connected via a backbone other than the sugar-phosphate backbone normally found in Nature (e.g., non-natural nucleotides).
[0181] As discussed above, the anti-codon is associated with a particular type of reactive unit to form a transfer unit. The reactive unit may represent a distinct entity or may be part of the functionality ofthe anti-codon unit. In certain embodiments, each anti-codon sequence is associated with one monomer type. For example, the anti-codon sequence ATTAG may be associated with a carbamate residue with an isobutyl side chain, and the anti-codon sequence CATAG may be associated with a carbamate residue with a phenyl side chain. This one-for-one mapping of anti-codon to monomer units allows the decoding of any polymer ofthe library by sequencing the nucleic acid template used in the synthesis and allows synthesis ofthe same polymer or a related polymer by knowing the sequence ofthe original polymer. By changing (e.g., mutating) the sequence ofthe template, different monomer units may be introduced, thereby allowing the synthesis of related polymers, which can subsequently be selected and evolved. In certain preferred embodiments, several anti-codons may code for one monomer unit as is the case in Nature. [0182] In certain other embodiments, where a small molecule library is to be created rather than a polymer library, the anti-codon generally is associated with a reactive unit or reactant used to modify a small molecule scaffold. In certain embodiments, the reactant is linked to the anti-codon via a linker long enough to allow the reactant to come into reactive proximity with the small molecule scaffold. The linker preferably has a length and composition to permit intramolecular reactions but yet minimize intermolecular reactions. The reactants include a variety of reagents as demonstrated by the wide range of reactions that can be utilized in nucleic acid-templated synthesis (see, Examples 2, and 7) and can be any chemical group, catalyst (e.g., organometallic compounds), or reactive moiety (e.g., electrophiles, nucleophiles) known in the chemical arts.
[0183] , Additionally, the association between the anti-codon and the reactive unit, for example, a monomer unit or reactant, in the transfer unit may be covalent or non-covaleht. The association maybe through a covalent bond and, in certain embodiments, the covalent bond may
' , ' / ' ' be severable., ι
[0184] Thus, the anti-codon can be associated with the reactant through a linker moiety
(see Example ,3). The linkage can be cleavable by light, oxidation, hydrolysis, exposure to acid, exposure to base, reduction, etc. Fruchtel et al. (1996) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. ENGL. 35: 17 describes a variety of linkages useful in the practice ofthe invention. The linker facilitates contact ofthe reactant with the small molecule scaffold, and in certain embodiments,! depending on the desired reaction, positions DNA as a leaving group ("autocleavable" strategy), or may link reactive groups to the template via the "scarless" linker strategy (which yields product without leaving behind an additional atom or atoms having chemical functionality), or a "useful scar" strategy (in which a portion ofthe linker is left behind to be functionalized in subsequent steps following linker cleavage).
[0185] With the "autocleavable" linker strategy, the DNA-reactive group bond is cleaved as a natural consequence ofthe reaction. In the "scarless" linker strategy, DNA-templated reaction of one reactive group is followed by cleavage ofthe linker attached through a second reactive group to yield products without leaving behind additional atoms capable of providing chemical functionality. Alternatively, a "useful scar" may be utilized on the theory that it may be advantageous to introduce useful atoms and/or chemical groups as a consequence of linker cleavage. In particular, a "useful scar" is left behind following linker cleavage and can be functionalized in subsequent steps.
[0186] The anti-codon and the reactive unit (monomer unit or reactant) may also be associated through non-covalent interactions such as ionic, electrostatic, hydrogen bonding, van der Waals interactions, hydrophobic interactions, pi-stacking, etc. and combinations thereof. To give but one example, an anti-codon may be linked to biotin, and a monomer unit linked to streptavidin. The propensity of streptavidin to bind biotin leads to the non-covalent association between the anti-codon and the monomer unit to form the transfer unit. [0187] The specific annealing of transfer units to templates permits the use of transfer units at concentrations lower than concentrations used in many traditional organic syntheses. Thus, transfer units can be used at submillimolar concentrations (e.g. less than 100 μM, less than 10 μM, less than 1 μM, less than 100 nM, or less than 10 nM). III. CHEMICAL REACTIONS
, [0188] A variety of compounds and or libraries can be prepared using the methods described herein. In certain embodiments, compounds that are not, or do not resemble, nucleic acids or analogs thereof, are synthesized' according to the method of the invention; In certain other embodiments, compounds that are not, or do not resemble, proteins, peptides, or analogs thereof, are synthesized according to the method ofthe invention. ,
(i) Coupling Reactions for Small Molecule Synthesis
[0189] In some embodiments, it is possible to create compounds such as small molecules using the methods described herein. These small molecules may be like natural products, non- polymeric, and/or non-oligomeric. The substantial interest in small molecules is due in part to their use as the active ingredient in many pharmaceutical preparations although they may also be used, for example, as catalysts, materials, or additives.
[0190] In synthesizing small molecules using the method ofthe present invention, an evolvable template also is provided. The template can include a small molecule scaffold upon which the small molecule is to be built, or a small molecule scaffold may be added to the template. The small molecule scaffold can be any chemical compound with two or more sites for functionalization. For example, the small molecule scaffold can include a ring system (e.g., the ABCD steroid ring system found in cholesterol) with functionalizable groups coupled to the atoms making up the rings. In another example, the small molecule may be the underlying structure of a pharmaceutical agent such as moφhine, epothilone or a cephalosporin antibiotic. The sites or groups to be functionalized on the small molecule scaffold may be protected using methods and protecting groups known in the art. The protecting groups used in a small molecule scaffold may be orthogonal to one another so that protecting groups can be removed one at a time.
[0191] In this embodiment, the transfer units comprise an anti-codon associated with a reactant or a building block for use in modifying, adding to, or taking away from the small molecule scaffold. The reactants or building blockjs may be, for example, electrophiles (e.g. , acetyl, amides, acid chlorides, esters, nitrile/s, imines), nucleophiles (e.g. , amines, hydroxyl groups, thiols)* catalysts (e.g., organoriietallic catalysts), or side chains. The transfer units are allowed to contact the template under hydridizirig conditions. As a result of oligonucleotide annealing, 'the attached reactant or building block is allowed to react with a site on the small molecule scaffold. In certain embodiments, protecting groups on the small molecule teriiplat'e are removed one at a time from the sites to be functionalized so that the reactant ofthe transfer unit will react at only the desired position on the scaffold. , ■ • ,
[0192] The reaction conditions, linker, reactant, and site to be functionalized are chosen to avoid intermolecular reactions and accelerate intramolecular reactions. Sequential or simultaneous contacting ofthe template with transfer units can be employed depending on the particular compound to be synthesized. In1 certain embodiments of special interest, the multi-step synthesis of chemical compounds is provided m which the template is coritacted sequentially with two or more transfer units to facilitate rriulti-step synthesis of complex chemical compounds.
[0193] After the sites on the scaffold have been modified, the newly synthesized small molecule remains associated with the template that encoded its synthesis. Decoding the sequence ofthe template permits the deconvolutiόn ofthe synthetic history and thereby the structure ofthe small molecule. The template can also be amplified in order to create more of the desired small molecule and/or the template can be evolved (mutagenized) to create related small molecules. The small molecule can also be cleaved from the template for purification or screening.
(ii) Coupling Reactions for Polymer Synthesis
[0194] In certain embodiments, polymers, specifically unnatural polymers, are prepared according to the method ofthe present invention. The unnatural polymers that can be created using the inventive method and system include any unnatural polymers. Exemplary unnatural polymers include, but are not limited to, peptide nucleic acid (PNA) polymers, polycarbamates, polyureas, polyesters, polyacrylate, polyalkylene (e.g., polyethylene, polypropylene), polycarbonates, polypeptides with unnatural stereochemistry, polypeptides with unnatural amino acids, and combination thereof. In certain embodiments, the polymers comprise at least 10, 25, 75, 100, 125, 150 monomer units or more. The polymers synthesized using the inventive system may be used, for example, as catalysts, pharmaceuticals, metal chelators, or catalysts.
. !' ' ' ' '
[0195], In preparing certain unnatural polymers, the monomer units attached to the anti- codons may be any monomers or oligomers capable of being joined together to form a polymbr.
5 The monomer units may be, for example, carbamates, D-amino acids, unnatural amino acids, PNAs, ureas, hydroxy acids, esters, carbonates, acrylates, or ethers. In certain embodiments, the monomer units have two reactive groups used to link the monomer unit into the' growing
, ' polymer ,chain, as depicted in Figure 4, Preferably, the two reactive groups are not the same so that the monomer unit may be incoφorated into the polymer in a directional sense, for example, 0 at one end may be an electrophile and at the other end a nucleophile. Reactive groups may include, but are not limited to, esters, amides, carboxylic acids, activated carbonyl groups, acid chlorides, amines, hydroxyl groups, and thiols. In certain embodiments, the reactive groups are masked or protected (Greene et al (1999) PROTECTIVE GROUPS IN ORGANIC SYNTHESIS 3rd Edition, Wiley) so that polymerization may not take place until a desired time when the reactive 5 groups are deprotected. Once the monomer units are assembled along the nucleic acid template, initiation ofthe polymerization sequence results in a cascade of polymerization and deprotection steps wherein the polymerization step results in deprotection of a reactive group to be used in the subsequent polymerization step.
[0196] The monomer units to be polymerized can include two or more monomers 0 depending on the geometry along the nucleic acid template. The monomer units to be polymerized must be able to stretch along the nucleic acid template and particularly across the distance spanned by its encoding anti-codon and optional spacer sequence. In certain embodiments, the monomer unit actually comprises two monomers, for example, a dicarbamate, a diurea, or a dipeptide. In yet other embodiments, the monomer unit comprises three or more monomers. Example 9C, for example, discloses the synthesis of PNA based polymers wherein each monomer unit comprises four PNA molecules.
[0197] The monomer units may contain any chemical groups known in the art. Reactive chemical groups especially those that would interfere with polymerization, hybridization, etc., are preferably masked using known protecting groups (Greene et al. (1999) supra). In general, the protecting groups used to mask these reactive groups are orthogonal to those used in protecting the groups used in the polymerization steps. [0198] It has been discovered that, under certain circumstances, the type of chemical reaction may affect the fidelity of the pOlymerization process. For example, distance ' ' independent chemical reactions, (for example, reactions that occur efficiently when the reactive units are spaced apart by intervening bases, for' example, amine acylation reactions) may result in the spurious incoφόration ofthe wrong monomers at a particular position of a polymer chain. In contrast, by choosing chemical reactions for/template mediated syntheses that are distance ' dependent ("for example, reactions that becorrie' inefficient the further the reactive units are ' spaced part via intervening bases, for example, reductive amination reactions), it is possible control the fidelity ofthe polymerization process. Example 9 discusses in detail effect of using. distance dependent chemical reactions to enhance the fidelity ofthe polymerization process during template mediated synthesis.
(iii) Functional Group Transformations ,
[0199] Nucleic acid-templated synthesis can be used to effect functional group transformations that either (i) unmask or (ii) interconvert functionality used in coupling reactions. By exposing or creating a reactive group within a sequence-programmed subset of a library, nucleic acid-templated functional group interconversions permit the generation of library diversity by sequential unmasking. The sequential unmasking approach offers the major advantage of enabling reactants that would normally lack the ability to be linked to a nucleic acid (for example, simple alkyl halides) to contribute to library diversity by reacting with a sequence- specified subset of templates in an intermolecular, non-templated reaction mode. This advantage significantly increases the types of structures that can be generated.
[0200] One embodiment ofthe invention involves deprotection or unmasking of functional groups present in a reactive unit. According to this embodiment, a nucleic acid- template is associated with a reactive unit that contains a protected functional group. A transfer unit, comprising an oligonucleotide complimentary to the template codon region and a reagent capable of removing the protecting group, is annealed to the template, and the reagent reacts with the protecting group, removing it from the reactive unit. To further functionalize the reactive unit, the exposed functional group then is subjected to a reagent not linked to a nucleic acid. In some embodiments, the reactive unit contains two or more protected functional groups. In still other embodiments, the protecting groups are orthogonal protecting groups that are sequentially removed by iterated annealing with reagents linked to transfer units. [0201] Another embodiment ofthe invention involves interconversions of functional groups present on a reactive unit. According fo this embodiment, a transfer unit associated with a reagent that can catalyze a reaction is annealed to a template bearing the reactive unit. A reagent not linked to a nucleic acid is added to the reaction, and the transfer unit reagent catalyzes the reaction between the unlinked reagent and the reactive unit, yielding a newly functionalized reactive unit. In some' embodiments, the, reactive unit contains two or more ' functional groups which are sequentially intefcόnverted'by iterative exposure to different transfer unit-bound teagents. ' ' , • ' ■ .
(iv) Reaction Conditions ' , [0202] Nucleic acid-templated reactions can occur in aqueous or non-aqueous (i. e. , organic) solutions, or a mixture of one or more. aqueous and non-aqueous solutions. In aqueous solutions, reactions can be performed at pH ranges from about 2 to about 12, or preferably from about 2 to about 10, or more preferably from about 4 to about 10. The reactions used in DNA- templated chemistry preferably should not require very basic conditions (e.g., pH > 12,,pH > 10) or very acidic conditions (e.g., pH < 1, pH < 2, pH < 4), because extreme conditions may lead to degradation or modification ofthe nucleic acid template and or molecule (for example, the polymer, or small molecule) being synthesized. The aqueous solution can contain one or more inorganic salts, including, but not limited to, NaCI, Na2SO4, KCl, Mg+2, Mn+2, etc., at various concentrations. [0203] Organic solvents suitable for nucleic acid-templated reactions include, but are not limited to, methylene chloride, chloroform, dimethylformamide, and organic alcohols, including methanol and ethanol. To permit quantitative dissolution of reaction components in organic solvents, quaternized ammonium salts, such as, for example, long chain tetraalkylammonium salts, can be added (Jost et al. (1989) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 17: 2143; Mel'nikov et al (1999) LANGMUIR 15: 1923-1928).
[0204] Nucleic acid-templated reactions may require a catalyst, such as, for example, homogeneous, heterogeneous, phase transfer, and asymmetric catalysis. In other embodiments, a catalyst is not required. The presence of additional, accessory reagents not linked to a nucleic acid are preferred in some embodiments. Useful accessory reagents can include, for example, oxidizing agents (e.g., NaIO ); reducing agents (e.g., NaCNBH3); activating reagents (e.g., EDC, NHS, and sulfo-NHS); transition metals such as nickel (e.g., Ni(NO3)2), rhodium (e.g. RhCl3), ruthenium (e.g. RuCl3), copper (e.g. Cu(NO3)2), cobalt (e.g. CoCl2), iron (e.g. Fe(NO3)3), osmium (e.g. OsO4), titanium (e.g. TiCLi or titanium tetraisopropoxide), palladium (e.g. NaPdCl ), or Ln; transition metal ligands (e.g., phosphines, amines, and halides); Lewis1 acids; and Lewis bases. , [0205] Reaction conditions preferably are optimized to suit the nature ofthe reactive units and oligonucleotides used.
(v) Classes of Chemical Reactions
[0206] Known chemical reactions for synthesizing polymers, small molecules, or other chemical compounds can be used in nucleic acid-templated reactions. Thus, reactions such as those listed in Marc 's Advanced Organic Chemistry, Organic Reactions, Organic Syntheses, organic text books, journals such as Journal ofthe American Chemical Society, Journal of Organic Chemistry, Tetrahedron, etc., and Carruther's Some Modern Methods of Organic Chemistry can be used. The chosen reactions preferably are compatible with nucleic acids such as DNA or RNA or are compatible with the modified nucleic acids used as the template. [0207] Reactions useful in nucleic-acid templated chemistry include, for example, substitution reactions, carbon-carbon bond forming reactions, elimination reactions, acylation reactions, and addition reactions. An illustrative but not exhaustive list of aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions useful in the present invention includes, for example, SN2 reactions, SNI reactions, S>[i reactions, allylic rearrangements, nucleophilic substitution at an aliphatic trigonal carbon, and nucleophilic substation at a vinylic carbon.
[0208] Specific aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with oxygen nucleophiles include, for example, hydrolysis of alkyl halides, hydrolysis of gen-dihalides, hydrolysis of 1,1,1-trihalides, hydrolysis of alkyl esters or inorganic acids, hydrolysis of diazo ketones, hydrolysis of acetal and enol ethers, hydrolysis of epoxides, hydrolysis of acyl halides, hydrolysis of anhydrides, hydrolysis of carboxylic esters, hydrolysis of amides, alkylation with alkyl halides (Williamson Reaction), epoxide formation, alkylation with inorganic esters, alkylation with diazo compounds, dehydration of alcohols, transetherification, alcoholysis of epoxides, alkylation with onium salts, hydroxylation of silanes, alcoholysis of acyl halides, alcoholysis of anhydrides, esterfication of carboxylic acids, alcoholysis of carboxylic esters (transesterfication), alcoholysis of amides, alkylation of carboxylic acid salts, cleavage of ether with acetic anhydride, alkylation of carboxylic acids with diazo compounds, acylation of caroxylic acids with acyl halides; acylation of carboxylic acids with carboxylic acids, formation , of oxoniύm salts, preparation of peroxides/arid hydroperoxides, preparation of inorganic esters (e.g., nitrites, nitrates, sulfonates), preparation of alcohols from amines, and preparation of mixed organic-inorganic anhydrides. , ' [0209] Specific aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with sulfur nucleophiles, which tend to be better nucleophiles than their oxygen' analogs, include, for1 example, attack by SH at an alkyl carbon to form thiols, attack by, S at an alkyl carbon to form thioethers, attack by SH or SR at an acyl carbon, formation of disulfides, fqrmation of Bunte salts, alkylation of, sulfinic acid salts, and formation of alkyl thiocyanates. / , [0210] Aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with nitrogen nucleophiles include, for example, alkylation of amines, N-arylatiόn of amines, replacement of a hydroxy by an amino group, trarisamination, transamidation, alkylation of amines with diazo compounds, amination of epoxides, amination of oxetanes, amination of aziri dines, amination of alkanes, formation of isocyanides, acylation of amines by acyl halides, acylation of amines by anhydrides, acylation of amines by carboxylic acids, acylation of amines by carboxylic esters, acylation of amines by amides, acylation of amines by other acid derivatives, N-alkylation or N-arylation of amides and imides, N-acylation of amides and imides, formation of aziridines from epoxides, formation of nitro compounds, formation of azides, formation of isocyanates and isothiocyanates, and formation of azoxy compounds. [0211] ' Aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with halogen nucleophiles include, for example, attack at an alkyl carbon, halide exchange, formation of alkyl halides from esters of sulfuric and sulfonic acids, formation of alkyl halides from alcohols, formation of alkyl halides from ethers, formation of halohydrins from epoxides, cleavage of carboxylic esters with lithium iodide, conversion of diazo ketones to α-halo ketones, conversion of amines to halides, conversion of tertiary amines to cyanamides (the von Braun reaction), formation of acyl halides from carboxylic acids, and formation of acyl halides from acid derivatives.
[0212] Aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions using hydrogen as a nucleophile include, for example, reduction of alkyl halides, reduction of tosylates, other sulfonates, and similar compounds, hydrogenolysis of alcohols, hydrogenolysis of esters (Barton-McCombie reaction), hydrogenolysis of nitriles, replacement of alkoxyl by hydrogen, reduction of epoxides, reductive cleavage of carboxylic esters, reduction of a C-Ν bond, desulfurization, reduction of acyl halides, reduction of carboxylic acids, esters, and anhydrides to aldehydes, and reduction of amides to aldehydes.
! [0213], Although certain carbon nucleophiles may be too nucleophilic and/or basic to be used in certain embodiments ofthe invention, aliphatic nucleophilic substitution reactions using carbon nucleophiles include, for example, coupling with silanes, coupling of alkyl halides (the
Wurtz reaction), the reaction of alkyl halides and sulfonate esters with Group I (I A) and II (II A) organometallic reagents, reaction of alkyl halides and sulfonate esters with organocuprates, reaction of alkyl halides and sulfonate esters with other organometallic reagentsj allylic and propargylic coupling with a halide substrate, coupling of organometallic reagents with esters of sulfuric and sulfonic acids, sulfoxides, and sulfones, coupling involving alcohols, coupling of organometallic reagents with carboxylic esters, coupling of organometallic reagents with compounds containing an esther linkage, reaction of organometallic reagents with epoxides, reaction of organometallics with aziriduie, alkylation at a carbon bearing an active hydrogen, alkylation of ketones, nitriles, and carboxylic esters, alkylation of carboxylic acid salts, alkylation at a position α to a heteroatom (alkylation of 1 ,3-dithianes), alkylation of dihydro-1 ,3- oxazine (the Meyers synthesis of aldehydes, ketones, and carboxylic acids), alkylation with trialkylboranes, alkylation at an alkynyl carbon, preparation of nitriles, direct conversion of alkyl halides to aldehydes and ketones, conversion of alkyl halides, alcohols, or alkanes to carboxylic acids and their derivatives, the conversion of acyl halides to ketones with organometallic compounds, the conversion of anhydrides, carboxylic esters, or amides to ketones with organometallic compounds, the coupling of acyl halides, acylation at a carbon bearing an active hydrogen, acylation of carboxylic esters by carboxylic esters (the Claisen and Dieckmann condensation), acylation of ketones and nitriles with carboxylic esters, acylation of carboxylic acid salts, preparation of acyl cyanides, and preparation of diazo ketones, ketonic decarboxylation.
[0214] Reactions which involve nucleophilic attack at a sulfonyl sulfur atom may also be used in the present invention and include, for example, hydrolysis of sulfonic acid derivatives (attack by OH), formation of sulfonic esters (attack by OR), formation of sulfonamides (attack by nitrogen), formation of sulfonyl halides (attack by halides), reduction of sulfonyl chlorides (attack by hydrogen), and preparation of sulfones (attack by carbon). [0215] Aromatic electrophilic substitutionjreactions may also be used in nucleotide- templated chemistry., Hydrogen exchange reactions are examples of aromatic electrophilic substitution reactions that use hydrogen as the electrOphile. Aromatic electrophilic substitution , reactions which use nitrogen electrophiles include; for example, nitration and nitro-de- hydrogenation, nitrόsation of nitroso-de-hydrogenation, diazonium coupling/ direct introduction ofthe diazonium group, and amination or arnino-de-hydrogenation. Reactions of this type with sulfur electrophiles include, for example, sulfphation, sulfo-de-hydrogenation, halosulfonation, halosulfo-de-hydrogenation, sulfurization, and sulfonylation. Reactions using halogen , electrophiles include, for example, halogenatip'n, and halo-de-hydrogenation. Aromatic > electrophilic substitution reactions with carbon electrophiles include, for example, Friedel-Crafts alkylation, alkylation, alkyl-de-hydrogenation, Friedel-Crafts arylation (the Scholl reaction), Friedel-Crafts acylation, formylation with disubstituted formamides, formylation with zinc cyanide and HCl (the Gatterman reaction), formylation with chloroform (the Reimer-Tiemanh * reaction), other formylations, formyl-de-hydrogenation, carboxylation with carbonyl halides, carboxylation with carbon dioxide (the Kolbe-Schmitt reaction), amidation with isocyanates, N- alkylcarbamoyl-de-hydrogenation, hydroxyalkylation, hydroxyalkyl-de-hydrogenation, cyclodehydration of aldehydes and ketones, haloalkylation, halo-de-hydrogenation, aminoalkylation, amidoalkylation, dialkylaminoalkylation, dialkylamino-de-hydrogenation, thioalkylation, acylation with nitriles (the Hoesch reaction), cyanation, and cyano-de- hydrogenation. Reactions using oxygen electrophiles include, for example, hydroxylation and hydroxy-de-hydrogenation.
[0216] Rearrangement reactions include, for example, the Fries rearrangement, migration of a nitro group, migration of a nitroso group (the Fischer-Hepp Rearrangement), migration of an arylazo group, migration of a halogen (the Orton rearrangement), migration of an alkyl group, etc. Other reaction on an aromatic ring include the reversal of a Friedel-Crafts alkylation, decarboxylation of aromatic aldehydes, decarboxylation of aromatic acids, the Jacobsen reaction, deoxygenation, desulfonation, hydro-de-sulfonation, dehalogenation, hydro-de-halogenation, and hydrolysis of organometallic compounds.
[0217] Aliphatic electrophilic substitution reactions are also useful. Reactions using the SEI, SE2 (front), SE2 (back), Sεi, addition-elimination, and cyclic mechanisms can be used in the present invention. Reactions of this type with hydrogen as the leaving group include, for example, hydrogen exchange (deuterio-de-hydrogenation, deuteriation), migration, of a double bond, and keto-enol tautomerization. Reactions with halogen electrophiles include, for example, halogenation of aldehydes and ketones, halogenation of carboxylic acids and acyl halides, and halogenation of sulfoxides and sulfones. Reactions with nitrogen electrophiles include, for , example, aliphatic diazonium coupling, nitrosation at a carbon bearing an active hydrogen, direct formation of diazo compounds, conversion of amides to α-azido amides, direct amination at an activated position, and insertion by nitrenes. Reactions with sulfur or selenium electrophiles i include, for example, sulfenylation, sulfonation, and selenylation of ketones and Carboxylic ' . ' ' ' esters. Reactions with carbon electrophiles include, for example, acylation at an aliphatic carbon, conversion of aldehydes to β-ketb esters or ketones, cyanation, cyano-de-hydrogenation, alkylation of alkanes, the Stork enamine reaction, and insertion by carbenes. Reactions with metal electrophiles include, for example, metalation with organometallic compounds, metalation with metals and strong bases, and conversion of enolates to silyl enol ethers. Aliphatic electrophilic substitution reactions with metals as leaving groups include, for example, replacement of metals by hydrogen, reactions between organometallic reagents and oxygen, reactions between organometallic reagents and peroxides, oxidation of trialkylboranes to borates, conversion of Grignard reagents to sulfur compounds, halo-de-metalation, the conversion of organometallic compounds to amines, the conversion of organometallic compounds to ketones, aldehydes, carboxylic esters and amides, cyano-de-metalation, transmetalation with a metal, transmetalation with a metal halide, transmetalation with an organometallic compound, reduction of alkyl halides, metallo-de-halogenation, replacement of a halogen by a metal from an organometallic compound, decarboxylation of aliphatic acids, cleavage of alkoxides, replacement of a carboxyl group by an acyl group, basic cleavage of β-keto esters and β- diketones, haloform reaction, cleavage of non-enolizable ketones, the Haller-Bauer reaction, cleavage of alkanes, decyanation, and hydro-de-cyanation. Elecfrophlic substitution reactions at nitrogen include, for example, diazotization, conversion of hydrazines to azides, N-nitrosation, N-nitroso-de-hydrogenation, conversion of amines to azo compounds, N-halogenation, N-halo- de-hydrogenation, reactions of amines with carbon monoxide, and reactions of amines with carbon dioxide. [0218] Aromatic nucleophilic substitution reactions may also be used in the present invention. Reactions proceeding via the SΝAΓ mechanism, the SΝI mechanism, the benzyne mechanism, the SRΝI mechanism, or other mechanism, for example, can be used. Aromatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with oxygen nucleophiles. include, for example,, hydroxy-de- . halogenation, alkali fusion of sulfonate gaits, and replacement of OR or OAr. Reactions with sulfur nucleophiles include, for example', replacement by'SH or SR. Reactions using nitrogen nucleophiles include, for example, replacement by NH2, NHR, or NR2, and replacement of a , hydroxy group by an amino group: Reactions with halogen nucleophiles include, for example, the introduction halogens. Aromatic nucleophilic substitution reactions with hydrogen as the nucleophile include, for example, reduction of phenols and phenolic esters and ethers, and i reduction of halides and nitro compounds. Reactions with carbon nucleophiles include, for example, the Rosenmund-von Braun reaction, coupling of organometallic compounds with aryl halides, ethers, and carboxylic esters, arylation at a carbon containing an active hydrogen, conversions of aryl substrates to carboxylic acids, their derivatives, aldehydes, and ketones, and the Ullmann reaction. Reactions with hydrogen as the leaving group include, for example, alkylation, arylation, and amination of nitrogen heterocycles. Reactions with N2 + as the leaving group include, for example, hydroxy-de-diazoniation, replacement by sulfur-containing groups, iodo-de-diazoniation, and the Schiemann reaction. Rearrangement reactions include, for example, the von Richter rearrangement, the Sommelet-Hauser rearrangement, rearrangement of aryl hydroxylamines, and the Smiles rearrangement.
[0219] Reactions involving free radicals can also be used, although the free radical reactions used in nucleotide-templated chemistry should be carefully chosen to avoid modification or cleavage ofthe nucleotide template. With that limitation, free radical substitution reactions can be used in the present invention. Particular free radical substitution reactions include, for example, substitution by halogen, halogenation at an alkyl carbon, allylic halogenation, benzylic halogenation, halogenation of aldehydes, hydroxylation at an aliphatic carbon, hydroxylation at an aromatic carbon, oxidation of aldehydes to carboxylic acids, formation of cyclic ethers, formation of hydroperoxides, formation of peroxides, acyloxylation, acyloxy-de-hydrogenation, chlorosulfonation, nitration of alkanes, direct conversion of aldehydes to amides, amidation and amination at an alkyl carbon, simple coupling at a susceptible position, coupling of alkynes, arylation of aromatic compounds by diazonium salts, arylation of activated alkenes by diazonium salts (the Meerwein arylation), arylation and alkylation of alkenes by organopalladium compounds (the Heck reaction), arylation and alkylation of alkenes by vinyltin compounds (the Stille reaction), alkylation and arylation of aromatic compounds by peroxides, photochemical arylation of aromatic compounds, alkylation, acylatiori, and carbalkoxylation of nitrogen heterocycles Particular reactions in which N2 + is the leaving group include, for example, replacement .ofthe diazonium group by hydrogen, replacement ofthe diazonium group by chlorine or bromine, nitro-de-diazόniation, replacement ofthe diazonium group by sulfur-containing groups, aryl' dimerization with diazonium salts, methylatioh of diazonium salts, vinylation of diazonium. salts, arylation of diazonium salts, and conversion of diazonium salts to aldehydes, ketones, or carboxylic acids. Free radical , ' substitution reactions with metals as leaving groups include, for example, coupling of Grignard reagents,' coupling of boranes, and coupling of other organometallic reagents. Reaction with halogen as the leaving group are included. Other free radical substitution reactions with various > leaving groups include, for example, desulfurization with Raney Nickel, conversion of sulfides to organolithrum compounds, decarboxylative dimerization (the Kolbe reaction), the Hunsdiecker reaction, decarboxylative allylation, and decarbonylation of aldehydes and acyl halides. , ' ι ' '
[0220] Reactions involving additions' to carbon-carbon multiple bonds are also used in nucleotide-templated chemistry. Any mechanism may be used in the addition reaction including, for example, electrophilic addition, nucleophilic addition, free radical addition, and cyclic mechanisms. Reactions involving additions to conjugated systems can also be used. Addition to cyclopropane rings can also be utilized. Particular reactions include, for example, isomerization, addition of hydrogen halides, hydration of double bonds, hydration of triple bonds, addition of alcohols, addition of carboxylic acids, addition of H S and thiols, addition of ammonia and amines, addition of amides, addition of hydrazoic acid, hydrogenation of double and triple bonds, other reduction of double and triple bonds, reduction ofthe double and triple bonds of conjugated systems, hydrogenation of aromatic rings, reductive cleavage of cyclopropanes, hydroboration, other hydrometalations, addition of alkanes, addition of alkenes and/or alkynes to alkenes and/or alkynes (e.g., pi-cation cyclization reactions, hydro-alkenyl-addition), ene reactions, the Michael reaction, addition of organometallics to double and triple bonds not conjugated to carbonyls, the addition of two alkyl groups to an alkyne, 1,4-addition of organometallic compounds to activated double bonds, addition of boranes to activated double bonds, addition of tin and mercury hydrides to activated double bonds, acylation of activated double bonds and of triple bonds, addition of alcohols, amines, carboxylic esters, aldehydes, etc., carbonylafion of double and triple bonds, hydrocarboxylation, hydroformylation, addition of aldehydes, addition of HCN, addition of silanes, radical addition, radical cyclization, halogenation of double and triple bonds (addition of halogen,, halogen), halolactonization, halolactamization, addition of hypohalous acids and hypohalites (addition of halogen, oxygen), addition of sulfur compounds (addition of halogen, sulfur), addition of halogen and an amino group (addition of halogen, nitrogen), addition of NOX and NO2X (addition of halogen, nitrogen), addition of XN3 (addition of halogen, nitrogen), addition of alkyl halides (addition of halogen, carbon), addition of acyl halides (addition of halogen, carbon), hydroxylation (addition of oxygen, oxygen) (e.g., asymmetric dihydroxylation reaction with OsO ), dihydroxylation of aromatic rings, epoxidation (addition of oxygen, oxygen) (e.g., Shaφless asymmetric ' , ' ' ' ' ' , epoxidation), photooxidation of dienes (addition of oxygen, oxygen), hydroxysulfenylation (addition of oxygen, sulfur), oxyamination (addition of oxygen, nitrogen), diamination (addition of nitrogen, nitrogen), formation of aziridines (addition of nitrogen), aminosulfeήylation (addition of nitrogen, sulfur), acylacyloxylation and acylamidation (addition of oxygen, carbon or nitrogen, carbon), 1,3-dipolar addition; (addition of oxygen, nitrogen, carbon), Diels- Alder reaction, heteroatom Diels- Alder reaction, all carbon 3 +2 cycloadditions, dimerization of alkenes, the addition of carbenes and carbenoids to double and triple bonds, trimerization and tetramerization of alkynes, and other cycloaddition reactions.
[0221] , In addition to reactions involving additions to carbon-carbon multiple bonds, addition reactions to carbon-hetero multiple bonds can be used in nucleotide-templated chemistry. Exemplary reactions include, for example, the addition of water to aldehydes and ketones (formation of hydrates), hydrolysis of carbon-nitrogen double bond, hydrolysis of aliphatic nitro compounds, hydrolysis of nitriles, addition of alcohols and thiols to aldehydes and ketones, reductive alkylation of alcohols, addition of alcohols to isocyanates, alcoholysis of nitriles, formation of xanthates, addition of H S and thiols to carbonyl compounds, formation of bisulfite addition products, addition of amines to aldehydes and ketones, addition of amides to aldehydes, reductive alkylation of ammonia or amines, the Mannich reaction, the addition of amines to isocyanates, addition of ammonia or amines to nitriles, addition of amines to carbon disulfide and carbon dioxide, addition of hydrazine derivative to carbonyl compounds, formation of oximes, conversion of aldehydes to nitriles, formation of gem-dihalides from aldehydes and ketones, reduction of aldehydes and ketones to alcohols, reduction ofthe carbon-nitrogen double bond, reduction of nitriles to amines, reduction of nitriles to aldehydes, addition of Grignard reagents and organolithium reagents to aldehydes and ketones, addition of other organometallics to aldehydes and ketones, addition of trialkylallylsilanes to aldehydes and ketones, addition of conjugated alkenes to aldehydes (the Baylis-Hillmajn reaction), the Reformatsky reaction, the conversion of carboxylic acid salts to ketones wit orgariometallic compounds, the addition of ' Grignard reagents to 'acid derivatives, the addition of organometallic compounds to CO2 and CS2, addition of organometallic compounds to C=N compounds, addition of carbenes and diazoalkanbs to C=N' compounds, addition of Grignard reagents to nitriles and' isocyanates, the
Aldol reaction, Mukaiyama Aldol and'related reactions, Aldol-type reactions .between carboxylic
1 . ' ' . ' ' . ■ ' i '■ esters or amides and aldehydes or ketones, the Knoevenagel reaction (e.g., the Nef reaction, the
Favorskii' reaction),, the Peterson alkeriylation reaction, the addition of active hydrogen > compounds to Oθ2 and CS2, the Perkin reaction,' Darzens glycidic ester condensation, the ■ Tollens' reaction, the Wittig reaction, the Tebbe alkenylation, the Petasis alkenylation, alternative alkenylations, the Thoφe reaction, the Thoφe-Ziegler reaction, addition of silanes, formation of cyanohydrins, addition of HCN'to'C=N and C=N bonds, the Prins reaction, the benzoin condensation, addition of radicals to C=O, C=S, C=N compounds, the Ritter reaction, ' acylation of aldehydes and ketones, addition of aldehydes to aldehydes, the addition of isocyanates to isocyanates (formation of carbodiimides), the conversion of carboxylic acid salts to nitriles, the formation of epoxides from aldehydes and ketones, the formation of episulfides and episulfones, the formation of β-lactones and oxetanes (e.g., the Paterno-Bϋchi reaction), the formation of β-lactams, etc. Reactions involving addition to isocyanides include the addition of water to isocyanides, the Passerini reaction, the Ug reaction, and the formation of metalated aldimines.
[0222] Elimination reactions, including α, β, and γ eliminations, as well as extrusion reactions, can be performed using nucleotide-templated chemistry, although the strength ofthe reagents and conditions employed should be considered. Preferred elimination reactions include reactions that go by El, E2, ElcB, or E2C mechanisms. Exemplary reactions include, for example, reactions in which hydrogen is removed from one side (e.g., dehydration of alcohols, cleavage of ethers to alkenes, the Chugaev reaction, ester decomposition, cleavage of quarternary ammonium hydroxides, cleavage of quaternary ammonium salts with strong bases, cleavage of amine oxides, pyrolysis of keto-ylids, decomposition of toluene-p-solfonylhydrazones, cleavage of sulfoxides, cleavage of selenoxides, cleavage of sulfornes, dehydrogalogenation of alkyl halides, dehydrohalogenation of acyl halides, dehydrohalogenation of sulfonyl halides, elimination of boranes, conversion of alkenes to alkynes, decarbonylation of acyl halides), reactions in which neither leaving atom is hydrogen (e.g., deoxygenation of vicinal diols, cleavage of cyclic thionocarbonates, conversion of epoxides to episulfides and alkenes, the Ramberg-Backlund reaction, conversion bf aziridines to alkenes, dehalogenation of vicinal dihalides, dehalogenation of α-halo acyl halides, and elimination of a halogen and a hetero group), fragmentation reactions (i.e., reactions in which carbon is the positive leaving group or < the electro fuge, such as, for example, fragmentation of γ-amino and γ-hydroxy halides, ' fragmentation of 1,3-diols, decarboxylation of β-hydrpxy carboxylic acids, decarboxylation of β- lactones, fragmentation of α,β-epoxy hydrazones, elimination of CO from briged bicyelic compounds, and elimination of CO from bridged bicyelic compounds), reactions in which C=N or C=N bonds are formed (e.g., dehydration of aldoximes or similar compounds, conversion of ketoximes to nitriles, dehydration of unsubstituted amides, and conversion of N-alkylformamides
» to isocyanides), reactions in which C=O bonds are formed (e.g., pyrolysis of β-hydroxy alkenes), and reactions in which N=N bonds are formed (e.g., eliminations to give diazoalkenes). Extrusion reactions include, for example, extrusion of N2 from pyrazolines, extrusion of N2 from pyrazoles, extrusion of N2 from triazolines, extrusion of CO, extrusion of CO2, extrusion of SO , the Story synthesis, and alkene synthesis by twofold extrusion.
[0223] Rearrangements, including, for example, nucleophilic rearrangements, electrophilic rearrangements, prototropic rearrangements, and free-radical rearrangements, can also be performed using nucleotide-templated chemistry. Both 1,2 rearrangements and non- 1,2 rearrangements can be performed. Exemplary reactions include, for example, carbon-to-carbon migrations of R, H, and Ar (e.g., Wagner-Meerwein and related reactions, the Pinacol rearrangement, ring expansion reactions, ring contraction reactions, acid-catalyzed rearrangements of aldehydes and ketones, the dienone-phenol rearrangement, the Favorskii rearrangement, the Arndt-Eistert synthesis, homologation of aldehydes, and homologation of ketones), carbon-to-carbon migrations of other groups (e.g., migrations of halogen, hydroxyl, amino, etc.; migration of boron; and the Neber rearrangement), carbon-to-nitrogen migrations of R and Ar (e.g., the Hofmann rearrangement, the Curtius rearrangement, the Lossen rearrangement, the Schmidt reaction, the Beckman rearrangement, the Stieglits rearrangement, and related rearrangements), carbon-to-oxygen migrations of R and Ar (e.g., the Baeyer-Nilliger rearrangement and rearrangment of hydroperoxides), nitrogen-to-carbon, oxygen-to-carbon, and sulfur-to-carbon migration (e.g., the Stevens rearrangement, and the Wittig rearrangement), boron-to-carbon migrations (e.g., conversion of boranes to alcohols (primary or otherwise), conversion of boranes to aldehydes, conversion of hpraries to carboxylic acids, conversion of vinylic boranes to alkenes, formation of alkynes from boranes and acetylides, formation of alkenes from boranes' and acetylides, arid formation of kςtόnes from boranes and acetylides), electrocyclic rearrangements (e.g., of cyclobutenes and,l,3-cyclohexadienes, or conversion of stilbenes to' phenanthreries); sigmatropic rearrangements (e.g., (1 j) sigmatropic migrations of hydrogen, (l,j) s'igmatropic migrations' of carbon, conversion of vinylcyclopropanes to , . cyclopentenes, the Cope rearrangement, the Claisen rearrangement, the Fischer indole synthesis, (2,3) sigmatropic rearrangements, and the benzidine rearrangement), other cyclic rearrangements.
(e.g., metathesis of alkenes, the di-π-methane and, related rearrangements, and the Hofmann- '
' . ' Lόffler and related reactions), and non-cyclic rearrangements (e.g., hydride shifts, the Chapman rearrangement, the Wallach rearrangement, and dyόtropic rearrangements).
[0224] Oxidative and reductive reactions may also be performed using nucleptide- templated chemistry. Exemplary reactions may involve, for example, direct electron transfer, hydride transfer, hydrogen-atom transfer, formation of ester intermediates, displacement mechanisms, or addition-elimination mechanisms. Exemplary oxidations include, for exaniple, eliminations of hydrogen (e.g., aromatization of six-membered rings, dehydrogenations yielding carbon-carbon double bonds, oxidation or dehydrogenation of alcohols to aldehydes and ketones, oxidation of phenols and aromatic amines to quinones, oxidative cleavage of ketones, oxidative cleavage of aldehydes, oxidative cleavage of alcohols, ozonolysis, oxidative cleavage of double bonds and aromatic rings, oxidation of aromatic side chains, oxidative decarboxylation, and bisdecarboxylation), reactions involving replacement of hydrogen by oxygen (e.g., oxidation of methylene to carbonyl, oxidation of methylene to OH, CO2R, or OR, oxidation of arylmethanes, oxidation of ethers to carboxylic esters and related reactions, oxidation of aromatic hydrocarbons to quinones, oxidation of amines or nitro compounds to aldehydes, ketones, or dihalides, oxidation of primary alcohols to carboxylic acids or carboxylic esters, oxidation of alkenes to aldehydes or ketones, oxidation of amines to nitroso compounds and hydroxylamines, oxidation of primary amines, oximes, azides, isocyanates, or notroso compounds, to nitro compounds, oxidation of thiols and other sulfur compounds to sulfonic acids), reactions in which oxygen is added to the subtrate (e.g., oxidation of alkynes to α-diketones, oxidation of tertiary amines to amine oxides, oxidation of thioesters to sulfoxides and sulfones, and oxidation of carboxylic acids to peroxy acids), and oxidative coupling reactions (e.g., coupling involving carbanoins, dimerization of silyl enol ethers or of lithium enolates, and oxidation of thiols to disulfides). [0225] Exemplary reductive reactions include, for example, reactions involving replacement of oxygen by hydrogen' (e.g., reduction of carbonyl to methylene in aldehydes and ' ketones, reduction of carboxylic acids to alcqhols, reduction of amides to amines, reduction of carboxylic esters to ethers, reduction of cyclic anhydrides to lactones and acid derivatives to alcohols, reduction of carboxylic esters to alcohols* reduction of carboxylic acids and esters to alkanes, complete reduction of epoxides, reduction of nitro compounds to aπunes, reduction of nitro compounds to hydroxylamines, reduction pf nitrόso' compounds and hydroxylamines to1 amines, reduction of oximes to primary amines' or aziridines, reduction of azides to primary amines, reduction of nitrogen compounds, and reduction of sulfonyl halides and sulfonic acids to • thiols), removal of oxygen from the substrate (e.g., reduction of amine oxides and azoxy compounds, reduction of sulfoxides and sulfones, reduction of hydroperoxides and peroxides, and reduction of aliphatic nitro compounds to oximes or nitriles), reductions that include
, ' '' . ! , ' l cleavage (e.g., de-alkylation of amines and amides, reduction of azo, azoxy, and hydrazo ' compounds to amines, and reduction of disulfϊdes to thiols), reductive couplic reactions (e.g., bimolecular reduction of aldehydes and ketones to 1 ,2-diols, bimolecular reduction of aldehydes or ketones to alkenes, acyloin ester condensation, reduction of nitro to azoxy compounds, and reduction of nitro to azo compounds), and, reductions in which an organic substrate is both oxidized and reduced (e.g., the Cannizzaro reaction, the Tishchenko reaction, the Pummerer rearrangement, and the Willgerodt reaction). (vi) Stereoselectivity
[0226] The chiral nature of nucleic acids raises the possibility that nucleic acid-templated synthesis can proceed stereoselectively without the assistance of chiral groups beyond those present in the nucleic acid, thereby transferring not only sequence but also stereochemical information from the template to the product. Previous studies have demonstrated that the chirality of nucleic acid templates can induce a preference for the template-directed ligation of (D)-nucleotides over (L)-nucleotides (Kozlov et al. (2000) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 39: 4292- 4295; Bolli et al. (1997) A. CHEM. BIOL.4: 309-320).
[0227] During nucleic acid-templated synthesis it is possible to transfer the chirality of a nucleic acid template transfer unit, catalyst or a combination ofthe foregoing to reaction products that do not resemble the nucleic acid backbone. In some embodiments, the reactive unit with a chiral center is associated with the template and the reactive unit associated with the transfer unit is achiral, while in other embodiments, the transfer unit's reactive unit is chiral and the template's reactive unit is achiral. Alternatively, both reactive units can possess chiral
'' ' I • . centers. In each of these cases, the chirality ofthe template directs which ofthe chiral reactive unit's stereoisomers reacts preferentially (i.e., with a higher rate constant) with the other reactive unit. ,
[0228] Useful template architectures include the H type, E. type, Ω type and T type architecture. One or more template or transfer unit nucleotides may be replaced with non- nucleotide, linkers, however, replacement ofthe nucleotides nearest the reactive units may result in loss of stereoselectivity. Preferably, 5 or more consecutive aromatic nucleotides are adjacent to the reactive units, and more preferably 6 or more consecutive aromatic nucleotides are adjacent to the reactive units.
[0229] At high salt concentrations, double-stranded DNA sequences rich in (5-Me-C)G repeats can adopt a left-handed helix (Z-form) rather than the usual right-handed helix (B-form). During DNA-templated synthesis, template-transfer unit complexes in the Z-form cause preferential reaction with one stereoisomer of a reactive unit, while template-transfer unit complexes in the B-form cause preferential reaction with the other stereoisomer of a reactive unit. Therefore, in some embodiments, a high concentration (e.g., at least 2.5 M, or at least 5 M) of a salt, such as, for example, sodium chloride (NaCI) or sodium sulfate (Na2SO4) is used during DNA-templated synthesis. In other embodiments, the concentration of salt is low (e.g., not greater than 100 mM) or is not present at all. The principles of DNA-templated stereospecific reactions are discussed in more detail in Example 6.
(vii) Otherwise Incompatible Reactions
[0230] It has been discovered that during nucleic acid-templated synthesis, oligonucleotides can simultaneously direct several different types of synthetic reactions within the same solution, even though the reactants involved would be cross-reactive and therefore incompatible under traditional synthesis conditions (see, Example 7). As a result, nucleic acid- templated synthesis permits one-pot diversification of synthetic library precursors into products of multiple reaction types.
[0231] In one embodiment, one or more templates associated with a single reactive unit are exposed to two or more transfer units, each associated with a different reagent that is capable of reacting with the templates reactive unit. In other embodiments, one or more transfer units associated with a single reagent are exposed to two or more templates, each associated with a different reactive unit that is capable of reacting, with the reagent. Under the conditions of nucleic acid-templated synthesis, it is' possible to have in a single solution multiple reactive units, (attached to the template and or the transfer units) that in normal synthetic reactions would cross react with' one another. The nucleic acid-templated chemistries described herein use very low concentrations'of reactants, that because of concentration effects do not reacj: with one another: It is only when the reactants are brought together via annealing ofthe oligonucleotide in the ' transfer unit to the template that their local concentrations are increased to permit a reaction occur. In some embodiments, a single accessory reagent (i.e., a reagent not linked, to a nucleic > acid or nucleic acid analbg), such as, for example, a reducing agent, an oxidizing agent, or an activating agent, is added to the reaction. In other embodiments, no accessory reagent is added.
In all cases, only the reactive units and reagents that are associated with complimentary oligonucleotides (i.e., that contain complimentary codon/anti-codon sequences) react to form a1 reaction product, demonstrating the ability of nucleic acid-templated synthesis to direct the selective one-pot transformation of a single functional group into multiple distinct type's of products.
[0232] In another embodiment, templates and transfer units are provided as described above, but the template reactive units and transfer unit reagents react with one another using multiple different reaction types. In some embodiments, multiple different accessory reagents are added to the reaction. Again, only reaction products resulting from complimentary template/transfer unit sequences are formed in appreciable amounts.
[0233] In certain embodiments, multiple transfer unit reagents are capable of reacting with each template reactive unit, and some ofthe transfer unit reagents can cross-react with one another. Even in the presence of several different cross-reactive functional groups, only reaction products resulting from complimentary template/transfer unit sequences are formed in appreciable amounts. These findings indicate that reactions of significantly different rates requiring a variety of accessory reagents can be directed by nucleic acid-templated synthesis in the same solution, even when both templates and reagents contain several different cross-reactive functional groups. The ability of nucleic acid templates to direct multiple reactions at concentrations that exclude non-templated reactions from proceeding at appreciable rates mimics, in a single solution, a spatially separated set of reactions. (viii) Identification of New Chemical Reactions
[0234] In another aspect ofthe iηyention, as, illustrated in Figure 12, nucleic acid- ■ . ■ templatpd synthesis can be used to discover previously unknown chemical reactions between two or more reactive units. To facilitate reaction discovery, multiple templates are synthesized, each comprising a different reactive unit coupled to a different oligonucleotide. Each template oligonucleotide contains a coding region, wliich identifies the reactive unit attached to the template, and an annealing region. In some embodiments, other sequences are included in the template pligonucleotide, including, for example, PCR primer sites. Multiple transfer units are also prepared, each comprising a different reagent coupled to a different oligonucleotide. [0235] To test for new bond-forming reactions, one or more templates are combined with one or more transfer units under conditions that allow for hybridization ofthe transfer units to the templates. In some embodiments, non-DNA linked accessory molecules are added to the reaction, such as, for example, an activating agent or a catalyst. In other embodiments, reaction conditions, including, for example, reaction duration, temperature, solvent, and pH, are varied to select reactions that proceed at different rates and under different conditions.
[0236] The crude reaction mixture then is selected for particular reaction products. The reaction products preferably still are associated with their respective templates whose nucleotide sequence encodes the bond forming reactions that produced the reaction products. In some embodiments, the transfer unit is coupled to a capturable molecule, such as, for example, biotin. Following creation and selection ofthe reaction products the associated templates can be selected by capturing the biotin by streptavidin. In one embodiment, the streptavidin is immobilized to a solid support, for example, by linkage to a magnetic bead. The selected templates then are amplified by PCR and subjected to DNA sequencing to determine the identities ofthe reactive unit and the reagent. In another embodiment, the reactions revealed by the above approach are characterized in a non-DNA-templated format in both aqueous and organic solvents using traditional reaction analysis methods including, for example, thin-layer chromatography, NMR, HPLC, and mass spectroscopy.
[0237] It is theoretically possible that some ofthe reactions discovered will require some aspect ofthe DNA template to proceed efficiently. However, the vast majority, if not all, ofthe reactions discovered in this system will take place in the absence of DNA template when performed at typical non-DNA-templated synthesis concentrations (e.g., about 0.1 M). Reactions discovered in this manner also are naturally well-suited for DNA-templated small molecule library synthesis. An illustrative example of this embodiment appears in Example 12, describing the, discovery of a new palladium-mediated coupling' reaction between a terminal alkyne and a simple alkene. ' (ix) Preparing Product Libraries '
[0238] A major practical difference, between traditional and nucleic acid-templated library synthesis is the scale of each manipulation. Due to the amounts of material needed for ' screening and compound identification, traditional, combinatorial syntheses typically proceed on the nmol-μmpl scale per library member. , In contrast, nucleic acid-templated library synthesis can take place on the frnol-pmol scale because only mmute quantities (e.g., about 10" mol) of each nucleic acid-linked synthetic molecule are needed for selection and PCR amplification. This vast difference in scale, combined with the: single-solution format ofthe nucleic acid- templated libraries, simplifies significantly the preparation of materials required for nucleic acid- templated library syntheses. [0239] Libraries can be produced via the template mediated syntheses described herein.
For example, the template may comprise one or rriore reactive units (for example, scaffold molecules). However, in each case the template contains a coding sequence that identifies the particular reactive unit associated with the oligonucleotide. A library of templates is initially subjected to one or more nucleic acid-templated bond formation reactions using reagents attached to decoding oligonucleotides through a linker as described above. Depending upon the circumstances, the template library can be subjected to multiple iterations of bond formation reactions, wherein each intermediate product is purified before the subsequent round of reactions. In other circumstances, the intermediate products are not purified between reaction iterations. Preferably less than 20 bond forming reactions are required to create a library. In other embodiments, less than 10 bond forming reaction steps are needed, and more preferably, between 3 and 7 steps are needed to create a full library.
[0240] After the final round of nucleic acid-templated bond formation reactions has been performed accessory reagents can be added to protect exposed reactive functional groups on the reaction product, if necessary. In some embodiments, accessory reagents are added to initiate a subsequent reaction with the reaction product, such as, for example, a cyclization reaction. The resulting library of reaction products attached to template oligonucleotides then are purified and/or selected as discussed herein. As would be appreciated by one skilled in this art, libraries of small molecules or polymers can be synthesized using the principles discussed herein.
[0241] , Using similar approaches, it is possible to create a library of non-natural polymers from a library of template oligonucleotides that are not initially associated with a reactive unit. ' In this casej the template encodes two or more codons which when annealed to corresponding anti-codons attached to monomer units bring together the monomer units in a sequence specific manner. The transfer units then are allowed to contact the template under conditions that permit hybridization ofthe anti-codons on eachtransfer unit to the complementary codon on the template. Polymerization ofthe monomer units along the template then produces the polymer. The polymerization may be step-by-step or may be essentially simultaneous with the chain being formed in one large reaction with one reaction between adjacent monomers leading to the attachment ofthe next monomer. In some embodiments, the functional group or groups of each monomer are protected, and must be deprotected prior to polymerization. The newly synthesized polymer can then be cleaved from the anti-codons and the template, and selected for a. desired activity or characteristic, as described herein. DNA-templated polymer synthesis reactions are described in more detail in Example 9A and 9C.
IV. SELECTION AND SCREENING
[0242] Selection and/or screening for reaction products with desired activities (such as catalytic activity, binding affinity, or a particular effect in an activity assay) may be performed according to any standard protocol. For example, affinity selections may be performed according to the principles used in library-based selection methods such as phage display, polysome display, and mRNA-fusion protein displayed peptides. Selection for catalytic activity may be performed by affinity selections on transition-state analog affinity columns (Baca et al. (1997) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 94(19): 10063-8) or by function-based selection schemes (Pedersen et al. (1998) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 95(18): 10523-8). Since minute quantities of DNA (~10"20 mol) can be amplified by PCR (Kramer et al. (1999) CURRENT PROTOCOLS IN MOLECULAR BIOLOGY (ed. Ausubel, F. M.) 15.1-15.3, Wiley), these selections can be conducted on a scale ten or more orders of magnitude less than that required for reaction analysis by current methods, making a truly broad search both economical and efficient. (i) Selection for Binding to Target Molecule
1 ( ' . '
[0243] The templates and reaction products can be selected (or screened) for binding to a target molecule. In this context, selection or partitioning means any process whereby a library member bound to a target molecule is separated from library members not bound to target molecules. ' Selection can be accomplished by various methods known in the art. .
, [0244] The templates ofthe present invention contain a built-in function for direct selection and amplification. In most applications, binding to a target molecule preferably is ' selective, such that the template and the resulting reaction product bind preferentially with a specific target molecule, perhaps preventing or inducing a specific biological effect. Ultimately, a binding molecule identified using the present invention may be useful as a therapeutic and/or diagnostic agent. Once the selection is complete, the selected templates optionally can be amplified and sequenced. The selected reaction products, if present in sufficient quantity, can be separated from the templates, purified (e.g., by HPLC, column chromatography, or other chromatographic method), and further characterized. (ii) Target Molecules
[0245] , Binding assays provide a rapid means for isolating and identifying reaction products that bind to, for example, a surface (such as metal, plastic, composite, glass, ceramics, rubber, skin, or tissue); a polymer; a catalyst; or a target biomolecule such as a nucleic acid, a protein (including enzymes, receptors, antibodies, and glycoproteins), a signal molecule (such as cAMP, inositol triphosphate, peptides, or prostaglandins), a carbohydrate, or a lipid. Binding assays can be advantageously combined with activity assays for the effect of a reaction product on a function of a target molecule.
[0246] The selection strategy can be carried out to allow selection against almost any target. Importantly, the selection strategy does not require any detailed structural information about the target molecule or about the molecules in the libraries. The entire process is driven by the binding affinity involved in the specific recognition and binding ofthe molecules in the library to a given target. Examples of various selection procedures are described below.
[0247] The libraries ofthe present invention can contain molecules that could potentially bind to any known or unknown target. The binding region of a target molecule could include a catalytic site of an enzyme, a binding pocket on a receptor (for example, a G-protein coupled receptor), a protein surface area involved in a protean-protein or protein-nucleic acid interaction (preferably a hot-spot region), or a specific site, on DNA/ (such as the major groove). The natural function of the target' could be stimulated (agonized), reduced (antagonized), unaffected, or completely changed by the binding ofthe reaction product. This will depend on the precise binding mode and the particular binding site the reaction product occupies on the target,
[0248] Functional sites (such as protein-protein interaction or catalytic sites) on proteins, often are more prone to bind molecules than are, other more neutral surface areas on a protein. In addition, these functional sites normally contain a smaller region that seems, to be primarily , responsible for the binding energy: the so-called ''hot-spot regions" (Wells, et al. (1993) RECENT PROG. HORMONE RES,. 48: 253- 262). This phenomenon facilitates selection for molecules affecting the biological function of a certain target,
[0249] The linkage between the template! molequle and reaction product allows rapid , identification of binding molecules using various selection strategies. This invention broadly permits identifying binding molecules for any known target molecule. In addition, novel unknown targets can be discovered by isolating binding molecules against unknown antigens (epitopes) and using these binding molecules for identification and validation. In another preferred embodiment, the target molecule is designed to mimic a transition state of a chemical reaction; one or more reaction products resulting from the selection may stabilize the transition state and catalyze the chemical reaction. (iii) Binding Assays
[0250] The template-directed synthesis of the invention permits selection procedures analogous to other display methods such as phage display (Smith (1985) SCIENCE 228: 1315- 1317). Phage display selection has been used successfully on peptides (Wells et al. (1992) CURR. OP. STRUCT. BIOL.2: 597-604), proteins (Marks etal. (1992) J. BIOL. CHEM. 267: 16007- 16010) and antibodies (Winter et al. (1994) ANNU. REV. IMMUNOL. 12: 433-455). Similar selection procedures also are exploited for other types of display systems such as ribosome display Mattheakis et al. (1994) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. 91: 9022-9026) and mRNA display (Roberts, et al (1997) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. 94:12297-302). The libraries ofthe present invention, however, allow direct selection of target-specific molecules without requiring traditional ribosome-mediated translation. The present invention also allows the display of small molecules which have not previously been synthesized directly from a nucleic acid template. ι
[0251] Selection of binding molecules from a library can be performed in any format to identify optimal binding molecules. Binding selections typically involve immobilizing the desired target molecule, adding a library of potential binders, and removing non-binders by washing. When the molecules showing low affinity for an immobilized target are washed away, the molecules with a stronger affinity generally remain attached to the target. The enriched population remaining bound to the target after stringent washing is preferably eluted with, for example, acid, chaotropic salts, heat, competitive elution with a known ligand or by proteolytic
. release ofthe target and or of template molecules. The eluted templates are suitable for PCR, leading to many orders of amplification, whereby essentially each selected template becomes available at a greatly increased copy number for cloning, sequencing, and/or further enrichment or diversification.
[0252] In a binding assay, when the concentration of ligand is much less than that ofthe target (as it would be during the selection of a DNA-templated library), the fraction of ligand bound to target is determined by the effective concentration ofthe target protein (see, Figure 10). The fraction of ligand bound to target is a sigmoidal function ofthe concentration of target, with the midpoint (50% bound) at [target] = Ki ofthe ligand-target complex. This relationship indicates that the stringency of a specific selection — the minimum ligand affinity required to remain bound to the target during the selection — is determined by the target concentration. Therefore, selection stringency is controllable by varying the effective concentration of target. [0253] The target molecule (peptide, protein, DNA or other antigen) can be immobilized on a solid support, for example, a container wall, a wall of a microtiter plate well. The library preferably is dissolved in aqueous binding buffer in one pot and equilibrated in the presence of immobilized target molecule. Non-binders are washed away with buffer. Those molecules that may be binding to the target molecule through their attached DNA templates rather than through their synthetic moieties can be eliminated by washing the bound library with unfunctionalized templates lacking PCR primer binding sites. Remaining bound library members then can be eluted, for example, by denaturation.
[0254] Alternatively, the target molecule can be immobilized on beads, particularly if there is doubt that the target molecule will adsorb sufficiently to a container wall, as may be the case for an unfolded target eluted from an SDS-PAGE gel. The derivatized beads can then be used to separate high-affinity library members from nonbinders by simply sedimenting the beads in a benchtop centrifuge. Alternatively, the beads can be used to make an affimty column. In such cases, the library is passed through'the column one or more times to permit binding. The column then is washed to remove nonbinding library members. Magnetic beads are essentially a variant on the above; the target is attached to magnetic beads which are then used in the selection. ' > ι
[0255] There are many reactive matrices available for immobilizing the target molecule, including matrices bearing -NH2 groups or -SH groups. The target molecule can be immobilized by conjugation with NHS ester or maleimide groups pvalently linked to Sepharose beads and the integrity of known properties ofthe target molecule can be verified. Activated beads are available with attachment sites for -NH2 or -COOH groups (which can be used for coupling). Alternatively, the target molecule is blotted onto nitrocellulose or PVDF. When using a blotting strategy, the blot should be blocked (e.g., with BSA or similar protein) after immobilization of the target to prevent nonspecific binding of library members to the blot.
[0256] Library members that bind a target molecule can be released by denaturation, acid, or chaotropic salts. Alternatively, elution conditions can be more specific to reduce ' background or to select for a desired specificity. Elution can be accomplished using proteolysis to cleave a linker between the target molecule and the immobilizing surface or between the reaction product and the template. Also, elution can be accomplished by competition with a known competitive ligand for the target molecule. Alternatively, a PCR reaction can be performed directly in the presence ofthe washed target molecules at the end ofthe selection procedure. Thus, the binding molecules need not be elutable from the target to be selectable since only the template is needed for further amplification or cloning, not the reaction product itself. Indeed, some target molecules bind the most avid ligands so tightly that elution would be difficult. [0257] To select for a molecule that binds a protein expressible on a cell surface, such as an ion channel or a transmembrane receptor, the cells themselves can be used as the selection agent. The library preferably is first exposed to cells not expressing the target molecule on their surfaces to remove library members that bind specifically or non specifically to other cell surface epitopes. Alternatively, cells lacking the target molecule are present in large excess in the selection process and separable (by fluorescence-activated cell sorting (FACS), for example) from cells bearing the target molecule. In either method, cells bearing the target molecule then are used to isolate library members bearing the target molecule (e.g., by sedimenting the cells or by FA.CS sorting). For example, a recombinant DNA encoding the target molecule can be introduced into a cell line; library members that bind the transformed cells but not the untransformed cells are enriched for target molecule binders. This approach is also called . subtraction, selection and has successfully been used for phage display on antibody libraries (Hoogenboom et α/. (1998) IMMUNOTECH 4:T- 20). , '
[0258] A selection procedure can also involve selection for binding to cell surface reςeptόrs that are internalized so that the, receptor together with the selected binding molecule passes into the cytoplasm, nucleus, or other cellular compartment, such as the Golgi or lysosomes. Depending on the dissociation rate constant for specific selected binding molecules, these molecules may localize primarily within the intracellular compartments. Internalized library members can be distinguished from molecules attached to the cell surface by washing the cells, preferably with a denaturant. More preferably, standard subcellular fractionation techniques are used to isolate the selected library members in a desired subcellular compartment. [0259] An alternative selection protocol also includes a known, weak ligand affixed to each member ofthe library. The known ligand guides the selection by interacting with a defined part ofthe target molecule and focuses the selection on molecules that bind to the same region, providing a cooperative effect. This can be particularly useful for increasing the affinity of a ligand with a desired biological function but with too low a potency. [0260] Other methods for selection or partitioning are also available for use with the present invention. These include, for example: immunoprecipitation (direct or indirect) where the target molecule is captured together with library members; mobility shift assays in agarose or polyacrylamide gels, where the selected library members migrate with the target molecule in a gel; cesium chloride gradient centrifugation to isolate the target molecule with library members; mass specfroscopy to identify target molecules labeled with library members. In general, any method where the library member/ target molecule complex can be separated from library members not bound to the target is useful.
[0261] The selection process is well suited for optimizations, where the selection steps are made in series, starting with the selection of binding molecules and ending with an optimized binding molecule. The procedures in each step can be automated using various robotic systems. Thus, the invention permits supplying a suitable library and target molecule to a fully automatic system which finally generates an optimized binding molecule. Under ideal conditions, this process should run without any requirement/ or external'work outside the robotic system during the entire procedure. '' , ' , ' .
[0262] , The selection methods ofthe present invention can be combined with secondary selection or screening to identify reaction products capable of modifying target moleculb function upon binding.. Thus, the methods .described herein can be employe to isolate or produce binding molecules that bind to and modify the function of any protein or nucleic acid. ,
For example, nucleic acid-templated chemistry can he used to identify, isolate, or produce , binding molecules (1) affecting catalytic activity of target enzymes by inhibiting catalysis or , modifying substrate binding; (2) affecting the functionality of protein receptors, by inhibiting binding to receptors or by modifying the specificity of binding to receptors; (3) affecting the formation of protein multimers by disrupting the quaternary structure of protein subunits; or (4)
' ' ' , ' 1 modifying transport properties of a protein by disrupting transport of small molecules or ions.
[0263] Functional assays can be included in the selection process. For example, ,after selecting for binding activity, selected library members can be directly tested for a desired > functional effect, such as an effect on cell signaling. This can, for example, be performed via FACS methodologies. .
[0264] The binding molecules ofthe invention can be selected for other properties in addition to binding. For example, to select for stability of binding interactions in a desired working environment. If stability in the presence of a certain protease is desired, that protease can be part ofthe buffer medium used during selection. Similarly, the selection can be performed in serum or cell extracts or in any type of medium, aqueous or organic. Conditions that disrupt or degrade the template should however be avoided to allow subsequent amplification. (iv) Other Selections
[0265] Selections for other desired properties, such as catalytic or other functional activities, can also be performed. Generally, the selection should be designed such that library members with the desired activity are isolatable on that basis from other library members. For example, library members can be screened for the ability to fold or otherwise significantly change conformation in the presence of a target molecule, such as a metal ion, or under particular pH or salinity conditions. The folded library members can be isolated by performing non-deriaturing gel electrophoresis under the conditions of interest. The folded library members , migrate to a different position in the gel and can subsequently be extracted from the gel and ι , ' ' ' ' isolated. . , ' ■ '' . , ' . ' '
[0266] , Similarly, reaction products that fluoresce in the presence of specific ligands may be selected by FACS based sorting of translated polymers linked through their DNA templates to beads. Those beads that fluoresce in the presence,, but not in the absence, ofthe target ligand are isolated and characterized. Useful beads with a homogenous population of nucleic acid- templates on any bead can be prepared using.the split-pool synthesis technique on the bead, such that each bead is exposed to only a single nucleotide sequence. Alternatively, a different aritir template (each complementary to only a single^ different template) can by synthesized on beads using a split-pool technique, and then can anneal to capture a solution-phase library.
[0267] Biotin-terminated biopolymers can be splected for the actual catalysis of bond- , breaking reactions by passing these biopolymers over a resin linked through a substrate to avidin (Figure 11A). Those biopolymers that catalyze substrate cleavage self-elute from a colμmn charged with this resin. Similarly, biotin-terminated biopolymers can be selected for the ' catalysis of bond-forming reactions (see, Figure 11B). One substrate is linked to resin and the second substrate is linked to avidin. Biopolymers that catalyze bond formation between the substrates are selected by their ability to react the' substrates together, resulting in attachment of the biopolymer to the resin. [0268] , Library members can also be selected for their catalytic effects on synthesis of a polymer to which the template is or becomes attached. For example, the library member may influence the selection of monomer units to be polymerized as well as how the polymerization reaction takes place (e.g., stereochemistry, tacticity, activity). The synthesized polymers can be selected for specific properties, such as, molecular weight, density, hydrophobicity, tacticity, stereoselectivity, using standard techniques, such as, electrophoresis, gel filtration, centrifugal sedimentation, or partitioning into solvents of different hydrophobicities. The attached template that directed the synthesis ofthe polymer can then be identified.
[0269] Library members that catalyze virtually any reaction causing bond formation between two substrate molecules or resulting in bond breakage into two product molecules can be selected using the schemes proposed in Figures 12 and 13. To select for bond forming catalysts (for example, hetero Diels- Alder, Heck coupling, aldol reaction, or olefin metathesis catalysts), library members are covalently linked to one substrate through their 5' amino or thiol termini. The other substrate ofthe reaction is synthesized as a derivative linked to biotin. When dilute solutions of library-substrate conjugate are combined with the substrate-biotin conjugate, those library members that catalyze bond formation cause the biotin group to become covalently attached to themselves. Active bond forming catalysts can then be separated from inactive library members by capturing the former with immobilized streptavidin and washing away inactive library members (Figure 12).
[0270] , In an analogous manner, library members that catalyze bond cleavage reactions such as retro-aldol reactions, amide hydrolysis, elimination reactions, or olefin dihydroxylation followed by periodate cleavage can be selected. In this case, library members are covalently linked to biotinylated substrates such that the bond breakage reaction causes the disconnection of the biotin moiety from the library members (Figure 13). Upon incubation under reaction conditions, active catalysts, but not inactive library members, induce the loss of their biotin groups. Streptavidin-linked beads can then be used to capture inactive polymers, while active catalysts are able to be eluted from the beads. Related bond formation and bond cleavage selections have been used successfully in catalytic RNA and DNA evolution (Jaschke et al. (2000) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 4: 257-62) Although these selections do not explicitly select for multiple turnover catalysis, RNAs and DNAs selected in this manner have in general proven to be multiple turnover catalysts when separated from their substrate moieties (Jaschke et al. (2000) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 4: 257-62; Jaeger et a (1999) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 96: 14712-7; Bartel et al. (1993) SCIENCE 261: 1411-8; Sen et al (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 680-7).
[0271] In addition to simply evolving active catalysts, the in vitro selections described above are used to evolve non-natural polymer libraries in powerful directions difficult to achieve using other catalyst discovery approaches. Substrate specificity among catalysts can be selected by selecting for active catalysts in the presence ofthe desired substrate and then selecting for inactive catalysts in the presence of one or more undesired substrates. If the desired and undesired substrates differ by their configuration at one or more stereocenters, enantioselective or diastereoselective catalysts can emerge from rounds of selection. Similarly, metal selectivity can be evolved by selecting for active catalysts in the presence of desired metals and selecting for inactive catalysts in the presence of undesired metals. Conversely, catalysts with broad substrate tolerance can be evolved by varying subsfrate structures between successive rounds of selection. . '' , ' '
(v) Iterative Selection ' ' '
[0272] , Iterating a selection by loading eluant from a first selection into a second selection multiplies the net enrichment. No intervening amplification of template is required. For example, a selection for binding to carbonic a ιnhydras 'e be * ads permitted a 330- fold enricnmen It of a ligand. .Application ofthe eluant directly to fresh carbonic anhydrase beads (see, Example 11) enriched the template encoding the carbonic anhydrase ligand >10,000-fold. Where the selection was repeated a third time, a 5, 000,000- fold net enrichment1 of the ligand was observed. This ' result indicates that iterating library selections can lead to very large enrichments of desired molecules. In certain embodiments, a first rpund of selection provides at least a 50-fold increase in the number of binding ligands. Preferably, the increase in enrichments is over 100-fold, more preferably over 1,000 fold, and even more preferably over 100,000-fold. Subsequent rounds of selection may further increase the enrichment 100-fold over the original library, preferably 1 ,000-fold, more preferably over 100,000-fold, and most preferably over 1 ,000,000-fold. .
[0273] Alternatively, following PCR amplification of DNA templates encoding selected synthetic molecules, additional rounds of translation, selection, and amplification can be conducted to enrich the library for high affimty binders. The stringency ofthe selection is gradually increased by increasing the salt concentration ofthe binding and washing buffers, decreasing the duration of binding, elevating the binding and washing temperatures, and increasing the concentration of washing additives such as template DNA or unrelated proteins.
[0274] Importantly, in vitro selections can also select for specificity in addition to binding affinity. Library screening methods for binding specificity typically require duplicating the entire screen for each target or non-target of interest. In contrast, selections for specificity can be performed in a single experiment by selecting for target binding as well as for the inability to bind one or more non-targets. Thus, the library can be pre-depleted by removing library members that bind to a non-target. Alternatively, or in addition, selection for binding to the target molecule can be performed in the presence of an excess of one or more non-targets, as described in Example 11. To maximize specificity, the non-target can be a homologous molecule. If the target molecule is a protein, appropriate non-target proteins include, for example, a generally promiscuous protein such as an albumin. If the binding assay is designed to target only a specific portion of a target molecule, the non-target can be a variation on the molecule in which that portion has been changed or removed.
(vi) Amplification and Sequencing
[0275] Once all rounds of selection are complete, the templates which are, or formerly were, associated with the selected reaction product preferably are amplified using any suitable technique to facilitate sequencing or other subsequent manipulation ofthe templates. Natural oligonucleotides can be amplified by any state ofthe art method. These methods include, for example, polymerase chain reaction (PCR); nucleic acid sequence-based amplification (see, for example, Compton (1991) NATURE 350: 91-92), amplified anti-sense RNA (see, for example, van Gelder et al. (1988) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 85: 77652-77656); self-sustained sequence replication systems (Gnatelli et al. (1990) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 87: 1874- 1878); polymerase-independent amplification (see, for example, Schmidt et al. (1997) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 25: 4797-4802, and in vivo amplification of plasmids carrying cloned DNA fragments. Descriptions of PCR methods are found, for example, in Saiki et al (1985) SCIENCE 230: 1350-1354; Scharf et al. (1986) SCIENCE 233: 1076-1078; and in U.S. Patent No. 4,683,202. Ligase-mediated amplification methods such as Ligase Chain Reaction (LCR) may also be used. In general, any means allowing faithful, efficient amplification of selected nucleic acid sequences can be employed in the method ofthe present invention. It is preferable, although not necessary, that the proportionate representations ofthe sequences after amplification reflect the relative proportions of sequences in the mixture before amplification.
[0276] For non-natural nucleotides the choices of efficient amplification procedures are fewer. As non-natural nucleotides can be incoφorated by certain enzymes including polymerases it will be possible to perform manual polymerase chain reaction by adding the polymerase during each extension cycle. [0277] For oligonucleotides containing nucleotide analogs, fewer methods for amplification exist. One may use non-enzyme mediated amplification schemes (Schmidt et al. (1997) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 25: 4797-4802). For backbone-modified oligonucleotides such as PNA and LNA, this amplification method may be used. Alternatively, standard PCR can be used to amplify a DNA from a PNA or LNA oligonucleotide template. Before or during amplification the templates or complementing templates may be mutagenized or recombined in order to create an evolved library for the next round of selection or screening. (vii) Sequence Determination . |
[0278] Sequencing can be done by a, standard dideoxy chain termination method, or by chemical sequencing, for example, using the Maxam-Gilbert sequencing procedure. '
Alternatively,, the sequence ofthe template (or, if a long template is used, the variable portion(s) thereof) can be determined by hybridization to a chip (see, Example 12). For example, a single- stranded template mqlecule associated with a detectable moiety such as a fluorescent moiety is exposed to a chip bearing a large number of^clpnal popμlations of single-stranded nucleic acids, or nucleic acid analogs of known sequence^ each clpnal population being present at a particular addressable location on the chip. The template sequences are permitted to anneal to the' chip, sequences. The position ofthe detectable moieties on the chip then is determined. Based upon the location ofthe detectable moiety and the immobilized sequence at that location, the sequence ofthe template can be determined. It is contemplated that large numbers of such
' ' ' 1 ' oligonucleotides can be immobilized in an array on a chip or other solid support.,
(viii) Diversification [0279] Inventive libraries can be evolved by introducing mutations at the DNA level, for example, using error-prone PCR (Cadwell et al. (1992) PCR METHODS APPL. 2: 28) or by subjecting the DNA to in vitro homologous recombination (Stemmer (1994) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 91: 10747; Stemmer (1994) NATURE 370: 389).
[0280] Small molecule evolution using mutation and recombination offers two potential advantages over simple enrichment. If the total diversity ofthe library is much less than the number of molecules made (typically 1012 to 1015), every possible library member is present at the start ofthe selection. In this case, diversification is still useful because selection conditions can change as rounds of evolution progress. For example, later rounds of selection can be conducted under higher stringencies and can involve counterselections against binding to non- target molecules. Diversification gives library members that have been discarded during earlier rounds of selection the chance to reappear in later rounds under altered selection conditions in which their fitness relative to other members may be greater. In addition, it is quite possible to generate a synthetic library that has a theoretical diversity greater than 1015 molecules. In this case, diversification allows molecules that never existed in the original library to emerge in later rounds of selections on the basis of their similarity to selected molecules, similar to the way in which protein evolution searches the vastness of protein sequence space one small subset at a time.
(viii)(a) Error-prone PCR
[0281] Random point mutagenesis is performed by conducting the PCR amplification step under enor-prone PCR (Cadwell et al (1992) PCR METHODS APPLIC. 2: 28.-33) conditions. Because the genetic code of these molecules are written to assign related codons to related chemical groups, similar to the way that the natural protein genetic code is constructed, random point mutations in the templates encoding selected molecules will diversify progeny towards chemically related analogs. Because error-prone PCR is inherently less efficient than normal PCR, error-prone PCR diversification is preferably conducted with only natural, dATP, dTTP, dCTP, and dGTP and using primers that lack chemical handles or biotin groups.
(viii)(b) Recombination \
[0282] Libraries may be diversified using recombination. For example, templates to be recombined may have the structure shown in Figure 14, in which codons are separated by five- base non-palindromic restriction endonuclease cleavage sites such as those cleaved by AvaTT (G/GWCC, W=A or T), Sau96\ (G/GNCC, N=A, G, T, or C), Ddel (C/TNAG), or HrnFI (G/ANTC). Following selections, templates encoding desired molecules are enzymatically digested with these commercially available restriction enzymes. The digested fragments then are recombined into intact templates with T4 DNA ligase. Because the restriction sites separating codons are nonpalindromic, template fragments can only reassemble to form intact recombined templates (Figure 14). DNA-templated translation of recombined templates provides recombined small molecules. In this way, functional groups between synthetic small molecules with desired activities are recombined in a manner analogous to the recombination of amino acid residues between proteins in Nature. It is well appreciated that recombination explores the sequence space of a molecule much more efficiently than point mutagenesis alone (MinshuU et al. (1999) CURR. OPIN. CΗEM. BIOL. 3: 284-90; Bogarad et al. (1999) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 96: 2591-5; Stemmer NATURE 370: 389-391).
[0283] A prefened method of diversifying library members is through nonhomologous random recombination, as described, for example, in WO 02/074978; US Patent Application Publication No. 2003-0027180-Al ; and Bittker et al. (2002) NATURE BIOTECH. 20(10): 1024-9. (iiiv)(c) Random Cassette Mutagenesis
[0284] Random cassette mutagenesis is useful to create a diversified library from a fixed starting sequence. Thus, such a method can be used, for example, after a library has been subjected to selection and one or more library members have been isolated and sequenced. , Generally,, a library of oligonucleotides with variations on the starting sequence is generated by traditional chemical synthesis, enor-prone PCR, or other methods. For example, a library of oligonucleotides can be generated in which, for each nucleotide position in a codon, tfre
1 nucleotide has a 90% probability of being identical fo the starting sequence at that position, and a
10% probability of being different. The oligonucleotides can be complete templates when synthesized, or can be fragments that are subsequently ligated with other oligonucleotides to form a diverse library of templates.
V. USES
[0285] The methods and compositions of the present invention represent new ways to generate molecules with desired properties. This approach marries extremely powerful genetic methods, which molecular biologists have taken advantage of for decades, with the flexibility and power of organic chemistry. The ability to prepare, amplify, and evolve unnatural polymers by genetic selection may lead to new classes of catalysts that possess activity, bioavailability, stability, fluorescence, photolability, or other properties that are difficult or impossible to achieve using the limited set of building blocks found in proteins and nucleic acids. Similarly, developing new systems for preparing, amplifying, and evolving small molecules by iterated cycles of mutation and selection may lead to the isolation of novel ligands or drugs with properties superior to those isolated by slower traditional drug discovery methods.
[0286] For example, unnatural biopolymers useful as artificial receptors to selectively bind molecules or as catalysts for chemical reactions can be isolated. Characterization of these molecules would provide important insight into the ability of polycarbamates, polyureas, polyesters, polycarbonates, polypeptides with unnatural side chain and stereochemistries, or other unnatural polymers to form secondary or tertiary structures with binding or catalytic properties.
[0287] The present invention further allows the discovery of new chemical reactions. The field of chemistry is continually being transformed by the discovery of new chemical reactions providing access to previously inaccessible molecules, allowing for expedited syntheses, and revealing new chemical principles: Guided by predictions of reactivity based on literature precedent, chemists typically search for a new reaction to overcome a particular' shortcoming in cunent synthetic methodology. Until now, it has not been feasible to conduct a broad, nόn-biased search for chemical reactivity iri which a large number of diverse reactants are simultaneously evaluated for their ability to react with one another under many different t conditions. Both1, the amount of material required for executing thousands of diverse reactions and the difficulty of analyzing the outcome of such an experiment makes this goal intractable > using cunent reaction discovery approaches. A broad, non-biased search for chemical reactivity is appealing because it is not limited by conventional wisdom or by our ability to predict , functional group reactivity:
[0288] The inventive method of discovering new chemical reactions and chemical reactivity has several advantages over existing me,thods. For example, several groups have developed high-throughput screens to test the efficiency of a particular reaction under a variety of conditions (Kuntz et al. (1999) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 3: 313-319; Francis et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 422-428; Pawlas et al (2002) J. AM. CHEM. Soc 124: 3669-3679; Lober et al. (2001) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 123: 4366-4367; Evans et al. (2002) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 6: 333-338; Taylor et al (1998) SCIENCE 280: 267-270; and Stambuli et al. (2001) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 123: 2677-2678); however, the screens are limited to a small set of reaction types. Reactions have been analyzed in a high-throughput manner using fluorescence specfroscopy, colorimetric assay, thermographic analysis, and traditional chromatography (Dahmen et al.
(2001) SYNTHESIS-STUTTGART 1431-1449 and Wennemers (2001) COMBINATORIAL CHEMISTRY & HIGH THROUGHPUT SCREENING 4: 273-285). Most high-throughput screens for chemical reactivity are useful for only a small set of reaction types because the screen depends on a particular property ofthe reaction such as the disappearance of an amine or the production of protons. As a result, high throughput screening methods can be useful for discovering catalysts for a known or anticipated reason, but are poorly suited to discover novel reactivity different from a reaction of interest. A non-biased search for chemical reactions would examine a broad range of both reaction conditions and reactants in a highly efficient manner that is practical on the scale of thousands of different reactions. The inventive method of discovering chemical reactions offers a much greater chance of discovering unexpected and unprecedented reactivity that may lead to new insights into reactivity and to useful new reactions for chemical synthesis. [02,89] Discovering new reactions from very large and diverse collections of reactants and conditions entails (1) a general assay for reactivity that does not depend on a particular substrate or product, and (2) increasing the overall efficiency of assaying reactions such'that both reaction condition space and reactant space can be searched extensively. For example, researchers evolving catalytic nucleic acids routinely select for bond formation catalysts by attaching one reactant to the pool of evolving nucleic acids and linking another reactant to a handle that can be easily immobilized such as biotin (Wilson et al. (1999) ANNU.'REV. BIOCHEM. , 68: 611-647; Jaschke (2001) CURR. OPIN. STRUCT. BIOL. 11: 321-326; Jaschke et al. (2000) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 4: 257-262; Jaschke (2001) BIOL. CHEM. 382: 1321-1325). Active nucleic acids become linked to the handle and are separated from the inactive sequences.
Because this type of selection does not depend on the consumption or generation of a specific substrate or product, the scope of reactants that can be tested in this type of selection is much larger than the scope of reactants that can be evaluated in cunent reactivity screens.
[0290] Nucleic acid-templated synthesis provides a way to use bond formation selections to discover new chemical reactivity independent of nucleic acid catalysis (Gartner et al. (2002) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 41: 1796-1800; Gartner et al. (2001) supra). Nucleic acid templates can direct a wide variety of chemical reactions in a highly sequence-specific manner without any obvious requirements for reaction geometry. By attaching reactants to appropriately designed nucleic acid sequences, it becomes possible to test thousands of unprecedented reactions in a single pot with individual sequences encoding each reaction. Pools of nucleic acid-linked reactants would be truly selected (not simply screened) for covalent bond formation with members of a second nucleic acid-linked reactant pool. PCR amplification and DNA sequencing would reveal which combinations of reactants successfully undergo bond formation.
[0291] In certain embodiments, the searchable reactions are those transformations that can occur in aqueous or substantially aqueous medium. In other embodiments, the searchable reactions are limited to those that do not degrade nucleic acids rapidly. The known chemical robustness of DNA suggests that a wide range of reaction conditions spanning different temperatures, pH ranges, and additives such as transition metals are compatible with the proposed approach. A DNA-templated Heck reaction demonstrates that transition metal catalyzed reactions are viable in a DNA-templated format, consistent with extensive evidence (Patolsky et al. (2002) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 124: 770-772; Weizman et al. (2002) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 124: 1568-1569; Gartner et al. (2002) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 41: 1796-1800; Czlapinski et al. (2001) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 123: 8618-8619; Holmlin et al. (1998) J. AM. CHEM. Soc! 120: 9724-9725; Basnkiri1 etal. (1994) J. AM. CHEM. So ' 116: 5981-5982; Magda et al. (1994) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 116; 7439-7440; and Dandliker et al. (1997) SCIENCE 275: 1465-1468) that DNA is compatible with many transition metal complexes, including those containing Pd, Ni, Mn, Pt, Ru, Os^ Cu, Eu, and Rh. Further, the1 rapid increase in the number of known water- ' compatible organic reactions (Li et al. Organic 'reaction' in aqueous media (Wiley and Sons,1 New York, 1997) and the inherent benefits of working m aqueous solvents suggests that, water is a rich medium for discovering new reactions. Reactions discovered in this effort may be of * general utility1 when performed in a standard non-nucleic acid-templated mode, and are also natural candidates for use in generating nucleic acid-templated synthetic libraries. ι '
[0292] Nucleic acid-templated chemistry is combined with in vitro selection and PCR amplification in certain embodiments to efficiently search for novel bond-forming reactions independent of reactant structures. The ability to select directly for covalent bond formation, the minute scale required for analysis, and compatibility of nucleic acids with a wide variety of reaction conditions may permit the first search for unprecedented reactivity that can examine thousands of combinations of reactants and reaction conditions in one or several experiments.
[0293] The reaction generality and distance independence of DNA-templated synthesis allows for a system for discovering new chemical reactions by selection. DNA-linked reactants (i.e., templates and/or transfer units) suitable for in vitro selection for bond formation exist in one or two forms designated pool A and pool B in Figure 9. Each reactant in pool B contains a functional group being tested linked to a short segment of biotinylated DNA (a coding region) encoding that functional group. Each reactant in pool A contains a functional group being tested, a conesponding coding region, and an "annealing region" or anti-codon that complements one of the pool B coding regions. Each functional group in pool A is linked to one of every possible annealing region. This arrangement allows any functional group in pool A to join any functional group in pool B on the same DNA duplex, providing the opportunity for DNA-templated bond formation if the reactants are mutually reactive. Generating these two pools of DNA-linked reactants in a format suitable for in vitro selection for bond formation requires the development of methods to efficiently assemble a small molecule reactant, a coding region, and in the case of pool A, a library of annealing regions. [0294] The inventive system is particularly useful for the identification of s all- molecule/target binding pairs. For instance, inventive DNA-templated small molecule libraries may be contacted with other solution or solid-phase libraries of potential target compounds such that small molecules within the inventive library that bind or interact with one or more compounds in the target libraries are identified. Preferably, bound pairs may be identified by selection (e.g., by tagging one ofthe components, combined with PCR to identify the other). In certain particularly prefened embodiments of this aspect ofthe invention, the target library or ' libraries comprise polypeptides and/or proteins. , ,
[0295] As described herein, the present invention also provides new modes of nucleic acid-templated synthesis, including simultaneous incompatible reactions and one pot multi-step ordered synthesis (e.g., incubating three DNA-linked amino acids and one template so that only a single tripeptide, of specified sequence, is produced). The invention also provides nucleic acid- templated synthesis in organic solvents (e.g., methylene chloride, dimethylformamide).
[0296] Yet another application ofthe inventive system is to identify and/or eVolve new templates for nucleic acid-templated synthesis. For instance, the present invention allows identification of nucleic acid templates that, when contacted with reagents that are sufficient to participate in a reaction to generate a selectable product, most efficiently lead to production of that product.
[0297] The invention also provides information useful to inform the development of chemical reaction pathways. For instance, according to the present invention, a researcher can select from within a library of nucleic acid-templated substrates those that permit a complex chemical reaction to take place (e.g., macrocyclization, which can be selected for by, for example, loss of a biotin leaving group). When successful reaction conditions have been identified, the inventive system allows ready identification of participating components. Thus, new chemistries can be developed without prior knowledge ofthe reagents and/or pathways likely to be useful in the reaction.
VI. KITS
[0298] The present invention also provides kits and compositions for use in the inventive methods. The kits may contain any item or composition useful in practicing the present invention. The kits may include, but are not limited to, templates, (e.g., end-of-helix, haiφin, omega, and T architectures), anticodons, transfer units, monomer units, building blocks, reactants, small molecule scaffolds, buffers, solvents, enzymes (e.g., heat stable polymerase, reverse transcriptase, ligase, restriction endonuclease, exonuclease, Klenow fragment, ' polymerase, alkaline' phosphatase, polynucleotide kinase), linkers, protectirig groups,, polynucleotides, nucleosides, nucleotides, salts, acids, bases, solid supports, or any combinations thereof. ' . ' ' ' .. ' , ■ ■ • '. •
[0299] ' A kit for preparing unnatural polymers should contain items needed to prepare , unnatural polymers using the methods described herein. Such a kit may include templates,, anti-, codons, transfer units, monomers units, or combinations thereof. A kit for synthesizing small molecules may include templates, anti-codons, transfer units, building blocks, small molecule, scaffolds, or combinations thereof.
' ' . '
[0300] The inventive kit can also be, .equipped with items needed to amplify and/or evolve a polynucleotide template such as a heat stable polymerase for PCR, nucleotides, buffer, and primers. In certain other embodiments, the inventive kit includes items commonly used in performing DNA shuffling such as polynucleotides, ligase, and nucleotides. [0301] in addition to the templates and transfer units described herein, the present ' invention also includes compositions comprising complex small molecules, scaffolds, or unnatural polymer prepared by any one or more ofthe methods ofthe invention as described ι herein.
[0302] A kit for identifying new chemical reactions or functionality may include template associated with reactive units (reactants), transfer units associated with reactive units (reactants), reagents, acids, bases, catalysts, solvents, biotin, avidin, avidin beads, etc. The kit can also include reagents for generating the template associated with a reactive group (e.g., biotin, polynucleotides, reactive units, Klenow fragment of DNA pol I, nucleotides, avidin beads, etc.). The kit can also include reagents for PCR (e.g., buffers, heat stable polymerase, nucleotides, primers, etc.).
[0303] The following examples contain important additional information, exemplification and guidance that can be adapted to the practice of this invention in its various embodiments and equivalents thereof. EXAltøPtES ' ' '
[0304] Examples 1 and 2 describe the preparation of materials for use in nucleic acid- templated synthesis and describe specific synthetic reactions. Example 3 discusses multi-step
Figure imgf000102_0001
describes the synthesis of exemplary compounds and libraries. Example 10 describes the use of polymerases to translate DNA into nonnafural polymers. Example 11 describes in vitro selection protocols. Example 12 describes the application of DNA-ten plated synthesis toward the discovery of new chemical reactions. ,
Example 1: The Generality of DNA-Templated Synthesis [0305] Nucleic acid-templated synthesis is extremely versatile and permits the synthesis of a variety of chemical compounds. This Example demonstrates that it is possible to perform DNA-templated synthesis using two different DNA template architectures.
[0306] As shown in Figure 15, templates with a haiφin (H) or end-of-helix (E) architecture bearing electrophilic maleimide groups were prepared to test their reactivity with a transfer unit comprising, a complementary DNA oligonucleotide associated with a thiol reagent. Both the H and E templates reacted efficiently with one equivalent ofthe DNA-linked thiol reagent to yield the thioether product in minutes at 25 °C. DNA-templated reaction rates (kapp = ~105 M-'s"1) were similar for H and E architectures despite significant differences in the relative orientation of their reactive groups. In contrast, no product was observed when using reagents containing sequence mismatches, or when using templates pre-quenched with excess β- mercaptoethanol (see Figure 15). Thus, both DNA templates support a sequence-specific DNA- templated reaction even though the structures ofthe resulting products differ markedly from the structure ofthe natural DNA backbone. Little or no non-templated intermolecular reaction products were observed under the reaction conditions (pH 7.5, 25 °C, 250 mM NaCI, 60 nM template transfer unit), demonstrating the specificity ofthe DNA-templated reaction. [0307] Indeed, sequence-specific DNA-templated reactions spanning a variety of reaction types (SN2 substitutions, additioris to α,β-unsaturated carbonyl systems, and additions to vinyl sulfones), nucleophiles (thiols and amines), and reactant structures all proceeded with good yields and excellent sequence selectivity (see, Figure 16). ■ Matched (M) or mismatched (X) reagents linked to thiols (S) or primary amines (N) were mixed with 1 equivalent of template functionalized with the variety of electrophiles shown in Figure 16. Reactions with thiol reagents were conducted at pH 7.5 under the following conditions: SLAB and SBAP: 37°C, 16 hours; SIA: 25°C, 16 hours, SMCC, GMBS, BMPS, SVSB: 25°C, 10 minutes. .Reactions with amine reagents were conducted at 25°C, pH 8.5 for 75 minutes. Expected product masses were verified by mass spectrometry. In each case, matched but not mismatched reagents afforded ι product efficiently despite considerable variations in their transition state geometry, steric hindrance, and conformational flexibility. Collectively these findings indicate that nucleic acid- templated synthesis is a general phenomenon capable of supporting a range of reaction types, and is not limited to the creation of structures resembling nucleic acid backbones. [0308] Sequence discrimination is important for the faithful translation of a nucleic acid into a synthetic reaction product. To test the sequence discrimination of DNA-templated synthesis, haiφin templates linked to an iodoacetamide group were reacted to thiol-bearing transfer units containing 0, 1, or 3 mismatches. At 25°C, the initial rate of reaction ofthe thiol- bearing transfer unit with no mismatches was 200-fold faster than that of transfer units bearing a single mismatch (kapp = 2.4 xlO4 M"V vs. 1.1 x 102 M'V1; Figure 17A).
[0309] In addition, small amounts of products arising from the annealing of mismatched reagents could be eliminated by elevating the reaction temperature beyond the melting temperature Tm ofthe mismatched reagents (Figure 17B). In Figure 17B, the reactions in Figure 17B were repeated at the indicated temperatures for 16 hours. The calculated reagent Tm values were found to be 38°C (matched) and 28°C (single mismatch). The inverse relationship between product formation and temperature indicates that product formation proceeds by a DNA-templated mechanism rather than by a simple intermolecular mechanism.
[0310] In addition to reaction generality and sequence specificity, DNA-templated synthesis, under certain circumstances, also demonstrates remarkable distance independence. Both H and E templates linked to maleimide or α-iodoacetamide groups promoted sequence- specific reaction with matched, but not mismatched, thiol reagents annealed anywhere on the templates examined thus far (up to 30 bases away from the reactive group on the template). Reactants annealed one base away reacted With similar ates as those annealed 2, 3, 4, 6,' 8, 10, ' 15, 20, or 30 bases away (Figure, 18). 'The reaction illustrated in Figure 18 used a 41-base E template and a 10-base reagent designed to anneal 1-30 bases from the 5' end ofthe template. The kinetic profiles of Figure 18 show the average of two trials (deviations < 10%). Tl e "n = 1 mis" reagent contained three mismatches. In all cases, templated reaction rates were several ' hundred-fold higher than the rate of uhtemplated (misriiatched) reaction (kapp = 104-105 M^s"1' vs.
5 x 10 M s" ). At .intervening distances of 30 bases, products were efficiently formed , presumably through transition states resembling'200-membered rings. , < [0311 ] In order to further characterize the basis of the distance independence of DNA- templated synthesis, a series of modified E templates were first synthesized in which the intervening bases were replaced by a series of DNA arialogs designed to evaluate the possible contribution of (/) interbase interactions, (ii) conformational preferences of the DNA backbone, (iii) the charged phosphate backbone, and (iv) backbone hydrophilicity. Templates in which the intervening bases were replaced with any ofthe analogs in Figure 19 showed little effect on the rates of product formation.
[0312] In the experiment shown in Figure 19, the n = 10 reaction in Figure 18 was repeated using templates in which the nine bases following the 5'-NH2-dT were replaced with the backbone analogues shown. Five equivalents of a DNA oligonucleotide complementary to the intervening bases were added to the "DNA + clamp" reaction. Reagents were either completely matched (0) or contained three mismatches (3). The gel shows reactions after 25 minutes at 25°C. Figure 19 shows that the backbone structural elements specific to DNA are not responsible for the observed distance independence of DNA-templated synthesis. However, the addition of a 10-base DNA oligonucleotide "clamp" complementary to the single-stranded intervening region significantly reduced product formation (Figure 19), suggesting that the flexibility of this region is critical to efficient DNA-templated synthesis.
[0313] The distance independent reaction rates may be explained if the bond-forming events in a DNA-templated format are sufficiently accelerated relative to their nontemplated counteφarts such that DNA annealing, rather than bond formation, is rate-determining. If DNA annealing is at least partially rate limiting, then the rate of product formation should decrease as the concentration of reagents is lowered because annealing, unlike templated bond formation, is a bimolecular process. Figure 20 shows the results of experiments in which the n —. , n = 10, and n = 1 mismatched (mis) reactions described in Figure 18 were repeated with template and reagent concentrations of 12.5, 25, 62.5 or 125 nM. Figure 20 shows that decreasing thd concentration of reactants in the case ofthe E template with one or ten intervening bases between reactive groups resulted in a marked decrease in the observed reaction rate. This observation suggests that proximity effects in DNA-templated synthesis can enhance bond formation rates to the point that DNA annealing becomes rate-determining. . ' , [0314] , These findings raise the possibility o using DNA-templated synthesis to translate in one pot libraries of DNA into solution-phase libraries of synthetic molecules suitable for PCR amplification and selection. The sequence specificity described above suggests that mixtures of reagents may be able to react predictably with complementary mixtures of templates. Finally, the observed distance independence suggests that different template codons can be used to encode different reactions without impairing reactions rates.
[0315] As a demonstration of this approach, a library of 1,025 maleimide-linked templates was synthesized, each with a different DNA sequence in an eight-base encoding region (Figures 21A-21B). One of these sequences, 5'-TGACGGGT-3', was arbitrarily chosen to code for the attachment of a biotin group to the template. A library of thiol reagents linked to 1,025 different oligonucleotides was also generated. The reagent linked to 3'-ACTGCCCA-5' , contained a biotin group, while the other 1,024 reagents (transfer units) contained no biotin. Equimolar ratios of all 1,025 templates and 1,025 reagents were mixed in one pot for 10 minutes at 25°C and the resulting products were selected in vitro for binding to streptavidin. Molecules surviving the selection were amplified by PCR and analyzed by restriction digestion and DNA sequencing.
[0316] Digestion with the restriction endonuclease 7jsp45I, which cleaves GTGAC and therefore cuts the biotin encoding template but none ofthe other templates, revealed a 1 : 1 ratio of biotin encoding to non-biotin encoding templates following selection. In the experiments shown in Figure 22A, lanes 1 and 5 represent the PCR-amplified library before streptavidin binding selection; lanes 2 and 6 represent the PCR-amplified library after selection; lanes 3 and 7 represent the PCR amplified authentic biotin-encoding template; and lane 4 represents a 20 bp ladder. Lanes 5-7 were digested with TspA5l. DNA sequencing traces ofthe amplified templates before and after selection are also shown, together with the sequences ofthe non- biotin-encoding and biotin-encoding templates. The results summarized in Figure 22A represent a 1, 000-fold enrichment compared with the unselected library. DNA sequencing ofthe PCR amplified pool before and after selection suggested a similar degree of enrichment and indicated that the biotin-encoding template is the major product after selection and amplification (Figure 22A). The ability of DNA-templated synthesis to support the simultaneous sequence- specific reaction of 1,025 reagents, each of which faces a 1,024:1 ratio of non-partner to, partner templates, demonstrates its potential as a method to create synthetic libraries in one pot. '
[0317] Taken together, these results show that it,is possible to translate, select, arid , amplify a synthetic library member having a specific property (for example, bind aVidin) as , shown in Figure 22B. Furthermore, these results indicate that nucleic acid-templated synthesis is a suφrisingly general phenomenon capable of directing, rather than simply encoding, a range of chemical reactions to form products unrelated jn structure to nucleioacid backbones. For several reactions examined, the DNA-templated format accelerates the rate of bond f 'ormation ' ' beyond the rate of a 10-base DNA oligonucleotide annealing to its complement, resulting in suφrising distance independence. The facile nature of long-distance DNA-templated reactions may also arise in part from the tendency of water to contract the volume of nonpolar reactants (see, C.-J. Li et al. Organic Reactions in Aqueous Media, Wiley and Sons: New York, 1997) and from possible compactness ofthe intervening single-stranded DNA between reactive groups.
Materials and Methods [0318] DNA Synthesis. DNA oligonucleotides were synthesized on a PerSeptive
Biosystems Expedite 8909 DNA synthesizer using standard protocols and purified by reverse phase HPLC. Oligonucleotides were quantitated spectrophotometrically and by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis (PAGE) followed by staining with ethidium bromide or SYBR Green (Molecular Probes) and quantitation using a Stratagene Eagle Eye II densitometer. Phosphoramidites enabling the synthesis of 5'-NH2-dT, 5' tetrachlorofluorescein, abasic backbone spacer, C3 backbone spacer, 9-bond polyethylene glycol spacer, 12-bond saturated hydrocarbon spacer, and 5' biotin groups were purchased from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA. Thiol-linked oligonucleotide reagents were synthesized on C3 disulfide controlled pore glass from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA. [0319] Template Functionalization. Templates bearing 5'-NH2-dT groups were transformed into a variety of electrophilic functional groups by reaction with the appropriate electrophile-N-hydroxysuccmimide (ΝHS) ester (Pierce, Rockford, IL, USA). Reactions were . performed in 200 mM sodium phosphate' pH 7.2 with 2 mg/mL electrophile-ΝHS ester, 10% dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO), and up to 100 μg of 5'-aminό template at 25 °C for 1 hours.1 Desired products were purified by reverse-phase HPLC and characterized by gel electrophoresis and . MALDI mass spectrometry.
[0320] DΝA-tempIated synthesis reactions. Reactions were initiated by mixing equimolar quantities of reagent (transfer unit) and template in buffer containing 50 mM N-[3- mpφholinopropane] sulfonic acid (MOPS) pH 7.5 and 250 mM ΝaCl at the desired temperature (25 °C unless stated otherwise). Concentrations of reagents and templates were 60 nM unless otherwise indicated. At various time points, aliquots were removed, quenched with excess β- mercaptoethanol, and analyzed by denaturing PAGE. Reaction products were quantitated by densitometry using their intrinsic fluorescence or by staining followed by densitometry. Representative products were also verified by MALDI mass spectrometry.
[0321] In Vitro Selection for Avidin Binding. Products ofthe library translation reaction (Figure 21A-21B) were isolated by ethanol precipitation and dissolved in binding buffer (10 mM Tris pH 8, 1 M ΝaCl, 10 mM ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid (EDTA)). Products were incubated with 30 μg of streptavidin-linked magnetic beads (Roche Biosciences) for 10 minute at room temperature in 100 μL total volume. The beads were washed 16 times with binding buffer and eluted by treatment with 1 μmol free biotin in 100 uL binding buffer at 70 °C for 10 minutes. The eluted molecules were isolated by ethanol precipitation and amplified by standard PCR protocols (2 mM MgCl2, 55 °C annealing, 20 cycles) using the primers 5 - TGGTGCGGAGCCGCCG [SEQ ID NO: 35] and 5'-
CCACTGTCCGTGGCGCGACCCCGGCTCC TCGGCTCGG [SEQ ID NO: 36]. Automated DNA sequencing used the primer 5'-CCACTGTCCGTGGCGCGACCC [SEQ ID NO: 37]. [0322] DNA Sequences. Sequences not provided in the Figures are as follows: matched reagent in Figure 16 SIAB and SBAP reactions: 5'-CCCGAGTCGAAGTCGTACC-SH [SEQ ID NO: 38]; mismatched reagent in Figure 16 SLAB and SBAP reactions: 5'- GGGCTCAGCTTCCCCATAA-SH [SEQ ID NO: 39]; mismatched reagents for other reactions in Figures 16, and 17A-17B; 5'-FAAATCTTCCC-SH (F= tetrachlorofluorescein) [SEQ JO NO: 40]; reagents in Figure 16 containing one mismatch: 5'-FAATTCTTACC-SH [SEQ JJ3 NO: 41]; E templates in Figures 15 and 16 SMCC, GMBS, BMPS, and SVSB reactions, and Figures 17A-17B: 5'-(NH2dT)-
CGCGAGCGTACGCTCGCGATGGTACGAATTCGACTCGGGAATAC CACCTTCGACTCGAGG [SEQ ID NO: 42]; H template in Figure 16 SLAB, SBAP, and SLA reactions: 5'-(NH2dT)- CGCGAGCGTACGCTCGCGATGGTACGAATTC [SEQ LD NO: 43]; clamp oligonucleotide in Figure 19: 5'-ATTCGTACCA [SEQ LD NO: 44].
Example 2: Exemplary Reactions for Use in DNA-Templated Synthesis
[0323] This Example demonstrates that DNA-templated synthesis can direct a modest collection of chemical reactions without requiring the precise alignment of reactive groups into DNA-like conformations. Furthermore, this Example also demonstrates that it is possible to ι simultaneously translate in one-pot a library of more than 1,000 templates into the conesponding thioether products, one of which could be enriched by in vitro selection for binding to streptavidin and amplification by PCR.
[0324] As described in detail herein, a variety of chemical reactions for example, DNA- templated organometallic couplings and carbon-carbon bond forming reactions other than pyrimidine photodimerization can be utilized to construct small molecules. These reactions represent an important step towards the in vitro evolution of non-natural synthetic molecules by permitting the DNA-templated construction of a diverse set of structures.
[0325] The ability of DNA-templated synthesis to direct reactions that require a non-
DNA-linked activator, catalyst or other reagent in addition to the principal reactants has also been demonstrated herein. To test the ability of DNA-templated synthesis to mediate such reactions without requiring structural mimicry ofthe DNA-templated backbone, DNA-templated reductive animations between an amine-linked template (1) and benzaldehyde- or glyoxal-linked reagents (3) with millimolar concentrations of sodium cyanoborohydride (NaBH3CN) at room temperature in aqueous solutions can be performed (see, Figure 23 A). Significantly, products formed efficiently when the template and reagent sequences were complementary, while control reactions in which the sequence ofthe reagent did not complement that ofthe template, or in which NaBH3CN was omitted, yielded no significant product (see Figures 23A-23D and 24). Although DNA-templated reductive animations to generate products closely mimicking the structure of double-stranded DNA have been previously reported (see, for example, Li et al. f2002) j. AM. CHEM. SOC. 124: 746 and Gat et al. (1998) BIOPOLYMERS 48: 19), these results demonstrate that reductive amination to generate structures unrelated to the phosphoribose backbone can take place efficiently and' sequence-specifically.
[0326] Referring to Figures 25A-25B, DNA-templated amide borid formations between amine-linked templates 4 and 5 and carboxylate-linked reagents 6-9 mediated by l-(3- dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide (EDC) and N-hydroxylsulfosuccinimide (sulfo- NHS) generated amide products in good yields at pH 6.0, 25°C. Product formatiori was (i) sequence-specific, (ii) dependent on thβipresence of EDC, and (iii) insensitive to the steric, encumbrance ofthe amine or carboxylate. Efficient DNA-templated amide formation Was also mediated by the water-stable activator 4-(4,6-dimethoxy-l,3,5-trizin-2-yl)-4- ' , ' methylmoφholinium chloride (DMT-MM) instead of EDC and sulfo-NHS (Figures 24 and
25A-25B)/ The efficiency and generality of DNA-templated amide bond formation under these conditions, together with, the large number of commercially available chiral amines and carboxylic acids, make this reaction an attractive candidate in future DNA-templated syntheses of structurally diverse small molecule libraries. ,. [0327] Carbon-carbon bond forming reactions are also important in both chemical and biological syntheses and thus several such reactions can be utilized in a nucleic acid-templated format. Both the reaction of nitroalkane-linked reagent (10) with aldehyde-linked template (11) (nitro-aldol or Henry reaction) and the conjugate addition of 10 to maleimide-linked template (12) (nitro-Michael addition) proceeded efficiently and with high sequence specificity at pH 7.5- 8.5, 25°C (Figures 23A and 24). In addition, the sequence-specific DNA-templated Wittig reaction between stabilized phosphorus ylide reagent 13 and aldehyde-linked templates 14 or 11 provided the conesponding olefin products in excellent yields at pH 6.0-8.0, 25°C (Figures 23B and 24). Similarly, the DNA templated 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition between nitrone-linked reagents 15 and 1 and olefin-linked templates 12, 17 or 18 also afforded products sequence specifically at pH 7.5, 25°C (Figures 23B, 23C arid 24).
[0328] In addition to the reactions described above, organometallic coupling reactions can also be utilized in the present invention. For example, DNA-templated Heck reactions were performed in the presence of water-soluble Pd precatalysts. In the presence of 170 mM Na^dCLt, aryl iodide-linked reagent 19 and a variety of olefin-linked templates including maleimide 12, acrylamide 17, vinyl sulfone 18 or cinnamamide 20 yielded Heck coupling products in modest yields at pH 5.0, 25°C (Figures 23D and 24). For couplings with olefins 17, 18 and 20, adding two equivalents of P(p-SO3C6H4)3 per equivalent of Pd prior to template and reagent addition typically increased overall yields by 2-fold. , Control reactions containing sequence mismatches or lacking Pd precatalyst yielded no product.
[0329] Example 1 above shows that certain DNA-templated reactions demonstrate distance independence. Distance independence may arise when the rate of bond formation in the DNA-templated reaction is greater than the rate of template-reagent annealing. Although only a subset of chemistries fall into this category, any DNA-templated reaction that affords corhparable product yields when the reagent is annealed at various distances from the reactive end ofthe template is of special interest because it can be encoded at a variety of template positions. In order to evaluate the ability ofthe DNA-templated reactions developed in this Example to take place efficiently when reactants are separated by distances relevant to library encoding, the yields of reductive amination, amide formation, nitro-aldol addition, nitro-Michael addition, Wittig olefination, dipolar cycloaddition, arid Heck coupling reactions were compared when either zero (n ~ 0) or ten (n = 10) bases separated the annealed reactive groups.(Figure 26 A). Among the reactions described here or in Example 1, amide bond formation, nitro-aldol addition, Wittig olefination, Heck coupling, conjugate addition of thiols to maleimides and SN2 reaction between thiols and α-iodo amides demonstrate comparable product formation when reactive groups are separated by zero or ten bases (Figure 26B). Figure 26B shows the results of denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis of a DNA-templated Wittig olefination between complementary 11 and 13 with either zero bases (lanes 1-3) or ten bases (lanes 4-6) separating the annealed reactants. Although the apparent second order rate constants for the n = 0 and n = 10 reactions differ by three-fold (kapp (n - 0) = 9.9 x 103 M'V1 while kapp (n = 10) = 3.5 x 10 M s" ), product yields after 13 hours at both distances were nearly quantitative. Control reactions containing sequence mismatches yielded no detectable product. These findings indicate that these reactions can be encoded during synthesis by nucleotides that are distal from the reactive end ofthe template without significantly impairing product formation.
[0330] In addition to the DNA-templated SN2 reaction, conjugate addition, vinyl sulfone addition, amide bond formation, reductive amination, nitro-aldol (Henry reaction), nitro Michael, Wittig olefination, 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition and Heck coupling reactions described directly above, a variety of additional reagents can also be utilized in the method ofthe present invention. For example, as depicted in Figure 27, powerful aqueous DNA-templated synthetic reactions including, but not limited to, the Lewis acid-catalyzed aldol addition, Mannich reaction, Robinson annulatiόh reactions, additions of allyl mdiun , zinc and tin to ketones and aldehydes; Pd-assisted allylic substitution, Diels-' Alder, cycloadditions, and hetero-Diels- Alder reactions can be utilized efficiently, in aqueous solvent and are important complexity-building reactions. [0331] Taken together, these results expand considerably the reaction scope of DNA-
Figure imgf000111_0001
formation (see, Schmidt et al. (1997) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 25: 4792; Bruick et al. (1996) CHEM. BIOL. 3: 49), imine formation (Czlaρinski;et al. (2001) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 123: 8618), reductive amination (Li e/ al (2002) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 124: 746; Gat et al. (1998) BIOPOLYMERS 48: 19),
SN2 reactions (Gartner et al. (2001) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 123: 6961; Xu et al. (2001) NAT. , BIOTECHNOL. 19: 148; Henlein et al. (1995) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 117: 10151) conjugate addition of thiols (Gartner et al. (2001) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 123: 6961), and phosphoester or phosphonamide formation (Orgel et al. (1995) Ace. CHEM. RES. 28: 109; Luther et al (1998) NATURE 396: 245), these results may permit the, sequence-specific translation of libraries of DNA into libraries of structurally and functionally diverse synthetic products. [0332] Because minute quantities of templates encoding desired molecules can be amplified by PCR, the yields of DNA-templated reactions arguably are less critical than the yields of traditional synthetic transformations. Nevertheless, many ofthe reactions discussed in this Example proceed efficiently.
Materials and Methods [0333] Functionalized templates and reagents were typically prepared by reacting 5 ' -NH terminated oligonucleotides (for template 1), 5'-NH2-(CH2O)2 terminated oligonucleotides (for all other templates) or 3'-OPO3-CH2CH(CH2OH)(CH2)4NH2 terminated nucleotides (for all reagents) with the appropriate NHS esters (0.1 volumes of a 20 mg/mL solution in DMF) in 0.2 M sodium phosphate buffer, pH 7.2, 25°C, for 1 hour to provide the template and reagent structures shown in Figures 23A-23D and 25A-25B. For amino acid linked reagents 6-9, 3'- OPO3CH2CH(CH2OH)(CH2)4NH2 terminated oligonucleotides in 0.2 M sodium phosphate buffer, pH 7.2 were reacted with 0.1 volumes of a 1.00 mM bis[2-
(s'uccinimidyloxycarbonyloxy)ethyl]sulfone (BSOCOES, Pierce, Rockford, IL, USA) solution in DMF'for 10 minutes at 25°C, followed by 0.3 volumes of a 300 mM amino aci in 300 mM sodium hydroxide (NaOH) for 30 minutes at 25°C. , , [0334] ' Functionalized templates and reagents were purified by gel filtration using Sephadex G-25 followed by reverse-phase HPLC (0.1 triethylarnmonium acetate-acetonitrile gradient) and characterized by MALDI mass spectrometry.
[0335] ' For the DNA templated reactions described in Figures 23A-23D,' reactions were conducted at 25 °C with one equivalent each of template and reagent at 60 nM final concentration unless otherwise specified. Conditions: (a) 3 mM NaBH3CN, 0.1 M N-[2-mθφholinoethane] sulfonic acid (MES) buffer pH 6.0, 0.5 M ΝaCl, 1.5 hours; b) 0.1 M N-tris[hydroxymethyl] methyl-3-aminopropanesulfonic acid (TAPS) buffer pH 8.5, 300 mM ΝaCl, 12 hours; c) 0.1 M pH 8.0 TAPS buffer, 1 M ΝaCl, 5°C, 1.5 hours; d) 50 mM MOPS buffer pH 7.5, 2.8 M ΝaCl, 22 hours; e) 120 nM 19, 1.4 mM Νa2PdCl4, 0.5 M NaOAc buffer pH 5.0, 18 hours; (f) Premix Na PdCl4 with two equivalents of P(p-SO3C6H )3 in water for 15 minutes, then add to reactants in 0.5 M NaOAc buffer pH 5.0, 75 mM NaCI, 2 hours (final [Pd] = 0.3 mM, [19] = 120 nM). The olefin geometry of products from 13 and the regiochemistries of cycloaddition products from 14 and 16 are presumed but not verified (Figures 23A-23D). Products were characterized by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis and MALDI mass spectrometry. For all reactions under the specified conditions, product yields of reactions with matched template and reagent sequences were greater than 20-fold higher than that of control reactions with scrambled reagent sequences.
[0336] The conditions for the reactions described in Figures 25A-25B were: 60 nM template, 120 nM reagent, 50 mM DMT-MM in 0.1 M MOPS buffer pH 7.0, 1 M NaCI, for 16 hours at, 25°C; or 60 nM template, 120 nM reagent, 20 mM EDC, 15 mM sulfo-NHS, 0.1 M MES buffer pH 6.0, 1 M NaCI, for 16 hours at 25°C. In each row ofthe table in Figures 25A- 25B, yields of DMT-MM-mediated reactions between reagents and templates complementary in sequence were followed by yields of EDC and sulfo-NHS-mediated reactions. In all cases, control reactions with mismatched reagent sequences yielded little or no detectable product and products were characterized by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis and MALDI mass spectrometry. [0337] Figure 24 depicts the analysis by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis of representative DNA-templated reactions listed in Figures 23A-23D and 25A-25B. The structures of reagents and templates conespόnd to the numbering in Figures 23A-23D and 25A- 25B. Lanes 1, 3, 5, 7, 9, 11: reaction of matched (complementary or "M") reagents and templates under conditions listed in Figures 23A-23D and 25A-25B (the reaction between 4 and
6 was mediated.by DMT-MM). Lanes 2, A, 6, 8, 10, 12: reaction of mismatched (non- ' complementary or "X") reagents and templates under conditions identical to those in lanes l1, 3,
' , 5, 7, 9 arid 11, respectively.
[0338] The sequences of oligonucleotide templates and reagents are as follows (5' to 3' direction, n refers to the number of bases between reactive groups when template and reagent are annealed as shown in Figure 26A). 1: TGGTACGAATTCGACTCGGG [SEQ LD NO: 45]; 2 and 3 matched: GAGTCGAATTCGTACC [SEQ LD NO: 46]; 2 and 3 mismatched: GGGCTCAGCTTCCCC A [SEQ LD NO: 47] ; 4 and 5: '
GGTACGAATTCGACTCGGGAATACCACCTT [SEQ LD NO: 48]; 6-9 matched (n = 10): TCCCGAGTCG [SE0 ID NO: 49]; 6 matched (n = 0): AATTCGTACC [SEQ LD NO: 50]; 6-9 mismatched: TCACCTAGCA [SEQ LD NO: 51]; 11, 12, 14, 17, 18, 20: GGTACGAATTCGACTCGGGA [SEQ LD NO: 52]; 10, 13, 16, 19 matched: TCCCGAGTCGAATTCGTACC [SEQ ID NO: 53]; 10, 13, 16, 19 mismatched: GGGCTCAGCTTCCCCATAAT [SEQ LD NO: 54]; 15 matched: AATTCGTACC [SEQ LD NO: 55]; 15 mismatched: TCGTATTCCA [SEQ LD NO: 56]; template for n = 10 vs. n = 0 comparison: TAGCGATTACGGTACGAATTCGACTCGGGA [SEQ LD NO: 57].
[0339] Reaction yields were quantitated by denaturing PAGE followed by ethidium bromide staining, UN visualization, and charge-coupled device (CCD)-based densitometry of product and template starting material bands. Yield calculations assumed that templates and products stained with equal intensity per base; for those cases in which products were partially double-stranded during quantitation, changes in staining intensity may have resulted in higher apparent yields.
Example 3: Multi-Step Small Molecule Synthesis Programmed by DΝA Templates
[0340] This Example demonstrates that it is possible to perform multi-step small molecule synthesis via DΝA-templated chemistries. [0341] DNA-templated synthesis can direct ,'a wide Variety of powerful chemical , reactions with high sequence-specificity and' without requiring structural mimicry of the DNA backbone. The application of this approach to synthetic molecules of useful complexity, however, requires the development of general methods to permit the product of a DNA- templated reaction to'uridergo subsequent DNA-templated transformations. ι
[0342] Multi-step DNA-templated small molecule synthesis faces two major challenges,
V '1 , ' . ' ' ■ . . beyond those associated with DNA-templated synthesis in general. First, the DNA used to direct reagents to appropriate templates must be removed from the product of a DNA-templated reaction prior to subsequent DNA-templated synthetic steps in order to prevent undesired hybridization to the template. Second, multi-step synthesis often requires the purification and isolation of intermediate products. To address these challenges, three distinct strategies have been developed (i) to link chemical reagents (reactive units) with their decoding DNA
1 , j ' ' ' oligonucleotides, and (ii) to punfy product after any DNA-templated synthetic step.
[0343] When possible, an ideal reagent-oligonucleotide linker for DNA-templated synthesis positions the oligonucleotide as a leaving group of the reagent. Under this '
"autocleaving" linker strategy, the oligonucleotide-^reagent bond is cleaved as a natural chemical consequence ofthe reaction (see, Figure 28A).
[0344] As the first example of this approach applied to DNA-templated chemistry, a dansylated Wittig phosphorane reagent (1) was synthesized in which the decoding DNA oligonucleotide was attached to one ofthe aryl phosphine groups (Hughes (1996) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 37: 7595). DNA-templated Wittig olefination with aldehyde-linked template 2 resulted in the efficient transfer ofthe fluorescent dansyl group from the reagent to the template to provide olefin 3 (Figure 28A). As a second example of an autocleaving linker, DNA-linked thioester 4, when activated with Ag(I) at pH 7.0 (Zhang et al. (1999) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 121: 3311) acylated amino-terminated template 5 to afford amide product 6 (Figure 28B).
[0345] Ribosomal protein biosynthesis uses aminoacylated tRNAs in a similar autocleaving linker format to mediate RNA-templated peptide bond formation. To purify desired products away from unreacted reagents and from cleaved oligonucleotides following DNA-templated reactions using autocleaving linkers, biotinylated reagent oligonucleotides and washing crude reactions with streptavidin-linked magnetic beads (see, Figure 30A) were utilized. Although this approach does not separate reacted templates from unreacted templates, unreacted templates can be removed in subsequent DNA-templated reaction and purification steps.
1 [0346] , Reagents bearing more than one functional group can be linked to their decoding
DNA oligonucleotides through second and third linker strategies. In the "scarless linker" ' approach (Figure 28C), one functional group ofthe reagent is reserved for DNA-templated bond formation, while the second functional group is used to attach a linker that can be cleaved without introducing additional unwanted chemical functionality. The DNA-templated reaction then is followed by cleavage ofthe linker attached through the second functional group to afford desired products (Figure 28C). For example, a series of aminoacylation reagents such as (D)- Phe derivative 7 were synthesized in which the α-amine is connected through a carbamoylethylsulfone linker (Zarling et al (1980) J. IMMUNOLOGY 124: 913) to its decoding DNA oligonucleotide. The product (8) of DNA-templated amide bond formation using this reagent and an amine-terminated template (5) was treated with aqueous base to effect the quantitative elimination and spontaneous decarboxylation ofthe linker, affording product 9 containing the cleanly transfened amino acid group (Figure 28C). This sulfone linker is stable in pH 7.5 or lower buffer at 25 °C for more than 24 hours yet undergoes quantitative cleavage when exposed to pH 11.8 buffer for 2 hours at 37 C.
[0347] In some cases it may be advantageous to introduce one or more atoms new , chemical groups as a consequence of linker cleavage. Under a third linker strategy, linker cleavage generates a "useful scar" that can be functionalized in subsequent steps (Figure 28C). As an example of this class of linker, amino acid reagents such as the (L)-Phe derivative 10 were generated linked through 1,2-diols (Fruchart et al. (1999) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 40: 6225) to their decoding DNA oligonucleotides. Following DNA-templated amide bond formation with amine terminated template (5), this linker was quantitatively cleaved by oxidation with 50 mM aqueous sodium periodate (NaIO4) at pH 5.0 to afford product 12 containing an aldehyde group appropriate for subsequent functionalization (for example, in a DNA-templated Wittig olefination, reductive amination, or nitrolaldol addition).
[0348] Figure 29 shows the results of exemplary DNA-templated synthesis experiments using autocleaving linkers, scarless linkers, and useful scar linkers. The depicted reactions were analyzed by denaturing PAGE. Lanes 1-3 were visualized using UV light without DNA staining; lanes 4-10 were visualized by staining with ethidium bromide following by UV transillumination. Conditions for 1 to 3 were: one equivalent each of reagent and template, 0.1
M TAPS buffer pH 8.5, 1 M NaCI, at 25 °C for 1.5 hours. Conditions for 4 to 6 were: three equivalents of A, 0: l'1 M. MES buffer pH 7.0,, 1 M sodium nitrite (NaNO2) 10 mM silver nitrate
(AgNO3), at 37 °C for 8 hours. Conditions for 8 to 9 were 0.1 M 3- (cyclohexylamino)-l- propanesulfonic acid (CAPS) buffer pH 11.8,' 60 mM β mercaptoethanol (BME), at 37 °C for 2 hours. Finally, '.conditions for 11 to 12 were: 50 mM aqueous NaIO , at 25 °C for 2 hours. i =
NH(CH2)2NH-dansyl; R2 = biotin. , ' , '
[0349] Desired products generated from DNA ,emplated reactions using the scarless, or useful scar linkers can be readily purified using biotinylated reagent oligonucleotides (Figure 30B). Reagent oligonucleotides together with desired products are first captured on streptavidin- linked magnetic beads. Any unreacted template bound to reagent by base pairing is removed by washing the beads with bμffer containing 4 M guanidinium chloride. Biotinylated molecules remain bound to the streptavidin beads under these conditions. Desired product then is isolated in pure form by eluting the beads with linker cleavage buffer (in the examples above, either pH 11 or sodium periodate (NaIO )-containing buffer), while reacted and unreacted reagents remain bound to the beads.
[0350] As one example of a specific library generated as described above, three iterated cycles of DNA-templated amide formation, trace'less linker cleavage, and purification with streptavidin-linked beads were used to generate a non-natural tripeptide (Figures 31 A-B). Each amino acid reagent was linked to a unique biotinylated 10-base DNA oligonucleotide through the sulfone linker described above. The 30-base amine-terminated template programmed to direct the tripeptide synthesis contained three consecutive 10-base regions that were complementary to the three reagents, mimicking the strategy that would be used in a multi-step DNA-templated small molecule library synthesis. [0351] hi the first step, two equivalents of 13 were activated by treatment with 20 mM
EDC, 15 mM sulfo-NHS, 0.1 M MES buffer pH 5.5, and 1 M NaCI, for 10 minutes at 25 °C. The template then was added in 0.1 M MOPS pH 7.5, and IM NaCI, at 25°C and was allowed to react for 1 hour. The free amine group in 14 then was elaborated in a second and third round of DNA-templated amide formation and linker cleavage to afford dipeptide 15 and tripeptide 16 using the following conditions: two equivalents of reagent, 50 mM DMT-MM, 0.1 M MOPS buffer pH 7.0, 1 M NaCI, at 25 °C for 6 hours. Desired product after each step was purified by capture on avidin-linked beads and elution with 0.1 M CAPS buffer pH 11.8, 60 mM BME, at 37
°C for 2 hours. The progress of each reabtion and purification was followed by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis (Figure 31B, bottom). Lanes 3, 6, and 9 represent control reactions using reagents containing scrambled oligonucleotide sequences. [0352] ' The progress of each reaction, purification, and sulfone linker cleavage step was followed by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis. The final tripeptide linked to template 16 was digested with the restriction endonuclease EcoRI and the digestion fragment ' containing the tripeptide was characterized by MALDI mass spectrometry. Beginning with 2 nmol (~ 20 μg) of starting material, sufficient tripeptide product was generated to serve as the template for more than 106 in vitro selections and PCR reactions (Kramer et al. (1999) CURRENT PROTOCOLS IN MOL. BIOL. 3: 15.1) (assuming 1/10,000 molecules survive selection). No significant product was generated when the starting material template was capped with acetic anhydride, or when control reagents containing sequence mismatches were used instead ofthe complementary reagents (Figure 31B). [0353] A non-peptidic multi-step DNA-templated small molecule synthesis that uses all three linker strategies developed above was also performed (Figure 32A-32B). An amine- terminated 30-base template was subjected to DNA-templated amide bond formation using an aminoacyl donor reagent (17) containing the diol linker and a biotinylated 10-base oligonucleotide to afford amide 18 (two equivalents 17 in 20 mM EDC, 15 mM sulfo-NHS, 0.1 M MES buffer pH 5.5, 1 M NaCI, 10 minutes, 25 °C, then add to template in 0.1 M MOPS pH 7.5, IM NaCI at 16°C for 8 hours). The desired product then was isolated by capturing the crude reaction on streptavidin beads followed by cleaving the linker with NaIO to generate aldehyde 19. The DNA-templated Wittig reaction of 19 with the biotinylated autocleaving phosphorane reagent 20 afforded fumaramide 21 (three equivalents 20, 0.1 M TAPS pH 9.0, 3 M NaCI at 25 °C for 48 hours). The products from the second DNA-templated reaction were partially purified by washing with streptavidin beads to remove reacted and unreacted reagent. In the third DNA-templated step, fumaramide 21 was subjected to a DNA-templated conjugate addition (Gartner et al. (2001) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 123: 6961) using thiol reagent 22 linked through the sulfone linker to a biotinylated oligonucleotide (three equivalents 22, 0.1 M TAPS pH 8.5, 1 M NaCI at 25°C for 21 hours). The desired conjugate addition product (23) was purified by immobilization with streptavidin beads. Linker cleavage with pH 11 buffer afforded final product 24 in 5-10% overall isolated yield for the three bond forming reactions, two linker cleavage steps, and three purifications (Figures 32 A-32B).
[0354] ' The final product was digested with EcoRI and the mass ofthe small molecule- linked template fragment was confirmed by MALDI mass spectrometry (exact mass: 2568, observed mass: 2566±5). As in the tripeptide exariiple,' each ofthe three reagents used'during this multi-step synthesis, annealed at a unique location on the DNA template!, and control reactions with sequence mismatches yielded no product (Figure 32B, bottom). In Figure 32B,, bottom lanes 3, 6, and 9 represent control reactions. As expected, control reactions in which the Wittig reagent was omitted (step 2) also did not generate product following the third step. [0355] Taken together, the DNA-templated syntheses of compounds 16 and 24 demonstrate the ability of DNA to direct the sequence-programmed multi-step synthesis of both oligomeric and non-oligomeric small molecules: unrelated in structure' to nucleic acids.
Example 4: Exemplary Reactions in Organic Solvents '
[0356] As demonstrated herein, a variety of DNA-templated reactions can occur in aqueous media. It has also been discovered that DNA-templated reactions can occμr in organic solvents, thus greatly expanding the scope of DNA-templated synthesis. Specifically, DNA templates and reagents have been complexed with long chain tetraalkylammonium cations (see, Jost et al. (1989) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 17: 2143; Mel'nikov et al (1999) LANGMUIR 15: 1923- 1928) to permit quantitative dissolution of reaction components in anhydrous organic solvents including CH2G2, CHC13, DMF and methanol. Suφrisingly, it was found that DNA-templated synthesis can indeed occur in anhydrous organic solvents with high sequence selectivity.
[0357] Figure 33 shows DNA-templated amide bond formation reactions where the reagents and templates are complexed with dimethyldidodecylammonium cations either in separate vessels or after preannealing in water, lyophilized to dryness, dissolved in CH2CI2, and mixed together. Matched, but not mismatched, reactions provided products both when reactants were preannealed in aqueous solution and when they were mixed for the first time in CH2C12 (Figure 33). DNA-templated amide formation and Pd-mediated Heck coupling in anhydrous DMF also proceeded sequence-specifically.
[0358] These observations of sequence-specific DNA-templated synthesis in organic solvents imply the presence of at least some secondary structure within tetraalkylammonium- complexed DNA in organic media, and should permit DNA receptors and catalysts, to be evolved towards stereoselective binding or catalytic properties in organic solvents. Specifically, DNA- templated reactions that are known to occur in aqueous media, including conjugate additions, cycloadditions, displacement reactions, and Pd-mediated couplings can also be performed in , organic solvents.
[0359] It is contemplated that reactions in organic solvents may be utilized that are inefficient or impossible to perform in water. For example, while Ru-catalyzed olefin metathesis ' in wafer has been reported (Lynn et al. (1998) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 120: 1627-1628; Lynn et al. (2000) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 122: 6601-6609; Mohr et al (1996) ORGANOMETALLICS 15: 4317- 4325), the aqueous metathesis system is extremely sensitive to the identities ofthe unctional groups. The functional group tolerance of Ru-catalyzed olefin metathesis in organic solvents, however, is significantly more robust. Some exemplary reactions to utilize in organic solvents include, but are not limited to 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition between nitrones and olefins which can proceed through transition states that are less polar than ground state starting materials. Example 5: New Architectures for Nucleic Acid-Templated Synthesis
[0360] This Example discloses two different template architectures that further expand the scope of nucleic acid-templated synthesis.
[0361] During a nucleic acid-templated chemical reaction a portion of a template anneals to a complementary sequence of an oligonucleotide-linked reagent, holding functional groups on the template and transfer unit in reactive proximity. Template architecture can have a profound effect on the nature ofthe resulting reaction, raising the possibility of manipulating reaction conditions by rationally designing template-reagent complexes with different secondary structures.
[0362] During the course of DNA templated synthesis using the end-of-helix ("E") and haiφin ("H") templates (see, Example 1), two challenges emerged. First, some DNA-templated reactions do not proceed efficiently when the annealed reactive groups on the template and transfer unit (reagent) are separated by even small numbers of bases. Using the E or H architectures, "distance-dependent" reactions can only be encoded by template bases at the reactive end ofthe template. Second, the presence of double-stranded DNA between annealed reactive groups can greatly reduce the efficiency of templated reactions because, under certain circumstances a single-stranded template may need to be flexible. This may preclude the - Im possibility of performing two or more reactions in a single DNA-templated step using the E or H architectures even though the template oligonucleotide may Contain enough bases to encode multiple reactions. This Example discuses two new template architectures, which overcome each of these challenges. ι . [0363] ' It was hypothesized that the distance dependence of certain DNA-templated reactions such as 1,3-dipolar cycloadditions and reductive amination could be overcome by designing a new architecture that permits a reagent to anneal to two distinct and spatially separated regions ofthe template. In the "omega" or "Ω" architecture (see, Figure 7), the template oligonucleotide contains a small number of constant bases at, for example, the reactive 5' end ofthe template in addition to distal coding regions. The oligonucleotide of the transfer unit for the Ω architecture contains at its reactive 3' end the bases that complement the constant region ofthe template followed by bases that complement a coding region anywhere on the template. The constant regions were designed to be of insufficient length to anneal in the absence of a complementary coding region. When the coding region of the template and transfer unit are complementary and anneal, the elevated effective molarity ofthe constant regions induces their annealing. Constant region annealing forms a bulge (resembling an Ω) in the otherwise double-stranded template-reagent complex and places groups at the ends ofthe template and reagent in reactive proximity. This design permits distance-dependent DNA- templated reactions to be encoded by bases distal from the reactive end ofthe template. [0364] The efficiency of DNA-templated synthesis using the Ω architecture was compared with that ofthe standard E and H architectures. The Ω architectures studied comprise (i) three to five constant bases at the 5' end ofthe template followed by (ii) a five- to 17-base loop and (iii) a ten-base coding region. As a basis for comparison, four different classes of DNA-templated reactions were performed that collectively span the range of distance dependence observed to date.
[0365] Amine acylation reactions are representative of distance independent reactions that proceed efficiently even when considerable distances (e.g., 30 bases) separate the amine and carboxylate groups. As expected, amine acylation (20 mM DMT-MM, pH 7.0, at 30 °C for 12 hours) proceeded efficiently (46-96% yield) in all architectures with both small and large distances between reactive groups on the reagent and template (Figure 34, lanes 1-5; and Figure 35A). The Ω architecture mediated efficient amine acylation with three, four, or five constant bases at the reactive ends ofthe template and reagent and 10 or 20 bases between annealed reactants (n = 10 or 20). Importantly, control reactions in which the distal coding region contained three sequence mismatches failed to generate significant product despite the presence ofthe complementary three-to five-base constant regions at the ends ofthe template and reagent (see, Figure 34, lane 5 for a representative example). The Ω architecture, therefore, did not impede the efficiency or sequence-specificity of the distance-independent amine, acylation reaction. , , ' , ' '
[0366] DNA-templated Wittig olefination reactions proceed at a significantly lower rate when the aldehyde and phosphorane are separated by larger numbers of template bases, even, though product yields typically are excellent after 12 hours or more of reaction regardless of intervening distance. After only 2 hours of reaςtion (pH 7.5, 30 °C) in the E or H architectures, however, yields of olefin products were three- to six-fold lower when reactants werp separated by ten or more bases (n = 10 or 20) than when reactants are separated by only one base (n = 1) (Figure 34, lanes 6-7, and Figure 35B). In contrast, the Ω architecture with four or five constant bases at the reactive end resulted in efficient and sequence-specific Wittig product formation after 2 hours of reaction even when 10 or 20 bases separated the coding region and reactive end ofthe template (Figure 34, lanes 8-9, and Figure 35B). These results suggest that the constant regions at the reactive ends ofthe template and transfer unit in the Ω architecture permit the aldehyde and phosphorane moieties to react at an effective concentration comparable to that achieved with the E-architecture when n = 1 (Figure 34).
[0367] Among the many DNA-templated reactions studied to date, the 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition and reductive amination reactions demonstrate the most pronounced distance dependence. Both reactions proceed in low to modest efficiency (7%-44% yield) under standard reaction conditions using the E or H architectures when 10 or 20 bases separate the annealed reactive groups (Figure 34, lanes 10-11 and 14-15, and Figures 35C-35D). This distance dependence limits the positions on a DNA template that can encode these or other similarly distant dependent reactions. In contrast, both 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition and reductive amination proceed efficiently (up to 97% yield) and sequence-specifically when encoded by template bases 15-25 bases away from the functionalized end ofthe template using the Ω architecture with four or five constant bases (Figure 34, lanes 12-13 and 16-17, and Figures 35C-35D). These results demonstrate that the templates Ω architecture permits distance-dependent reactions to be efficiently directed by DNA bases far from the reactive end ofthe template. By overcoming the distance dependence of these reactions while preserving the efficiency of distant independent reactions, the Ω architecture may permit virtually any contiguous subset of bases in a single- stranded 30-base template to encode any viable DNA-templated reaction. Interestingly, the Ω < templates with only three constant bases at, their reactive ends do not consistently improve the efficiency of these reactions compared with the E-architecture (Figures 35C-35D), suggesting that four or five constant bases may be required in the Ω architecture to fully realize favorable proximity, effects. , , ',
[0368] In order to probe the structural features underlying the observed properties ofthe Ω architecture, the thermal denaturation of the Ω-5 arid E architectures using n == 10 and n - 20 reagents were characterized. For all template-reagent combinations, only a single cooperative melting transition was observed. Compared to the E architecture reagent lacking the five-base constant region, the Ω-5 reagent increased the hypochromicity upon annealing by -50% but did not significantly affect melting temperature in either phosphate-buffered saline (PBS) or in 50 mM sodium phosphate pH 7.2 with 1 M NaCI (Figure 36). These results are consistent with a model in which template-reagent annealing in the Ω architecture is dominated by coding region interactions even though the constant region forms secondary structure once the coding region is annealed. The entropic cost of partially ordering the loop between the coding and constant, regions may, therefore, be offset by the favorable interactions that arise upon annealing ofthe constant region.
[0369] DNA templates of arbitrary length are easy to synthesize and undesired cross reactivity between reactants in the same solution can be avoided using concentrations that are too low to allow non-complementary reactants to react intermolecularly. These features of DNA- templated synthesis permit more than one DNA-templated reaction to take place on a single template in one solution, saving the effort associated with additional DNA-templated steps and product purifications.
[0370] Multiple DNA-templated reactions per step can be difficult using the E, H, or Ω architectures, because the reagent oligonucleotide that remains annealed to the template following the first reaction forms a relatively rigid double helix that can prevent a second reagent annealed further away along the template from encountering the reactive end ofthe template. To overcome this, the reactive group on the template was moved from the end ofthe oligonucleotide to the middle, attaching the reactive group to the'noμ- Watson-Crick face of a base. This "T" architecture (see, Figure 7G) was designed to permit two DNA-templated reactions, one with a ' reagent coupled to the 51 end ofthe oligonucleotide of a first transfer unit arid one with a reagent coupled to the 31 end ofthe oligonucleotide of a second transfer unit, to take place sequence- specifically1 in the sarrie solution on a single template. ,
[0371 ] To test the viability of the T, architecture m DNA-templated reactions, the efficiency of the amine acylation, Wittig olefination, 1 ,3 -dipolar cycloaddition, and reductive amination reactions using the T architecture was studied, The T architecture sequence- specifically directed these four reactions with efficiencies comparable to or greater than those qf the E or H architectures (Figure 37, 69-100% yield when n = 1). The observed degree of distance dependence using the T architecture for each ofthe four reactions was consistent with the above findings (compare Figure 37 and Figure 35). Together these results demonstrate that the T architecture can mediate sequence-specific and efficient DNA-templated synth Iesis.
[0372] Once the ability ofthe T architecture to support efficient DNA-templated synthesis was established, the ability ofthe T architecture to direct two DNA-templated reactions on one template in one solution was studied. Two different two-reaction schemes using the T architecture were performed. In the first scheme, depicted in Figure 38A, a benzaldehyde- linked T template (1) was combined with a phosphine-linked reagent (2) and an -iodoamide- linked reagent (3) in a single solution (pH 8.5, 1 M NaCI, at 25 °C for 1 hour). The phosphine- linked oligonucleotide complemented ten bases ofthe template 5' ofthe aldehyde (n = -A), while the iodide-linked oligonucleotide complemented ten bases 3' ofthe aldehyde (n = 0). DNA- templated SN2 reaction between the phosphine and α-iodoamide generated the conesponding phosphorane, which then participated in a DNA-templated Wittig reaction to generate cinnanamide 4 in 52% overall yield after 1 hour (Figure 38B, lanes 9-10). Control reactions containing sequence mismatches in either reagent generated no detectable product. The additional control reaction lacking the aldehyde group on the template generated only the SN2 reaction product (Figure 38B, lanes 3-4) while control reactions lacking either the phosphine group or the α-iodoamide group did not generate any detectable products (Figure 38B, lanes 5- 8). [0373] In a second two-reaction scheme mediated by the T architecture, depicted in
Figure 38C, an amine-linked T template (5) was combined with a propargylglycine-linked 5' reagent (6) at n = -1 and a phenyl azide-linked 31 reagent (7) at n = 1. The addition of 20 mM DMT-MM at pH 7.0 to induce amide forrriation followed by the addition of 500 μM copper(n) sulfate and sodium ascorbate to induce the recently reported Shaφless-modified Huisgen' 1,3- dipolar cycloaddition provided 1,4-disubstituted triazoyl alanine adduct 8 in 32% overall yield. , [0374] ' Taken together, these observations show that the T architecture permits two sequence-specific DNA-templated reactions to take place on one template in one solution. Importantly, the T architecture templates described above were accepted as efficient templates for, both a single cycle of primer extension as well as standard PCR amplification'using Taq DNA polymerase, consistent with the known tolerance of several DNA polymerases for modifications to the non- Watson-Crick face of DNA templates. In addition to reducing the number of separate DNA-templated steps needed to synthesize a target structure, this architecture may also permit three-component reactions commonly used to build structural complexity in synthetic libraries to be performed in a DNA-templated format.
[0375] In summary, the Ω and T architectures significantly expand the scope of DNA- templated synthesis. By enabling distance-dependent DNA-templated reactions to be encoded by bases far away from the reactive end ofthe template, the omega architecture expands the types of reactions that can be encoded anywhere on a DNA template. The T architecture permits two DNA-templated reactions to take place on a single template in one step.
Materials and Methods [0376] Oligonucleotide synthesis. Unless otherwise specified, DNA oligonucleotides were synthesized and functionalized as previously described using 2-[2-(4-monomethoxytrityl) aminoethoxy]ethyl-(2-cyanoethyl)-N,N-diisopropyl-ρhosphoramidite (Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA) for 5'-functionalized oligonucleotides, and using (2-dimethoxytrityloxymethyl-6- fluorenylmethoxycarbonylamino-hexane-l-succinoyl)-long chain alkylamino-CPG (Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA) for 3'-functionalized oligonucleotides (Calderone et al.
(2002) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. ENGL. 41: 4104; (2002) ANGEW. CHEM. 114: 4278). In the case of templates for the T architecture, amine groups were added using 5'-dimethoxytrityl-5-[N- (trifluoroacetylaminohexyl)-3-acrylimido]-2'-deoxyuridine-3l-[(2-cyanoethyl)-(N,N- diisopropyl)]-phosphoramidite (Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA) and then acylated as reported previously (Calderone et al. (2002) supra). [0377] Amine Acylation. Amine-labeled arid carboxylic acid-labeled DNA were combined in aqueous 100 mM MOPS buffer, 1 ,M NaCl/pH 7.0 (60 nM in template DNA, 120 ' ' nM in reagent DNA) in the presence of 20 mM DMT-MM. Reactions proceeded for 12 hours at
25 °C. '_ [0378] Wittig Olefination. Aldehyde-labeled and phosphorane-labeled DNA were combined in aqueous LOO rnM MOPS, 1 M NaCI, pH 7.5 (60 nM in template'DNA, 120 nM in ',
, '' . ' ' ' I reagent DNA). Reactions proceeded for 2 hours at 30°C.
[0379] 1,3-Dipolar Cycloaddition. Dialdehyde^labeled DNA was incubated in 260 mM
N-methylhydrpxylamine hydrochloride for 1 hour at room temperature (Gartner et al. (2002) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 124: 10304). It was subsequently combined with succinimide-labeled DNA in aqueous 50 mM MOPS, 2.8 M NaCI, pH 7.5 ,(final concentrations of N-methylhydroxylamine hydrochloride 0.75 mM, 60 M in template DNA and 9,0 nM in reagent DNA). Reactions proceeded for 12 hours at 37°C. ,
[0380] Reductive Amination. Amine-labeled and aldehyde-labeled DNA were combined in aqueous 100 mM MES buffer, 1 M NaCI, pH 6.0 (60 nM in template DNA, 120 nM in reagent DNA). Sodium cyanoborohydride was added as a 5 M stock in 1 M NaOH to a final concentration of 38 mM, and reactions proceeded for 2 hours at 25 °C. Reactions were quenched by ethanol precipitation in the presence of 15 rriM methylamine.
[0381] T Architecture-mediated Conversion of Compound I to 4. The 5'-phosphine- linked oligonucleotide (2) was generated by coupling N-succinimidyliodoacetate (SIA) to the amine derived from 12-(4-monomethoxytritylamino)dodecyl-(2-cyanoethyl)-(N,N-diisopropyl)- phosphoramidite (Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA) using the T (n = -A) oligonucleotide listed below, followed by treatment with 4-diphenylphosphinobenzoic acid as described previously (Gartner et al. (2002) supra). The 3'-Ω-iodoamide-linked reagent (3) was prepared by reacting the T (n = 1) oligonucleotide (see below) with SIA as described previously (Gartner et al. (2001) supra). Aldehyde-labeled template (1) was prepared by reacting the "T template" oligonucleotide (see below) with j rα-formyl benzoic acid N-hydroxysuccinimidyl ester as described previously (Gartner et al. (2002) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 41: 1796; (2002) ANGEW. CHEM. 114: 1874). Template 1 was combined with reagents 2 and 3 in aqueous 200 mM N-(2- hydroxyethyl)piperazine-N'-(2-ethanesulfonic acid) (HEPES) buffer at pH 8.5 with 1 M NaCI, (63 nM template and 125 nM of each reagent). Reactions proceeded for up to 1 hour at 25 °C. [0382] The results of denaturing polyacr iaμiide gel electrophoresis analysis of these reactions is shown in Figure 38B. The 30-base T architecture template (1) containing ari aldehyde group was present in lanes 1-2 andϋanes 5-10. A template lacking the aldehyde group but otherwise identical to (1) was present in lane's 3 and 4. DNA-linked phosphine reagent (2) was present, in lanes 3-6 and lanes 9-10. DNA-linked α-iodoamide reagent (3) was present in lanes 3-4 and laries 7-10. , Lanes 1, 3, 5, 7, and 9 show, reactions after 30 minutes. , Lanes 2, 4, 6,
8, and 10 show reactions after 1 hour. ' , '
[0383] T Architecture-mediated Conversion; of, Compound 5 to 8. The 5'- propargylglycine linked oligonucleotide (6) was generated ,by combining the conesponding T ,(n = -1) 5'-amine-linked reagent oligonucleotide (see below) with 2 mg/mL bis(sulfosuccinimidyl)suberate in 9:1 200 mM spdium phosphate pH 7.2:DMF for 10 minutes at 25 °C, followed by treatment with 0.3 vol of 300,mM racemic propargylglycine in 3Q0 mM NaOH for 2 hours at 25 °C. The 3'-azido linked oligonucleotide (7) was generated by combining the T (ra - 1) amine-linked reagent oligonucleotide (see below) with 2 mgmL (N- hydroxysuccinimidyl)-4-azidobenzoate in 9: 1 200 mM sodium phosphate pH 7.2:DMF for, 2 hours at 25 °C. Reagents 6 and 7 were purified by gel filtration and reverse-phase HPLC. Template 5 and reagents 6 and 7 were combined in aqueous 100 mM MOPS pH 7.0 in the presence of 1 M NaCI and 20 mM DMT-MM for 2 hours (60 nM template, 120 nM reagents) at 25 °C. Copper (II) sulfate pentahydrate and sodium ascorbate were then added to 500 μM each. After 1 hour at 25 °C, reactions were quenched by ethanol precipitation.
[0384] DNA Oligonucleotide Sequences Used. E or Ω template: 5'-H2N-GGT ACG
AAT TCG ACT CGG GAA TAC CAC CTT [SEQ LD NO: 58]. H template: 5'-H2N-CGC GAG CGT ACG CTC GCG GGT ACG AAT TCG ACT CGG GAA TAC CAC CTT [SEQ LD NO: 59]. T template: 5'- GGT ACG AAT TCG AC(dT-NH2) CGG GAA TAC CAC CTT [SEQ ID NO: 60]. E or H reagent (ra = 1): 5'-AAT TCG TAC C-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 61]. E or H reagent (n = 10): 5'-TCC CGA GTC G-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 62]. E or H reagent (ra = 20): 5'- AAG GTG GTA T-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 63]. Mismatched E or H reagent: 5'-TCC CTG ATC G- NH2 [SEQ ID NO: 64]. Ω-3 reagent (ra = 10): 5'-TCC CGA GTC GAC C-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 65]. Ω-4 reagent (ra = 10): 5'-TCC CGA GTC GTA CC-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 66]. Ω-5 reagent (ra = 10): 5'-TCC CGA GTC GGT ACC-NH2[SEQ ID NO: 67]. Ω-3 reagent (ra = 20): 5'-AAG GTG GTA TAC C-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 68]. Ω-4 reagent (ra = 20): 5'-AAG GTG GTA TTA CC- NH2 [SEQ ID NO: 69]. Ω-5 reagent (ra = 20): 5'-AAG GTG GTA TGT ACC- NH2 [SEQ ID NO: 70]. Mismatched Ω-3 reagent: 5'-TCC CTG ATC GAC C-NH2 [SEQ ID NO: 71]. , , Mismatched Ω-4 reagent: 5'-TCC CTG ATC GTA CC-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 72]. Mismatched Ω- 5 reagent: 5'-TCC CTG ATC GGT ACC- H2 [SEQ LD NO: 73]. T reagent (ra = 1): 5'-GGT ' ATT CCC G-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 74]. T reagent (ra = 2): 5 '-TGG TAT TCC C-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 75]. T reagent (ra = 3): 5'-GTG GTA TTC C-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 76]. T reagent (ra = 4): 5'-GGT GGT ATT C-NH2 [SEQ LD NO: 77]. T reagent (ra = 5): 5'-AGG TGG TAT T-NH2 , [SEQ LD NO: 78]. T reagent (ra = -1): 5VNH2-GTC GAA TTC G [SEQ ID NO: 79], T reagent (ra = -4) for 2: 5'-[Cι2-amine linker]-AAT TCG TAC C [SEQ ID NO: 80]. [0385] Reaction yields were quantitated by denaturing polyacrylamide gql electrophoresis followed by ethidium bromide staining, UV visualization, and CCD-based densitometry of product and template starting material bands. Yield calculations assumed that templates and products were denatured and, therefore, stained with comparable intensity per base; for those cases in which products are partially double-stranded during quantitatiόn, changes in staining intensity may result in higher apparent yields. Representative reaction products were characterized by MALDI mass spectrometry in addition to denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis.
[0386] Melting curves were obtained on a Hewlett-Packard 8453 UV-visible spectrophotometer using a Hewlett-Packard 89090A Peltier thermocontroller. Absorbances of template-reagent pairs (1.5 μM each) at 260 nm were measured every 1 °C from 20 °C to 80 °C holding for 1 minute at each temperature in either phosphate-buffered saline ("PBS," 137 mM NaCI, 2.7 mM potassium chloride, 1.4 mM potassium phosphate, 10 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.4) or in high salt phosphate buffer ("HSB," 50 mM sodium phosphate pH 7.2, 1 M NaCI).
Example 6: Stereoselectivity in Nucleic Acid-Templated Synthesis [0387] This Example demonstrates that it is possible to perform stereoselective nucleic acid-templated syntheses. The chiral nature of DNA raises the possibility that DNA-templated synthesis can proceed stereoselectively without the assistance of chiral groups beyond those present in DNA, thereby transferring not only sequence but also stereochemical information from the template to the product. [0388] Stereoselectivity was examined in the context of DNA-templated nucleophilic substitution reactions. .Hairpin architecture templates conjugated at their 51 amino termini directly to (S)- or (R)'-2-bromopropionamide,were combined with 3' thiol-lϊriked reagent oligonucleotides at 25 ,°C (Figure 39A) (Gartner et al (2001) supra; Gartner et al (2003) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 42: 1370). The exact structure ofthe hairpin template and its , complimentary reagent (Figure 39 A) were as "follows: , , , , '
Template: 5'-BrCH(CH3)CONH-TC,G CGA GCG TAC GCT CGC GAG GTA CGA ' ATT C-3' [SEQ D NO: 81] ; , ,, ' , ' ' ,
Reagent: 5'-GAA TTC GTA CC-(CH2)3SH-3i [SEQ LD NO: 82] , ' [0389] The stability of the bromides under the reaction conditions was confirmed by several independent methods. Initial rates of thioether, product formation were determined by denaturing gel electrophoresis and the products were additionally characterized by MALDI-TOF mass spectrometry. Apparent rates of product, formation were 4.0±0.2-fold higher for (S)- bromide-linked templates than for (R)-bromide-linked templates. Because template-reagent annealing could be partially rate-determining, this value is a lower limit ofthe actual ratio of ks/k , assuming annealing rates are unaffected by bromide stereochemistry.
[0390] Surprisingly, similar preferences favoring the (S)-bromide were also observed using end-of-helix template architectures (Figure 39B), even when 12 nucleotides separated the thiol and bromide in the template-reagent complexes. The exact structure ofthe end-of-helix template and its complimentary reagent (Figure 39B) were as follows:
Template: 5'- BrCH(CH3)CONH-TAC GCT CGC GAT GGT ACG AAT TC-3' [SEQ LD NO: 83]
Reagent: 5*-GAA TTC GTA CC-(CH2)3SH-3 '
[0391] Stereoselectivity appeared to be independent of whether the bromide or the thiol was conjugated to the template (Figures 39B and 39C). The exact structure ofthe end-of-helix template conjugated to the thiol and its complimentary reagent (Figure 39C) were as follows:
Template: 5'-GAA TTC GTA CAT AGC GCT CGC AT-(CH2)3SH-3' [SEQ LD NO: 84]
Reagent: 5'- BrCH(CH3)CONH-TGT ACG AAT TC-3* [SEQ LD NO: 85] [0392] Similar selectivities emerged from pseudo-kinetic resolutions containing both bromide stereoisomers in which thioether'products arising from (S)- and (R)-bromides were distinguished using templates of two distinct lengths (kslkn = 4.2±0.4 to 4.9±0.3). Taken' together, these findings indicate that the chirality of a DNA template can be transfened to products of.DNA-templated synthesis that do not resemble the DNA backbone.
[0393] In order to probe the origins ofthe observed stereoselectivity, a series of template and reagent analogs were synthesized in which nucleotides near the thiol or bromide were replaced with flexible achiral linkers. Replacing the' 12 template nucleotides separating the bromide and thiol in either ofthe end-of-helix reactions with an achiral polyethylene glycol linker of similar length (72 bonds) resulted in the loss of stereoselectivity. Stereoselectivity was also abolished when flexible achiral linkers consisting of three or five consecutive methylene or ether oxygens were inserted between the 5' end ofthe template oligonucleotide and the thiol or bromide groups, or between the 3' end ofthe reagent oligonucleotide and the thiol or bromide. Chiral linkers between reactants, therefore, are required for stereoselectivity in this DNA- templated reaction. These results also suggest that both the thiol and the bromide participate in the rate-determining step ofthe reaction, consistent with an SN2 mechanism.
[0394] ' The known sensitivity of single- and double-stranded DNA conformations on distal base stacking or base pairing interactions suggests that groups distal from the bromide or thiol could play important roles in inducing stereoselectivity. To test these possibilities, 11 of the 12 template nucleotides closest to the 5' bromide were replaced in the end-of-helix reaction with chiral abasic phosphoribose linkers in which the aromatic base was replaced with a proton (Figure 40A). The exact structure ofthe end-of-helix template was the same as in Figure 39, except that bases 2-12 were replaced with abasic phosphoribose units (prepared from the conesponding phosphoramidite from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA). Even though the 5' thymidine nucleotide closest to the bromide was unchanged, the resulting reactions were not stereoselective, indicating that the nucleotide closest to the bromide was not sufficient to induce the observed stereoselectivity.
[0395] Each of the 11 missing aromatic bases from the 5' end were then restored (Figure
40B) and measured rates of (S)-bromide and (R)-bromide reaction for each resulting template. Surprisingly, no stereoselectivity was observed when up to five bases were restored.
Stereoselectivity increased steadily up to &SR = 4.3 when 6 through 11 bases were restored (Figure 40C). Restoration ofthe missing aromatic bases from the 3' end ofthe abasic region instead of from the 5' end also induced stbreoselectivity only after several bases were restored (five to 11 bases in this case) (Figure 40D). Collectively, these findings suggest that stereoselectivity arises from the conformation of nucleotides adjacent to either reactant, and that the conformation(s) leading to stereoselectivity require at least 5-6 consecutive aromatic bases.
[0396] This model of stereoselectivity predicts that global conformational changes in the template-reagent complex may alter stereoselectivity even if the covalent structure and absolute stereochemistry of all reactants were preserved. Double-stranded DNA sequences rich in (5-Me- C)G repeats can adopt a left-handed helix (Z-form) rather than the usual right-handed helix (B- form) at high salt concentrations (Rich et al. (1984) J. ANNU. REV. BIOCHEM. 53: 791-846; Behe et al. (1981) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 78: 1619-1623; Mao et al. (1999) NATURE 397: 144- 146). Bromide-linked (5-Me-C)G-rich hairpin templates and complementary thiol-linked reagents protected as unreactive disulfides were prepared. When combined in equimolar ratios, the circular dichroism (CD) spectra ofthe resulting template-reagent complexes in low salt (100 mM NaCI) were characteristic of B-form DNA (see, for example, Figure 42D). In the presence of high salt concentrations (5 M NaCI or 2.5 M Na2SO4), the same template-reagent complexes exhibited CD spectra representative of Z-form DNA. In contrast, the CD spectra of template- reagent complexes of normal sequence were representative of B-form DNA under both low salt and high salt conditions (see, for example, Figure 42C). [0397] The stereoselectivity of DNA-templated reactions between bromide-linked templates and thiol-linked reagents using either the mixed or (5-Me-C)G-rich sequences was examined in the presence of low or high salt concentrations. The mixed sequence templates and reagents (B-form DNA) in the presence of low or high salt concentrations favored the (S)- bromide by 4.3- or 3.2-fold, respectively (Figure 41 A). The (5-Me-C)G-rich template and reagent in low salt concentrations (B-form DNA) exhibited a 4.4-fold preference for reaction of the (S)-bromide (Figure 41A). Remarkably, repeating this reaction in the presence of high salt concentrations that induce Z-form DNA resulted in a 14-fold change in stereoselectivity now favoring the (R)-bromide by 3.2-fold ks/k^~ 0.31) (Figure 41B). This inversion of stereoselectivity as a result of changing the handedness ofthe DNA double helix is consistent with the theory implicating the conformation ofthe template and reagent in determining the stereoselectivity of this DNA-templated reaction. [0398] These experiments demonstrate that, stereoselectivity can be imparted during nucleic acid-templated organic synthesis. Conformations of DNA dependent on base stacking ' together with a partially constrained presentation of reactants appear to be responsible for the observed stereoselectivity. These experiments further demonstrate that a single structure with one absolute stereochefnistry can induce opposite istereoselectivities when its macromojecular conformation is altered. , , ' .' , ' ' , , . '
; ' V ' "1 . ' ■ ' < Oligonucleotides ' ". ' , .' ■ . ,
[0399] The exact structures ofthe templates, cpntaining mixed and (5 -Me-C)G-ri'ch , sequence, and their conesponding reagents used; are as fqllows: ' , Mixed sequence: >
Template: 5*-GAA TTC TGG AGA CTT AGC TAT TCA TCG AGC GTA CGC ' TCG ATG AAT AGC'-(CH2)3SH-3' [SEQ LD N0 86] ' ' ι
Reagent: 5'-BrCH(CH3)CONH-TAA GTG TCC AGA ATT C-3' [SEQ LD NO: 87]
(5-Me-C)G-rich sequence: , Template: 5*-GAA TTC C*GC* GC*G C*GC* AC*G C*GC* GC*G C*GG AGC
GTA CGC TCC* GC*G C*GC* GC*G-(CH )3SH-3' [SEQ LD NO: 88]
Reagent: 5'- BrCH(CH3)CONH-TGC* GC*G C*GC* GGA ATT-3' [SEQ LD NO:
89]
C* = 5-methyl cytosine. The thiols in both the mixed and (5-Me-C)G-rich sequences were protected as disulfides (-(CH2)3S-S(CH2)3OH) for circular dichroism measurements.
DNA Synthesis and Analysis
[0400] DNA oligonucleotides were synthesized on a PerSeptive Biosystems Expedite
8090 DNA synthesizer using standard phosphoramidite protocols and were purified by reverse phase HPLC with a triethylammonium acetate (TEAA)/CH3CN gradient. Oligonucleotides were quantitated by UV and by denaturing PAGE after staining with ethidium bromide. Quantitation of DNA by denaturing PAGE was performed with a Stratagene Eagle Eye II densitometer. Synthetically modified oligonucleotide analogs were incorporated using the conesponding phosphoramidites or controlled pore glass (CPG) beads purchased from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA . DNA Functionalization
[0401] 2-bromopropionamide-NJfS esters. 200 mg N-hydroxysuccinimide (Pierce,
Rockford, IL, USA) was dissolved in anhydrous CH2C1 together with 1.1 equivalents of 'a 2- bromopropionic acid (either racemic, (R)-, or (S)-) and 2 equivalents of l-(3- . dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbόdiimide (EDC) (Aldrich). The 2-bromopropionic acid enantiomers were >95% enantiopure as judged by chiral HPLC (5% isopropanol in hexanes, (R,R) WHELK Ol chiral phase, detection at 220 nm). The reaction was maintained at room temperature and complete after 1.5 hours as judged by TLC (EtOAc). The crude reaction mixture was extracted with 2.5% sodium hydrogen sulfate (ΝaHSO ) to remove the excess EDC. The organic phase was washed with brine, dried over magnesium sulfate (MgSO ), and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dried and used directly for DNA functionalization.
[0402] 5 '-functionalization of oligonucleotides. An NHS ester prepared as described above was dissolved in DMSO. Up to 150 μg of a 5 '-amino DNA oligonucleotide was combined with 3 mg/mL NHS ester (final reaction = 10% DMSO) in 200 mM sodium phosphate (pH = 7.2) at room temperature for 2 hours. The functionalized oligonucleotides were purified by gel filtration and reverse-phase HPLC, and were characterized by denaturing PAGE and MALDL-TOF mass spectrometry.
[0403] 3 '-thiol modified oligonucleotides. The 3' thiol group was incorporated by , standard automated DNA synthesis using 3'-disulfide-linked CPG (Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA). Following oligonucleotide synthesis, the disulfide was cleaved with 50 mM DTT, IM TAPS (pH = 8.0) at room temperature for 1 hour and purified by gel filtration before being used in DNA-templated reactions.
DNA-templated Reactions
[0404] Reactions were performed with 60 nM template and 60 nM reagent in 50 mM MOPS (pH = 7.5) and 250 mM NaCI at 25 °C unless otherwise specified. Reaction aliquots were removed at time points from 2 minutes to 120 minutes and quenched with excess β- mercaptoethanol. Starting materials and products were ethanol-precipitated from the quenched reaction mixtures, analyzed by denaturing PAGE, quantified as described above. Relative initial rates of product formation were determined from the fitting the raw yield vs. time data and were used to calculate k lk^. Representative data are shown in Figure 42. [0405] For the representative data sets shown in' Figure 42, the apparent second order rate constants derived from the initial rates are as follows:
[0406] Figures 39A and 42A
ΛR.app 1.94 x lO3 M'V1; ks,apP = 7.07 x 103 MrV; kacapp = 4.58 x 103 M"V
[0407] Figures 39B and 42B a p ,= 5-83 x 103 MV; £s,app = 21.9 x ,10J MV -ι„-ι;. '£rac,aPP = 13.6 x 10J M" ιs„-ι
[0408] Figures 42C and 44A, low salt: , , '. . kκ,m =.4.00 x W M -'ιV„-ι1; ks,apP = 17.6 x 10J M- 1ls_-1l;. %ac,app = 9.88 10J M -"1's-1
[0409] Figures 42C and 44A, high salt: PP = 5-95 x 103 MV; &s,aPP = 18.8 x lp3 NT's"1; fc^ = 10.8 x 103 M .
[0410] Figures 42D and 44B, low salt: ap = 6.11 x 103 MV; £s,app = 25.4 x 103 M ; krac,app = 12.1 x 103 M [0411] Figures 42D and 44B, high salt: kR,app = 24.6 x 103 M'V1; ks,apP = 7.66 x 103 M ; krac,app = 13.6 x 103 M'V1 Evaluating Bromide Stability
[0412] The structural and configurational stability ofthe bromides under the reaction conditions was confirmed by several independent methods. Each bromide-linked template or reagent oligonucleotide was pre-incubated for up to 72 hours at 25°C, and up to 48 hours at 37°C under the reaction conditions in the absence of thiol. Following the pre-incubation, stereoselectivity was measured as described above and always found to be unchanged as a result ofthe pre-incubation. In addition, large-scale (250 pmol) quantities of bromide-linked templates ((R), (S), and pseudo-racemic) were each incubated under the reaction conditions for 16 hours and analyzed by MALDI-TOF mass spectrometry. No evidence of bromide displacement (by water or by chloride) was observed as shown in Tables 11 and 12.
TABLE 11: End-of-helix template (expected mass = 7202.1)
Figure imgf000133_0001
Figure imgf000134_0002
[0413] Finally, small molecule analogs ofthe above bromide-linked DNAs (both enantiomers of N-methyl 2-bromopropionamide) were incubated for 16 hours under the reaction conditions and analyzed by chiral HPLC under conditions that resolve the (S)- and (R)- enantiomers. No change in retention time was observed.
Stereoselectivities Using Achiral Flexible Linkers
[0414] Figure 43 shows modified template or reagent structures that result in loss of stereoselectivity during DNA-templated SN2 reactions. In all cases,
Figure imgf000134_0001
values fell within the range of 0.95 to 1.09 (±0.09), which reflects the mean and standard deviation of at least three independent experiments. The exact structures ofthe templates containing achiral linkers and their conesponding reagents were as follows:
[0415] Figure 43A: Template 5,-BrCH(CH3)CONH-[(CH2)2O]2OPO3 '-{[(CH2)2O]6OPO3 '}3-GGT ACG
AAT TC-3' [SEQ LD NO: 90] . i ' . 134,. Reagent; 5'-GAA TTC GTA CC-(CHJ2)3SH-3? [SEQ LD NO: 91]
[0416] Figure 43B:
Template: 5'-GAA TTC GTA ' CN-(CH2)3OPO3--{[(CH2)2O]6OPO3-}3-(CH2)3SH-3'
[SEQ ID NO: 92]
1 Reagent: 5'- BrCH(CH3)CONH*TGT ACG AAT TC-3' [SEQ LD NO: ,93]
[0417] Figure 43C:
Template: ' 5'- BrCH(CH3)CONH-[(CII2)2O,]2OPO3--AC GCT CGC GAT GGT ACG AAT TC-3' [SEQ LD NO: '94] , '
Reagent: . 5 :GAA TTC GTA CC-(CH2)3SH-3' [SEQ LD NO: 95] [0418] Figure 43D:
, : , ' 1
Template: 5'-GAA TTC GTA CAT AGC GCT CGC A-(CH2 ,)3OPO3 _-(CH2)3SH-3' [SEQ LD NO: 96] '
Reagent: 5'- BrCH(CH3)CONH-TGT ACG AAT TC-3' [SEQ ID NO: 97] 1
[0419] Figure 43E: Template: 5'- BrCH(CH3)CONH-TAC GCT CGC GAT GGT ACG AAT TC-3'
[SEQ LD NO: 98]
Reagent: 5'-GAA TTC GTA CC-(CH2)3OPO3--(CH2)3SH-3 ' [SEQ LD NO: 99]
[0420] Figure 43F:
Template: 5'-GAA TTC GTA CAT AGC GCT CGC AT-(CH2)3SH-3 ' [SEQ LD NO: 100]
Reagent: 5'-BrCH(CH3)CONH-[(CH2)2O]2OPO3 "-TGT ACG AAT TC-3" [SEQ LD
NO: 101]
Circular Dichroism (CD) ofB-DNA andZ-DNA
[0421] The DNA templates and reagents were prepared as described above. Thiol-linked reagents were not deprotected and remained in their disulfide forms during CD analysis. CD samples contained 215 nM template and 215 nM protected reagent in 50 mM phosphate buffer (pH = 7.5) with either 100 mM or 5 M NaCI. A background sample lacking DNA was also prepared for each sample. The CD measurements were performed in a 1 mm path cuvette at
' ' , ' ' ' '
25 °C scanning from 3,60 nm to 200 nm'at 2 nm/sec on ύ. JASCO polarized spectrometer with a '
2.0 nm resolution. The resulting CD spectra, of B-form and Z-form template-reagent complexes are shown in Figure 44: Figure 44A shows circular dichroism (CD) spectra of template-reagent complex es'containing normal (mixed composition) sequences which are characteristic qf B—
DNA. Figu re 44B shows CD spectra of (5 -Me-C)G-rich complexes having a B-DN A conformation at low salt concentrations, and haying a Z-DNA conformation at high salt ' concentrations. Thp exact structures ofthe templates containing mixed and (5-Me-C)G-rich sequence, and their conesponding reagents used, ,are as follows: [0422] Mixed sequence:
Template: 5'-GAA TTC TGG ACA CTT AGC TAT TCA TCG AGC GTA CGC TCG ATG AAT AGC-(CH2)3SH-3' [SEQ LD NO: 102] I
(The thiol was protected as a disulfide [(CH2)3S-S(CH2)3OH]'for circular dichroism measurements). Reagent: 5'-BrCH(CH3)CONH-TAA GTG TCC AGA ATT C-3' [SEQ, LD NO: 103]
[0423] (5-Me-C)G-rich sequence:
Template: 5'-GAA TTC C*GC* GC*G C*GC* AC*G C*GC* GC*G C*GG AGC GTA CGC TCC* GC*G C*GC* GC*G-(CH2)3SH-3' [SEQ LD NO: 104]
(The thiol was protected as a disulfide [(CH2)3S-S(CH2)3OH]for circular dichroism measurements)
Reagent: 5'- BrCH(CH3)CONH-TGC* GC*G C*GC* GGA ATT-3' [SEQ LD NO:
105]
C* = 5-methyl cytosine
Stereoselectivity Induced by B-form and Z-form DNA [0424] Figure 45 shows a representative denaturing gel electrophoresis analysis of reactions using the CG-rich sequences at 100 mM NaCI (lanes 1-3) or at 5 M NaCI (lanes 4-6) (6 hour time point). Lanes 1 and 4: racemic bromide; lanes 2 and 5: (R)-bromide; lanes 3 and 6: (S)-bromide. The bromide-linked reagent is not visible. Similar results were observed using Na2SO4 instead of NaCI. DNA-templated Reactions in the Presence ofNa2S04 instead of NaCI
[0425] In order to ascertain that the observed stereoselectivities were not affected by the presence of chloride, the experiments shown in Figures 39 and 44 were repeated in the ptesence of Na2SO4 instead of NaCI (keeping the concentration of sodium constant). The results of three, independent trials were very similar to those reported in the presence of NaCI, and are as follows:
[0426] Figure 39A with Na2SO4 instead of NaCI: ks/kκ = 5.4 ± 0.5 [0427] ' Figure 39B with Na2SO4 instead ofNaCl: ^s ^R =3.9 ± 0.3 [0428] Figure 39C with Na2SO4 iristead of NaCI: ks/kR = 4.7 ± 0.7 [0429] Figure 44A, low salt with Na2SO instead of NaCI: ks/kR = 3.7 ± 0.7
[0430] Figure 44 A, high salt with Na2SO4 instead of NaCI: ks/kκ = 3.1 ± 0.6
[0431] Figure 44B, low salt with Na2SO4 instead of NaCI: kslkR = 3.6 ± 0.5
[0432] Figure 44B, high salt with Na2SO4 instead of NaCI: ks/fa = 0.25 ± 0.03
MALDI-TOF Mass Spectrometry of Representative Products [0433] ' The products from the representative DNA-templated reactions (240 pmol scale) in Figure 39 were purified by preparative denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis followed by extraction with 0.1 M triethylammonium acetate at 37 °C overnight. The lyophilized products were subjected to MALDI-TOF mass spectrometry, the results of which are summarized in Table 13. In all cases the observed mass is consistent with the expected mass. TABLE 13
Figure imgf000137_0001
Example 7: Directing Otherwise Incompatible Reactions in a Single Solution
[0434] This Example demonstrates, that .oligonucleotides can simultaneously direct several different synthetic reaction types within the same solution, even though the reactants involved would be cross-reactive and, therefore, incompatible under traditional synthesis conditions. These findings also demonstrate that it is possible to perform a one-pot ' diversification of synthetic library precursors into products using multiple, simultaneous and not necessarily ςompatible reaction types. ι
[0435] The ability of DNA templates' to mediate diversification using different reaction types without .spatial separation was initially tested by preparing three oligonucleotide templates of different DNA sequences (la-3a) functionalized at their 5' ends with maleimide groups and three oligonucleotide reagents (4a-6a) functionalized at their 3' ends with an amine, thiol, or nitroalkane group, respectively (Figure 46). The DNA sequences ofthe three reagents each , contained a different 10-base annealing region that was complementary to ten bases near the 5' end of each ofthe templates. Combining la with 4a, 2a with 5a, or 3a with 6a in three , separate vessels at pH 8.0 resulted in the expected DNA-templated amine conjugate addition, thiol' conjugate addition, or nitro-Michael addition products 7-9 (Figure 46, lanes 1-3).
[0436] To distinguish the nine possible reaction products that could be generated upon combining la-6a, the lengths of template oligonucleotides were varied to include 11, 17, or 23 bases and the lengths of reagent oligonucleotides were varied to include 14, 16, or 18 bases. Differences in oligonucleotide length were achieved using extensions distal from the reactive groups that did not significantly affect the efficiency of DNA-templated reactions. This design permitted all nine possible reaction products (linked to 25, 27, 29, 31, 33, 35, 37, 39, or 41 bases of DNA) to be distinguished by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis.
[0437] A solution containing all three templates (la-3a) was combined with a solution containing all three reagents (4a-6a) at pH 8.0. The resulting reaction exclusively generated the three desired products 7, 8, and 9 of lengths 25, 33, and 41 bases indicating that only the three reactions conesponding to the complementary template-reagent pairs took place (Figure 46, lane 4). Formation ofthe other six possible reaction products was not detected by densitometry (<5% reaction). In contrast, individually reacting templates and reagents containing the same, rather than different, 10-base annealing regions permitted the formation of all possible products
(Figure 46, lane 5). This result demonstrates the ability of DNA-templated synthesis to direct the selective one-pot transformation of a single functional group into three distinct types of products (in this Example, maleimide into secondary amine, thioether, or α-branched nitroalkane).
[0438] To test the ability of this diversification mode to support one-pot reactions requiring nόn-DNA-linked accessory reagents, an analogous experiment was conducted with two aldehyde-linked reagents either 14 or 16 bases in length (4b or 5b, respectively) and a complementary 11 -base amine-linked template (lb) or a 17-base phosphorane-liriked template (2b): Combining lb and 4b at pH 8.0 in, the presence of 3 mM NaBH3CN resulted in the DNA- templated reductive amination product 10, while 2b and 5b under the same conditions generated Wittig olefination product 11 (Figure 46). Mixing all four reactants together in one pot resulted in an identical product distribution as the combined individual Wittig olefination or reductive amination reactions (Figure 46)1 No reaction between amine lb and aldehyde 5b or between phosphorane 2b and aldehyde 4b was detected (Figure 46, lane 8 versus lane 9).
[0439] The generality of this approach was explored by including multiple reaction types that required different accessory reagents. Three amine-linked templates (lc-3c) of length 11, 17, or 23 bases were combined with an aldehyde-, carboxylic acid-, or maleimide-linked reagent (4c-6c) 14, 16, or 18 bases in length, respectively, at pH 8.0 in the presence of 3 mM NaBH3CN, 10 mM 1 -(3-dimethyl-aminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide (EDC), and 7.5 mM N- hydroxylsulfosuccinimide (sulfo-ΝHS). The reactions containing all six reactants afforded the same three reductive amination, amine acylation, or conjugate addition products (12-14) that were generated from the individual reactions containing one template and one reagent and did not produce detectable quantities ofthe six possible undesired products arising from non-DΝA- templated reactions (Figure 46, lanes 10-14). Collectively, these results indicate that DΝA- templated synthesis can direct simultaneous reactions between several mutually cross-reactive groups in a single pot to yield only the sequence-programmed subset of many possible products.
[0440] The above three examples each diversified a single functional group (maleimide, aldehyde, or amine) into products of different reaction types. A more general format for the one- pot diversification of a DΝA-templated synthetic library into products of multiple reaction types would involve the simultaneous reaction of different functional groups linked to both reagents and templates. To examine this possibility, six DΝA-linked nucleophile templates (15-20) and six DΝA-linked electrophile reagents (21-25) collectively encompassing all ofthe functional groups used in the above three examples (amine,1 aldehyde;, maleimide, carboxylic acid, nitroalkane, phosphorane, and thiol) werb prepared,(Figιire 47). These twelve DNA-linked reactants could,, in theory, undergo simultanepus amine conjugate addition, thiol, conjugate addition, nitro-Michael addition, reductive amination, amine acylation, arid Wittig olefination in the same pdt, although the apparent second order rate constants of these six reactions vary by more than 10-fold. ' . " ' , - , , , ,
[0441] i D etermin ' in'g th ' e out 'com :e of '■ co■'mbin 'ing a.ll tw. elve reagents and templates in a single pot by using oligonucleotides of varying lengths; is difficult due the large number (at least 28) of possible products that could be, generated. Accordingly, the length ofthe reagents as 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, or 40 bases were varied but the length ofthe templates was fixed at 11 bases (Figure 47). Each ofthe six complementary template-reagent pairs when reacted separately at pH 8.0 in the presence of 3 mM NaBH3CN; 10 m EDC, and 7.5 mM sulfo-NHS generated the expected amine conjugate addition, thiol conjugate addition, nitro-Michael addition, reductive amination,' amine acylation, or Wittig olefination products (Figure 47). Reaction efficiencies were greater than 50% relative to the conesponding individual reactions despite having to compromise between differing optimal reaction conditions. Templates 15-20 were also prepared in a 3'-biotinylated form. The biotinylated templates demonstrated reactivities indistinguishable from those of their non-biotinylated counterparts (Figure 47).
[0442] Six separate reactions each containing twelve reactants then were performed at pH 8.0 in the presence of 3 mM NaBH3CN, 10 mM EDC, and 7.5 mM sulfo-NHS (Figure 48). Each reaction contained a different biotinylated template (15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20) together with five non-biotinylated templates (from 15-20) and six reagents (21-25). These reactions were initiated by combining a solution containing 15-20 with a solution containing 21-25. The products that arose from each biotinylated template were captured with streptavidin-coated magnetic beads and identified by denaturing gel electrophoresis. Because the six reagents in each reaction contained oligonucleotides of unique lengths, the formation of any reaction products involving the biotinylated templates and any ofthe reagents could be detected. In all six cases, the biotinylated template formed only the single product programmed by its DNA sequence (Figure 48) despite the possibility of forming up to five other products in each reaction. Taken together, these findings indicate that reactions of significantly different rates requiring a variety of non-DNA-linked accessory reagents can be directed by DNA-templated synthesis in the same solution, even when both templates and reagents contain several different
. . . > .. cross7reactive functional groups. The ability of DNA templates to direct multiple reactions at concentrations that exclude non-templated reactions from proceeding at appreciable rates' mimics, in a single solution, a spatially separated set of reactions. . [0443] Compared to the use of traditional synthetic methods, generating libraries of small molecules by DNA-templated synthesis is limited by several factors including the need to prepare DNA-linked reagents, the restriction of aqueous, DNA-compatible chemistries,' and the reliance oμ characterization methods such as mass spectrometry and electrophoresis that are appropriate for molecular biology-scale (pg to μg) reactions. On the other hand, DNA-templated synthesis (i) allows the direct in vitro selection (as opposed to screening) and amplification of synthetic molecules with desired properties, (ii) permits the preparation of synthetic libraries of unprecedented diversity, and (iii) requires only minute quantities of material for selection and identification of active library members. In addition, this Example demonstrates that potentially useful modes of reactivity not possible using cunent synthetic methods can be achieved in a DNA-templated format. For example, six different types of reactions can be performed simultaneously in one solution, provided that required non-DNA-linked accessory reagents are compatible. This reaction mode permits the diversification of synthetic small molecule libraries using different reaction types in a single solution.
Materials and Methods Synthesis of Templates and Reagents
[0444] Oligonucleotides were synthesized using standard automated solid-phase techniques. Modified phosphoramidites and controlled-pore glass supports were obtained from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA. Unless otherwise noted, functionalized templates and reagents were synthesized by reacting 5'-H N(CH2O)2 terminated oligonucleotides (for templates) or 3 '-OPO3-CH2CH(CH2OH)(CH2) NH2 terminated oligonucleotides (for reagents) in a 9:1 mixture of aqueous 200 mM pH 7.2 sodium phosphate buffeπDMF containing 2 mg/mL of the appropriate N-hydroxysuccinimide ester (Pierce, Rockford, IL, USA) at 25 °C.
[0445] For the aldehyde and nitroalkane-linked oligonucleotides (4b, 4c, 5b, 6a, 17, 24, and 26, Figures 46 and 47) the NHS esters were generated by combining the appropriate carboxylic acid (900 mM in DMF) with equal volumes of dicyclohexylcarbodiimide (900 mM in DMF) and NHS (900 mM in DMF) for 90 minutes. Phosphorane-linked oligonucleotides (2b and.20, Figures 46 and 47) were prepared by a 90 minute reaction ofthe appropriate amino- terminated oligonucleotide with 0.1 voluiries of a 20 mg/mL DMF solution of the NHS ester of
I' . ' r . • ' ' ' ' iodoac'etic acid (SIA, Pierce, Rockford; IL, USA) in pH 7.2 buffer as above, followed by addition of 0.1 volumes of a 20 mg/mL solution of 4-diphenylphosρhinobenzoic acid in DMF. , Thiol-linked template 16 was synthesized by reacting ethylene glycol bis(succinimidylsuccinate) (EGS, Pierce, Rockford, IL, USA) with the appropriate oligonucleotide for 15 minutes, followed by addition of 0.1 volumes of 300 mM 2-aminoethanethiol. Reagent 5a was synthesized using
3'-OPO3-(CH2)3SS(CH2)3ODMT functionalized controlled-pore glass (CPG) support and reduced prior to use according to the manufacturer's protocol. [0446] The 3 '-biotinylated oligonucleotides were prepared using biotin-TEG CPG (Glen
Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA). Products arising from biotinylated templates were purified by mixing with 1.05 equivalents of streptaVidin-linked magnetic beads (Roche), washing twice with 4 M guanidinium hydrochloride, and eluting with aqueous 10 mM Tris pH 7.6 with 1 mM biotin at 80 °C. Synthesis of Linkers
[0447] Linkers between DNA oligonucleotides and the functional groups in 1 a-6c are as follows.' lb and lc: DNA-5'-NH2; la, 2a-2c, 3a, and 3c: DNA-5'-O(CH2)2O(CH2)2-NH-; 5a: DNA-3'-O-(CH2)3SH; 4a-4c, 5b, 5c, 6a, and 6c : DNA-3*-O-CH2CH(CH2OH)(CH2)4NH-. , Oligonucleotide sequences used to generate all possible products in Figure 46 (lanes 5, 9, and 14), with annealing regions underlined: R-TATCTACAGAG-3' [SEQ LD NO: 106] (la-lc); R- TATCTACAGAGTAGTCT-3' [SEQ LD NO: 107] (2a-2c); R-
TATCTACAGAGTAGTCTAATGAC-3' [SEQ ID NO: 108] (3a-3c); 5'-CAGCCTCTGTAGAT- R [SEQ LD NO: 109] (4a-4c); 5'-CTCAGCCTCTGTAGAT-R [SEQ LD NO: 110] (5a-5c); 5*- GGCTCAGCCTCTGTAGAT-R [SEQ LD NO: 111] (6a-6c). Functionalized templates and reagents were purified by gel filtration (Sephadex G-25) followed by reverse-phase HPLC (0.1 M triethylammonium acetate/acetonitrile gradient). Representative functionalized templates and reagents were further characterized by MALDI mass spectrometry.
Reaction Conditions [0448] All reactions were performed by dissolving reagents and templates in separate vessels in pure water before combining them into a solution of 50 mM aqueous TAPS buffer, pH 8.0, 250 mM NaCI at 25 °C for 16 hours with DNA-linked reactants at 60 nM (Figure 47) or at 12.5 nM (Figures 47 and 48). NaBH3CN, EDC, and sulfo-NHS were present when appropriate as described. Products were analyzed by denaturing polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis using ethidium bromide staining and UV transillumination.' Differences in charge states, attached functional groups, and partial secondary structure resulted in modest variations in gel mobility for differbnt functionalized oligonucleotides ofthe same length (Figures 46-48). ,
Example 8: DNA-Templated Functional Group Transformations '
[0449] , ', While coupling reactions' are useful for building molecular diversity, the development of DNA-templated functional group transformations can significantly expand the types of strucμires that can be generated. DNA-templated synthesis can be used to transform' functional groups by unmasking or interconverting functionalities used in coupling reactions. By exposing or creating a reactive group within a sequence-programmed subset of a library, DNA- templated functional group interconversions permit lib, rary diversity to be generated by sequential unmasking (Figure 49). In Figure 49, PG1 - PG3 represent three different protecting groups, arid A-F represent reactants capable of reacting with deprotected functionalities, of a scaffold molecule. The sequential unmasking approach offers the major advantage of permitting reactants that would normally lack the ability to be linked to DNA (for example, simple alkyl halides) to contribute to library diversity by reacting with a sequence-specified subset of templates in an intermolecular, non-templated reaction mode. This advantage significantly increases the types of structures that can be generated. On the other hand, sequential unmasking has the drawback of requiring more manipulations per "step" because previously used small molecule reactants must be removed between DNA-templated functional group unmaskings. This removal can be rapidly performed on the entire library using a simple gel filtration cartridge.
DNA-Templated Deprotection [0450] The first class of DNA-templated functional group transformations sequence- specifically unmask amine, thiol, alcohol, carboxylate, or aldehyde groups from protected forms.
In the Staudinger reaction, azides react with phosphines to yield aza-ylides (Staudinger et al.
(1919) HELV. CHIM. ACTA. 2: 635-646). When this reaction is performed in aqueous media, the aza-ylides undergo spontaneous hydrolysis to provide amines and phosphine oxides (Scriven et al. (1988) CHEM. REV. 88: 297-368). DNA-linked aryl and alkyl phosphine reagents, when combined with azide-linked DNA templates, permit sequence-specific amine deprotection (Figure 50A). DNA-linked phosphines and DNA-linked azides have both been used successfully in previous DNA-templated reactions. As an alternative DNA-templated amine
'' ■ r , ■ ' ' ' ' ' deprotection, the nucleophilic aromatic i/wo-substitution of o-nitrobenzenesulfonamides ' (prepared from amines and commercially available o-nitrobenzene sulfonylchloride) can yield . free amines, (Figure 50B). This reaction is known to proceed efficiently in the presence of deprotonated thiophenols, so at pH > 8 the DNA-templated attack of thiophenol-linked reagents on ø-nitrobenzenesulfonamide-linked templates can permit sequence-specific amine deprotection (Fukuyama et β/. (1999) SYNLETT 8: 1301-1303). ,, '
[0451] Once optimized, DNA-templated amine deprotection reactions can be extended to include deprotection reactions for alcohols and thiols. Kusumoto and co-workers have reported that 4-aminobutyryl esters undergo spontaneous intramolecular lactam formation to afford 2- pynolidinone and the liberated hydroxyl group in excellent yields (Kusumoto et al. (1986) BULL. CHEM. SOC. JPN. 59: 1296-1298). Kahne and co-workers have used this reaction effectively in aqueous media (Thomson et al. (1999) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 121: 1237-1244). A DNA-templated hydroxyl group deprotection is shown in Figure 50C. If lactam formation is slow, the reaction can be heated or Lewis acids can be added since sequence specificity is not required after amine deprotection. An analogous DNA-templated thiol deprotection that uses 4-azidobutyryl thioesters is shown in Figure 50C. It is contemplated that these groups will be stable to hydrolysis under a wide range of conditions. [0452] Palladium-mediated deallylation can also be used in DNA-templated carboxylate, amine, hydroxyl, or thiol deprotections. Allyloxycarbonyl (Alloc) esters, carbonates, thiocarbonates, and carbamates are treated with DNA-linked Pd ligands such as the 2, 2'- bis(diphenylphosphino)-l, l'-binaphthyl (BINAP) reagent as shown in Figure 50D (prepared from the known BINAP-6-butanoic acid) in the presence of pM to μM concentrations of water- soluble Pd sources such as Na2PdCl (Bayston et al (1998) J. ORG. CHEM. 63: 3137-3140). The DNA-linked Pd ligands increase the effective molarity of Pd at complementary templates, but not at mismatched templates, to permit the sequence-specific deprotection of carboxylate, hydroxyl, thiol, and amine groups from the conesponding Alloc esters, carbonates, thiocarbonates, and carbamates, respectively (Figure 50D) (Genet et al. (1994) TETRAHEDRON 50: 497-503). It is particularly encouraging that the rates of BINAP ligand dissociation from Pd have been measured during Pd-mediated aryl aminations and found to be much slower than the rates of association and dissociation of substrate and products (Singh et α/. (2002) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 124: 14104-1411,4). The Pd sourc and. ti e.pNA-linked Pd ligands can, be pre-incubated at high concentrati'ons, 'and then the resulting, complexes added either to complementary or mismatched templates, at 60 nM concentrations.1 This procedure also results in sequence-specific Alloc deprotection if ligand-metal dissociation' is slow relative to DNA annealing and P,d- catalyzed deallylation. . .. , , , , ,
[0453] , Finally, transition metal salts including Sc and Yb are known to catalyze acetal hydrolysis to yield aldehydes (Fukuzawa t α^ (2001) CHEM. LETT! 5: 430-436). ' Conjugating the crown ether shown in Figure 50E to oligonucleotides permits DNA-templated ' aldehyde deprotections in the presence of lanthanide triflates. These crown ether-Ln3+ complexes have been previously reported to catalyze aqueous aldol reactions while completely sequestering one equivalent of Ln ι+ (Kobaya ' 'sh 'i et a ' l (2001) ORG. LETT. 3). Aldehyde deprotection is' highly sequence-specific because the co ' ncentrati •on of free Ln 3+ should be ' l ' negligible. DNA-Templated Functional Group Interconversions <
[0454] The second class of DNA-templated functional group transformations interconverts groups generated from or used by DNA-templated reactions. Two functional group interconversions are shown in Figure 51. Ruthenium(II) porphyrins in the presence of 2,6- disubstituted pyridine N-oxides catalyze the remarkably efficient epoxidation of a wide variety of simple and electron-deficient olefins (Higuchi et al. (1989) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 30: 6545- 6548; Groves et al. (1985) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 107: 5790-5792; Zhang et al. (2002) ORG. LETT. 4: 1911-1914; Yu et al. (2000) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 122: 5337-5342). Single-stranded DNA is stable in the presence of aqueous tetrakis(4-carboxyphenyl) porphyrin complexed with Ru(II), and Ru(II)-DNA conjugates have been previously reported (Hartmann et al. (1997) J. BIOL. INORG. CHEM. 2: 427-432; Pascaly et al (2002) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 124: 9083-9092). DNA- templated olefin epoxidations using DNA-linked Ru(II) porphyrin catalysts are shown in Figure 51 A, which are prepared by coupling commercially available tetrakis(4-carboxyphenyl) porphyrin to amine-terminated oligonucleotides (Holmlin et al. (1999) BIOCONJUG. CHEM. 10: 1122-1130). The resulting DNA-linked porphyrin is metalated with Ru3(CO)12 as described previously to afford the reagent shown in Figure 51 A. This functional group interconversion bridges several versatile reactions by permitting products of DNA-templated Wittig olefmations and Heck couplings to become substrates for epoxide addition reactions.
! ,
[0455] , As a second functional group interconversion, lanthanide triflate-catalyzed aqueous Diels-Alder and hetero Diels- Alder cycloadditions proceed efficiently in water, and ' DNA-linked Lewis acid chelators such as binapthol, bis-trifylamides, or the crown ether shown in Figure 50E permit the sequence-specific Diels-Alder reaction between a template-linked aldehyde and a free diene in solution (Figure 51B). When Danishefsky's diene is used, this functional group transformation provides α,β-unsaturated ketones that serve as substrates for subsequent DNA-templated conjugate addition reactions. Fully coordinated Ln complexes (such as those that arise from the crown ether) have been reported to be kinetically stable yet permit efficient catalysis through facile ligand exchange (Chappell et al. (1998) INORG. CHEM.
37: 3989-3998). Moreover, DNA-linked lanthanide complexes have been previously used as stable luminescent agents in aqueous solutions and, therefore, these complexes are compatible with the functionality present in DNA (Li et al (1997) BIOCONJUG. CHEM. 8: 127-132). Example 9: Synthesis of Exemplary Compounds and Libraries of Compounds
A) Synthesis of a Polycarbamate Library
[0456] This Example demonstrates a strategy for producing an amplifiable polycarbamate library.
Overview [0457] Ofthe sixteen possible dinucleotide codons used to encode the library, one is assigned a start codon function, and one is assigned to serve as a stop codon. An artificial genetic code then is created assigning each ofthe up to 14 remaining dinucleotides to a different monomer. For geometric reasons one monomer actually contains a dicarbamate containing two side chains. Within each monomer, the dicarbamate is attached to the conesponding dinucleotide (analogous to a fRNA anticodon) through a silyl enol ether linker which liberates the native DNA and the free carbamate upon treatment with fluoride.
[0458] The dinucleotide moiety exists as the activated 5 '-2-methylimidazole phosphate, that has been demonstrated to serve as an excellent leaving group for template-directed oligomerization of nucleotides yet is relatively stable under neutral or basic aqueous conditions (Inoue et al. (1982) J. MOL. BIOL. 162: 201; Rembold et al. (1994) J. MOL. EVOL. 38: 205; Chen et al (1985) J. MOL. BIOL. 181: 271; Acevedo et al. (1987) J. MOL. BIOL. 197: 187; Inoue et al. (1981) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 103: 7666; Schwartz et ώ. (1985) SCIENCE 228: 585). The dicarbamate' moiety exists in a cyclic form linked through a vinyloxycarbonate linker. The vinylcarbonate group has been demonstrated to be stable in neutral or basic aqueous conditions and further has been sbown to provide carbamates in very high yields upon the addition of amines Olόfson et al. (197,7) TETRAHEDRON LETT, 18: 1563; Olofson et al. (1977) ,
TETRAHEDRON -LETT. 18: 1567; Olofson et α/:l (1977)'TETRAHEDRθN LETT. 1,8: 1571). , '
[0459] , When attacked by an amine from a nascent polycarbamate chain, the vmyl , carbonate' linker, driven by the aromatization, of m-cresol, liberates a free amine. This free amine subsequently serves as the nucleophile to attack the next vinyloxycarbonate, propagating the polymerization ofthe growing carbamate chain. Such a strategy minimizes the potential for cross-reactivity and bi-directional polymerization by ensuring that only one nucleophile is present at any time during polymerization.. , ι
[0460] Using the monomer described above, artificial translation of DNA into a polycarbari a'te can be viewed as a three-stage process. In the first stage, single stranded DNA templates encoding the library are used to guide the assembly ofthe dinucleotide moieties, ofthe monomers, terminating with the "stop" monomer which possesses a 3 'methyl ether instead of a 3 'hydroxyl group (Figure 52).
[0461] Once the nucleotides have assembled, the' "start" monomer ending in a o- nitrobenzylcarbamates is photodeprotected to reveal the primary amine that initiates carbamate polymerization. Polymerization proceeds in the 5' to 3' direction along the DNA backbone, with each nucleophilic attack resulting in the subsequent unmasking of a new amine nucleophile. Attack ofthe "stop" monomer liberates an acetamide rather than an amine, thereby terminating polymerization (Figure 53). Because the DNA at this stage exists in a stable double-stranded form, variables such as temperature and pH may be explored to optimize polymerization efficiency.
[0462] Following polymerization, the polycarbamate can be cleaved from the phosphate backbone ofthe DNA upon treatment with fluoride. Desilylation ofthe enol ether linker and the elimination ofthe phosphate driven by the resulting release of phenol provides the polycarbamate covalently linked at its carboxy terminus to its encoding single-stranded DNA (Figure 54). [0463] At this stage, the polycarbamate may be. completely liberated from the DNA by base hydrolysis ofthe, ester linkage. The liberated polycarbamate can be purified by HPLC and retested to verify that its desired, properties are intact: The free DNA can be amplified using PCR, mutated with enor-prone PCR (Cadwell et al. (1992) PCR METHODS APPL. 2: 28) or DNA shuffling (Stemmer (1994) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 91: 10747; Stemmer (1994) NATURE 370: 389; U-S. 'Patent 5,811,238), and/or sequenced to reveal the primary structure ofthe ' polycarbamate polymer. ' . ' ' " , ' ' ' ' '
Synthesis of monomer units , ; ', ,. •
[0464] After the monomers are synthesized, the assembly and polymerization ofthe monomers on the DNA scaffold should occur spontaneously. Shikimic acid 1, available commercially, biosynthetically (Davis (1955) ADV. ENZYMOL. 16: 287), or by short syntheses from D-mannose (Fleet e,t al. (1984) J. CHEM. SpC 905; Harvey et aL (1991) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 32:14111), serves as a convenient starting point for the monomer synthesis. The syn hydroxyl groups are protected as the/?-meth'oxybenzylidene, and remaining hydroxyl groμp as the tert-butyldimethylsilyl ether to afford 2. The carboxylate moiety ofthe protected shikimic acid then is completely reduced by lithium aluminum hydride (LAH) reduction, tosylation ofthe resulting alcohol, and further reduction with LAH to provide 3.
Figure imgf000148_0001
[0465] Commercially available and synthetically accessible N-protected amino acids can serve as the starting materials for the dicarbamate moiety of each monomer. Reactive side chains are protected as photolabile ethers, esters, acetals, carbamates, or thioethers. Using chemistry previously developed (Cho et al. (1993) SCIENCE 261: 1303), a desired amino acid 4 is converted to the conesponding amino alcohol 5 by mixed anhydride formation with isobutylchloroformate followed by reduction with sodium borohydride. The amino alcohol then is converted to the activated carbonate by treatment with -nitrophenylchloroformate to afford 6, which then is coupled to a second amino alcohol 7 to provide, following hydroxyl group silylation and FMOC deprotection, carbamate 8. ,
Figure imgf000149_0001
[0466] Coupling of carbamate 8 onto the shikimic acid-derived linker proceeds as follows. The allylic hydroxyl group of 3 is deprotected with tetra-butylammonium fluoride (TBAF), treated with triflic anhydride to form the secondary triflate, then displaced with aminocarbamate 8 to afford 9. Presence ofthe vinylic methyl group in 3 should assist in minimizing the amount of undesired product resulting from S 2' addition (Magid (1980) TETRAHEDRON 36: 1901). Michael additions of deprotonated carbamates to α,|3-unsaturated esters have been well documented (Collado et al. (1994) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 35: 8037; Hirama et al. (1985) J. AM. CHEM. SOC 107: 1797; Nagasaka et al (1989) HETEROCYCLES 29: 155; Shishido et al (1987) J. CHEM. SOC. 993; Hirama et al (1989) HETEROCYCLES 28: 1229). By analogy, the secondary amine is protected as the o-nitrobenzyl carbamate (NBOC), and the resulting compound is deprotonated at the carbamate nitrogen. This deprotonation can typically be performed with either sodium hydride or potassium tert-butyloxide (Collado et al. (1994) supra; Hirama et al. (1985) supra; Nagasaka et al (1989) supra; Shishido et al. (1987) supra; Hirama et al. (1989) supra), although other bases may be utilized to minimize deprotonation of the nitrobenzylic protons. Additions ofthe deprotonated carbamate to o;ι8-unsaturated ketone 10, followed by trapping ofthe resulting enolate with tert-butyldimethyl silyl chloride (TBSC1), should afford silyl enol ether 11. The previously found stereoselectivity of conjugate additions to 5-substituted enones such as 10 (House et al. (1968) J. ORG. CHEM. 33: 949; Still et al. (1981) TETRAHEDRON 37: 3981) suggests that 11 should be formed preferentially over its diastereomer. Ketone 10, the precursor to the fluoride-cleavable carbamate-phosphate linker, may be synthesized from 2 by one pot decarboxylation (Baijton et al. (1985) TETRAHEDRON 41 : 3?01) followed by treatment with tefrabutylamriioriium fluoride (TBAF), Swern oxidation ofthe resulting alcohol to afford 12, deprotection with 2, 3-dichlόro-5, 6-dicyam l, 4-benzoquinone (DDQ), selective nitrobenzyl ether formation of the less-hindered alcohol, and reduction ofthe α-hydroxyl' group with samarium iodide (Molarider (1994) ORGANIC REACTIONS 46: 211).
Figure imgf000150_0001
[0467] The -methoxybenzylidiene group of 11 is transformed into the α-hydroxy p- methoxybenzyl (PMB) ether using sodium cyanoborohydride and trimethylsilyl chloride
(TMSC1) (Johansson et al (1984) J. CHEM. SOC. 2371) and the TES group deprotected with 2% HF (conditions that should not affect the TBS ether (Boschelli et al. (1985) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 26: 5239)) to provide 13. The PMB group, following precedent (Johansson et al. (1984) J. CHEM. SOC. 2371; Sutherlin et al. (1993) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 34: 4897), should remain on the more hindered secondary alcohol. The two free hydroxyl groups may be macrocyclized by very slow addition of 13 to a solution of j-nitrophenyl chloroformate (or another phosgene analog), providing 14. The PMB ether is deprotected, and the resulting alcohol is converted into a triflate and eliminated under kinetic conditions with a sterically hindered base to afford vinyloxycarbonate 15. Photodeprotection ofthe nitrobenzyl either and nitrobenzyl carbamate yields alcohol 16.
Figure imgf000151_0001
[0468] The monomer synthesis is completed by the sequential coupling of three components. Chlorodiisopropylaminophosphine 17 is synthesized by the reaction of PC13 with diisopropylamine (King et al. (1984) J. ORG. CHEM. 49: 1784). Resin-bound (or 3'-o- nifrobenzylether protected) nucleoside 18 is coupled to 17 to afford phosphoramidite 19. Subsequent coupling of 19 with the nucleoside 20 (Inoue et al. (1981 ) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 103 : 7666) provides 21. Alcohol 16 then is reacted with 21 to yield, after careful oxidation using m- chloroperbenzioc acid (MCPBA) or I2 followed by cleavage from the resin (or photodeprotection), the completed monomer 22. This strategy of sequential coupling of 17 with alcohols has been successfully used to generate phosphates bearing three different alkoxy substituents in excellent yields (Bannwarth et al. (1987) HELV. CHIM. ACTA 70: 175).
Figure imgf000152_0001
[0469] The unique start and stop monomers used to initiate and terminate carbamate polymerization may be synthesized by simple modification of the above scheme. B) Macrocyclic Fumaramide Library
[0470] This Example demonstrates that DNA templated-synthesis can be used to create a library of small molecules. In particular, it has been possible to create a DNA-templated macrocyclic fumaramide library as shown in Figure 55.
[0471] The library synthesis scheme employs robust DNA-templated amine acylation and intramolecular Wittig olefination reactions to generate diverse and partially rigid macrocyclic ramaramides. The fumaramide group is stable to neutral solutions but is sufficiently electrophilic to covalently capture nucleophiles when presented at elevated effective molarities. Nucleophilic side chains found in target protein active sites may, therefore, be covalently trapped by the fumaramide functionality. The key steps in the library synthesis are (i) DNA-templated amine acylation using the sulfone linker, (ii) DNA-templated amine acylation using the diol linker, (Hi), DNA-templated amine acylation using a phosphorane linker, and (iv) intramolecular Wittig olefinaton to afford macrocyclic fumaramides linked to their conesponding DNA templates (Figure 55). [0472] Macrocyclization is potentially the most challenging step ofthe library synthesis.
To test this, seven model step 3 substrates were prepared to validate the third DNA-templated i' . v ' . • • ' ' ' step arid the subsequent macrocyclizatiori (Figure 56). Each substrate contained a variety of Ri and R2 groups of varying steric hindrances, stereochemistries, and backbone chain lengths. The model substrates were each mixed with one of four biotinylated DNA-linked reagents containing both a carboxylic acid and a phosphorane under DNA-templated amine acylation conditions. To evaluate both amide bond formation and Wittig macrocyclization, a two-stage purification 'strategy was implemented. The ten products ofthe DNA-templated amine acylation (Figure 56 and step 3 in Figure 55) were purified away from unreacted templates by capture with streptavidin- linked magnetic beads. The captured intermediates then were treated with pH 8.0 buffer to induce Wittig olefination-mediated macrocyclization. Macrocyclization created the fumaramide products (lacking the biotinylated reagent oligonucleotide) to self-elute from the magnetic beads. In every case, amine acylation and macrocyclization proceeded efficiently (Figure 56) despite the wide range of steric, stereochemical, and backbone diversity in the intermediates. Control reactions at pH < 6 (too low to form the phosphorane), or at pH 8.0 but lacking the aldehyde group, failed to elute any product. In summary, the DNA-templated amine acylation- Wittig macrocyclization sequence is a highly efficient route to produce desired macrocyclic fumaramides.
[0473] After validating the macrocylization step, a DNA-templated macrocyclic fumaramide library was synthesized. The pilot library was restricted to 83 macrocyclic fumaramides containing 4 x 4 x 5 = 80 macrocycles plus three macrocycles containing either an aryl sulfonamide, a desthiobiotin group, or both groups as positive controls for binding to carbonic anhydrase or avidin. Reagent oligonucleotides consisted ofthe six-base codons flanked by two constant bases on either side conjugated at their 3' ends to aminoacyl donors through the sulfone, diol, or phosphorane linker as previously reported. Multi-μg quantities of each ofthe 19 DNA-linked amine acylation reagents shown in Figure 57 were created in a single day starting from commercially available free amino acids, linker precursors, and reagent oligonucleotides as described previously. The building blocks were chosen to sample structural and functional group diversity and include (L) and (D) α-amino acids, α,α'-disubstituted amino acids, and β- amino acids bearing alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, polar, heterocyclic, negatively charged, and positively charged side chains (Figure 57). Each ofthe 19 reagents was successfully tested in single template reactions and generated product with < 30% variance in efficiency. All 19 reagents reacted with high sequence-specificity, generating no significant product with mismatched teriiplates even when five equivalents of r'eagent were used. '
[0474] , The macrocyclic fumaramide-encoding template library was prepared from modular coding region cassettes in a single solution (Figure 58). Oligonucleotides representing all reagent annealing regions were combined together with T4 DNA ligase in a single solution. Due to the sequence design ofthe oligonucleotide termini, the desired assembled template library is the only possible product when the ligation is complete. Excellent yields ofthe desired template library resulted from a 4 hour ligation reaction. Following ligation, T7 exonuclease was added to degrade the non-coding template strand (the desired coding strand is protected by its non-natural 5'-aminoethylene glycol linker). This procedure provided 20 nmol ofthe 5' functionalized single-stranded template library in 6 hours. The constant 10-base primer binding regions at the ends of each template were sufficient to permit PCR amplification of as few as 1,000 molecules (10"21 mol) of template from this assembled material. Three positive control templates were added to produce a library containing 83 templates which were then combined with 3.0 equivalents of five step 1 reagents to produce the first library synthesis step. Products were purified as described above, then subjected to the second DNA-templated library synthesis step with five new reagents complementing the step 2 coding regions. The efficiency of both DNA-templated pilot library steps was judged to exceed 70% by denaturing gel electrophoresis and densitometry. [0475] As a model for the deprotection prior to step 3, the Pd-mediated deprotection of
DNA-linked Alloc carbamates was executed with excellent efficiency as judged by the liberation of ~1 equivalent of free amine groups. The products from each library synthesis step were analyzed by mass spectrometry. In the hope of eliminating the deprotection step, the necessity of protecting and deprotecting the side chain amine in the starting material was tested because the lower pKa ofthe α-amine may permit selective reaction ofthe α-amine at a pH that ensures protonation ofthe side chain amine. It was found that the α-amine group indeed could be selectively and efficiently acylated in a DNA-templated reaction in the presence of unprotected side-chain amine at pH 6.0. This may eliminate the need for a deprotection step following the second DNA-templated amide formation in step 2. [0476] Several model substrates then were synthesized to validate the third DNA- templated step and the subsequent macrocyclization. Each model substrate consisted of a template-linked intermediate containing a free amine group and a diol linker separated by varying numbers of bonds to simulate groups pf, differing, sizes during library synthesis.' The ' model substrates were each mixed with one 'of several biotinylated DNA-linked reagents containing both a carboxylic acid and a phosphorane under DNA-templated amide formation conditions' (pH 6.0, 0 mM EDC, 15 mM sulfo-NHS). DNA-templated amide formatiqn proceeded in >60% yields and products were'1 captured with avidin-linked magnetic beads. Bead- bound product was treated with 10 mM NaIO4 at pH 8.5'to effect diol cleavage. The resulting aldehyde group reacted with the phosphorane in a spontaneous Wittig olefination reaction to furnish a cyclic fumaramide, free from the biotin group, that self-elutes from the ayidin-linked , beads (Figure 59). Importantly, all ofthe model substrates under went macrocyclization in
>60% yield, suggesting that this reaction is tolerant of a variety of substrate geometries. Control reactions confirmed that fumaramide formation was dependent on (i) periodate cleavage, (ii) the presence of the phosphorane group, and (iii) successful DNA-templated amide formation '
(required for capture onto avidin-linked beads). C) PNA Polymer Library Formation
[0477] Despite significant successes, the generality and sequence-specificity of template- directed polymerization is still largely unexplored. For example, the efficient and sequencp- specific templated polymerization of easily functionalized synthetic monomers lacking a ribose backbone has not been reported. Such a system would raise the possibility of evolving polymers comprised of these synthetic monomers through iterated cycles of translation (polymerization), selection, and amplification presently available only to DNA, RNA, and proteins.
[0478] The minimal requirements of a system for synthetic polymer evolution are: (i) distance-dependent nucleic acid-templated monomer coupling reactions to ensure that oligomerization proceeds exclusively between adjacently annealed monomers; (ii) efficient nucleic acid-templated oligomerization to provide sufficient yields of full-length products for in vitro selections; (iii) stable linkage of each synthetic polymer to its encoding template to ensure the survival ofthe appropriate template during polymer selection; and (iv) a readily functionalized synthetic monomer backbone to introduce tailor made functionality into the polymer. [0479] In order to test the feasibility of producing polymers by DNA templated synthesis,
DNA-templated amine acylation, Wittig olefination, reductive amination, and olefin metathesis reactions were tested for their ability to translate DNA sequences into functionalized peptide nucleic acid (PNA) polymers. The proposed PNA monomers are stable and can be easily synthesized from commercially available α-amino acids containing a wide variety of functional groups (Haaima et al. (1996) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. ENGL. 35: 1939-1942; Puschl et al. (1998) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 39: 4707). PNAs containing functionalized side chains are known to retain their ability to hybridize to DNA sequence-specifically (Haaima et al. (1996) supra; Puschl et al. ' (199%) supra). , ' ' [0480] , In the first strategy, PNA serves as the backbone ofthe functional polymer and displays the functional groups of each monomer. In another strategy, the DNA-templated PNA polymerizations organize reactive functional groups, enabling a second polymerization reaction between these functional groups (for example, an olefin metathesis or Wittig olefination reaction) to form the synthetic polymer backbone of interest.
[0481] In both strategies templates consist of 5'- functionalized, single-stranded DNA libraries 50-200 bases long that contain a central region of variable bases. These templates are made by standard solid-phase oligonucleotide synthesis combined with enzyme-catalyzed ligation for longer templates. Monomer structures are chosen to provide chemical functionalities includirig (i) Brønsted acidic and basic groups, (ii) nucleophilic and electrophilic groups, (iii) conjugated olefins suitable for post-PNA polymerization metathesis, and (iv) metal-binding groups capable of forming complexes with chemically potent transition metals. Representative monomer structures containing these functionalities are shown in Figure 60. The DNA bases encoding each monomer (the "genetic code" of these polymers) are chosen from the examples shown in Table 10 to preclude the possibility of out-of-frame annealing. These genetic codes should prevent undesired frameshifted DNA-templated polymer translation.
[0482] Libraries of 5'-functionalized hairpin DNA templates containing up to 1015 different sequences are combined with sets of monomers under conditions that optimize the efficiency and sequence fidelity of each DNA-templated polymerization. Synthetic polymer strands then are de-annealed from their DNA templates by denaturation, and the 3' DNA haiφin primer extended using DNA polymerase to generate hairpin DNA templates linked to now liberated single-stranded synthetic polymers (Figure 61). Libraries are characterized by gel electrophoresis and MALDI mass spectrometry, and individual representative library members are also characterized from single template reactions to confirm expected reaction efficiencies. [0483] Once the libraries of DNA-linked' PNAs are characterized, they can be subjected
' . .'. ' ' ' ,' ' . ' to three types of tn vttrø selections for: (i) folding, (ii) target binding, or (iii) catalysis. Prior to ' selection, polymers with anticipated mέtal binding ability are incubated with one or more water- compatible metal sources. Selections for folding are performed using the gel electrophoresis selection described iri Example 10. Polymers capable of folding in the presence, but nof in the absence, of nietals serve as especially attractive starting points for the next tw,o types of , selections. ■ ' ' ' ' '
[0484] Selections for target binding can be conducted by incubating the solution-phase polymer library with either immobilized target or with biotinylated target followed by , streptavidin-linked beads. Non-binders are removed by washing, and polymers with desired binding properties are eluted by chemical denaturation or by adding excess authentic free ligand. To complete one cycle of functionalized PNA evQlutiori, the DNA templates conesponding to the desired'PNA library members are amplified by PCR using one primer containing the 5'- functionalized haiφin primer and a biotinylated second primer, optionally diversified by enor- prone PCR (Caldwell et al. (1992) PCR METHODS APPLIC. 2: 28-33), and then denatured into single stranded DNA and washed with streptavidin beads to remove the non-coding template strand. The resulting pool of selected single-stranded, 5 '-functionalized DNA completes the evolution cycle and enters subsequent rounds of DNA-templated translation, selection, diversification, and amplification. [0485] Selection for synthetic polymers that catalyze bond-forming or bond-cleaving reactions can also be performed. To select for bond-forming catalysts (for example, hetero Diels-Alder, Heck coupling, aldol reaction, or olefin metathesis catalysts), functionalized PNA library members are covalently linked to one substrate through their 5' haiφin termini. The other substrate ofthe reaction is synthesized as a derivative linked to biotin. When dilute solutions of library-substrate conjugate are reacted with the substrate-biotin conjugate, those library members that catalyze bond formation induce self-biotinylation. Active bond forming catalysts then are separated from inactive library members by capturing the former with immobilized streptavidin. In an analogous manner, functionalized PNAs that catalyze bond cleavage reactions such as retro-aldol reactions, amide hydrolysis, elimination reactions, or olefin dihydroxylation followed by sodium periodate cleavage can also be selected. In this case, library members are linked to biotinylated substrates such that the bond breakage reaction causes the disconnection ofthe biotin moiety from the library members. Active catalysts self-elute from streptavidin-linked beads while inactive catalysts remain bound.
Validatipn of PNA Polymer Library Formation
[0486] Peptide nucleic acids (PNAs) are attractive 'candidates for synthetic polymer ' evolution because of their known ability to bind DNA sequence-specifically, and their simple preparation from synthetically accessible amino acids. Previous efforts to oligomerize PNAs-on DNA or RNA templates have used amine acylation as the coupling reaction and proceeded with mqdest efficiency and sequence specificity (Bohler et al. (1995) NATURE 376: 578-581; Schmidt et al. (1997) NUC. ACIDS RES. 25: 4792-4796). When five PNA tetramers were combined using a variety of aqueous amine acylation conditions in the presence of DNA templates containing complementary 20-base annealing regions, only modest formation (<20% yield) of full-length PNAs, representing five successive coupling reactions, were observed. Even more problematic, however, was the formation of higher molecular weight products indepe ndent ofthe position of a mismatched 4-base'annealing region in the template. These observations indicate that PNAs are able to couple using amine acylation chemistry even when not adjacently annealed, leading to an unpredictable mixture of products.
[0487] It was contemplated that the distance independence previously observed in DNA- templated amine acylation reactions was the origin ofthe poor regiospecificity of amine acylation-mediated PNA couplings. This Example shows that it is possible to overcome this problem by replacing the distance independent amine acylation reaction with a distance dependent DNA-templated reaction, such as a reductive amination reaction.
[0488] In order to test this, a thymine-containing PNA monomer amino aldehyde was synthesized and coupled to threonine-linked resin following the method of Ede and Bray (Ede et al. (1997) TETRAHEDRON LETTERS 38, 7119-7122). Standard FMOC peptide synthesis was used to extend the peptide by three PNA monomers (final sequence: NH2-gact-CHO), and aqueous acidic cleavage from the resin yielded the desired tetrameric peptide aldehyde 1 (Figure 62).
[0489] A DNA template containing a 5'-amine-terminated haiφin and five successive repeats ofthe "codon" complementary to 1 (5'-AGTC-3') was combined with 8 μM 1 in aqueous pH 8.5 buffer. The reactants were annealed (95°C to 25°C) and NaCNBH3 was added to 80 mM. The reactions were quenched by buffer 'exchange with a Sephadex column, and subjected to denaturation (95°C for 10 rhinutes, in 50% fbrmamide) and 15% denaturing PAGE: In Figure 62, lanes i1 and 2 show, that the starting template was almost entirely consumed, and the higher molecular weight product was formed in >90% yield. Gel purification ofthe product following removal ofthe DNA template with DNase I and MALDI-TOF mass spectrometry confirmed full-length pentamer of the'gact PNA aldehyde.. This result indicates that DNA- ' ' templated reductive amination can mediate the highly efficient oligomerization of PNA ' aldehydes, , ' ' , . ■ .
[0490] In order to examine the regio- and sequence-specificity of this reaction, the oligomerization reactions were repeated using a variety of template sequences. When a mismatched DNA template codon (5'-ATGC-3') was introduced at the second, third, fourth, or fifth 4-base, coding region (i.e., the codon) of the, template, highly efficient formation of products conesponding to the coupling of exactly one, two, three, or four copies of 1, respectively, was observed (see, Figure 62, lanes 4-14). Wheri the mismatched codon was placed at only the first coding position, or at all five coding positions, no product formation was observed (see, Figure 62, lanes 3 and 15). The termination of oligomerization at the first mismatched codon in every case indicates that the DNA-templated PNA aldehyde coupling requires functional group , adjacency (i.e., is highly distance dependent), and, therefore, is ideally suited for templated polymerization. [0491] The sequence specificity of this system was probed by performing oligomerization experiments using DNA templates containing eight different mismatched codons (ATTC, ATGC, ATCC, AGGC, AGCC, ACTC, ACGC, or ACCC) in the third coding region. Even though four of these codons differ from the matched sequence (ATGC) in only one base, in each case only two copies of 1 were coupled to the template (see Figure 62, lanes 5-12). This high degree of sequence specificity raises the possibility that libraries of different DNA sequences may be faithfully translated into libraries of conesponding polymers using this system, analogous to DNA-templated small molecule synthesis.
[0492] It is contemplated that synthetic polymers with desired properties (e.g., binding or catalytic properties) may require lengths beyond those previously achieved efficiently using nucleic acid-templated synthesis. In order to test the ability ofthe above system to generate longer polymers in an efficient and sequence-specific manner, DNA templates were translated with 40-base coding regions encoding ten repeats ofthe, above matched or mismatched codon into conesponding PNA aldehyde polyrhers: Polymerizations were carried out as in Figure 62,' except that the PNA peptide aldehyde 'concentration Was 16 μM and the reaction time with NaCNBH3 was 15 minutes. The results of these experiments are shown in Figure 63, where the lanes alternate between template (withmismatch at indicated position) and reactions (tejmplate plus the gact monomer). As Figure 63 illustrates, both denaturing PAGE and MALDI-TOF ' mass spectrometry revealed a single predominant product Conesponding to the polymerization of a full length 40-mer PNA after 15 minutes. Introducing a mismatched codo in the first, third, . fifth, seventh, or ninth coding positions on the template again resulted in truncation .(Figure 63, < lanes 4, 6, 8, 10, and 12, respectively). This efficient translation of DNA sequences into 40 PNA bases (10 couplings) provides a polymer of length similar to DNA and RNA oligonucleotides with binding or catalytic properties, but made entirely of synthetic building blocks.
[0493] ' A challenging requirement of creating libraries of sequence-defined synthetic polymers in this manner is maintaining sequeriCe specificity in the presence of multiple monomers of closely related sequence. In order to study the specificity of DNA-templated polymerization using multiple PNA building blocks in a single solution, nine PNA aldehyde tetramers ofthe sequence NH2-gvvt-CHO (v = g, a, or c) were synthesized. In addition, nine DNA templates containing one of nine codons complementary to gwt at codon 5, and containing AGTC at the other nine positions were prepared. Reaction conditions were identical to those from Figure 63, except that the reaction time with NaCNBH3 was further shortened to 5 minutes and incubation was carried out at 37°C. The first two lanes of each panel in Figure 64 show a positive control polymerization. Each additional set of four lanes conesponds to: (i) 20 pmol template, (ii) reaction with 14.4 μM gact, (iii) reaction with 14.4 μM gact plus 1.6 μM PNA aldehyde complementary to the highlighted codon, and (iv) reaction with 14.4 μM gact plus 0.2 μM of each PNA aldehyde of the sequence gwt except the PNA complementary to the highlighted codon. As expected, each ofthe nine templates was translated into a single predominant truncated product conesponding to the incoφoration of four copies of 1 when 1 was the only PNA building block included in the reaction (37 °C, 5 min) (see, Figure 64). Full- length product was efficiently generated for all nine templates, however, when the PNA aldehyde complementary to the fifth coding sequence was included in addition to 1. When all PNA aldehyde tetramers were included in the reaction except the PNA complementary to the fifth coding region, only the fruncated product was efficiently generated (see, Figure 64). [0494] Taken together, these experiments reveal that DNA-templated PNA aldehyde polymerizations maintain sequence specificity even when a mixture of different PNA building blocks are present in a single solution. '
D) Evolving Plastics [0495] In yet another embodiment, a nucleic acid (e.g., DNA, RNA, derivative thereof) is attached to a polymerization catalyst. Since nucleic acids can fold into complex structures, the nucleic acid can be used to direct and/or affect the polymerization of a growing polymer chain. For example, the nucleic acid may influence the selection of monomer units to be polymerized as well as how the polymerization reaction takes place (e.g., stereochemistry, tacticity, activity). The synthesized polymers may be selected for specific properties such molecular, weight, density, hydrophobicity, tacticity, stereoselectivity, etc., and the nucleic acid which formed an integral part ofthe catalyst which directed its synthesis may be amplified and evolved (Figure 65A). Iterated cycles of ligand diversification, selection, and amplification allow for the true evolution of catalysts and polymers towards desired properties. [0496] By way of example, a library of DNA molecules is attached to Grubbs' ruthenium-based ring opening metathesis polymerization (ROMP) catalyst through a dihydroimidazole ligand (Scholl et al. (1999) ORG. LETT. 1(6): 953) creating a large, diverse pool of potential catalytic molecules, each unique by nature ofthe functionalized ligand (see, Figure 65B). Functionalizing the catalyst with a relatively large DNA-dehydroimidazole (DNA- DHI) ligand can alter the activity ofthe catalyst. Each DNA molecule has the potential to fold into a unique stereoelectronic shape which potentially has different selectivities and/or activities in the polymerization reaction (Figure 66). Therefore, the library of DNA ligands can be "translated" into a library of plastics upon the addition of various monomers. In certain embodiments, DNA-DHI ligands capable of covalently inserting themselves into the growing polymer, thus creating a polymer tagged with the DNA that encoded its creation, are used.
Using the synthetic scheme shown in Figure 65A, dehydroimidazole (DHI) ligands are produced containing two chemical handles, one used to attach the DNA to the ligand, the other used to attach a pedant olefin to the DHI backbone. Rates of metathesis are known to vary widely based upon olefin substitution as well as the identity ofthe catalyst. Through alteration of these variable, the rate of pendant olefin incoφoration can be modulated such that pendant oiefm metathesis « &ROMP, thereby, allowing polymers of moderate to high molecular weights to be formed before insertion ofthe DNA tag and conesponding polymer termination. Vinylic ethers are commonly used in RQMP to functionalize the polymer termini (Gordon et al (2000) CHEM. ' BIOL. 7: 9-16), as well as produce polymers of decreased molecular weight.
[0497] , A polymer from the library is subsequently selected based on a desired property by electrophoresis, gel filtration, centrifugal sedimentation, partitioning into solvents of different hydrophobi cities, etc. t Amplification and diversification ofthe coding nucleic acid via >
' , ' '' . ' ' ' techniques sμch as enor-prone PCR or DNA shuffling followed by attachment to a DHI backbone will allow for production of another pool pfpotential ROMP catalysts enriched in ,the selected activity (Figure 66). This method provides a new approach to generating polynieric, materials and the catalysts that create them.
Example 10: Development of Catalysts by Templated Synthesis
[0498] An alternative approach to translating DNA into non-natural, evolvable polymers takes advantage of the ability of some DNA polymerases to accept certain modified nucleotide triphosphate substrates (Perrin et al (2001) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 123: 1556; Perrin et al. (1999) NUCLEOSIDES NUCLEOTIDES 18: 377-91 ; Gouriain et al. (2001) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 29: i 898- 1905; Lee et al. (2001) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 29: 1565-73; Sakthievel et al. (1998) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 37: 2872-2875). Several deoxyribonucleotides and ribonucleotides bearing modifications to groups that do not participate in Watson-Crick hydrogen bonding are known to be inserted with high sequence fidelity opposite natural DNA templates. Importantly, single- stranded DNA containing modified nucleotides can serve as efficient templates for the DNA- polymerase-catalyzed incoφoration of natural or modified mononucleotides.
[0499] The functionalized nucleotides incoφorated by DNA polymerases to date are shown in Figure 67. In one ofthe earliest examples of modified nucleotide incoφoration by DNA polymerase, Toole and co-workers reported the acceptance of 5-(l-pentynyl)-deoxyuridine 1 by Vent DNA polymerase under PCR conditions (Latham et al. (1994) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 22: 2817-22). Several additional 5-functionalized deoxyuridines (2-7) derivatives were subsequently found to be accepted by thermostable DNA polymerases suitable for PCR (Sakthievel et al. (1998) supra). The first functionalized purine accepted by DNA polymerase, deoxyadenosine analog 8, was incoφorated into DNA by T7 DNA polymerase together with deoxyuridine analog 7 (Perrin et al. (1999) NUCLEOSIDES NUCLEOTIDES 18: 377-91). DNA libraries containing both 7 and 8 were successfully selected for metal-independent RNA cleaving activity (Perrin et al (2001) J. Am. Chem. Soc. 123:, 1556-63). Williams and co-workers recently tested several deoxyuridine derivatives for acceptance by Taq DNA polymerases arid
I' ' i , ' concluded that acceptance is greatest wheri using C5-modified uridines bearing rigid alkyne or tr ns-alkene groups such as 9 and 10 (Lee et al. (2001) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 29: 1565-73). A , similar study (Gouriain et al. (2001 ) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 29: 1898- 1905) on C7-functionalized 7-deaza-deoxyadenosines revealed acceptance by Taq DNA polymerase of 7-amiήopropyl- (11), cώ-7-aminopropenyl- (12), and 7-aminopropynyl-7-deazadeoxyadenosine (13). , •
[0500] With simple general acid and general 'base functionality, chiral metal centers would expand considerably the chemical scope of nucleic acids. Functionality aimed at binding chemically potent metal centers has yet to been incoφorated into nucleic acid polymers. Natural DNA has demonstrated the ability to fold in complex three-dimensional structures capable of stereospecifically binding target molecules (Lin et al. (1997) CHEM. BiOL. 4: 817-32; Lin et al. (1998) CHEM. BIOL. 5: 555-72; Schulrze et al. (1994) J. MOL. BIOL. 235: 1532-47) or catalyzing phosphodiester bond manipulation (Santoro et al. (1997) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 94: 4262-6; Breaker et al. (1995) CHEM. BIOL. 2: 655-60; Li et al. (2000) BIOCHEMISTRY 39: 3106- 14; Li et al. (1999) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 96: 2746-51), DNA depurination (Sheppard et al. (2000) PROC NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 97: 7802-7807) and poφhyrin metallation (Li et al. (1997) BIOCHEMISTRY 36: 5589-99; Li et al. (1996) NAT. STRUCT. BIOL. 3: 743-7). Non-natural nucleic acids augmented with the ability to bind chemically potent, water-compatible metals such Cu, La, Ni, Pd, Rh, Ru, or Sc may possess greatly expanded catalytic properties. For example, a Pd-binding oligonucleotide folded into a well-defined structure may possess the ability to catalyze Pd-mediated coupling reactions with a high degree of regiospecificity or stereospecificity. Similarly, non-natural nucleic acids that form chiral Sc binding sites may serve as enantioselective cycloaddition or aldol addition catalysts. The ability of DNA polymerases to translate DNA sequences into these non-natural polymers coupled with in vitro selections for catalytic activities would therefore permit the direct evolution of desired catalysts from random libraries.
[0501] Evolving catalysts in this approach addresses the difficulty of rationally designing catalytic active sites with specific chemical properties that has inspired recent combinatorial approaches (Kuntz et al. (1999) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 3: 313-319; Francis et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 422-8) to organometallic catalyst discovery. For example, Hoveyda and co-workers identified Ti-based enantiόselective epoxidation catalysts by serial screening of peptide ligands (Shimizu etal. (1997), ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 36). Serial'' screening was also used by Jacob,sen arid co-iworkers to identify peptide ligands that form enantioselective epoxidation catalysts when complexed with metal cations (Francis et al. (1999) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. ENGL. 38: 937-941). ' Recently,. a peptide library containing phpsphine side chains was 'screened for the ability to catalyze malonate ester addition to^yclppentenyl ' acetate in the presence of Pd (Gilbertsόn etal. (2000) L AM. CHEM. SOC. 122: 6522-6523). '
[0502] The cunent approach differs fundamentally from previous combinatorial catalyst discovery efforts in that it permits catalysts with desired properties to spontaneously emerge , from one pot, solution-phase libraries after evolutionary cycles of diversification, amplification, translation, and selection. This strategy allows up to 1015 different catalysts to be generated and selected for, desired properties in a single experiment. The compatibility of this approach with one-pot ifi 'vitro selections allows the direct selection for reaction catalysis rather than screening for a phenomenon associated with catalysis such as metal binding or heat generation. In , addition, properties difficult to screen rapidly such as substrate stereospecificity or metal selectivity can be directly selected using approaches disclosed herein.
[0503] Key intermediates for a number of C5-functionalized uridine analogs and C7- fimctionalized 7-deazaadenosine analogs have been synthesized for incoφoration into non- natural DNA polymers. In addition, the synthesis of six C8-functionalized adenosine analogs as deoxyribonucleotide triphosphates has been completed.
Synthesis of Metal-Binding Nucleotides
[0504] A strategy for synthesizing metal-binding uridine and 7-deazaadenosine analogs is shown in Figure 68. Both routes end with amide bond formation between NHS esters of metal-binding functional groups and amino modified deoxyribonucleotide triphosphates (7 and 13). Analogs 7 and 13 as well as acetylated derivatives of 7 have been previously shown to be tolerated by DNA polymerases, including thermostable DNA polymerases suitable for PCR (Perrin et al. (2001) supra; Perrin et al. (1999) supra; Latham et al (1994) NUCLEIC ACIDS 12V1PRE 22: 2817-22; Gouriain et al. (2001) Nucleic Acids Res. 29: 1898-1905; Lee et al. (2001) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 29: 1565-73; Sakthivel et al. (1998) ANGEW. CHEM. INT. ED. ENGL. 37: 2872-2875). This approach allows a wide variety of metal-binding ligands to be rapidly incoφorated into either nucleotide analog. Amino modified deoxy-ribonucleotide triphosphate 7 hasheen synthesized using a previously reported route (Sakthivel et al. (1998) supra). As illustrated in Figure 69, Heck coupling of commercially available 5-iodo-2'-deoxyuridine (22)
' ' ith '" N' -allyltrifluoroacetamide ' provided C ' ompound 2 ' '3. „ T*he• ■ 5 ''-triphosphate grou p ' was • ' ' ' incoφorated by treatment of compound 23 with trimethylphosphate, phosphorous oxychloride , (POCl3), aμd proton sponge (1 ,8-bis(dimethylamino)-naphthalene) followed by tri-«- butylammonium pyrophosphate, and the trifluoroacetamide group then removed with aqueous ammonia to afford C5-modified uridine intermediate ,7. ,
, [0505] C7-modified 7-deazaadenosine intermediate 13, the key intermediate for 7- deazaadenosine analogs, has been synthesized. As shown in Figure 70, diethoxyethylcyanoacetate 24 was synthesized frombromoacetal 25 and ethyl cyanbacetate 26 following a known protocol (Davoll (1960) J. AM. CHEM. SOC. 82: 131-138). Condensation of 24 with thiourea provided pyrimidine 27, which was desulfurized with Raney nickel and then cyclized to pynolopyrimidine 28 with dilute aqueous HCl. Treatment of 28 with POCl3 afforded 4-chloro-7-deazaadenine 29. The aryl iodide group which can serve as a Sonogashira, coupling partner for installation of the propargylic amine in 13 was incoφorated by reacting 29 with N- iodosuccinimide to generate 4-chloro-7-iodo-7-deazaadenine 30 in 13% overall yield from bromoacetal 25. Figure 71 shows glycosylation of compound 30 with protected deoxyribosyl chloride 38 (generated from deoxyribose as shown in Figure 72), followed by ammonolysis afforded 7-iodo-adenosine 39 (Gouriain et al (2001) NUCLEIC ACIDS RES. 29: 1898-1905)1 Pd- mediated Sonogashira coupling (Seela et al. (1999) HELV. CHEM. ACTA 82: 1878-1898) of 39 with N-propynyltrifluoroacetamide provides 40, which is then converted to the 5' nucleotide triphosphate and deprotected with ammonia to yield C7-modified 7-deazaadenosine intermediate 13.
[0506] In order to create a library of metal-binding uridine and adenosine analogs, a variety of metal-binding groups as NHS esters can be coupled to C5-modified uridine intermediate 7 and C7-modified 7-deazaadenosine intermediate 13. Exemplary metal-binding groups are shown in Figure 68 and include phosphines, thiopyridyl groups, and hemi-salen moieties. Additional deoxyadenosine derivatives, such as, for example, compounds 41 and 42 shown in Figure 73, can be prepared by coupling alkyl- and vinyl trifluoroacetamides to 8- bromo-deoxyadenosine (31). These intermediates then are coupled with the NHS esters shown in Figure 68 to generate a variety of metal-binding, 8 -functionalized deoxyadenosine triphosphates.
[0507] , ' As alternative functionalized adenine analogs that will both probe the structural requirements of DNA polymerase acceptance and provide potential metal-binding functionality, six 8-modified deoxyadenosine triphosphates (Figure 74) have been synthesized. All functional groups were installed by addition to 8-brorrio-deoxyadenόsine (31), which was prepared by bromination of deoxyadenosine in the presence of scandium chloride (ScCl3), which we foμnd to greatly increase product yield. Methyl-, (32), ethyl-' (33), and vinyladenosine (34) were synthesized by Pd-mediated Stille coupling ofthe conesponding alkyl tin reagent and 31 (Mamos et al. (1992) TETRAHEDRON LETT. 33: 2413-2416). Methylamino- (35) (Nandanan et al. (1999) J. MED. CHEM. 42: 1625-1638), ethylamino- (36), and histaminoadenosine (37) were prepared by treatment of 23 with the conesponding amine in water or ethanol. The 5 '-nucleotide triphosphates of 32-37 were synthesized as descnbed above.
Acceptance of Nucleotides by Polymerase [0508] The ability of the modified nucleotide triphosphates containing metal-binding functionality shown in Figure 75 to be accepted by DNA polymerase enzymes was studied. Synthetic nucleotide triphosphates were purified by ion exchange and reverse-phase HPLC and were added to PCR reactions containing Taq DNA polymerase, three natural deoxynucleotide triphosphates, pUC19 template DNA, and two DNA primers. The primers were chosen to generate PCR products ranging from 50 to 200 base pairs in length. Control PCR reactions contained the four natural deoxynucleotide triphosphates and no non-natural nucleotides. PCR reactions were analyzed by gel electrophoresis and the results indicate that functionalized uridine analogs 2, 3, 7, 13, 28, 29, and 30 were efficiently incoφorated by Taq DNA polymerase over 30 PCR cycles, while uridine analogs 31 and 32 were not efficiently incoφorated (see, Figure 75). These results demonstrate that synthetic nucleotides containing metal-binding functionality can both be read as templates and incoφorated as building blocks into non-natural nucleic acids using DNA polymerases. The 8-modified adenosine triphosphates 32 and 33 were not accepted by Taq DNA polymerase, suggesting possible rejection of modifications at C8 (see, Figure 75).
[0509] Functionalized nucleotides that are especially interesting yet are not compatible with Taq, Pfu, or Vent thermostable DNA polymerases can be tested for their ability to participate in primer extension using other commercially available DNA polymerases including the Klenow fragment of E. coli DNA polymerase I, T7 or T4 DNA polymerase, or M-MuLN reverse transcriptase: ,
Generation of Polymer Libraries
[0510] . Νon-natural polymer libraries containing synthetic metal-binding nucleotides that are compatible with DΝA polymerases have been created. Libraries of 1015 different modified nucleic acids consisting of 40 random bases flanked by two primer binding regions and '
V ' "1 . ' ■ ' ' ■ ■ i containing the imidazole-linked thymine base shown in Figure 76 have been created. These libraries were efficiently generated by three methods; standard PCR, enor-prone PCR, and , primer extension using large quantities of template and stoichiometric quantities of only one , primer. The resulting double-stranded libraries were denatured and the desired strand isolated using the avidin-based purification system described hereinabove. Two rounds of in vitro selection on this library for polymers that fold only in the presence of Gu2+ have been performed using the gel electrophoresis selection for folded nucleic acids as described herein.
[0511] Libraries of nucleic acids containing the most promising polymerase-accepted metal-binding nucleotides, including 28-30 (Figure 75), can also be generated. Libraries can be generated by PCR amplification or by primer extension of a synthetic DΝA template library consisting of a random region of 20 or 40 nucleotides flanked by two 15-base constant priming regions (Figure 77). The priming regions contain restriction endonuclease cleavage sites to allow DΝA sequencing of pools or individual library members. One primer contains a primary amine group at its 5' terminus and will become the coding strand ofthe library. The other primer contains a biotinylated 5' terminus and will become the non-coding strand. The PCR reaction includes one or two non-natural metal-binding deoxyribonucleotide triphosphates, three or two natural deoxyribonucleotide triphosphates, and a DΝA polymerase compatible with non- natural nucleotides. Following PCR to generate the double-stranded form ofthe library, library members then are denatured and the non-coding strands removed by washing with streptavidin- linked magnetic beads to ensure that no biotinylated strands remain in the library. Libraries of up to 1015 different members can be generated by this method, far exceeding the combined diversity of previously reported combinatorial metal-binding catalyst discovery efforts.
[0512] Each library then is incubated in aqueous solution with a metal of interest from the following non-limiting list of water compatible metal salts: ScCl3, CrCl3, MnCl2, FeCl2, FeCl3, CoCl2, ΝiCl2, CuCl2, ZnCl2, GaCl3, YC13, RuCl3, RhCl3, Na2PdCl4, AgCl, CdCl2, InCl3, SnCl2, La(OTf)3, Ce(OTf)3, Pr(OTf)3, Nd(OTf)3, ,Sm(OTf)3, Eu(OTf)3, Gd(OTf)3, Tb(OTf)3, Dy(OTf)3, Ho(OTf)3, Er(OTf)3, Tm(OTf)3, Yb(OTf)3, Lu(OTf)3, IrCl3, PtCl2, AuCl, HgCl2, HgCl, PbCl2, and BiCl3 (Kobayashi et al. (1998) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 120: 8287-8288; Fringuelli et al. (2001) EUR. J. ORG. CHEM. 2001: 439-455). The metals are chosen in part based on the , specific chemical reactions to be catalyzed. For example, libraries aimed at reactions such as aldol condensations or hetero Diels-Alder reactions that are known to be catalyzed by Lewis acids are incubated with ScCl3 or with one ofthe lanthanide triflates (Fringuelli et al. (2001)
•supra). In other cases, metals not previously known to. catalyze the transformations of interest are also used to evolve polymers with unprecedented activity. The metal-incubated library is purified away from unbound metal salts using gel filtration cartridges (available from, for example, Princeton Separations) that separate DNA oligonucleotides 25 bases or longer from unbound smaller reaction components.
[0513] The ability ofthe polymer library (or of individual library members) to bind metals of interest is verified by treating the metalated library free of unbound metals with metal staining reagents, such as dithiooxamide, dimethylglyoxime, or potassium isothiocyanate (KSCN) (Francis et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 422-8) or EDTA (Zaitoun et al (1997) J. PHYS. CHEM. B 101: 1857-1860), that become distinctly colored in the presence of different metals. The approximate level of metal binding is measured by spectrophotometric comparison with solutions of free metals of known concentration and with solutions of positive control oligonucleotides containing an EDTA group (which can be introduced using a commercially available phosphoramidite from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA).
Selecting Nucleic Acid Polymers
[0514] Once the libraries of functionalized DNAs are synthesized and characterized, they are subjected to three types of in vitro selections for: (0 folding, (ii) target binding, or (iii) catalysis.
[0515] (i) Folding. Non-denaturing gel electrophoresis can be used as a simple selection, to be applied to inventive libraries of modified nucleic acids, to select for nucleic acid folding in the presence of specific metals of interest. In order to test this selection approach on molecules similar to future library members, three 60-base DNA oligonucleotides known (Schultze et al. (1994) J. MOL. BIOL. 235: 1532-1547) or predicted (SantaLucia (1998) PROC NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 95: 1460-1465) to have very different folded states were synthesized. Each oligonucleotide contained a core 30-base sequence, flanked by two 15-base primer binding sequences. The unstructured control oligonucleotide contained a poly T core and an EcoR I restriction site. The second core sequence contained a perfect inverted repeat predicted to form a highly stable haiφin, while the third core sequence contained a poly G core known to fold in solution into, an intramolecular G-quartet (Cheng etal. (1997) GENE 197: 253-260). Thς three DNA sequences were combined in equimolar ratios and the mixture subjected to preparative ' non-denaturing gel electrophoresis. The highriidbility portion ofthe DNA was captured and ' compared'by analytic electrophoresis to authentic poly T, haiφin, and poly G oligonucleotides. , The results indicate that folded DNA sequences Can be readily separated from a mixture of . . folded and unfolded DNA molecules by non-denaturing gel electrophoresis. This selection ' approach can be applied to the metal-binding polymer libraries, wherein polymers with anticipated metal binding ability will be incubated with one or more water-compatible metal sources pripr to, selection. Polymers capable of folding in the presence, but not in the absence, of metals will serve as especially attractive starting points for the next two types of selections. [051 ] (ii) Target Binding. Selections for target binding can be performed by incubating the solution-phase polymer library with either immobilized target or with biotinylated target followed by streptavidin-linked beads. Non-binders are removed by washing, and polymers, with desired binding properties are eluted by chemical denaturation or by adding excess authentic free ligand. In order to complete one cycle of functionalized DNA evolution, the DNA templates are amplified by PCR using one primer containing the 5 '-functionalized haiφin primer and a biotinylated second primer, optionally diversified by enor-prone PCR (Caldwell (1992) PCR METHODS APPLIC. 2: 28-33) or by nonhomologous random recombination method, and then denatured into single stranded DNA and washed with streptavidin beads to remove the non- coding template strand. The resulting pool of selected single-stranded, 5 '-functionalized DNA completes the evolution cycle and enters subsequent rounds of DNA-templated translation, selection, diversification, and amplification.
[0517] (iii) Catalysis. Selection for synthetic polymers that catalyze bond-forming or bond-cleaving reactions can also be performed. Library members that catalyze virtually any reaction that causes bond formation between two substrate molecules or that results in bond breakage into two product molecules can be selected using the schemes proposed in Figures 12 and 13. As illustrated in Figure 12, in order to select for bond forming catalysts (for example, hetero Diels-Alder, Heck coupling, aldol reaction, or, olefin metathesis catalysts), library members are covalently linked to one substrate through their 5' amino or thiol termini. The other substrate ofthe reaction is synthesiz !e' d as a derivative i linked to biotin. When di .lute1 ' ' ' solutions of library-substrate conjugate are reacted with the substrate-biotin conjugate, those , library members that catalyze bond formation cause the biotin group to become covalently attached to themselves. Active bond forming catalysts can then be separated from inactive library members by capturing the former with immobilized streptavidin and washing away inactive polymers. By way of example, the synthesis and selection of active Heck coupling catalysts, active hetero diels-alder catalysts and active aldol addition catalysts may be performed as shown in Figures 78A, 78B, and 78C, respectively.
[0518] In an analogous manner, library members that catalyze bond cleavage reactions such as retro-aldol reactions, amide hydrolysis, elimination reactions, or olefin dihydroxylation followed by periodate cleavage can also be selected, as illustrated in Figure 13. In this case, metalated library members are covalently linked to biotinylated substrates such that the bond breakage reaction causes the disconnection ofthe biotin moiety from the library members. Upon incubation under reaction conditions, active catalysts, but not inactive library members, induce the loss of their biotin groups. Streptavidin-linked beads can then be used to capture inactive polymers, while active catalysts are able to elute from the beads. Related bond formation and bond cleavage selections have been used successfully in catalytic RNA and DNA evolution (Jaschke et al. (2000) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 4: 257-62). Although these selections do not explicitly select for multiple turnover catalysis, RNAs and DNAs selected in this manner have in general proven to be multiple turnover catalysts when separated from their substrate moieties (Jaschke et al. (2000) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 4: 257-62; Jaeger et al. (1999) PROC. NATL. ACAD. SCI. USA 96: 14712-7; Bartel et al. (1993) SCIENCE 261: 1411-8; Sen et al. (1998) CURR. OPIN. CHEM. BIOL. 2: 680-7).
[0519] It is contemplated that catalysts of three important and diverse bond-forming reactions (Heck coupling, hetero Diels-Alder cycloaddition, and aldol addition) can be created using the technologies described herein. All three reactions are water compatible (Kobayashi et al. (1998) J. AM. CHEM. Soc. 120: 8287-8288; Fringuelli et al. (2001) EUR. J. ORG. CHEM. 2001: 439-455; Li et al. (1997) ORGANIC REACTIONS IN AQUEOUS MEDIA) and are known to be catalyzed by metals. Evolving Functionalized DNA Polymers , ' ' ',
[0520] Following each round of selection,, active library members can be amplified directly by PCR with the non-natural nucleotides and subjected to additional rounds of selection to enrich the library for desired catalysts. Libraries may' be diversified by random mutagenesis using enor-prone PCR or by nonhomologous recombination and characterized by DNA sequencing before and after selection: Because enor-prone PCR is inherently less efficient than normal PCR, enor-prone PCR diversification is conducted with only natural nucleotides. The mutagenized DNA templates then are translated into non-natural nucleic acid polymers as described above. ' , , [0521] In addition to simply evolving active catalysts, the in vitro selections descnbed herein may be used to evolve catalysts with properties difficult to achieve using cunent catalyst discovery approaches. For example, substrate specificity among catalysts can be evolved by selecting for active catalysts in the presence ofthe desired substrate and then selecting for inactive catalysts in the presence of one or rriόre undesired substrates. Using this strategy, it is contemplated that it will be possible to evolve libraries of catalysts with unprecedented regio- and stereoselectivity. By way of example, four types of substrate specificity cunently unachievable by known catalysts nor likely to be solvable by cunent catalyst discovery methods include: (i) Heck catalysts that operate on para- but not meta- aryl chlorides, (ii) aldol catalysts that accept ketones but not aldehydes as enolate acceptors, (iii) hetero Diels-Alder catalysts that reject olefin dienophiles, and (iv) hetero Diels-Alder catalysts that accept trans-trans but reject cis-trans or terminal dienes. Metal-binding polymers containing well-ordered, three-dimensional dispositions of key steric and electronic groups may be ideally suited to solving these problems. Similarly, metal selectivity can be evolved by selecting for active catalysts in the presence of desired metals and selecting against activity in the presence of undesired metals. Catalysts with broad substrate tolerance may be evolved by varying substrate structures between successive rounds of selection. Characterizing catalysts evolved by the above methods may provide new insights into developing analogous small molecule catalysts with powerful and unprecedented selectivities.
[0522] In addition, the observations of sequence-specific DNA-templated synthesis in DMF and CH2C12 suggested that DNA-tetralkylammonium cation complexes may form base- paired structures in organic solvents. These findings raise the possibility of evolving non-natural nucleic acid catalysts in organic solvents using slightly modified versions ofthe selections described above. The .actual bond forming and bond cleavage selection reactions fnay be conducted in organic' solvents, the crude reactions then will be ethanol precipitated to, remove the tetraalkylammonium cations, and the immobilized avidin separation of biotinylated and non- biotinylated library members in aqueous, solution will be performed. PCR amplification of selected members will then take place' as, describe4 hereinabove. Successful evolution of , ' reaction catalysts that function in organic solvents would expand considerably both the scope of reactions that can be catalyzed and the utility of the resulting evolved non-natural polymer catalysts. ,' , ' ■ • • < Example 11: In Vitro Selection for Protein Binding and Affinity
[0523] This Example demonstrates that it is possible to perform in vitro selections for nucleic acid-linked synthetic small molecules.with protein binding affinity. These selections (i) offer much greater sensitivities (10"20 mol) than previously reported synthetic molecule screens for protein binding, (ii) can be rapidly iterated to achieve 106-fold net enrichments of aptive molecules, and (iii) can be adapted to select for binding specificity. ι
[0524] Because all molecules in a selection are processed simultaneously, selections offer much higher potential throughput than screens. Selections typically do not require sophisticated equipment and can be iterated to multiply trie net enrichment of desired molecules. Certain properties such as binding specificity, although difficult to screen, can be readily selected. Finally, the outcomes of laboratory and natural selections usually are linked to amplifiable nucleic acids, permitting the selections to offer far greater sensitivities than screens. The covalent linkage of oligonucleotides to conesponding synthetic molecules, either as a consequence of nucleic acid-templated organic synthesis or as a result of conjugating a nucleic acid to synthetic molecules, allows synthetic molecules to be selected and then identified. Despite these attractions, selections for synthetic molecules have been largely unexplored.
[0525] At the outset, a variety of synthetic small molecules conjugated to 36- to 42-base
DNA oligonucleotides (see, Figure 79) were synthesized such that each small molecule was linked to a unique DNA sequence. The small molecules were chosen either for their known binding affinities to six proteins (see, Figure 79), or as nonbinding negative controls. Solutions containing mixtures of DNA-linked protein ligands and DNA-linked negative controls were used to simulate DNA-templated synthetic small molecule libraries containing small fractions of library members with protein binding activities.
[0526] , Selections for protein affinity were performed by incubating mixtures of DNA- linked synthetic small molecules for 1-2 hours with target proteins covalently conjugated to beads. The non-binders were removed by washing the beads with high salt buffer. The bound molecules were then PCR amplified to amplify the DNA oligonucleotides surviving selection. Sequences encoding known protein binding ligands were distinguished from DNA encoding. non-binders by digestion with sequence-specific restriction endonucleases, permitting their relative ratio to be quantitated by gel electrophoresis and densitometry. The efficiency of each selection was assessed by the degree to which DNA-linked protein ligands were enriched relative to DNA-linked non-binders (the "enrichment factor").
[0527] Among the protein-small molecule interactions considered, the binding of glutathione amide to glutathione S-transferase (GST) is among the lowest affinity (Kά = ~10 ) and, therefore, represents a stringent test of protein binding selections for DNA-linked synthetic small molecules. To measure the sensitivity and efficiency of these selections (see, Figure 80), the number of DNA-linked glutathione molecules (1) were vaned from 10 to 10 molecules. A 100- to 106-fold molar excess ofthe negative control N-formyl-Met-Leu-Phe linked DΝA (2) was combined with (1) and the resulting mixture was selected for binding to GST-linked agarose beads. The selection strongly enriched as few as 10,000 copies ofthe DΝA-linked glutathione by 100- to >104-fold relative to the negative control (Figure 80). Although the concentrations of DΝA-linked molecules during selections were much lower than μM, the selections were successful because GST was immobilized at an effective concentration exceeding ~10 μM and, therefore, permitted a significant fraction of (1) to remain bound to GST. These results demonstrate that selections for modest protein affinities (for example, Ka = ~\0 μM) are possible in this format.
[0528] In order to evaluate the generality of this approach, analogous selections were performed for binding to streptavidin, carbonic anhydrase, papain, trypsin, and chymotrypsin in addition to GST (Figure 79). Collectively these six functionally diverse proteins bind the ligands shown in Figure 79 with predicted affinities that span more than eight orders of magnitude (Kά = -14 μM to -40 fM) (D'Silva (1990) BIOCHEM. J. 271 : 161-165) (Jain et al. (1994) J. MED. CHEM. 37: 2100-2105; Green (1990) METHODS EΝZ. 184: 51-67; Otto et al. (1997) CHEM. REV. 97: 133-172). In each of these < ases, selection enriched < 10"16 mol of a known small molecule ligand conjugated to DNA by at least 50-fold over a non-biriding negative control (Figure 79), indicating that DNA conjugation does not impair the ability of the ligands in Figure 79 to bind their cognate protein targets arid suggesting that these selections may be applicable to a wide variety.of unrelated proteins. ι ,
[0529] ' Furthermore, selections can.be iterated to multiply the net ennchment of desired , molecules. To test this possibility with DNA-liμked synthetic molecules, a 1 : 1 ,000 mixture. of . DNA-linked phenyl sulfonamide (3):DNA-linked N-forrnyl-Met-Leu-Phe (2) was subjected to a selection for binding carbonic anhydrase. The' molecules surviving the first selection were elufed '
1 ' '
I I ' and directly subjected to a second selection using fresh immobilized carbonic anhydrase. PCR amplification and restriction digestion revealed that the first round of selection yielded a 1 :3 ratio of (3):(2), representing a 3,30- fold enrichment for, the DΝA-linked phenyl sulfonamide. The second round of selection further enriched 3 by more than 30-fold, such that the ratio of (3):(2) following two rounds of selection exceeded 10:1 (>104-fold net enrichment). Similarly, three rounds of iterated selection were used to enrich a 1 : 106 starting ratio of (3):DΝA-linked biotin (4) by a factor of 5 x 106 into a solution containing predominantly DNA-linked phenyl sulfonamide (3) (see, Figure 81). These findings demonstate that enormous net enrichments for DNA-linked synthetic molecules can be achieved .through iterated selection, and suggest that desired molecules represented as rarely as 1 part in 106 (approximately the largest number of different small molecules generated in a single library to date) within DNA-templated synthetic libraries may be efficiently isolated in this manner.
[0530] In addition to binding affinity, binding specificity is a broadly important property of synthetic molecules. Library screening methods for binding specificity typically require duplicating the entire screen for each target or non-target of interest. In contrast, selections for specificity in principle can be performed in a single experiment by selecting for target binding as well as for the inability to bind one or more non-targets. In order to validate selections for specificity among DNA-linked synthetic small molecules, DNA-linked biotin (4), DNA-linked chymostatin (5), and DNA-linked antipain (6) were combined into a single solution in a 24:4:1 ratio, respectively. Because biotin has no significant affinity for chymotrypsin or papain, chymostatin binds to both proteases, and antipain binds only to papain, (see, Figure 82) this mixture simulates a library containing predominantly nonbinding molecules with a minor fraction of nonspecific binders and an even smaller fraction of a target-specific binder.
. , , ' r , •
[0531] < When this mixture was subjected to two rounds of selection for binding to papain, both 5 and 6 were enriched at the expense of 4, as expected (Figure 82). However, when the ' 5 above mixture was washed with chymotrypsin-linked beads and selected for binding to papain in the presence of excess free chymotrypsin, only the papain-specific ligand (6) was enriched (Figure 82). The ability ofthe selections described above to separate target-specific and non-
I - , ,
' specific DNA-linked synthetic molecules from a single solution suggests their use to discover synthetic molecules that exclusively bind a single member of a large family of related proteins (e.g. , kinases, proteases, or glycotransferases), and that do not bind proteins that cornmonly reduce the biological efficacy of small molecules (e.g. by sequestering, exporting, or metabolizing them).
[0532] In summary, this Example demonstrates the feasibility of performing in vitro selections for DNA-linked synthetic small molecules with protein binding activities. The application of methods developed here to nucleic acid-templated (or nucleic acid-conjugated) libraries may play an important role in the discovery of synthetic molecules with desired properties using powerful selection and amplification strategies previously available only to biological molecules.
Materials and Methods DNA Synthesis
[0533] DNA oligonucleotides were synthesized on a PerSeptive Biosystems Expedite
8090 DNA synthesizer using standard phosphoramidite protocols. All reagents were purchased from Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA. The templates for the glutathione S-transferase (GST) selection were synthesized using a 5'-amino-modifier C12 and all other templates were synthesized using 5 '-amino-modifier C5.
Preparation of Compound (1) [0534] Glutathione was synthesized on the solid phase using standard Boc chemistry at room temperature. 200 mg PAM Resin (Advanced ChemTech) was swelled in 2 mL DMF for 20 minutes. N-Boc-glycine (Sigma, 640 μmol, 112 mg), diisopropylcarbodiimide (570 μmol, 89 μL), and 4-dimethylaminopyridine (DMAP, 57 μmol, 7 mg) were added to the resin and stined for 4 hours. The resin was washed with DMF and then with DMF/CH2C12 (1:1). The N-Boc protecting group was removed using two 3 minute gashes of trifluoroacetic acid (TFA):m-cresol (95 :5). The resin then.was washed with' DMF :CH2C12 (1 : 1) and DMF,:ρyridine (1 : 1). A solution of N-Boc-Cys(Frn)-θH (Chernlrnpex, 800 μriiol, 320 ing), O-(7-Azabenzotriazol-l-yl)-
N,N,N',N'-tetramethylufonium hexafluoroρhosphate (Aldrich, 720 μmol, 274 mg), 2,6-lutidine (1.2 mmol,' 131 μl) and NN-diisopropyiethylamin (DIPEA, 750 μmol, 131 μl) in 800 μL of 1- methyl-2pynohdmone was stined for 15 minutes and then added to the resini, stirring for 30 minutes. The resin then was washed with DMF/CH2C12 (1 :1). To remove the N-Boc protecting , group on cysteine, a solution of trimethylsilyl triflate (TMS-Otf) (2.8 mmόl, 0.5 mL) and 2,6r lutidine (4.58 mmol, 0.5 mL) in 1.75 mL CH2C12 was added to the resin and stined for 1 hour. '
' ' ' The resin then was washed with methanol and then with DMF:CH2Cl2 (1:1). Fmoc-Glu-OFm
(Chernhnpex, 800 μmol, 438 mg) was coupled as described above. The fully protected glutathione, as cleaved from the resin with a solution of trifluoromethanesulfonic acid:m- cresol:thioanisόle:TFA (2:1:1 :8), stirring for 1 hours. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was extracted into hexane. The crude extract was purified, using preparative thin layer chromatography in hexane. The silica containing the crude product (Rf = 0.35) was washed extensively with hexane:ethyl acetate (4:1). The filtrate was isolated under vacuum to afford a yellowish solid. Yields for this synthesis were not optimized.
[0535] A solution of protected glutathione (1.1 μmol, 4mg) in 90 μl DMF withN- hydroxysuccinimide (ΝHS, 11 μmol, 1.3 mg), dicyclohexylcarbodiimide (DCC, 11 μmol, 2.3 mg), and DMAP (5.7 μmol, 0.7 mg) was agitated for 1 hour. The mixture was spun down and the supernatant was added to 5'-amino-terminated protected DΝA on CPG beads. This mixture was agitated for 2 hours and then the beads were washed with DMF, with CH3CΝ, and dried with nitrogen.
Preparation of Compound (2a) [0536] N-formyl-Met-Leu-Phe (MLF) was purchased from Sigma and coupled to 5'- amino-terminated protected DΝA on CPG beads using the conditions described for compound
Preparation of Compound (2b)
[0537] MLF (10-100 μmol, 0.17 M) was dissolved in dry DMF with 1 equiv. 1- hydroxybenzotriazole (Νovabiochem), 0.9 equiv. 0-Benzotriazol-l-yl-N,N,N',N'- tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate (Aldrich), and 2.3 equivalents of DIPEA. The solution was. agitated at room temperature for 1 hour and then added to a unique sequence of 5 '-amino- terminated protected DNA on CPG beads'. The mixture was agitated for 1 hour at room
I' , ' , , . • ' temperature. , The beads then were washed with DMF, then with CH3CN, and dried under nitrogen. ι . . Preparation of Compound (3)
[0538] Fmoc-Lys(Mmt)-OH (Novabiochem) was attached, to amino-terminated protected
DNA on CPG beads using the method described for compound (2b). The Fmoc group was , removed with three 2 minute washes with 20% piperidine in DMF. The mixture then was washed with DMF and then with CH3CN. The α-amine then was capped with a solution of 5% 1 -methylimidazole in acetic anhydride/pyridine/tetrahydrofuran (1 : 1.1 : 18) for 10 minutes at room temperature. The beads then were washed with DMF and CH3CN, and then treated with 3% trichloroacetic acid, 1% thioanisole in CH2CI2 for 5 minutes at room temperature to remove the Mmt protecting group. The mixture was washed with CH3CN and dried with nitrogen. Fmoc-Phg-OH (Novabiochem) was attached to the ε-amine ofthe Lys-linked DNA using the method described for compound (2b). After removal ofthe Fmoc protecting group, 4- carboxybenzenesulfonamide (Aldrich) was attached to the beads using the method described for compound (2b). The beads were washed with DMF, then with CH3CN, and dried with nitrogen.
Preparation of Compounds (4a, 4b) [0539] A 5 '-biotin modified phosphoramidite (Glen Research, Sterling, Virginia, USA) was used as the final monomer in the DNA synthesis.
Preparation of Compound (5) [0540] Chymostatin (Sigma) was attached to amino-terminated protected DNA on CPG beads using the conditions described for compound (2b).
Preparation of Compound (6) [0541] Antipain (Sigma, 1.5 μmol, 0.9 mg) was added to a 30 μL solution of 300 mM
DCC and 300 mM NHS in DMF. After agitating for 1 hour at room temperature, this solution was added to 45 μL of 5 '-amino terminated DNA (-200-300 μM) in 0.1 M MES buffer pH 6.0. This DNA had previously been cleaved from the CPG beads and purified by HPLC as described in the next section. After 2 hours, this solution was purified by gel filtration using Sephadex G- 25 followed by reverse-phase HPLC. [0542] The complete structures of synthetic groups 1-6 linked to DNA are shown in
Figure 83.
, Characterization of DNA-linked Synthetic Molecules
[0543] Small molecule-DNA conjugates were cleaved from the CPG beads with a solution of methylamine:ammonium hydroxide (1:1) at 55 °C for 1 hour. The solution was dried under vacuum and then purified by reverse phase HPLC using TEAA/CH3CN gradient and analyzed by MALDI-TOF mass spectrometry. Stock solution concentrations were determined
, usjng UN- Vis specfroscopy and serial dilutions were prepared for the selection experiments. Samples were stored in water at -20 °C. Preparation of Immobilized Target Proteins
[0544] NHS-activated Sepharose 4 Fast Flow (Amersham Pharmacia) was prepared in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. Equine GST, bovine carbonic anhydrase (CA), papain, Nα-p-tosyl-L-lysine chloromethyl ketone (TLCK)-treated bovine chymotrypsin, and N- -tosyl-L-phenylalanine chloromethyl ketone (TPCK)-treated bovine trypsin were purchased from Sigma. Typically, proteins were dissolved in phosphate buffered saline (PBS) buffer pH 7.4-7.6 at concentrations of 20-100 μM. Protein concentrations were determined using UV-Vis spectrometry. Proteins were incubated with beads for 16 hours at 4 °C. The beads were capped for two hours with Tris buffer, then washed extensively with the appropriate selection buffer containing 1 M NaCI and then exchanged into the appropriate selection buffer (see, Table 14). Beads were stored for up to 1 month at 4 °C in a volume of selection buffer equal to the initial volume of beads used. Before use, papain beads were activated using a solution of 5.5 mM cysteine HCl, 1.1 mM EDTA, and 0.067 mM β-mercaptoethanol for 30 minutes at 4 °C. Streptavidin magnetic particles (Roche) were washed 3x with selection buffer before use.
TABLE 14: Selection and Wash Buffers
Figure imgf000178_0001
Figure imgf000179_0001
GST Selection
[0545] 'The amount of compound (1), the binding ligand, was varied between 103 and 107 molecules and compound (2a), the non-binding ligand, was used in 10 -10 molar excess. (1) and (2a) were added to 40 μL of GST beads and agitated at 4 °C for 1 hour. The mixture was transfened to a 5.0 μm low-binding Durapore'membrane spin filter (Millipore), wasned with 2χι 150 μL PBS pH 7.4, lx 100 μL 0.1 M Tris pH 8.0, 0.5 M NaCI, and 1x150 μL PBS! The bound ligands were eluted by agitating the beads with 100 μL 0.1 M glutathione (Sigma) at room temperature. The eluant was ethanol precipitated with 3 M sodium acetate and 1 μL glycogen. The precipitate was used directly for PCR.
Carbonic Anhydrase Selection [0546] Compound (2b), the non-binding ligand, and compound (3), the binding ligand, were added to 40 μL of resuspended beads and were diluted to 400 μL with selection buffer. Ratios were similar to those for the GST selection. The mixture was agitated at 4 °C for 1-2 hours. Selections then were carried out at room temperature. Each mixture was transfened to a spin filter and washed 3x with 400 μL of wash buffer and lx 400 μL with selection buffer. The resin was removed from the spin filter with 60 μL of selection buffer and the resulting beads were subjected to PCR.
Papain Selection [0547] Compound (4a), the non-binding ligand, and compounds (5) or (6), the binding ligands, were incubated with papain beads and selected as described for the carbonic anhydrase selection. Chymotrypsin Selection [0548] Compound (4a), the non-binding ligand, and compound (5), the binding ligand, were incubated with chymotrypsin beads and selected as described for the carbonic anhydrase selection. ι ' Trypsin Selection
[0549] Compound (4a), the non-binding ligand, and compound (6), the binding ligand, were incubated with trypsin beads and selected as described for carbonic anhydrase.
' Streptavidin Selection [0550] Compound (3), the non-binding ligand, and compound (4b), the binding ligand, were incubated with 15 μL streptavidin magnetic particles and agitated at room temperature for 20 minutes. Using a MPC-S magnet (Dynal), the beads were washed 2x with 0.1 M NaOH, 1 mM EDTA (100-200 μL), 4x with wash buffer (100-200 μL), and lx with selection buffer. The beads then were resuspended in 15 μL double distilled H20.
Iterated Carbonic Anhydrase Selection [0551] 108 molecules of compound (3) and 1011 molecules of compound (2b) were incubated with 40 μL carbonic anhydrase beads for 1 hours and then selected as described. After the first round of selection, 5 μL of resuspended agarose beads were removed for PCR. 6 M guanidinium HCl, 10 mM EDTA (40 μL) was added to the beads and the mixture was heated to 90 °C for 15 minutes. The beads were filtered away using a Wizard Minicolumn (Promega). The filtrate was buffer exchanged into selection buffer using a Centrisep Spin Column (Princeton Separations). A new aliquot of carbonic anhydrase beads was added to the eluted templates. After a second round of selection, the agarose beads were suspended in 30 μL of H2O and 15 μL were used for PCR. The PCR products were digested with Hind III, generating the results in Figure 84. [0552] The triple iteration selection was carried out essentially as described above with a few minor changes. The prepared carbonic anhydrase beads were incubated with ZnSO4 (1 mM) for 1 hour and then washed extensively with selection buffer containing 2 M NaCI. The beads were exchanged back into selection buffer and used directly for the iterated selection. 109 molecules of compound (3) and 1015 molecules of compound (4b) were added to the beads and selected as described above. After the first round of selection, 3 μL aliquot was removed for PCR. A second round of selection was carried dut ^s described above and 8 μL aliquot of beads was removed for PCR, After a third round of selection, the resulting beads were removed from ' the spin filter using 30 μL of double distilled H2O and 15 μL of resuspended beads were used for PCR. , ' , , Papain Affinity And Papain Specificity Selections
[0553] Affinity selection: 6xl09 molecules of compound (6), 2.3xl010 molecules' . compound (5), and ,1.4χlOu molecules of compound (4a) were added to 40 μL papain beads for '
1 hour. The beads were washed with papairi wash buffer (3 x 100 μL) and once with 100 μL' papain selection buffer. The beads were removed from the spin filter with 30 μL of double ' distilled H2O. A 3 μL aliquot of resuspended beads were removed for PCR. The DNA conjugates were eluted from the beads by adding 70 μL 6 M guanidinium HCl and heating the mixture to 90°C for 15 minutes. The eluted material was buffer exchanged as described in the • , iterated carbonic anhydrase selection. After a second round of selection, the agarose beads were removed from the spin filter using 30 μL H2O and 15 μL of resuspended beads were used for PCR.
[0554] Specificity selection: The same amounts of antipain, chymostatin, and biotin were added to 40 μL chymotrypsin agarose beads in chymotrypsin selection buffer and incubated for 1 hour. The beads were spun down and the flow through was added to 40 μL fresh chymotrypsin beads and incubated for 1 hour. The beads were spun down and 15 μL of 100 μM chymotrypsin in papain selection buffer was added to the flow through and then incubated for 1 hour. This solution was added to 40 μL of papain beads and selected as described above. The small molecule-DNA conjugates were eluted and buffer exchanged as described, incubated with 15 μL 100 μM chymotrypsin for 1 hour and then subjected to a second round of selection. The beads were removed from the spin filter with 30 μL of H2O and 15 μL were used for PCR. Contamination Controls
[0555] Due to the high sensitivity of these experiments, two important contamination controls were used throughout these studies. First, each selection was carried out as described above except no ligand-DNA conjugates were added to the protein-linked beads, which permitting testing for buffer contamination and any cross-contamination among samples. Secondly, a PCR reaction in which no material from the selection was added was used to test for contamination in primers, dNTPs, and PCR buffers. i PCR Conditions and Gel Electrophoresis Analysis
[0556] Templates surviving the selection were amplified using PCR. All reactions ' contained i μM of each primer and 250 μM of each dNTP (Promega). For the GST selection, the precipitated DNA was used in the PCR reaction and amplified with Platinum Taq
(Invifrogen). PCR conditions were step 1: 94°C, 2'; step 2: 94°C, 30 s; step 3: 55°C, 1"; step
4:72°C, 3,0 s; step 5: go to step 2, x29; step 6: 72°C,' 5';' step 7: hold at 4°C. For all other selections, the agarose beads (3-15 μL) w,ere used directly in the PCR reaction with Taq polymerase (Promega). PCR conditions were step 1: 94°C, 2' step 2: 94°C, 30 s- step 3: 55°C,
1'; step 4: 72°C, 30 s; step 5: go to step 2, x24; step 6: 4°C.
[0557] The PCR products then
Figure imgf000182_0001
digested for 1 -2 hours with the restriction enzymes
(New England Biolabs, 5-10 units) that digest the ligand-encoding DNA. Digestion products were analyzed by electrophoresis on 3% agarose gels and quantitiated by ethidium bromide staining and densitometry on a Strategene Eagle Eye II system.
Enrichment Calculations [0558] Enrichment ratios are calculated as the ratio ofthe fraction of binding ligand surviving the selection as determined by restriction digestion to the fraction of binding ligand entering the selection as determined by the known concentrations ofthe stock solutions. DNA Sequences of Templates and Primers
[0559] Restriction endonuclease cleavage sites are underlined.
DNA Sequences for Glutathione S Transferase Selections: [0560] GSH-template (1): 5 '-GCC TCT GCG ACC GTT CGG AAG CTT CGC GAG TTG CCC AGC GCG (Hind III) [SEQ ID NO: 112]
[0561] MLF-template (2a): 5 '-GCC TCT GCG ACC GTT CGG GAA TTC CGC GAG
TTG CCC AGC GCG (Eco RI) [SEQ ID NO: 113]
[0562] Primer 1 : 5'-GCC TCT GCG ACC GTT CGG [SEQ ID NO: 114]
[0563] Primer 2: 5'-CGC GCT GGG CAA CTC GCG [SEQ ID NO: 115] DNA Sequences for Carbonic Anhydrase Selections: [0564] Phenyl sulfonamide-template O): 5'-CGA TGC TAG CGA AGG AAG CTT
CCA CTG CAC GTC TGC (Hind TIT) [SEQ ID NO: 116] [0565] ' MLF-template (2b): 5'-CGA TGC TAG. CGA AGG GAA TTC CCA CTG CAC GTC TGC (EcøTI) [SEQ ID NO: 117] , ". • ' ■ ' ' • ,
[0566] , ', Biotin-template (4b): 5'-CGA TGC TAG CGA AGG GAA TTC GCA CTG CAC GTC TGC (EcαRI) [SEQ ID NO:1118] " '; ,■ ' ' :' '
[0567] Primer 1: 5'CGA TGC TAG CGA AGG [SEQ ID NO: 119] [0568] Primer 2: 5'-GCA GAC GTG CAG TGG [SEQ ID NO: 120]
DNA Sequences for Protease Selections: '
[0569] Chymostatin-template (5): 5 '-GCA GTC GAC TCG ACC GGA TCC GGC TAC
GAC GTG CAC (BaM HI) [SEQ ID NO: 121] [0570] Antipain-template (6): 5'-GCA GTC GAC TCG ACC CAG CTG GGC TAC
GAC GTG CAC (Pvu II) [SEQ ID NO: 122]
[0571] Biotin-template (4a): 5 '-GCA GTC GAC TCG ACC AAG CTT GGC TAC GAC
GTG CAC (Hind III) [SEQ TD NO: 123]
[0572] Primer 1 : 5 '-GCA GTC GAC TCG ACC [SEQ ID NO: 124] [0573] Primer 2: 5'-GTG CAC GTC GTA GCC. [SEQ ID NO: 125]
Example 12: Identification of New Chemical Reactions
[0574] This Example demonstrates that it is possible to identify the existence of new chemical reactions via nucleic acid-templated synthesis. New chemical reactions have been identified as a result of experiments to select for, and characterize, bond forming reactions.
[0575] A one-pot selection scheme to identify new bond forming reactions is summarized in Figure 85. Briefly, when n pool A reactants and combined with m pool B biotinylated reactants, n x m possible reaction combinations are available. When the templated reaction is performed under a particular set of reaction conditions certain combinations ofthe template (e.g., reactant A27) reacts with certain combinations ofthe transfer unit (e.g., the reactant biotinylated Bl 1). The reaction products are captured by avidin linked beads. ' Unreacted templates 'are not captured by the 'avidin and can be removed by washing. The avidin captured reaction product can then be amplified,' for exarhple, by PCR, and the template sequenced 'to determine its codon sequence. As shown, the amplified template included, a sequence tag (coding region) for reactant A27 and a codon sequence (annealing region) for ' ' reactant Bll. ' , ' ' ' '
[0576] Figure 86 provides a schematic overview of a scheme for producing a library, of ' compounds, members of which were, created by new identified chemical reactions. In order to select for bond-forming reactions, four pool A reactants presenting either a phenyl group (AlBl and A1B2) or a primary amine (A2B1 and A2B2) and two biotinylated pool B reactants presenting either a carboxylic acid (Bl) or a methyl ester (B2) were prepared. The two coding and two annealing regions contained different restriction digestion sites to permit the relative quantitiation of each of the four pool A members from within a mixture. All six reactants (250 mol of each pool A reactant and 500 finol of each of Bl and B2) were combined in a single pot either in the presence or absence of DMT-MM, which is known to mediate amide formation between amines and carboxylic acids (Gartner et al. (2002) AGNEW. CHEM. INT. ED. 41: 1796- 1800; Kunishima et al. (2002) TETRAHEDRON 57: 1551-1558). The crude reactions were passed over streptavidin-linked magnetic beads to select for templates encoding bond-forming reactions and washed with denaturant to remove pool A members that did not undergo bond formation with a pool B member. The selected molecules were eluted with free biotin and formamide. A fraction ofthe eluant conesponding to 5 frnol of initial total reactants was amplified by PCR and subjected to DNA sequencing and restriction digestion to determine the ratio ofthe four possible reaction-encoding sequences (i.e., reaction ofthe phenyl group with the carboxylic acid, reaction ofthe phenyl group with the ester, reaction ofthe amine group with the carboxylic acid, and reaction ofthe amine group with the ester) (Figure 86).
[0577] Combining the reactants in the absence of DMT-MM resulted in very little PCR product formation following selection. In contrast, strong PCR product was observed when the reactants were combined in the presence of DMT-MM (Figure 86), consistent with the effectiveness of capturing reacted pool A members and the thoroughness ofthe washing steps. This result suggests that the yield of PCR product following selection for bond-forming reactions can .serve as a simple screen for the presence of bond formation within a pool of reactants. To determine the identity of the bond-forming reactants, the PCR products were digested with Mse
I' . r . ■ ' '
I,, hich cleaves the coding region for A2 but not Al, and 7sp45 I, which cleaves the annealing region for B2 but not B 1. An analysis of the digestion fragments revealed that reaction in the , absence of DMT-MM followed by selection resulted in a mixture of all four possible reaction- encoding pool A members (Figure 86). in contrast, reaction in the presence of DMT-MM followed by selection generated the A2B1 sequence and no significant amount ofthe other three sequences (Figure 86), indicating strong enrichment for the DNA encoding bond formation between the amine and the carboxylic acid. DNA sequencing ofthe selected PCR products was consistent with the restriction digestion analysis. These results validate the basic principle ofthe proposed method and system for discovering new reactions.
[0578] In order to test the ability ofthe proposed reaction discovery system to select a single reactive combination out of an even larger excess of unreactive combinations, the system was programmed with three reaction possibilities (amine + carboxylic acid, amide + ester, and amine + ester) and combined the conesponding DNA-linked reactants in proportions that favor the unreactive combinations (amide + ester and amine + ester) by 100-fold. In the presence of amide coupling reagent DMT-MM, in vitro selection ofthe resulting mixture for bond-forming reactions resulted in a >1, 000-fold enrichment ofthe template encoding bond formation between the amine and carboxylic acid. No enrichment was observed when DMT-MM was omitted. This result further supports the possibility of selecting and decoding a single reactive bond- forming combination from the planned 30 by 30 matrix of 900 reaction possibilities.
Validation of New Reaction Discovery (Example A) [0579] This Example shows that it is indeed possible to discover new chemical reactions using DNA-templated synthesis. A 25-reaction matrix containing the DNA-linked functional groups shown in Figure 87 was generated essentially as described in Figure 9 using the omega architecture, the one-pot assembly method for pool A reactants, and an optimized codon set. Among the 25 possible reactions in this set is the Huisgen 1,3-dipolar cycloaddition (Huisgen et al. (1989) PURE APPL. CHEM. 61: 613) between an azide and an alkyne. Shaφless and co- workers recently reported (Rostoutseu et al. (2002) ANGEW CHEM. INT. ED. ENGL. 41 : 2596) that catalytic CuSO4 and sodium ascorbate dramatically improve the regioselectivity and efficiency of this process, permitting a robust reaction at room temperature. A reaction discovery selection was performed on a 1 pmol scale using this 25-reaction matrix either in the presence or the absence of CuSO and sodium ascorbate.
[0580] In the presence of copper and ascorbate, selection for bond-forming reactions followed by PCR amplification and sequence analysis by restriction digestion highly enriched the pool A template encoding the alkyne- and azide-encoding reactants (see, Lane 2 in Figure
87B). In contrast, omjtting copper and ascorbate resulted in no enrichment for the alkyne- and azide-encoding template (see, Lane 3 in Figure 87B). The reaction discovery selection system , therefore successfully "rediscovered" the Cu(I)-mediatqd coupling of an alkyne and azide. ,
, Validation of New Reaction Discovery (Example B) [0581] This Example shows that the reaction identified in Example A can also be identified in a 96-reaction matrix. Briefly, a 96-reaction matrix containing the DNA-linked functional groups shown in Figure 88 was generated. ,Pool A contained 12 reactants (A1-A12) and pool B contained 8 biotinylated reactants (B1-B8). When combined, 96 different reactions were possible. [0582] The reactants (10 finol each) were combined in the presence of 500 μM Cu (I) at pH 6.0. Following reaction selection and amplification, one oligonucleotide sequence was enriched. In particular, there was a 27-fold enrichment for the template encoding the reaction between reactant A2 and reactant B5. The reaction product, like Example A, appears to have resulted from a Huisgen cycloaddition reaction. In contrast, when no Cu (I) was present, there was very little PCR product with no enrichment for any combination ofthe reactants.
Validation of New Reaction Discovery (Example C) [0583] This Example shows another example that it is possible to discover new chemical reactions using nucleic acid-templated synthesis. In particular, this Example demonstrates the discovery of a novel Pd-mediated coupling reaction. [0584] A library of reactants were created and combined to test for the ability of nucleic acid-templated Pd-mediated coupling reactions. Two pools of reactants (see, Figure 89) were synthesized to give 12 pool A reactants (A1-A12) and 8 biotinylated pool B reactants (B1-B8). When combined, 96 different reactions were possible. The reactants (10 finol each) were combined in the presence of 1 mM Pd(II) at pH 7.0. Following reaction selection and amplification, five oligonucleotide sequences were enriched between 10-fold and 22-fold. Analysis ofthe five oligonucleotide sequences revealed that reactions occuned between (i) I reactant A2 and reactant Bl (ii) reactant A2 and reactant B4, (iii) reactant A2 and reactant B8
(iv) reactant A9 and reactant Bl, and (v) reactant A10 and reactant B4.
[0585] i As an alternative to sequencing the enriched oligonucleotides, the identity ofthe oligonucleotide sequences attached to the reaction products' were determined by microarray analysis (see, Figure 90). A library of anti-sense oligonucleotides complementary to eac ofthe templates to be included in the reaction matrix are synthesized. Then, individual antisense oligonucleotides (1 ' - 9' in Figure 90) complementary to each template are immobilized at , sep&rate addressable locations of a microanay. The1 sequence of each anti-sense Oligonucleotide immobilized in the microanay is known. After nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the oligonucleotides attached to the resulting reaction products (for example, PI attached to template
1 and product P8 attached to template 8 in Figure 90) are amplified under conditions to permit incoφoration of a detectable moiety, for example, a fluoφhore, into the amplified template. The amplified oligonucleotides then are denatured and combined with the microanay under conditions to permit the template oligonucleotide (for example, oligonucleotide 1 and oligonucleotide 8 in Figure 90) to hybridize to its immobilized, complementary oligonucleotide. After washing to remove unbound material, the microanay may then be scanned to detect a specific binding event via detection ofthe detectable moiety at a particular location. Based on the location ofthe detectable moiety and the known sequence ofthe complementary oligonucleotide immobilized at that location, it is possible to determine the sequence ofthe bound template and thus the reactants that produced the reaction product.
[0586] This type of microarray analysis approach was used following reactions similar to those described in Example B (96-reaction matrix with Cu (I)) and in Example C hereinabove (96-reaction matrix with Pd (TT)). The microanay analysis was found to agree with the DNA sequencing results. Furthermore, the microanay analysis was found to be more direct, more sensitive, and significantly faster (at least 5-fold faster) than standard sequencing methodologies.
[0587] By way of example, various products ofthe Pd (II) mediated reactions were detected via the microanay system, the results of which are summarized in Figure 91. Figure 91 summarizes which reactants in pool A reacted with which biotinylated reactants in pool B to create a product. Figure 91 also summarizes the level of signal over background and DNA- templated reaction yield for each product. Of particular interest is the discovery using both sequence analysis approaches of a bond-forming reaction between DNA-linked terminal alkyne A2 and DNA-linked acrylamide B8 in the presence of 1 mM Pd(II) at pH 7 (see, Figures 89 and 91). This reaction is comparable iri efficiency ,a DNA-templated Heck coupling reactions of aryl iodides and olefins and does not proceed in fhe absence of a Pd source. Although Pdrmediated couplings between terminal alkynes and aryl iodides are known (Amatbre et al. (1995) J. ORG. CHEM. 60:' 6829), the Pd-mediated coupling of terminal alkynes with simple or electron deficient olefins appears 'to be a new type of reaction sόheme. This newly discovered reaction scheme may now be characterized in greater detail using more conventional larger scale reactions. '
INCORPORATION By REFERENCE
[0588] i The entire contents of each ofthe publications, patents and patent applications' cited herein are incoφorated by reference into this application for all puφoses.
EQUIVALENTS
, '' ' : ■
[0589] ' , The invention may be embodied in other specific forms without departing form the spirit or essential characteristics thereof. The foregoing embodiments are therefore to be considered in all respects illustrative rather than limiting on the invention described herein. Scope of the invention is thus indicated by the appended claims rather than by the foregoing description, and all changes that come within the meaning and range of equivalency ofthe. claims are intended to be embraced therein.

Claims

What is claimed is: , , , 1. A method of inducing reaction between first and second reactive units during a nucleic , acid-templated chemical reaction, the method comprising the steps of: (a) providing (i) a template comprising a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a codon and (ii) a transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an ariti-codon capable of annealing to said codon, wherein said codon or said anti-codon comprise first and second spaced apart regions; ' (b) annealing said oligonucleotides together thereby to bring said first reactive unit and said second reaction unit into reactive proximity, wherein said codon or said anti-codon having said first and second spaced apart regions produce a loop of oligonucleotides not annealed to the conesponding anti-codon or codon; and (c) inducing a covalent bond-forming reaction between said reactive units to produce a reaction product.
2. The method of claim 1, wherein at least one of said reactive units is attached adjacent a terminal region of its conesponding oligonucleotide.
3. The method of claim 2, wherein each of said reactive units is attached adjacent a terminal portion of its conesponding oligonucleotide.
4. The method of claim 1, 2, or 3, wherein said codon or said anti-codon is disposed at least 10 bases away from its conesponding reactive unit.
5. The method of claim 1, 2, or 3, wherein said codon or said anti-codon is disposed at least 20 bases away from its conesponding reactive unit.
6. The method of claim 1, 2, or 3, wherein said codon or said anti-codon is disposed directly adjacent its conesponding reactive unit.
7. The method of claim 1, wherein in said codon or said anti-codon comprising said first and second spaced apart regions, said first region is disposed directly adjacent a terminus of its conesponding oligonucleotide.
8. The method of claim 1 or 7, wherein said first region of said codon or said anti-codon comprises three, four or five adjacent nucleotides.
9. The method of claim 1 or 7, wherein said first region of said codon or said anti-codon comprises five adjacent nucleotides.
10; The method of claim 1 or 7,' wherein said second region is disposed at least 20 bases away from said reactive unit. , ' ■ ', ,
11., The metliod of claim 1 or 7, wherein said second region is disposed at least 30 bases away from said reactive unit. , ,, ' ' , '
1 . ' ' ' " '.. ' ', ', ' 12. The method of claim 1, wherein said first reactive unit is covalently attached to, said , first oligonucleotide. , , , ' ,
13. The method of claim 1 or 12, wherein said second reactive unit is covalently attached to said second oligonucleotide. , , , '
14. A method, of inducing reaction between first and second reactive units dμring a
1 , ι ' ' ' nucleic acid-templated chemical reaction, the method comprising the steps of: (a) providing (i) a template comprising a first reactive unit associated with a first . oligonucleotide having a proximal end and a distal end and comprising a codon and (ii) a transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon capable of annealing with said codon, wherein said first reactive unit is attached to an attachment site intermediate said proximal end and said distal end of said first oligonucleotide; (b) annealing said oligonucleotides together thereby to bring said first reactive unit and said second reactive unit into reactive proximity; and (c) inducing a covalent bond-forming reaction between said reactive units to produce a reaction product.
15. The method of claim 14, wherein said template comprises a second, different codon capable of annealing to a second, different anti-codon sequence.
16. The method of claim 15, wherein said first codon is located proximal to, and said second codon is located distal to, said attachment site of said first reactive unit.
17. The method of claim 15 or 16, further comprising providing a second transfer unit comprising a third reactive unit associated with a third oligonucleotide comprising a second, different anti-codon sequence capable of annealing with said second codon.
18. The method of claim 17, wherein said first anti-codon of said first transfer unit anneals to said first codon of said template and said second anti-codon of said second transfer uqit anneals to said second codon of said template. i ' ■ .
, ,
19. The method of claim 18, wherein said first transfer unit anneals with said teriiplate concunently with said second transfer unit, so that said second reactive unit and said third > reactive unit react with said first reactive unit.
20. The method of claim 14, wherein said first reactive unit is covalently attached to said first oligonucleotide.
21. The method of claim 14 or 20, wherein said second reactive unit is covalently attached to said second oligonucleotide.
22. The method of claim 17, wherein said third reactive unit is covalently attached to said third oligonucleotide. ,
23. The method of claim 14, wherein said first reactive unit is a scaffold molecule.
24. A method of increasing reaction selectivity among a plurality of reactants in a nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the method comprising the steps of: (a) providing (i) a template comprising a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a predetermined codon sequence, (ii) a first transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to said codon sequence, and (iii) a second transfer unit comprising a third reactive unit different from said second reactive unit associated with a third oligonucleotide without an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to said codon sequence; and (b) mixing said template, said first transfer unit and said second transfer unit under conditions to permit annealing of said second oligonucleotide of said first transfer unit to said first oligonucleotide of said template thereby to enhance covalent bond formation between said second reactive unit and said first reactive unit relative to covalent bond formation between said third reactive unit and said first reactive unit.
25. The method of claim 24, wherein said template is associated with a capturable moiety.
26. The method of claim 24, wherein said first transfer unit is associated with a capturable moiety. ' .
.. ' . , - . .
27. The method of claim 24, wherein said second transfer unit is associated with a capturable moiety. ' , ' ,
28., The method of claim 25, 26, or 27, wherein said capturable moiety is selected from the group consisting of biotin, avidin and streptavidin.
29. The method of claim 28, further comprising the step of capturing said capturable moiety. ' . , . , , ' ,
30. The method of claim 24, wherein said first reactive unit is covalently attached to said first oligonucleotide. ' , , , . '
31. . The method of claim 24, wherein said second reactive unit is covalently, attached to said secorid oligonucleotide.
32. The method of claim 24, wherein said third reactive unit is covalently attached to said third oligonucleotide.
33. The method of claim 24, wherein said second reactive unit and said third reactive unit are capable of reacting independently with said first, reactive unit.
34. The method of claim 24 or 33, wherein said second reactive unit and said third reactive unit are capable of reacting with one another.
35. The method of claim 34, wherein the reaction between said second reactive unit and said third reactive unit are incompatible with their respective reactions with said first reactive unit.
36. The method of claim 24, comprising providing a plurality of transfer units.
37. A method of increasing reaction selectivity among a plurality of reactants in a nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the method comprising the steps of: (a) providing (i) a template comprising a first oligonucleotide comprising first and second codon sequences, (ii) a first transfer unit comprising a first reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising a first anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to said first - 192 - " . . . ' , codon sequence, (iii) a second transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a . third oligonucleotide comprising a second anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to said second codon sequence, and (iv) a third transfer unit comprising a third reactive unit associated with a fourth oligonucleotide sequence without an anti-codon sequence capable of annealing to, said first codon sequence or said second codon sequence; and (b) mixing said template, said first transfer unit, said second transfer unit and said third transfer unit under conditions to permit annealing of said first anti-codon sequence to said first i codon sequence and said second anti-codon sequence to said second codon sequence thereby to enhance covalent bond formation between said first reactive unit and said second reactive unit relative to covalent bond formation between said third reactive unit and said first reactive unit or between said third reactive unit and said second reactive unit.
38. The method of claim 37, wherein said template is associated with a capturable moiety.
39. The method of claim 38, wherein said capturable moiety is selected from the group consisting of biotin, avidin and streptavidin.
40. The method of claim 38, wherein said capturable moiety is a reaction product resulting from a reaction between said first reactive unit and said second reactive unit when said first transfer unit and said second transfer unit are annealed to said template.
41. The method of claim 37, wherein said first reactive unit is covalently attached to said second oligonucleotide.
42. The method of claim 37, wherein said second reactive unit is covalently attached to said third oligonucleotide.
43. The method of claim 37, wherein said third reactive unit is covalently attached to said fourth oligonucleotide.
44. The method of claim 37, wherein said third reactive unit is capable of reacting with said first reactive unit or said second reactive unit.
45. The method of claim 37, wherein said fhird reactive unit is capable of reacting with
, I 1 ' ' said first reactive unit and said second reactive unit,
46. The method of claim 44 or 45, whereiri trie reaction between said, third reactive unit and said first reactive unit is incompatible with the reaction between said first reactive unit and said second reactive unit.
' ' .. ' . ' " ' . ' 47. The method of claim 44 or 45, whereiri the reaction between said third reactive unit and said second reacti e unit is incompatible, with the reaction between said first reactive unjt and sard.secbnd reactive unit. <
48. The method of claim 37, wherein said covalent bond formation between said first reactive unit and said second reactive unit is via a regioselective distance dependent reaction.
49. A method of performing stereoselective nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the method comprising the steps of: ' ι | ,
(a) providing (i) a template comprising a first oligonucleotide optionally associated with a reactive unit and (ii) one or more transfer units each comprising a second oligonucleotide associated with a reactive unit; (b) annealing said first and second oligonucleotides, thereby bringing at least two said reactive units into reactive proximity and inducing formation of a covalent bond between said reactive units to form a reaction product, wherein said reaction product comprises a chiral center and is of at least 60% stereochemical purity at said chiral center.
50. The method of claim 49, wherein said reaction product is of at least 80% stereochemical purity at said chiral center.
51. The method of claim 49, wherein said reaction product is of at least 95% stereochemical purity at said chiral center.
52. The method of claim 49, wherein said reaction product is of at least 99% stereochemical purity at said chiral center.
53. The method of claim 49, wherein said chiral center is at an atom participating in said covalent bond in said reaction product.
54. A method of performing stereoselective nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the method comprising the steps of: . (a) providing (i) at least I VO templates, one' template comprising a first oligonucleotide , associated with a first reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration and the other template comprising a said first oligonucleotide associated with a said first reactive unit having a second,' different stereochemical configuration and (ii) at least one transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide, wherein a sequence of said second oligonucleotide is complementary to a sequence, of said first oligonucleotide; and (b) annealing said first and secorid oligonucleotides together under conditions to permit ' said second reactive unit of said transfer unit to react preferentially with either said first reactive unit having sa d first stereochemical configuration or said first reactive unit having said second stereochemical configuration to produce a reaction product.
55. A method of performing stereqselective nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the method
■ • 'r- ' ' ' I ' ' , compnsmg the. steps of: ι (a) providing (i) template comprising a first oligonμcleotide associated with a first reactive unit and (ii) at least two transfer units, one transfer unit comprising a second oligonucleotide associated with a second reactive unit having a first stereochemical, configuration and the other transfer unit comprising a said second oligonucleotide associated with a said second reactive unit having a second, different stereochemical configuration, wherein a sequence of said second oligonucleotide is complementary to a sequence of said first oligonucleotide; and (b) annealing said first and second oligonucleotides together under conditions to permit said first reactive unit of said template to react preferentially with either said second reactive unit having said first stereochemical configuration or said second reactive unit having said second stereochemical configuration to produce a reaction product.
56. The method of claim 54 or 55, wherein said reaction product has a particular stereochemical configuration.
57. The method of claim 54, wherein a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation of said first oligonucleotide determines which of said first reactive units reacts preferentially with said second reactive unit.
58. The method of claim 55, wherein a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation of said second oligonucleotide determines which of said second reactive units reacts preferentially with said first reactive unit. , '<
59. A reaction product produced by the method of any one of claims 54-58.
60. A method of performing stereoselective nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the method comprising the steps of: '; (a) providing (i) a template comprising a first oligonucleotide comprising a first codon sequence and a second codon sequence; (ii) a first pair of transfer units, wherein one transfer unit of said first pair comprises a second oligonucleotide with a first anti-codon sequence associated with a first reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration and the other, transfer unit of said first pair comprises a said second oligonucleotide associated with a said first, reactive unit having a second stereochemical configuration, and (iii) a second pair of transfer units, wherein one transfer unit ofthe second pair comprises a third oligonucleotide with a second anti-codon sequence associated with a second reactive unit having a first stereochemical configuration and the other transfer unit of said second pair comprises a said third oligonucleotide associated with a second reactive unit having a second stereochemical configuration; and (b) annealing said template, said first pair of transfer units, and said second pair of transfer units under conditions to permit a member of said first pair of transfer units to react preferentially with a member of said second pair of transfer units to produce a reaction product.
61. The method of claim 60, wherein said reaction product has a particular stereochemical configuration.
62. The method of claim 60, wherein a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation of said second oligonucleotide determines which member of said first pair of transfer units reacts preferentially to produce said reaction product.
63. The method of claim 60 or 62, wherein a stereochemical configuration or macromolecular conformation of said third oligonucleotide determines which member of said second pair of transfer units reacts preferentially to produce said reaction product.
64. A reaction product produced by the method of any one of claims 60-63.
65. A method of enriching a product, of a nucleic acid-templated synthesis, the method comprising the steps of: (a) providing a first library of molecules coriiprising a plurality of reaction prbdμcts ■ associated with a corresponding plurality of oligonucleotides, wherein each qligonuclόotide comprises a nucleotide sequence indicative of the reaction product associated therewith, and wherein a portion of said reaction products are capable of binding to a preselected binding moi e♦ty; ' ' ' - " ' ' " ' . ' ' (b) exposing said first library ofmolecules to said binding moiety under conditions to ■
1 , ' '' " ' ' ' ' ' ' ' permit reaction product capable of binding said'bindjng moiety to bind thereto; . . (c) removing unbound reaction products; and ./ (d) eluting bound reaction product, from said binding moiety to produce a second library ofmolecules enriched at least 50-fold for reaction prodμct that binds ,said binding moiety relative to said first library. , •
. : ' i
66., The method of claim 65, wherein in step, (b), said binding moiety is immobilized on ' a solid support.
67. The method of claim 65 or 66, wherein said binding moiety is a target biomolecule.
68. The method of claim 67, wherein said target biomolecule is a protein.
69. The method of claim 65, wherein in step (d),'said second library is enriched at least 100-fold for reaction product that binds said binding moiety.
70. The method of claim 69, wherein in step (d), said second library is enriched at least 1 ,000-fold for reaction product that binds said binding rnoiety.
71. The method of claim 65, further comprising repeating steps (b), (c), and (d).
72. The method of claim 71, wherein repeating steps (b), (c), and (d) produces a third library enriched by at least 10,000-fold for reaction product that binds said binding moiety.
73. The method of claim 72, wherein said library is enriched by at least 100,000-fold for reaction product that binds said binding moiety.
74. The method of claim 65, wherein said oligonucleotide comprises a first sequence that identifies a first reactive unit that produced said reaction product capable of binding said preselected binding moiety. ■ ι >
! 75. The method of claim 74, wherein said oligonucleotide comprises a second sequence that identifies a second reactive unit that produced said reaction product capable of binding said preselected binding moiety.
76. The method of claim 65 or 71, comprising the additional step of amplifying oligonucleotide associated with the enriched reaction product.
77. The method of claim 65, 71, 74, or 75, comprising the additional step of determining the sequence ofthe oligonucleotide associated with the enriched reaction product. '
78. The method of claim 76, comprising the additional step of determining the sequence ofthe amplified oligonucleotide. ,
79. The method of claim 77, further comprising the step of characterizing said reaction product from information in said sequence of said oligonucleotide.
80. The method of claim 79, further comprising the step of identifying a new chemical reaction that produced said reaction product.
81. The method of claim 78, further comprising the step of characterizing the reaction product from information in said sequence of said oligonucleotide.
82. The method of claim 81, further comprising the step of identifying a new chemical reaction that produced said reaction product.
83. The method of claim 65, wherein said reaction products are covalently attached to a conesponding plurality of oligonucleotides.
84. A method of identifying a new chemical reaction, the method comprising the steps of: (a) providing a library ofmolecules comprising a plurality of reaction products associated with a conesponding plurality of oligonucleotides, wherein each oligonucleotide comprises a nucleotide sequence indicative ofthe reaction product associated therewith; (b) selecting a particular reaction product associated with its conesponding oligonucleotide; , ' '• , , , (c) characterizing the reaction product; and ' '(d) identifying a new chemical reaction that made the reaction product using information encoded by said conesponding oligonucleotide. ι ■ • ,
85. The method of claim 84, wherein step (c) comprises sequencing said conesponding' oligonucleotide to identify what reactive units produced, the reaction product. '
86. The method of claim 84, comprising the additional step of after step (b) amplifying ' its said conesponding oligonucleotide.
87. The method of claim 84, wherein the reaction product is covalently attached to its conesponding oiigomϊcleotides. ' ■ i ' ■ ,
88'. A method of identifying a new chemical reaction, the method ςomprising the steps of: , (a) providing (i) a template comprising a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide comprising a codon and (ii) a transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide comprising an anti-codon, wherein said codon and said anti-codon are capable of annealing together; (b) annealing the oligonucleotides together thereby to bring said first reactive unit and said second reactive unit into reactive proximity; (c) inducing a covalent bond-forming reaction between said reactive units to produce a reaction product; (d) characterizing the reaction product; and (e) identifying a new chemical reaction to make the reaction product using information encoded by the template to identify the first reactive unit and the second reactive unit that reacted to produce the reaction product.
89. The method of claim 88, further comprising the step of, after step (c) but prior to step (d), selecting the reaction product.
90. The method of claim 89, wherein in step (a), the transfer unit or the template is associated with a capturable moiety.
91. The method of claim 90, wherein said capturable moiety is selected fromi the' group consisting of biotin, avidin and streptavidin. .
,
92. The method of claim 91, wherein said capturable tnoiety is biotin.
93. The method of claim 92, wherein said biotin associated with the reaction product is captured by avidin or streptavidin coupled to a solid support.
94. The method of claim 88, whereiri said first reactive umt is covalently attached to said first oligonucleotide. ' • ,
95. The method of claim 88 or 94, wherein said second reactive unit is covalently attached to said second oligonucleotide. '
I 96. A method of identifying a new chemical reaction, the method comprising: (a) providing (i) a first transfer unit comprising a first reactive unit associated with a first oligonucleotide, (ii) a second transfer unit comprising a second reactive unit associated with a second oligonucleotide, and (iii) a template comprising sequences capable of annealing to said first oligonucleotide and to said second oligonucleotide; (b) annealing said oligonucleotides to said template thereby to bring said first and second reactive units into reactive proximity; (c) inducing a covalent bond-forming reaction between said reactive units to produce a reaction product; (d) characterizing said reaction product; and (e) identifying a new chemical reaction to make said reaction product using information encoded by said template to identify said first reactive unit and said second reactive unit that reacted to produce the reaction product.
97. The method of claim 96, further comprising the step of, after step (c) but prior to step (d), selecting said reaction product.
98. The method of claim 96, wherein in step (a), said template, said first transfer unit or said second transfer unit is associated with a capturable moiety.
99. The method of claim 98, wherein said capturable moiety is selected from the group consisting of biotin, avidin and streptavidin.
100. The method of claim 99, wherein said capturable moiety is biotin. >
' 101. The method of claim 100, wherein said biotin associated with said reaction product
' ' • , is captured by avidin or streptavidin coupϊed to a solid support.
102. The method of claim 96, wherein said first reactive unit is covalently attached to said first oligonucleotide. , '
103. The method of claim 96 or 102,' whereiri said secorid reactive unit is covalently attached to said second oligonucleotide. ' ,
PCT/US2003/025984 2002-08-19 2003-08-19 Evolving new molecular function WO2004016767A2 (en)

Priority Applications (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP2005502071A JP4657919B2 (en) 2002-08-19 2003-08-19 Evolving new molecular functions
CA2495881A CA2495881C (en) 2002-08-19 2003-08-19 Evolving new molecular function
AU2003263937A AU2003263937B2 (en) 2002-08-19 2003-08-19 Evolving new molecular function
EP03788662.9A EP1540013B1 (en) 2002-08-19 2003-08-19 Evolving new molecular function
AU2010202702A AU2010202702B2 (en) 2002-08-19 2010-06-29 Evolving new molecular function

Applications Claiming Priority (14)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US40439502P 2002-08-19 2002-08-19
US60/404,395 2002-08-19
US41966702P 2002-10-18 2002-10-18
US60/419,667 2002-10-18
US43281202P 2002-12-11 2002-12-11
US60/432,812 2002-12-11
US44477003P 2003-02-04 2003-02-04
US60/444,770 2003-02-04
US45778903P 2003-03-26 2003-03-26
US60/457,789 2003-03-26
US46986603P 2003-05-12 2003-05-12
US60/469,866 2003-05-12
US47949403P 2003-06-18 2003-06-18
US60/479,494 2003-06-18

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2004016767A2 true WO2004016767A2 (en) 2004-02-26
WO2004016767A3 WO2004016767A3 (en) 2005-03-24

Family

ID=31892407

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2003/025984 WO2004016767A2 (en) 2002-08-19 2003-08-19 Evolving new molecular function

Country Status (6)

Country Link
US (3) US7491494B2 (en)
EP (1) EP1540013B1 (en)
JP (2) JP4657919B2 (en)
AU (2) AU2003263937B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2495881C (en)
WO (1) WO2004016767A2 (en)

Cited By (48)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2004083427A2 (en) * 2003-03-20 2004-09-30 Nuevolution A/S Ligational encoding of small molecules
WO2005090566A2 (en) * 2004-03-22 2005-09-29 Nuevolution A/S Ligational encoding using building block oligonucleotides
WO2006048025A1 (en) 2004-11-08 2006-05-11 Vipergen Aps Structural nucleic acid guided chemical synthesis
WO2006053571A2 (en) * 2004-11-22 2006-05-26 Peter Birk Rasmussen Template directed split and mix systhesis of small molecule libraries
WO2006079061A2 (en) * 2005-01-21 2006-07-27 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Free reactant use in nucleic acid-templated synthesis
JP2006320271A (en) * 2005-05-20 2006-11-30 Tokyo Institute Of Technology Method for evaluation of binding between low molecular weight compound with protein
WO2006133312A2 (en) * 2005-06-07 2006-12-14 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Ordered multi-step synthesis by nucleic acid-mediated chemistry
WO2006135654A2 (en) * 2005-06-07 2006-12-21 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Polymer evolution via templated synthesis related applications
WO2006135786A2 (en) * 2005-06-09 2006-12-21 Praecis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
WO2006138560A2 (en) * 2005-06-17 2006-12-28 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Nucleic acid-templated chemistry in organic solvents
WO2007010251A2 (en) * 2005-07-20 2007-01-25 Solexa Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing
US7413854B2 (en) 2002-03-15 2008-08-19 Nuevolution A/S Method for synthesising templated molecules
US7727713B2 (en) 2001-06-20 2010-06-01 Nuevolution A/S Templated molecules and methods for using such molecules
US7928211B2 (en) 2006-05-03 2011-04-19 Vipergen Pharmaceuticals Aps Method for preparing compounds by nucleic acid directed synthesis
US7935658B2 (en) 2003-12-17 2011-05-03 Praecis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
WO2011070333A2 (en) 2009-12-10 2011-06-16 Trillion Genomics Limited Probes
US7972994B2 (en) 2003-12-17 2011-07-05 Glaxosmithkline Llc Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
WO2011089393A1 (en) 2010-01-23 2011-07-28 Trillion Genomics Limited Detection of target nucleic acids based on oligonucleotide hybridization and chemical ligation
US7989395B2 (en) 2005-10-28 2011-08-02 Glaxosmithkline Llc Methods for identifying compounds of interest using encoded libraries
US8722583B2 (en) 2002-10-30 2014-05-13 Nuevolution A/S Method for selecting a chemical entity from a tagged library
US8791053B2 (en) 2002-09-27 2014-07-29 Mpm-Holding Aps Spatially encoded polymer matrix
US8975232B2 (en) 2010-07-29 2015-03-10 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Macrocyclic kinase inhibitors and uses thereof
WO2015135856A1 (en) * 2014-03-14 2015-09-17 Philochem Ag Purification of dna-conjugate products
US9243038B2 (en) 2011-07-01 2016-01-26 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Macrocyclic insulin-degrading enzyme (IDE) inhibitors and uses thereof
US9359601B2 (en) 2009-02-13 2016-06-07 X-Chem, Inc. Methods of creating and screening DNA-encoded libraries
US9914958B2 (en) 2011-11-05 2018-03-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Nucleic acid-based linkers for detecting and measuring interactions
US10730906B2 (en) 2002-08-01 2020-08-04 Nuevolutions A/S Multi-step synthesis of templated molecules
US10865409B2 (en) 2011-09-07 2020-12-15 X-Chem, Inc. Methods for tagging DNA-encoded libraries
US10919037B2 (en) 2016-03-23 2021-02-16 Children's Medical Center Corporation Systems and apparatus for detecting compounds in human biological samples
US11040976B2 (en) 2015-04-24 2021-06-22 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Substrate selective inhibitors of insulin-degrading enzyme (IDE) and uses thereof
US11072816B2 (en) 2017-05-03 2021-07-27 The Broad Institute, Inc. Single-cell proteomic assay using aptamers
US11092607B2 (en) 2015-10-28 2021-08-17 The Board Institute, Inc. Multiplex analysis of single cell constituents
US11118215B2 (en) 2003-09-18 2021-09-14 Nuevolution A/S Method for obtaining structural information concerning an encoded molecule and method for selecting compounds
US11198900B2 (en) 2014-12-06 2021-12-14 Children's Medical Center Corporation Nucleic acid-based linkers for detecting and measuring interactions
US11225655B2 (en) 2010-04-16 2022-01-18 Nuevolution A/S Bi-functional complexes and methods for making and using such complexes
US11396650B2 (en) 2015-06-02 2022-07-26 Children's Medical Center Corporation Nucleic acid complexes for screening barcoded compounds
EP3191605B1 (en) * 2014-09-09 2022-07-27 The Broad Institute, Inc. A droplet-based method and apparatus for composite single-cell nucleic acid analysis
US11591636B2 (en) 2017-11-20 2023-02-28 Children's Medical Center Corporation Force-controlled nanoswitch assays for single-molecule detection in complex biological fluids
US11608527B2 (en) 2011-03-24 2023-03-21 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Single cell nucleic acid detection and analysis
US11674136B2 (en) 2018-02-09 2023-06-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College DNA-templated macrocycle library
US11674135B2 (en) 2012-07-13 2023-06-13 X-Chem, Inc. DNA-encoded libraries having encoding oligonucleotide linkages not readable by polymerases
US11702652B2 (en) 2005-12-01 2023-07-18 Nuevolution A/S Enzymatic encoding methods for efficient synthesis of large libraries
US11713483B2 (en) 2016-02-09 2023-08-01 Children's Medical Center Corporation Method for detection of analytes via polymer complexes
US11873483B2 (en) 2015-03-11 2024-01-16 The Broad Institute, Inc. Proteomic analysis with nucleic acid identifiers
US11904310B2 (en) 2015-10-28 2024-02-20 The Broad Institute, Inc. High-throughput dynamic reagent delivery system
US12071663B2 (en) 2016-01-15 2024-08-27 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Semi-permeable arrays for analyzing biological systems and methods of using same
US12077807B2 (en) 2015-06-27 2024-09-03 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York Compositions and methods for analyte detection using nanoswitches
US12123869B2 (en) 2017-03-23 2024-10-22 Children's Medical Center Corporation Rapid and sensitive detection and quantification of analytes in complex samples using polymer-based methods

Families Citing this family (54)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DE60213826T3 (en) * 2001-03-19 2013-10-17 President And Fellows Of Harvard College DEVELOPMENT OF NEW MOLECULAR FUNCTIONS
DE10147074A1 (en) * 2001-09-25 2003-05-08 Beru Ag Method for operating a multi-stage electric heater consisting of several heating elements
WO2004016767A2 (en) * 2002-08-19 2004-02-26 The President And Fellows Of Harvard College Evolving new molecular function
EP2175019A3 (en) 2002-12-19 2011-04-06 Nuevolution A/S Quasirandom structure and function guided synthesis methods
WO2004074429A2 (en) 2003-02-21 2004-09-02 Nuevolution A/S Method for producing second-generation library
US8017323B2 (en) * 2003-03-26 2011-09-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Free reactant use in nucleic acid-templated synthesis
US7043463B2 (en) 2003-04-04 2006-05-09 Icosystem Corporation Methods and systems for interactive evolutionary computing (IEC)
WO2005013081A2 (en) 2003-08-01 2005-02-10 Icosystem Corporation Methods and systems for applying genetic operators to determine system conditions
US7356518B2 (en) * 2003-08-27 2008-04-08 Icosystem Corporation Methods and systems for multi-participant interactive evolutionary computing
US20090239211A1 (en) * 2004-02-17 2009-09-24 Nuevolution A/S Method For Enrichment Involving Elimination By Mismatch Hybridisation
US7707220B2 (en) * 2004-07-06 2010-04-27 Icosystem Corporation Methods and apparatus for interactive searching techniques
US20060010117A1 (en) * 2004-07-06 2006-01-12 Icosystem Corporation Methods and systems for interactive search
JP2008541698A (en) * 2005-05-03 2008-11-27 アンサンブル ディスカバリー コーポレイション Turnover probe and its use for nucleic acid detection
CN101248189B (en) * 2005-05-26 2013-05-01 通信改革公司 Biodetection by nucleic acid-templated chemistry
US20090163371A1 (en) * 2005-05-31 2009-06-25 Stern Andrew M Anchor-Assisted Fragment Selection and Directed Assembly
EP1899465B1 (en) * 2005-06-17 2010-03-24 The President and Fellows of Harvard College Iterated branching reaction pathways via nucleic acid-mediated chemistry
WO2007011722A2 (en) 2005-07-15 2007-01-25 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Reaction discovery system
US8423323B2 (en) * 2005-09-21 2013-04-16 Icosystem Corporation System and method for aiding product design and quantifying acceptance
JP2009541017A (en) * 2006-06-26 2009-11-26 アイコシステム コーポレーション Method and system for interactive customization of avatars and other biological or inanimate items in video games
US8034563B1 (en) * 2006-09-12 2011-10-11 Steven Albert Benner Activated joining of nucleic acid probes
DK2064348T3 (en) * 2006-09-18 2012-05-29 Ensemble Therapeutics Corp Receptor family profiling
CA2664649A1 (en) * 2006-09-28 2008-05-08 Ensemble Discovery Corporation Compositions and methods for biodetection by nucleic acid-templated chemistry
US7792816B2 (en) * 2007-02-01 2010-09-07 Icosystem Corporation Method and system for fast, generic, online and offline, multi-source text analysis and visualization
AU2008282557A1 (en) * 2007-07-27 2009-02-05 Ensemble Discovery Corporation Detection assays and use thereof
CN102245760A (en) 2008-07-07 2011-11-16 牛津纳米孔技术有限公司 Enzyme-pore constructs
US8338565B2 (en) * 2008-08-20 2012-12-25 Ensemble Therapeutics Corporation Macrocyclic compounds for inhibition of tumor necrosis factor alpha
CN102482330A (en) * 2009-01-30 2012-05-30 牛津纳米孔技术有限公司 Enzyme mutant
CA2853829C (en) 2011-07-22 2023-09-26 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Evaluation and improvement of nuclease cleavage specificity
WO2013113127A1 (en) * 2012-02-03 2013-08-08 The Governors Of The University Of Alberta Method of quantifying peptide-derivative libraries using phage display
GB201209239D0 (en) 2012-05-25 2012-07-04 Univ Glasgow Methods of evolutionary synthesis including embodied chemical synthesis
ES2942031T3 (en) * 2013-03-11 2023-05-29 Meso Scale Technologies Llc Improved methods for performing multiplexed assays
US20150044192A1 (en) 2013-08-09 2015-02-12 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Methods for identifying a target site of a cas9 nuclease
US9228207B2 (en) 2013-09-06 2016-01-05 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Switchable gRNAs comprising aptamers
US10077453B2 (en) 2014-07-30 2018-09-18 President And Fellows Of Harvard College CAS9 proteins including ligand-dependent inteins
WO2016109808A1 (en) * 2014-12-31 2016-07-07 Ensemble Therapeutics Corporation Methods and compositions for nucleic acid-templated synthesis of large libraries of complex small molecules
WO2016165621A1 (en) * 2015-04-14 2016-10-20 成都先导药物开发有限公司 Method for solid-phase synthesis of dna-encoded chemical library
IL294014B2 (en) 2015-10-23 2024-07-01 Harvard College Nucleobase editors and uses thereof
EP3472376A4 (en) 2016-06-16 2019-12-18 Richard Edward Watts Oligonucleotide directed and recorded combinatorial synthesis of encoded probe molecules
IL308426A (en) 2016-08-03 2024-01-01 Harvard College Adenosine nucleobase editors and uses thereof
US11661590B2 (en) 2016-08-09 2023-05-30 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Programmable CAS9-recombinase fusion proteins and uses thereof
US11542509B2 (en) 2016-08-24 2023-01-03 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Incorporation of unnatural amino acids into proteins using base editing
WO2018081534A1 (en) 2016-10-28 2018-05-03 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Assay for exo-site binding molecules
DE17829597T1 (en) * 2016-11-30 2019-12-05 Noxxon Pharma Ag METHOD FOR THE POLYALKOXYLATION OF NUCLEIC ACIDS FOR THE RECOVERY AND RE-USE OF AN EXCESSIVE POLYALKOXYLATION REAGENT
WO2018119359A1 (en) 2016-12-23 2018-06-28 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Editing of ccr5 receptor gene to protect against hiv infection
US11898179B2 (en) 2017-03-09 2024-02-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Suppression of pain by gene editing
EP3592777A1 (en) 2017-03-10 2020-01-15 President and Fellows of Harvard College Cytosine to guanine base editor
US11795580B2 (en) 2017-05-02 2023-10-24 Haystack Sciences Corporation Molecules for verifying oligonucleotide directed combinatorial synthesis and methods of making and using the same
US11560566B2 (en) 2017-05-12 2023-01-24 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Aptazyme-embedded guide RNAs for use with CRISPR-Cas9 in genome editing and transcriptional activation
CN111801345A (en) 2017-07-28 2020-10-20 哈佛大学的校长及成员们 Methods and compositions using an evolved base editor for Phage Assisted Continuous Evolution (PACE)
US11319532B2 (en) 2017-08-30 2022-05-03 President And Fellows Of Harvard College High efficiency base editors comprising Gam
CN111757937A (en) 2017-10-16 2020-10-09 布罗德研究所股份有限公司 Use of adenosine base editor
EP3899521A4 (en) 2018-12-20 2022-08-24 Sergey N. Krylov Binder selection using capillary electrophoresis
WO2020191243A1 (en) 2019-03-19 2020-09-24 The Broad Institute, Inc. Methods and compositions for editing nucleotide sequences
DE112021002672T5 (en) 2020-05-08 2023-04-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS FOR EDIT BOTH STRANDS SIMULTANEOUSLY OF A DOUBLE STRANDED NUCLEOTIDE TARGET SEQUENCE

Family Cites Families (84)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US578160A (en) * 1897-03-02 Weighing-machine
US4863857A (en) * 1985-03-01 1989-09-05 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Polypeptide complementary to peptides or proteins having an amino acid sequence or nucleotide coding sequence at least partially known
US5506337A (en) * 1985-03-15 1996-04-09 Antivirals Inc. Morpholino-subunit combinatorial library and method
US4683202A (en) * 1985-03-28 1987-07-28 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying nucleic acid sequences
US5449602A (en) 1988-01-13 1995-09-12 Amoco Corporation Template-directed photoligation
US5162218A (en) * 1988-11-18 1992-11-10 The Regents Of The University Of California Conjugated polypeptides and methods for their preparation
US6291161B1 (en) * 1989-05-16 2001-09-18 Scripps Research Institute Method for tapping the immunological repertiore
US6680192B1 (en) * 1989-05-16 2004-01-20 Scripps Research Institute Method for producing polymers having a preselected activity
US6291160B1 (en) * 1989-05-16 2001-09-18 Scripps Research Institute Method for producing polymers having a preselected activity
DK0494955T3 (en) 1989-10-05 1998-10-26 Optein Inc Cell-free synthesis and isolation of novel genes and polypeptides
US5660985A (en) * 1990-06-11 1997-08-26 Nexstar Pharmaceuticals, Inc. High affinity nucleic acid ligands containing modified nucleotides
US5637682A (en) * 1990-06-11 1997-06-10 Nexstar Pharmaceuticals, Inc. High-affinity oligonucleotide ligands to the tachykinin substance P
US5723289A (en) * 1990-06-11 1998-03-03 Nexstar Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Parallel selex
US5843701A (en) * 1990-08-02 1998-12-01 Nexstar Pharmaceticals, Inc. Systematic polypeptide evolution by reverse translation
US20020038000A1 (en) * 1990-08-02 2002-03-28 Larry Gold Systematic polypeptide evolution by reverse translation
AU8498091A (en) 1990-08-02 1992-03-02 Regents Of The University Of Colorado, The Systematic polypeptide evolution by reverse translation
US6037120A (en) * 1995-10-12 2000-03-14 Benner; Steven Albert Recognition of oligonucleotides containing non-standard base pairs
US6140496A (en) * 1990-10-09 2000-10-31 Benner; Steven Albert Precursors for deoxyribonucleotides containing non-standard nucleosides
US5888819A (en) * 1991-03-05 1999-03-30 Molecular Tool, Inc. Method for determining nucleotide identity through primer extension
US5641625A (en) * 1992-05-22 1997-06-24 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Cleaving double-stranded DNA with peptide nucleic acids
US5539082A (en) * 1993-04-26 1996-07-23 Nielsen; Peter E. Peptide nucleic acids
US5719262A (en) * 1993-11-22 1998-02-17 Buchardt, Deceased; Ole Peptide nucleic acids having amino acid side chains
EP0600965B1 (en) * 1991-08-28 1998-02-18 Roche Diagnostics GmbH Primers for the matrix-dependant, enzymatic synthesis of nucleic acids
US5639603A (en) * 1991-09-18 1997-06-17 Affymax Technologies N.V. Synthesizing and screening molecular diversity
ES2097925T3 (en) 1991-09-18 1997-04-16 Affymax Tech Nv METHOD FOR SYNTHESIZING DIFFERENT OLIGOMER COLLECTIONS.
US5270170A (en) * 1991-10-16 1993-12-14 Affymax Technologies N.V. Peptide library and screening method
ATE241426T1 (en) * 1991-11-22 2003-06-15 Affymetrix Inc A Delaware Corp METHOD FOR PRODUCING POLYMER ARRAYS
US5573905A (en) * 1992-03-30 1996-11-12 The Scripps Research Institute Encoded combinatorial chemical libraries
US5565324A (en) 1992-10-01 1996-10-15 The Trustees Of Columbia University In The City Of New York Complex combinatorial chemical libraries encoded with tags
US5721099A (en) * 1992-10-01 1998-02-24 Trustees Of Columbia University In The City Of New York Complex combinatorial chemical libraries encoded with tags
US6436635B1 (en) * 1992-11-06 2002-08-20 Boston University Solid phase sequencing of double-stranded nucleic acids
US6194144B1 (en) * 1993-01-07 2001-02-27 Sequenom, Inc. DNA sequencing by mass spectrometry
US5547835A (en) * 1993-01-07 1996-08-20 Sequenom, Inc. DNA sequencing by mass spectrometry
US5605798A (en) * 1993-01-07 1997-02-25 Sequenom, Inc. DNA diagnostic based on mass spectrometry
AU687801B2 (en) * 1993-03-19 1998-03-05 Sequenom, Inc. DNA sequencing by mass spectrometry via exonuclease degradation
US6074823A (en) * 1993-03-19 2000-06-13 Sequenom, Inc. DNA sequencing by mass spectrometry via exonuclease degradation
US5840485A (en) * 1993-05-27 1998-11-24 Selectide Corporation Topologically segregated, encoded solid phase libraries
GB9315847D0 (en) * 1993-07-30 1993-09-15 Isis Innovation Tag reagent and assay method
US5922545A (en) * 1993-10-29 1999-07-13 Affymax Technologies N.V. In vitro peptide and antibody display libraries
US6207373B1 (en) * 1998-02-25 2001-03-27 Nanogen, Inc. Methods for determining nature of repeat units in DNA
US5925517A (en) * 1993-11-12 1999-07-20 The Public Health Research Institute Of The City Of New York, Inc. Detectably labeled dual conformation oligonucleotide probes, assays and kits
WO1995014106A2 (en) * 1993-11-17 1995-05-26 Id Biomedical Corporation Cycling probe cleavage detection of nucleic acid sequences
US6127154A (en) * 1994-02-10 2000-10-03 Mosbach; Klaus Methods for direct synthesis of compounds having complementary structure to a desired molecular entity and use thereof
US5605793A (en) * 1994-02-17 1997-02-25 Affymax Technologies N.V. Methods for in vitro recombination
US20030099945A1 (en) * 1994-09-20 2003-05-29 Invenux, Inc. Parallel selex
US6048698A (en) * 1994-09-20 2000-04-11 Nexstar Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Parallel SELEX™
US5597697A (en) * 1994-09-30 1997-01-28 Diamond; Paul Screening assay for inhibitors and activators of RNA and DNA-dependent nucleic acid polymerases
US5559000A (en) * 1995-01-18 1996-09-24 The Scripps Research Institute Encoded reaction cassette
DE19646372C1 (en) 1995-11-11 1997-06-19 Evotec Biosystems Gmbh Conjugates of polypeptide and encoding nucleic acid
US5846839A (en) * 1995-12-22 1998-12-08 Glaxo Group Limited Methods for hard-tagging an encoded synthetic library
AU713667B2 (en) * 1996-04-12 1999-12-09 Phri Properties, Inc. Detection probes, kits and assays
US5998140A (en) * 1996-07-31 1999-12-07 The Scripps Research Institute Complex formation between dsDNA and oligomer of cyclic heterocycles
US6140053A (en) * 1996-11-06 2000-10-31 Sequenom, Inc. DNA sequencing by mass spectrometry via exonuclease degradation
US5958703A (en) * 1996-12-03 1999-09-28 Glaxo Group Limited Use of modified tethers in screening compound libraries
US6080826A (en) * 1997-01-06 2000-06-27 California Institute Of Technology Template-directed ring-closing metathesis and ring-opening metathesis polymerization of functionalized dienes
US6261804B1 (en) 1997-01-21 2001-07-17 The General Hospital Corporation Selection of proteins using RNA-protein fusions
DE69835143T2 (en) * 1997-01-21 2007-06-06 The General Hospital Corp., Boston SELECTION OF PROTEINS BY THE RNA PROTEIN FUSIONS
US6969584B2 (en) * 1997-06-12 2005-11-29 Rigel Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Combinatorial enzymatic complexes
US6607878B2 (en) * 1997-10-06 2003-08-19 Stratagene Collections of uniquely tagged molecules
EP1051515A2 (en) * 1998-01-27 2000-11-15 Cytocell Limited Modified nucleic acid probes and uses thereof
US5945325A (en) * 1998-04-20 1999-08-31 California Institute Of Technology Thermally stable para-nitrobenzyl esterases
US6287765B1 (en) * 1998-05-20 2001-09-11 Molecular Machines, Inc. Methods for detecting and identifying single molecules
US6175001B1 (en) * 1998-10-16 2001-01-16 The Scripps Research Institute Functionalized pyrimidine nucleosides and nucleotides and DNA's incorporating same
CA2346989A1 (en) 1998-10-19 2000-04-27 The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University Dna-templated combinatorial library chemistry
DE69935248T2 (en) 1998-12-02 2007-11-08 Adnexus Therapeutics, Inc., Waltham DNA PROTEIN FUSIONS AND APPLICATIONS THEREOF
CA2403209A1 (en) * 1999-04-08 2000-10-19 Pavel V. Sergeev Synthesis of biologically active compounds in cells
AU779653B2 (en) 1999-08-27 2005-02-03 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Methods for encoding and sorting in vitro translated proteins
US7306904B2 (en) * 2000-02-18 2007-12-11 Olink Ab Methods and kits for proximity probing
US6511809B2 (en) * 2000-06-13 2003-01-28 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Method for the detection of an analyte by means of a nucleic acid reporter
DE60213826T3 (en) * 2001-03-19 2013-10-17 President And Fellows Of Harvard College DEVELOPMENT OF NEW MOLECULAR FUNCTIONS
WO2002102820A1 (en) * 2001-06-20 2002-12-27 Nuevolution A/S Nucleoside derivatives for library preparation
US20030143561A1 (en) * 2001-06-20 2003-07-31 Nuevolution A/S Nucleoside derivatives for library preparation
CA2468733C (en) * 2001-11-30 2013-06-11 Biogen Idec Ma Inc. Antibodies against monocyte chemotactic proteins
US20060154246A1 (en) * 2002-03-08 2006-07-13 Dario Neri Encoded self-assembling chemical libraries (esachel)
EP1487978B1 (en) * 2002-03-15 2008-11-19 Nuevolution A/S An improved method for synthesising templated molecules
WO2004016767A2 (en) * 2002-08-19 2004-02-26 The President And Fellows Of Harvard College Evolving new molecular function
WO2004083427A2 (en) * 2003-03-20 2004-09-30 Nuevolution A/S Ligational encoding of small molecules
US8017323B2 (en) * 2003-03-26 2011-09-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Free reactant use in nucleic acid-templated synthesis
TWI375796B (en) * 2003-04-18 2012-11-01 Becton Dickinson Co Immuno-amplification
EP1888746B1 (en) * 2005-06-07 2010-03-17 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Ordered multi-step synthesis by nucleic acid-mediated chemistry
US20090035824A1 (en) * 2005-06-17 2009-02-05 Liu David R Nucleic acid-templated chemistry in organic solvents
EP1899465B1 (en) 2005-06-17 2010-03-24 The President and Fellows of Harvard College Iterated branching reaction pathways via nucleic acid-mediated chemistry
WO2009105657A1 (en) 2008-02-22 2009-08-27 Ensemble Discovery Corporation Compositions and methods for catalyzing dna-programmed chemistry
US8338565B2 (en) 2008-08-20 2012-12-25 Ensemble Therapeutics Corporation Macrocyclic compounds for inhibition of tumor necrosis factor alpha

Non-Patent Citations (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
CHAN, B.: 'Intra-tRNA distance measurements for nucleocapsid protein-dependent tRNA unwinding during priming of HIV reverse transcription' PROC.NATL.ACAD.SCI. USA vol. 96, 1999, pages 459 - 464, XP002984827 *
NAZARENKO, I.A.: 'Aclosed tube format for amplification and detection of DNA based on energy transfer' NUCLEIC ACIDS RESEARCH vol. 25, no. 12, 1997, pages 2516 - 2521, XP002094959 *

Cited By (87)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7727713B2 (en) 2001-06-20 2010-06-01 Nuevolution A/S Templated molecules and methods for using such molecules
US8808984B2 (en) 2002-03-15 2014-08-19 Neuvolution A/S Method for synthesising templated molecules
US7413854B2 (en) 2002-03-15 2008-08-19 Nuevolution A/S Method for synthesising templated molecules
US10731151B2 (en) 2002-03-15 2020-08-04 Nuevolution A/S Method for synthesising templated molecules
US10730906B2 (en) 2002-08-01 2020-08-04 Nuevolutions A/S Multi-step synthesis of templated molecules
US8791053B2 (en) 2002-09-27 2014-07-29 Mpm-Holding Aps Spatially encoded polymer matrix
US11001835B2 (en) 2002-10-30 2021-05-11 Nuevolution A/S Method for the synthesis of a bifunctional complex
US10077440B2 (en) 2002-10-30 2018-09-18 Nuevolution A/S Method for the synthesis of a bifunctional complex
US8722583B2 (en) 2002-10-30 2014-05-13 Nuevolution A/S Method for selecting a chemical entity from a tagged library
US7915201B2 (en) 2003-03-20 2011-03-29 Nuevolution A/S Ligational encoding of small molecules
EP2236606A3 (en) * 2003-03-20 2010-10-20 Nuevolution A/S Ligational encoding of small molecules
WO2004083427A3 (en) * 2003-03-20 2005-02-17 Nuevolution As Ligational encoding of small molecules
WO2004083427A2 (en) * 2003-03-20 2004-09-30 Nuevolution A/S Ligational encoding of small molecules
US11118215B2 (en) 2003-09-18 2021-09-14 Nuevolution A/S Method for obtaining structural information concerning an encoded molecule and method for selecting compounds
US11965209B2 (en) 2003-09-18 2024-04-23 Nuevolution A/S Method for obtaining structural information concerning an encoded molecule and method for selecting compounds
US8410028B2 (en) 2003-12-17 2013-04-02 Glaxosmithkline Llc Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
US7972994B2 (en) 2003-12-17 2011-07-05 Glaxosmithkline Llc Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
US7972992B2 (en) 2003-12-17 2011-07-05 Praecis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
US7935658B2 (en) 2003-12-17 2011-05-03 Praecis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
US7704925B2 (en) 2004-03-22 2010-04-27 Nuevolution A/S Ligational encoding using building block oligonucleotides
WO2005090566A2 (en) * 2004-03-22 2005-09-29 Nuevolution A/S Ligational encoding using building block oligonucleotides
WO2005090566A3 (en) * 2004-03-22 2006-03-09 Nuevolution As Ligational encoding using building block oligonucleotides
WO2006048025A1 (en) 2004-11-08 2006-05-11 Vipergen Aps Structural nucleic acid guided chemical synthesis
WO2006053571A2 (en) * 2004-11-22 2006-05-26 Peter Birk Rasmussen Template directed split and mix systhesis of small molecule libraries
US8168381B2 (en) 2004-11-22 2012-05-01 Peter Birk Rasmussen Template directed split and mix systhesis of small molecule libraries
US8951728B2 (en) 2004-11-22 2015-02-10 Chemgene Holding Aps Template directed split and mix synthesis of small molecule libraries
WO2006053571A3 (en) * 2004-11-22 2006-08-17 Peter Birk Rasmussen Template directed split and mix systhesis of small molecule libraries
AU2006206219B2 (en) * 2005-01-21 2012-07-26 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Free reactant use in nucleic acid-templated synthesis
WO2006079061A2 (en) * 2005-01-21 2006-07-27 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Free reactant use in nucleic acid-templated synthesis
WO2006079061A3 (en) * 2005-01-21 2006-09-28 Harvard College Free reactant use in nucleic acid-templated synthesis
CN101107357B (en) * 2005-01-21 2013-01-02 哈佛大学校长及研究员协会 Free reactant use in nucleic acid-templated synthesis
JP2008528000A (en) * 2005-01-21 2008-07-31 プレジデント・アンド・フェロウズ・オブ・ハーバード・カレッジ Free reactants used in nucleic acid template synthesis
JP2006320271A (en) * 2005-05-20 2006-11-30 Tokyo Institute Of Technology Method for evaluation of binding between low molecular weight compound with protein
WO2006133312A3 (en) * 2005-06-07 2007-07-26 Harvard College Ordered multi-step synthesis by nucleic acid-mediated chemistry
WO2006135654A2 (en) * 2005-06-07 2006-12-21 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Polymer evolution via templated synthesis related applications
WO2006133312A2 (en) * 2005-06-07 2006-12-14 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Ordered multi-step synthesis by nucleic acid-mediated chemistry
WO2006135654A3 (en) * 2005-06-07 2007-04-05 Harvard College Polymer evolution via templated synthesis related applications
KR101346432B1 (en) * 2005-06-09 2014-02-14 프래시스 파마슈티컬즈 인코포레이티드 Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
EP2258870A3 (en) * 2005-06-09 2011-11-30 Praecis Pharmaceuticals Inc. Method for identifying compounds which bind to biological target molecule
EP2338990A3 (en) * 2005-06-09 2011-10-19 Praecis Pharmaceuticals Inc. Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
WO2006135786A3 (en) * 2005-06-09 2007-06-21 Praecis Pharm Inc Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
WO2006135786A2 (en) * 2005-06-09 2006-12-21 Praecis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods for synthesis of encoded libraries
WO2006138560A3 (en) * 2005-06-17 2007-05-03 Harvard College Nucleic acid-templated chemistry in organic solvents
WO2006138560A2 (en) * 2005-06-17 2006-12-28 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Nucleic acid-templated chemistry in organic solvents
US8715966B2 (en) 2005-07-20 2014-05-06 Illumina Cambridge Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing
US9999866B2 (en) 2005-07-20 2018-06-19 Illumina Cambridge Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing
US9085802B2 (en) 2005-07-20 2015-07-21 Illumina Cambridge Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing
WO2007010251A3 (en) * 2005-07-20 2007-08-30 Solexa Ltd Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing
WO2007010251A2 (en) * 2005-07-20 2007-01-25 Solexa Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing
US9498763B2 (en) 2005-07-20 2016-11-22 Illumina Cambridge Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing
US10710046B2 (en) 2005-07-20 2020-07-14 Illumina Cambridge Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing
US7989395B2 (en) 2005-10-28 2011-08-02 Glaxosmithkline Llc Methods for identifying compounds of interest using encoded libraries
US11702652B2 (en) 2005-12-01 2023-07-18 Nuevolution A/S Enzymatic encoding methods for efficient synthesis of large libraries
US7928211B2 (en) 2006-05-03 2011-04-19 Vipergen Pharmaceuticals Aps Method for preparing compounds by nucleic acid directed synthesis
US9359601B2 (en) 2009-02-13 2016-06-07 X-Chem, Inc. Methods of creating and screening DNA-encoded libraries
US11168321B2 (en) 2009-02-13 2021-11-09 X-Chem, Inc. Methods of creating and screening DNA-encoded libraries
WO2011070333A2 (en) 2009-12-10 2011-06-16 Trillion Genomics Limited Probes
WO2011089393A1 (en) 2010-01-23 2011-07-28 Trillion Genomics Limited Detection of target nucleic acids based on oligonucleotide hybridization and chemical ligation
US11225655B2 (en) 2010-04-16 2022-01-18 Nuevolution A/S Bi-functional complexes and methods for making and using such complexes
US8975232B2 (en) 2010-07-29 2015-03-10 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Macrocyclic kinase inhibitors and uses thereof
US11629379B2 (en) 2011-03-24 2023-04-18 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Single cell nucleic acid detection and analysis
US11608527B2 (en) 2011-03-24 2023-03-21 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Single cell nucleic acid detection and analysis
US11834712B2 (en) 2011-03-24 2023-12-05 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Single cell nucleic acid detection and analysis
US9610322B2 (en) 2011-07-01 2017-04-04 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Macrocyclic insulin-degrading enzyme (IDE) inhibitors and uses thereof
US9243038B2 (en) 2011-07-01 2016-01-26 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Macrocyclic insulin-degrading enzyme (IDE) inhibitors and uses thereof
US10865409B2 (en) 2011-09-07 2020-12-15 X-Chem, Inc. Methods for tagging DNA-encoded libraries
US9914958B2 (en) 2011-11-05 2018-03-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Nucleic acid-based linkers for detecting and measuring interactions
US11674135B2 (en) 2012-07-13 2023-06-13 X-Chem, Inc. DNA-encoded libraries having encoding oligonucleotide linkages not readable by polymerases
WO2015135856A1 (en) * 2014-03-14 2015-09-17 Philochem Ag Purification of dna-conjugate products
US11597964B2 (en) 2014-09-09 2023-03-07 The Broad Institute, Inc. Droplet-based method and apparatus for composite single-cell nucleic acid analysis
EP4105337A1 (en) * 2014-09-09 2022-12-21 The Broad Institute, Inc. A droplet-based method and apparatus for composite single-cell nucleic acid analysis
US11566279B2 (en) 2014-09-09 2023-01-31 The Broad Institute, Inc. Droplet-based method and apparatus for composite single-cell nucleic acid analysis
EP3191605B1 (en) * 2014-09-09 2022-07-27 The Broad Institute, Inc. A droplet-based method and apparatus for composite single-cell nucleic acid analysis
US11198900B2 (en) 2014-12-06 2021-12-14 Children's Medical Center Corporation Nucleic acid-based linkers for detecting and measuring interactions
US11873483B2 (en) 2015-03-11 2024-01-16 The Broad Institute, Inc. Proteomic analysis with nucleic acid identifiers
US11040976B2 (en) 2015-04-24 2021-06-22 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Substrate selective inhibitors of insulin-degrading enzyme (IDE) and uses thereof
US11396650B2 (en) 2015-06-02 2022-07-26 Children's Medical Center Corporation Nucleic acid complexes for screening barcoded compounds
US12077807B2 (en) 2015-06-27 2024-09-03 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York Compositions and methods for analyte detection using nanoswitches
US11904310B2 (en) 2015-10-28 2024-02-20 The Broad Institute, Inc. High-throughput dynamic reagent delivery system
US11092607B2 (en) 2015-10-28 2021-08-17 The Board Institute, Inc. Multiplex analysis of single cell constituents
US12071663B2 (en) 2016-01-15 2024-08-27 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Semi-permeable arrays for analyzing biological systems and methods of using same
US11713483B2 (en) 2016-02-09 2023-08-01 Children's Medical Center Corporation Method for detection of analytes via polymer complexes
US10919037B2 (en) 2016-03-23 2021-02-16 Children's Medical Center Corporation Systems and apparatus for detecting compounds in human biological samples
US12123869B2 (en) 2017-03-23 2024-10-22 Children's Medical Center Corporation Rapid and sensitive detection and quantification of analytes in complex samples using polymer-based methods
US11072816B2 (en) 2017-05-03 2021-07-27 The Broad Institute, Inc. Single-cell proteomic assay using aptamers
US11591636B2 (en) 2017-11-20 2023-02-28 Children's Medical Center Corporation Force-controlled nanoswitch assays for single-molecule detection in complex biological fluids
US11674136B2 (en) 2018-02-09 2023-06-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College DNA-templated macrocycle library

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
WO2004016767A3 (en) 2005-03-24
EP1540013A2 (en) 2005-06-15
US20050170376A1 (en) 2005-08-04
EP1540013A4 (en) 2006-06-28
AU2003263937A1 (en) 2004-03-03
JP5254934B2 (en) 2013-08-07
US8206914B2 (en) 2012-06-26
EP1540013B1 (en) 2015-07-08
AU2010202702B2 (en) 2012-12-06
JP2010046092A (en) 2010-03-04
US20040180412A1 (en) 2004-09-16
JP2005536234A (en) 2005-12-02
AU2010202702A1 (en) 2010-07-15
US7491494B2 (en) 2009-02-17
CA2495881C (en) 2014-07-08
AU2003263937B2 (en) 2010-04-01
US20110190141A1 (en) 2011-08-04
US7771935B2 (en) 2010-08-10
JP4657919B2 (en) 2011-03-23
CA2495881A1 (en) 2004-02-29

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
WO2004016767A2 (en) Evolving new molecular function
EP1899465B1 (en) Iterated branching reaction pathways via nucleic acid-mediated chemistry
EP1888746B1 (en) Ordered multi-step synthesis by nucleic acid-mediated chemistry
JP2005536234A5 (en)
JP5509270B2 (en) Evolution of new molecular functions
US20090035824A1 (en) Nucleic acid-templated chemistry in organic solvents
US20090203530A1 (en) Polymer evolution via templated synthesis
AU2002306777A1 (en) Evolving new molecular function
WO2016109808A1 (en) Methods and compositions for nucleic acid-templated synthesis of large libraries of complex small molecules

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AK Designated states

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): AE AG AL AM AT AU AZ BA BB BG BR BY BZ CA CH CN CO CR CU CZ DE DK DM DZ EC EE ES FI GB GD GE GH GM HR HU ID IL IN IS JP KE KG KP KR KZ LC LK LR LS LT LU LV MA MD MG MK MN MW MX MZ NI NO NZ OM PG PH PL PT RO RU SC SD SE SG SK SL SY TJ TM TN TR TT TZ UA UG UZ VC VN YU ZA ZM ZW

AL Designated countries for regional patents

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): GH GM KE LS MW MZ SD SL SZ TZ UG ZM ZW AM AZ BY KG KZ MD RU TJ TM AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR HU IE IT LU MC NL PT RO SE SI SK TR BF BJ CF CG CI CM GA GN GQ GW ML MR NE SN TD TG

121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application
ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2495881

Country of ref document: CA

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2005502071

Country of ref document: JP

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2003263937

Country of ref document: AU

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2003788662

Country of ref document: EP

WWP Wipo information: published in national office

Ref document number: 2003788662

Country of ref document: EP